]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - doc/misc/gnus.texi
Fix merge conflicts in network-stream-tests.el
[gnu-emacs] / doc / misc / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @include gnus-overrides.texi
4
5 @setfilename ../../info/gnus.info
6 @settitle Gnus Manual
7 @include docstyle.texi
8 @syncodeindex fn cp
9 @syncodeindex vr cp
10 @syncodeindex pg cp
11
12 @copying
13 Copyright @copyright{} 1995--2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14
15 @quotation
16 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
17 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
18 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
19 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual'',
20 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
21 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
22
23 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
24 modify this GNU manual.''
25 @end quotation
26 @end copying
27
28 @iftex
29 @iflatex
30 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
31 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
32 \usepackage{pagestyle}
33 \usepackage{epsfig}
34 \usepackage{pixidx}
35 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
36
37 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
38 \else
39 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
40 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
41 \pdfcompresslevel=9
42 \fi
43
44 \makeindex
45 \begin{document}
46
47 % Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
48 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.13}
49 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
50 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
51
52 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
53
54 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
55 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
56 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
57 \else
58 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
59 \fi
60 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
61 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
62
63 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
64 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
65
66 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
67 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
68 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
70 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
71 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
73 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
75 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
76 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
77 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
78 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
79 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
80 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
81 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
82 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
83 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
84 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
85 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
88 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
89 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
90
91 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
92 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
93 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
94 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
95 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
96 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
97 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
98 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
99 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
100 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
101 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
104
105 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
106 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
107 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
108 }
109
110 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
111
112 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
113 {\mbox{}}
114 }
115
116 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
117 \gnusdimen 0pt
118
119 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
120 \gnuscleardoublepage
121 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
122 \chapter{#2}
123 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
124 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
125 \thispagestyle{empty}
126 \hspace*{-2cm}
127 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
128 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
129 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
130 \end{picture}
131 \clearpage
132 }
133
134 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
135 \begin{figure}
136 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
137 #3
138 \end{picture}
139 \caption{#1}
140 \end{figure}
141 }
142
143 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
144 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
145 }
146
147 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
148 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
149 }
150
151 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
152 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
153 }
154
155 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
156 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
157 }
158
159 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
160
161 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
162 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
163 \section{#1}
164 }
165
166 \newenvironment{codelist}%
167 {\begin{list}{}{
168 }
169 }{\end{list}}
170
171 \newenvironment{asislist}%
172 {\begin{list}{}{
173 }
174 }{\end{list}}
175
176 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
177 {\begin{list}{}{
178 \labelwidth=0cm
179 }
180 }{\end{list}}
181
182 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
183 {\begin{list}{}{
184 }
185 }{\end{list}}
186
187 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
188 {\begin{list}{}{
189 }
190 }{\end{list}}
191
192 \newenvironment{samplist}%
193 {\begin{list}{}{
194 }
195 }{\end{list}}
196
197 \newenvironment{varlist}%
198 {\begin{list}{}{
199 }
200 }{\end{list}}
201
202 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
203 {\begin{list}{}{
204 }
205 }{\end{list}}
206
207 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
208 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
209 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
210
211 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
212 {
213 {
214 \ifodd\count0
215 {
216 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
217 }
218 \else
219 {
220 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
221 }
222 }
223 \fi
224 }
225 }
226 {
227 \ifodd\count0
228 \mbox{} \hfill
229 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
230 \else
231 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
232 \hfill \mbox{}
233 \fi
234 }
235
236 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
237 {
238 {
239 \ifodd\count0
240 {
241 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
242 }
243 \else
244 {
245 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
246 }
247 \fi
248 }
249 }
250 {
251 \ifodd\count0
252 \mbox{} \hfill
253 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
254 \else
255 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
256 \hfill \mbox{}
257 \fi
258 }
259
260 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
261 {
262 {
263 \ifodd\count0
264 {
265 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
266 }
267 \else
268 {
269 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
270 }
271 \fi
272 }
273 }
274 {
275 \ifodd\count0
276 \mbox{} \hfill
277 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
278 \else
279 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
280 \hfill \mbox{}
281 \fi
282 }
283
284 \pagenumbering{roman}
285 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
286
287 @end iflatex
288 @end iftex
289
290 @iftex
291 @iflatex
292
293 \begin{titlepage}
294 {
295
296 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
297 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
298 \parindent=0cm
299 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
300
301 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
302 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
303 \vfill
304 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
305 \vfill
306 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
307 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
308 \newpage
309 }
310
311 \mbox{}
312 \vfill
313
314 \thispagestyle{empty}
315
316 @c @insertcopying
317 \newpage
318 \end{titlepage}
319 @end iflatex
320 @end iftex
321
322 @dircategory Emacs network features
323 @direntry
324 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
325 @end direntry
326 @iftex
327 @finalout
328 @end iftex
329
330
331 @titlepage
332 @ifset WEBHACKDEVEL
333 @title Gnus Manual (DEVELOPMENT VERSION)
334 @end ifset
335 @ifclear WEBHACKDEVEL
336 @title Gnus Manual
337 @end ifclear
338
339 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
340 @page
341 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
342 @insertcopying
343 @end titlepage
344
345 @summarycontents
346 @contents
347
348 @node Top
349 @top The Gnus Newsreader
350
351 @ifinfo
352
353 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
354 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
355 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
356 luck.
357
358 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
359 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
360
361 @ifnottex
362 @insertcopying
363 @end ifnottex
364
365 @end ifinfo
366
367 @iftex
368
369 @iflatex
370 \tableofcontents
371 \gnuscleardoublepage
372 @end iflatex
373
374 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
375 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
376
377 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
378 being accused of plagiarism:
379
380 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
381 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
382 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
383 can even read news with it!
384
385 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
386 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
387 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
388 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
389 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
390 the program.
391
392 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
393 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
394
395 @heading Other related manuals
396 @itemize
397 @item Message manual: Composing messages
398 @item Emacs-MIME: Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
399 @item Sieve: Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
400 @item EasyPG: @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
401 @item SASL: @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
402 @end itemize
403
404 @end iftex
405
406 @menu
407 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
408 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
409 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
410 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
411 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
412 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
413 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
414 * Searching:: Mail and News search engines.
415 * Various:: General purpose settings.
416 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
417 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
418 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
419 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
420 * Key Index:: Key Index.
421
422 @c Doesn't work right in html.
423 @c FIXME Do this in a more standard way.
424 @ifinfo
425 Other related manuals
426
427 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
428 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
429 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
430 * EasyPG:(epa). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
431 * SASL:(sasl). @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
432 @end ifinfo
433
434 @detailmenu
435 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
436
437 Starting Gnus
438
439 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
440 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
441 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
442 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
443 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
444 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
445 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
446 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
447 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
448 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
449
450 New Groups
451
452 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
453 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
454 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
455
456 Group Buffer
457
458 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
459 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
460 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
461 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
462 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
463 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
464 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
465 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
466 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
467 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
468 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
469 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
470 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
471 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
472 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
473 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
474 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
475 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
476
477 Group Buffer Format
478
479 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
480 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
481 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
482
483 Group Topics
484
485 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
486 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
487 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
488 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
489 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
490
491 Misc Group Stuff
492
493 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
494 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
495 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
496 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
497 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
498
499 Summary Buffer
500
501 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
502 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
503 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
504 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
505 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
506 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
507 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
508 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
509 * Threading:: How threads are made.
510 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
511 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
512 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
513 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
514 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
515 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
516 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
517 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
518 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
519 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
520 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
521 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
522 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
523 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
524 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
525 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
526 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
527 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
528 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
529 or reselecting the current group.
530 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
531 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
532 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
533 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
534
535 Summary Buffer Format
536
537 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
538 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
539 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
540 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
541
542 Choosing Articles
543
544 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
545 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
546
547 Reply, Followup and Post
548
549 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
550 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
551 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
552 * Canceling and Superseding::
553
554 Marking Articles
555
556 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
557 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
558 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
559 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
560 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
561 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
562
563 Threading
564
565 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
566 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
567
568 Customizing Threading
569
570 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
571 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
572 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
573 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
574
575 Decoding Articles
576
577 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
578 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
579 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
580 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
581 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
582 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
583
584 Decoding Variables
585
586 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
587 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
588 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
589
590 Article Treatment
591
592 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
593 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
594 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
595 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
596 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
597 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
598 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
599 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
600 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys, Gravatars
601 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
602 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
603
604 Alternative Approaches
605
606 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
607 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
608
609 Various Summary Stuff
610
611 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
612 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
613 * Summary Generation Commands::
614 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
615
616 Article Buffer
617
618 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
619 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
620 * HTML:: Reading @acronym{HTML} messages.
621 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
622 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
623 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
624
625 Composing Messages
626
627 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
628 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
629 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
630 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
631 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
632 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
633 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
634 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
635 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
636
637 Select Methods
638
639 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
640 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
641 * Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
642 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
643 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
644 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
645 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
646 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
647 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
648
649 Server Buffer
650
651 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
652 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
653 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
654 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
655 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
656 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
657 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
658
659 Getting News
660
661 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
662 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
663
664 @acronym{NNTP}
665
666 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
667 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
668 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
669
670 Getting Mail
671
672 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
673 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
674 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
675 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
676 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
677 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
678 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
679 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
680 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
681 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
682 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
683 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
684 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
685
686 Mail Sources
687
688 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
689 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
690 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
691
692 Choosing a Mail Back End
693
694 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
695 * Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
696 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
697 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
698 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
699 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
700 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
701
702 Browsing the Web
703
704 * Archiving Mail::
705 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
706 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
707
708 Other Sources
709
710 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
711 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
712 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
713 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
714 * The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
715
716 Document Groups
717
718 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
719
720 Combined Groups
721
722 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
723
724 Email Based Diary
725
726 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
727 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
728 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
729
730 The NNDiary Back End
731
732 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
733 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
734 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
735
736 The Gnus Diary Library
737
738 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
739 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
740 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
741 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
742
743 Gnus Unplugged
744
745 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
746 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
747 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
748 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
749 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
750 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
751 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
752 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
753 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
754 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
755 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
756 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
757 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
758 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
759
760 Agent Categories
761
762 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
763 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
764 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
765
766 Agent Commands
767
768 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
769 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
770 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
771
772 Scoring
773
774 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
775 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
776 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
777 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
778 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
779 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
780 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
781 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
782 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
783 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
784 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
785 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
786 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
787 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
788 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
789 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
790
791 Advanced Scoring
792
793 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
794 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
795 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
796
797 Searching
798
799 * nnir:: Searching with various engines.
800 * nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
801
802 nnir
803
804 * What is nnir?:: What does nnir do.
805 * Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
806 * Setting up nnir:: How to set up nnir.
807
808 Setting up nnir
809
810 * Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
811
812 Various
813
814 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
815 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
816 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
817 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
818 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
819 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
820 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
821 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
822 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
823 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
824 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
825 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
826 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
827 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
828 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
829 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
830 * The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
831 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
832 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
833
834 Formatting Variables
835
836 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
837 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
838 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
839 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
840 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
841 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
842 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
843 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
844
845 Image Enhancements
846
847 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
848 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
849 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
850 meant to be shown.
851 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
852 * Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
853 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
854
855 Thwarting Email Spam
856
857 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
858 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
859 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
860 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
861
862 Spam Package
863
864 * Spam Package Introduction::
865 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
866 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
867 * Spam and Ham Processors::
868 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
869 * Spam Back Ends::
870 * Extending the Spam package::
871 * Spam Statistics Package::
872
873 Spam Statistics Package
874
875 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
876 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
877 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
878
879 Appendices
880
881 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
882 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
883 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
884 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
885 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
886 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
887 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
888 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
889 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
890
891 History
892
893 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
894 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
895 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
896 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
897 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
898 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
899 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
900 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
901
902 New Features
903
904 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
905 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
906 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
907 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
908 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
909 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
910 * No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13
911 * Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
912
913 Customization
914
915 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
916 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
917 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
918 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
919
920 Gnus Reference Guide
921
922 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
923 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
924 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
925 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
926 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
927 * Group Info:: The group info format.
928 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
929 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
930 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
931
932 Back End Interface
933
934 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
935 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
936 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
937 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
938 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
939 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
940
941 Various File Formats
942
943 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
944 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
945
946 Emacs for Heathens
947
948 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
949 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
950
951 @end detailmenu
952 @end menu
953
954 @node Starting Up
955 @chapter Starting Gnus
956 @cindex starting up
957
958 If you haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs for
959 Heathens} first.
960
961 @kindex M-x gnus
962 @findex gnus
963 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
964 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
965 your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
966 @code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
967 minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
968 @code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
969
970 @findex gnus-other-frame
971 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
972 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
973 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
974
975 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
976 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
977 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
978
979 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
980 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
981
982 @menu
983 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
984 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
985 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
986 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
987 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
988 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
989 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
990 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
991 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
992 @end menu
993
994
995 @node Finding the News
996 @section Finding the News
997 @cindex finding news
998
999 First of all, you should know that there is a special buffer called
1000 @file{*Server*} that lists all the servers Gnus knows about. You can
1001 press @kbd{^} from the Group buffer to see it. In the Server buffer,
1002 you can press @kbd{RET} on a defined server to see all the groups it
1003 serves (subscribed or not!). You can also add or delete servers, edit
1004 a foreign server's definition, agentize or de-agentize a server, and
1005 do many other neat things. @xref{Server Buffer}.
1006 @xref{Foreign Groups}. @xref{Agent Basics}.
1007
1008 @vindex gnus-select-method
1009 @c @head
1010 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
1011 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
1012 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
1013 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
1014 secondary or foreign groups.
1015
1016 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
1017 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
1018
1019 @lisp
1020 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
1021 @end lisp
1022
1023 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
1024
1025 @lisp
1026 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
1027 @end lisp
1028
1029 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
1030 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
1031 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
1032 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
1033
1034 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1035 @cindex NNTPSERVER
1036 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1037 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1038 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1039 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1040 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1041 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1042 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1043
1044 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1045 @kindex B (Group)
1046 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1047 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1048 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1049 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1050 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1051 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1052
1053 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1054 @c @head
1055 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1056 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1057 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1058 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1059 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1060 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1061 groups are.
1062
1063 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1064 you would typically set this variable to
1065
1066 @lisp
1067 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1068 @end lisp
1069
1070
1071
1072 @node The Server is Down
1073 @section The Server is Down
1074 @cindex server errors
1075
1076 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1077 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1078 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1079
1080 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1081 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1082 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1083 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1084 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1085 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1086 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1087
1088 @findex gnus-no-server
1089 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1090 @c @head
1091 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1092 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1093 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1094 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1095 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1096 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1097 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1098
1099
1100 @node Slave Gnusae
1101 @section Slave Gnusae
1102 @cindex slave
1103
1104 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1105 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1106 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1107 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1108
1109 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1110 @file{.newsrc} file.
1111
1112 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1113 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1114 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1115 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1116 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1117 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1118 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1119
1120 @findex gnus-slave
1121 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1122 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1123 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1124 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1125 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1126 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1127 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1128 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1129
1130 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1131 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1132
1133 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1134 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1135 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1136 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1137 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1138
1139
1140
1141 @node New Groups
1142 @section New Groups
1143 @cindex new groups
1144 @cindex subscription
1145
1146 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1147 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1148 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1149 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1150 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1151 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1152 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1153 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1154 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1155
1156 @menu
1157 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1158 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1159 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1160 @end menu
1161
1162
1163 @node Checking New Groups
1164 @subsection Checking New Groups
1165
1166 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing
1167 the list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of
1168 subscribed and dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method.
1169 If @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will
1170 ask the server for new groups since the last time. This is both
1171 faster and cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list
1172 of killed groups (@pxref{Group Levels}) altogether, so you may set
1173 @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to @code{nil}, which will save time both
1174 at startup, at exit, and all over. Saves disk space, too. Why isn't
1175 this the default, then? Unfortunately, not all servers support this
1176 command.
1177
1178 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1179 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1180 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1181 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1182 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1183 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1184 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1185 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1186 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1187 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1188 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1189
1190 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1191 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1192 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1193 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1194 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1195 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1196
1197
1198 @node Subscription Methods
1199 @subsection Subscription Methods
1200
1201 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1202 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1203 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1204
1205 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1206 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1207
1208 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1209
1210 @table @code
1211
1212 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1213 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1214 Make all new groups zombies (@pxref{Group Levels}). This is the
1215 default. You can browse the zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either
1216 kill them all off properly (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them
1217 (with @kbd{u}).
1218
1219 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1220 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1221 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1222 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1223
1224 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1225 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1226 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1227
1228 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1229 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1230 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1231 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1232 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1233 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1234 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1235 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1236 up. Or something like that.
1237
1238 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1239 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1240 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1241 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1242 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1243
1244 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1245 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1246 Kill all new groups.
1247
1248 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1249 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1250 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1251 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1252 topic parameter that looks like
1253
1254 @example
1255 "nnml"
1256 @end example
1257
1258 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1259 that topic.
1260
1261 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1262 top-level topic.
1263
1264 @end table
1265
1266 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1267 A closely related variable is
1268 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1269 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1270 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1271 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1272 hierarchy or not.
1273
1274 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1275 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1276 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1277 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1278
1279
1280 @node Filtering New Groups
1281 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1282
1283 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1284 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1285 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1286
1287 @example
1288 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1289 @end example
1290
1291 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1292 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1293 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1294 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1295 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1296 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1297 subscribing these groups.
1298 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1299 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1300
1301 The ``options -n'' format is very simplistic. The syntax above is all
1302 that is supports: you can force-subscribe hierarchies, or you can
1303 deny hierarchies, and that's it.
1304
1305 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1306 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1307 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1308 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1309 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1310 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1311 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1312 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1313
1314 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1315 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1316 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1317 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1318 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1319 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1320 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1321 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1322 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, @code{nnimap}, and
1323 @code{nnmaildir}) subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this
1324 variable to @code{nil}.
1325
1326 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-categories
1327 As if that wasn't enough, @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-categories} also
1328 allows you to specify that new groups should be subscribed based on the
1329 category their select methods belong to. The default is @samp{(mail
1330 post-mail)}, meaning that all new groups from mail-like backends
1331 should be subscribed automatically.
1332
1333 New groups that match these variables are subscribed using
1334 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1335
1336
1337 @node Changing Servers
1338 @section Changing Servers
1339 @cindex changing servers
1340
1341 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1342 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1343 very flaky and you want to use another.
1344
1345 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1346 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1347
1348 @emph{Wrong!}
1349
1350 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1351 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1352 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1353 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1354 worthless.
1355
1356 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1357 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1358 You can use the @kbd{M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups}
1359 command to clear out all data that you have on your native groups.
1360 Use with caution.
1361
1362 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1363 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1364 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1365 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1366
1367 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1368 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1369 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1370 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1371 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1372 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1373 cache for all groups).
1374
1375
1376 @node Startup Files
1377 @section Startup Files
1378 @cindex startup files
1379 @cindex .newsrc
1380 @cindex .newsrc.el
1381 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1382
1383 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1384 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1385 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1386 read.
1387
1388 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1389 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1390 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1391 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1392 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1393 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1394 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1395
1396 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1397 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1398 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1399 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1400 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1401 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1402
1403 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1404 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1405 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1406 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1407 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1408 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1409 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1410 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1411 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1412 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1413 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1414 news reader.
1415
1416 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1417 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1418 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1419 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1420 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1421 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1422 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1423 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1424 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1425 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1426 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1427 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1428
1429 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1430 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1431 @vindex version-control
1432 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1433 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1434 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1435 If you want to keep multiple numbered backups of this file, set
1436 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1437 @code{version-control} variable.
1438
1439 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1440 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1441 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1442 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1443 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1444 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1445 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1446 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1447 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1448 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1449
1450 @lisp
1451 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1452 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1453
1454 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1455 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1456 @end lisp
1457
1458 @vindex gnus-init-file
1459 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1460 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1461 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1462 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1463 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1464 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1465 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1466 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1467 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1468 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1469 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1470 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1471 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1472
1473
1474 @node Auto Save
1475 @section Auto Save
1476 @cindex dribble file
1477 @cindex auto-save
1478
1479 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1480 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1481 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1482 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1483 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1484 this file.
1485
1486 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1487 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1488 saved.
1489
1490 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1491 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1492 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1493
1494 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1495 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1496 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1497 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1498 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1499 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1500
1501 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1502 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1503 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1504
1505
1506 @node The Active File
1507 @section The Active File
1508 @cindex active file
1509 @cindex ignored groups
1510
1511 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1512 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1513 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1514
1515 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1516 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1517 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1518 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1519 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1520 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1521 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1522
1523 @c This variable is
1524 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1525 @c if you set it to anything else.
1526
1527 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1528 @c @head
1529 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1530 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1531 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1532
1533 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1534 you actually subscribe to.
1535
1536 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1537 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1538 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1539 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1540
1541 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1542 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1543 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1544 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1545 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1546 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1547
1548 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1549 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1550 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1551 variable.
1552
1553 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1554 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1555 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1556 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1557 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1558 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1559
1560 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1561 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1562
1563 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1564 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1565
1566 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1567 secondary select methods.
1568
1569
1570 @node Startup Variables
1571 @section Startup Variables
1572
1573 @table @code
1574
1575 @item gnus-load-hook
1576 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1577 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1578 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1579 times you start Gnus.
1580
1581 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1582 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1583 A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is started.
1584
1585 @item gnus-before-resume-hook
1586 @vindex gnus-before-resume-hook
1587 A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is resumed after a suspend.
1588
1589 @item gnus-startup-hook
1590 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1591 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1592
1593 @item gnus-started-hook
1594 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1595 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1596 successfully.
1597
1598 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1599 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1600 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1601 generating the group buffer.
1602
1603 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1604 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1605 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1606 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1607 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1608 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1609 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1610 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1611
1612 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1613 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1614 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1615 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1616 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1617 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1618
1619 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1620 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1621 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1622
1623 @item gnus-use-backend-marks
1624 @vindex gnus-use-backend-marks
1625 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will store article marks both in the
1626 @file{.newsrc.eld} file and in the backends. This will slow down
1627 group operation some.
1628
1629 @end table
1630
1631
1632 @node Group Buffer
1633 @chapter Group Buffer
1634 @cindex group buffer
1635
1636 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1637 @c
1638 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1639 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1640 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1641 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1642 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1643 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1644 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1645 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1646 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1647 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1648 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1649 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1650 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1651 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1652 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1653 @c human rights at 9...
1654
1655
1656 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1657 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1658 long as Gnus is active.
1659
1660 @iftex
1661 @iflatex
1662 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1663 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1664 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1665 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1666 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1667 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1668 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1669 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1670 }
1671 @end iflatex
1672 @end iftex
1673
1674 @menu
1675 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1676 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1677 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1678 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1679 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1680 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1681 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1682 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1683 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1684 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1685 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1686 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1687 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1688 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1689 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1690 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1691 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
1692 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1693 @end menu
1694
1695
1696 @node Group Buffer Format
1697 @section Group Buffer Format
1698
1699 @menu
1700 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1701 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1702 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1703 @end menu
1704
1705 You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1706 customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1707 available in Emacs.
1708
1709 The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1710 cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1711 slower. You can disable this via the variable
1712 @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1713 Emacs version.
1714
1715 @node Group Line Specification
1716 @subsection Group Line Specification
1717 @cindex group buffer format
1718
1719 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1720 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1721
1722 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1723
1724 @example
1725 25: news.announce.newusers
1726 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1727 @end example
1728
1729 Quite simple, huh?
1730
1731 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1732 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1733 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1734 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1735
1736 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1737 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1738 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1739 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1740 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C@.
1741 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1742
1743 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1744
1745 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1746 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1747 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1748 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1749 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1750
1751 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1752 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1753 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1754
1755 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1756
1757 @table @samp
1758
1759 @item M
1760 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1761
1762 @item S
1763 Whether the group is subscribed.
1764
1765 @item L
1766 Level of subscribedness.
1767
1768 @item N
1769 Number of unread articles.
1770
1771 @item I
1772 Number of dormant articles.
1773
1774 @item T
1775 Number of ticked articles.
1776
1777 @item R
1778 Number of read articles.
1779
1780 @item U
1781 Number of unseen articles.
1782
1783 @item t
1784 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1785 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1786
1787 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1788 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1789 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1790 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1791 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1792 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1793 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job.
1794
1795 The nnml backend (@pxref{Mail Spool}) has a feature called ``group
1796 compaction'' which circumvents this deficiency: the idea is to
1797 renumber all articles from 1, removing all gaps between numbers, hence
1798 getting a correct total count. Other backends may support this in the
1799 future. In order to keep your total article count relatively up to
1800 date, you might want to compact your groups (or even directly your
1801 server) from time to time. @xref{Misc Group Stuff}, @xref{Server Commands}.
1802
1803 @item y
1804 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1805
1806 @item i
1807 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1808
1809 @item g
1810 Full group name.
1811
1812 @item G
1813 Group name.
1814
1815 @item C
1816 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1817 comment element in the group parameters.
1818
1819 @item D
1820 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1821 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1822 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1823 command.
1824
1825 @item o
1826 @samp{m} if moderated.
1827
1828 @item O
1829 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1830
1831 @item s
1832 Select method.
1833
1834 @item B
1835 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1836
1837 @item n
1838 Select from where.
1839
1840 @item z
1841 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1842 used.
1843
1844 @item P
1845 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1846
1847 @item c
1848 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1849 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1850 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1851 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1852 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1853
1854 @item m
1855 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1856 @cindex %
1857 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1858 the group lately.
1859
1860 @item p
1861 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1862
1863 @item d
1864 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1865 Timestamp}).
1866
1867 @item F
1868 The disk space used by the articles fetched by both the cache and
1869 agent. The value is automatically scaled to bytes(B), kilobytes(K),
1870 megabytes(M), or gigabytes(G) to minimize the column width. A format
1871 of %7F is sufficient for a fixed-width column.
1872
1873 @item u
1874 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1875 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1876 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1877 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1878 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1879 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1880 specifier.
1881 @end table
1882
1883 @cindex *
1884 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1885 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1886 group, or a bogus native group.
1887
1888
1889 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1890 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1891 @cindex group mode line
1892
1893 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1894 The mode line can be changed by setting
1895 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1896 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1897
1898 @table @samp
1899 @item S
1900 The native news server.
1901 @item M
1902 The native select method.
1903 @end table
1904
1905
1906 @node Group Highlighting
1907 @subsection Group Highlighting
1908 @cindex highlighting
1909 @cindex group highlighting
1910
1911 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1912 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1913 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1914 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1915 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1916
1917 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1918 background is dark:
1919
1920 @lisp
1921 (cond (window-system
1922 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1923 (defface my-group-face-1
1924 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1925 (defface my-group-face-2
1926 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1927 "Second group face")
1928 (defface my-group-face-3
1929 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1930 (defface my-group-face-4
1931 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1932 (defface my-group-face-5
1933 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1934
1935 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1936 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1937 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1938 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1939 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1940 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1941 @end lisp
1942
1943 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1944
1945 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1946 include:
1947
1948 @table @code
1949 @item group
1950 The group name.
1951 @item unread
1952 The number of unread articles in the group.
1953 @item method
1954 The select method.
1955 @item mailp
1956 Whether the group is a mail group.
1957 @item level
1958 The level of the group.
1959 @item score
1960 The score of the group.
1961 @item ticked
1962 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1963 @item total
1964 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1965 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1966 @item topic
1967 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1968 topic being inserted.
1969 @end table
1970
1971 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1972 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1973 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1974
1975 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1976 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1977 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1978 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
1979
1980
1981 @node Group Maneuvering
1982 @section Group Maneuvering
1983 @cindex group movement
1984
1985 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1986 expected, hopefully.
1987
1988 @table @kbd
1989
1990 @item n
1991 @kindex n (Group)
1992 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1993 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1994 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1995
1996 @item p
1997 @itemx DEL
1998 @kindex DEL (Group)
1999 @kindex p (Group)
2000 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
2001 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
2002 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
2003
2004 @item N
2005 @kindex N (Group)
2006 @findex gnus-group-next-group
2007 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2008
2009 @item P
2010 @kindex P (Group)
2011 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2012 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2013
2014 @item M-n
2015 @kindex M-n (Group)
2016 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2017 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2018 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2019
2020 @item M-p
2021 @kindex M-p (Group)
2022 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2023 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2024 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2025 @end table
2026
2027 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2028
2029 @table @kbd
2030
2031 @item j
2032 @kindex j (Group)
2033 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2034 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2035 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2036 like living groups.
2037
2038 @item ,
2039 @kindex , (Group)
2040 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2041 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2042 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2043
2044 @item .
2045 @kindex . (Group)
2046 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2047 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2048 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2049 @end table
2050
2051 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2052 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2053 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2054 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2055 is @code{t}.
2056
2057 @vindex gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit
2058 If @code{gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit} is @code{t}, when a summary is
2059 exited, the point in the group buffer is moved to the next unread group.
2060 Otherwise, the point is set to the group just exited. The default is
2061 @code{t}.
2062
2063 @node Selecting a Group
2064 @section Selecting a Group
2065 @cindex group selection
2066
2067 @table @kbd
2068
2069 @item SPACE
2070 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2071 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2072 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2073 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2074 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2075 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2076 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2077 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2078 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2079 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2080
2081 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2082 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2083 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2084
2085 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2086 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2087 ones.
2088
2089 @item RET
2090 @kindex RET (Group)
2091 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2092 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2093 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2094 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2095 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2096 entry.
2097
2098 @item M-RET
2099 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2100 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2101 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2102 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2103 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2104 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2105 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2106 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2107 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2108 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2109
2110 @item M-SPACE
2111 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2112 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2113 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2114 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2115 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2116
2117 @item C-M-RET
2118 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2119 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2120 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2121 doing any processing of its contents
2122 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2123 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2124 manner will have no permanent effects.
2125
2126 @end table
2127
2128 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2129 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2130 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2131 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2132 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2133 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2134 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2135 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2136 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2137 most recently will be fetched.
2138
2139 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2140 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2141 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2142 newsgroups.
2143
2144 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles
2145 In groups in some news servers, there might be a big gap between a few
2146 very old articles that will never be expired and the recent ones. In
2147 such a case, the server will return the data like @code{(1 . 30000000)}
2148 for the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, for example. Even if there
2149 are actually only the articles 1--10 and 29999900--30000000, Gnus doesn't
2150 know it at first and prepares for getting 30000000 articles. However,
2151 it will consume hundreds megabytes of memories and might make Emacs get
2152 stuck as the case may be. If you use such news servers, set the
2153 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} to a positive number.
2154 The value means that Gnus ignores articles other than this number of the
2155 latest ones in every group. For instance, the value 10000 makes Gnus
2156 get only the articles 29990001--30000000 (if the latest article number is
2157 30000000 in a group). Note that setting this variable to a number might
2158 prevent you from reading very old articles. The default value of the
2159 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} is @code{nil}, which
2160 means Gnus never ignores old articles.
2161
2162 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2163 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2164 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2165 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2166 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2167 Which article this is controlled by the
2168 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2169 variable are:
2170
2171 @table @code
2172
2173 @item unread
2174 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2175
2176 @item first
2177 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2178
2179 @item unseen
2180 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2181
2182 @item unseen-or-unread
2183 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2184 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2185 unread article.
2186
2187 @item best
2188 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2189
2190 @end table
2191
2192 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2193 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2194
2195 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2196 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2197 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2198 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2199 selected.
2200
2201
2202 @node Subscription Commands
2203 @section Subscription Commands
2204 @cindex subscription
2205
2206 The following commands allow for managing your subscriptions in the
2207 Group buffer. If you want to subscribe to many groups, it's probably
2208 more convenient to go to the @ref{Server Buffer}, and choose the
2209 server there using @kbd{RET} or @kbd{SPC}. Then you'll have the
2210 commands listed in @ref{Browse Foreign Server} at hand.
2211
2212 @table @kbd
2213
2214 @item S t
2215 @itemx u
2216 @kindex S t (Group)
2217 @kindex u (Group)
2218 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2219 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2220 Toggle subscription to the current group
2221 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2222
2223 @item S s
2224 @itemx U
2225 @kindex S s (Group)
2226 @kindex U (Group)
2227 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2228 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2229 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2230 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2231
2232 @item S k
2233 @itemx C-k
2234 @kindex S k (Group)
2235 @kindex C-k (Group)
2236 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2237 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2238 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2239
2240 @item S y
2241 @itemx C-y
2242 @kindex S y (Group)
2243 @kindex C-y (Group)
2244 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2245 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2246
2247 @item C-x C-t
2248 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2249 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2250 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2251 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2252 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2253
2254 @item S w
2255 @itemx C-w
2256 @kindex S w (Group)
2257 @kindex C-w (Group)
2258 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2259 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2260
2261 @item S z
2262 @kindex S z (Group)
2263 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2264 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2265
2266 @item S C-k
2267 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2268 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2269 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2270 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2271 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2272 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2273 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2274 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2275 @file{.newsrc} file.
2276
2277 @end table
2278
2279 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2280
2281
2282 @node Group Data
2283 @section Group Data
2284
2285 @table @kbd
2286
2287 @item c
2288 @kindex c (Group)
2289 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2290 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2291 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2292 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2293 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2294 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2295 the group buffer.
2296
2297 @item C
2298 @kindex C (Group)
2299 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2300 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2301 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2302
2303 @item M-c
2304 @kindex M-c (Group)
2305 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2306 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2307 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2308
2309 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2310 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2311 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2312 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2313 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2314 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2315 caution.
2316
2317 @end table
2318
2319
2320 @node Group Levels
2321 @section Group Levels
2322 @cindex group level
2323 @cindex level
2324
2325 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2326 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2327 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2328 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2329 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2330
2331 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2332
2333 @table @kbd
2334
2335 @item S l
2336 @kindex S l (Group)
2337 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2338 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2339 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2340 prompted for a level.
2341 @end table
2342
2343 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2344 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2345 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2346 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2347 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2348 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2349 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2350 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2351 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2352 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2353 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2354 same, but zombie and killed groups store no information on what articles
2355 you have read, etc. This distinction between dead and living
2356 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2357 reasons of efficiency.
2358
2359 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2360 low levels (e.g., 1 or 2).
2361
2362 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2363 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2364 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2365 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2366 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2367 groups are hidden, in a way.
2368
2369 @cindex zombie groups
2370 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2371 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2372 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2373 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2374 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2375 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2376
2377 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2378 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2379 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2380 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2381 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2382 list of killed groups.)
2383
2384 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2385 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2386 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2387
2388 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2389 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2390 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2391 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2392 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2393 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2394 relevant valid ranges.
2395
2396 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2397 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2398 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2399 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2400 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2401 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2402 rest.
2403
2404 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2405 one with the best level.
2406
2407 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2408 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2409 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2410 by default.
2411 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function will
2412 be called and the result will be used as value.
2413
2414
2415 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2416 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2417 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2418 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2419 listed.
2420
2421 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2422 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2423 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2424 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2425
2426 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2427 Gnus will normally just activate (i.e., query the server about) groups
2428 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2429 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2430 to 5. The default is 6.
2431
2432
2433 @node Group Score
2434 @section Group Score
2435 @cindex group score
2436 @cindex group rank
2437 @cindex rank
2438
2439 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2440 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2441 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2442 reason?
2443
2444 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2445 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2446 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2447 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2448 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2449 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2450 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2451 least significant part.))
2452
2453 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2454 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2455 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2456 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2457 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2458 action after each summary exit, you can add
2459 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2460 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2461 slow things down somewhat.
2462
2463
2464 @node Marking Groups
2465 @section Marking Groups
2466 @cindex marking groups
2467
2468 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2469 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2470 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2471 bidding on those groups.
2472
2473 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2474 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2475 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2476
2477 @table @kbd
2478
2479 @item #
2480 @kindex # (Group)
2481 @itemx M m
2482 @kindex M m (Group)
2483 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2484 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2485
2486 @item M-#
2487 @kindex M-# (Group)
2488 @itemx M u
2489 @kindex M u (Group)
2490 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2491 Remove the mark from the current group
2492 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2493
2494 @item M U
2495 @kindex M U (Group)
2496 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2497 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2498
2499 @item M w
2500 @kindex M w (Group)
2501 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2502 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2503
2504 @item M b
2505 @kindex M b (Group)
2506 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2507 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2508
2509 @item M r
2510 @kindex M r (Group)
2511 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2512 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2513 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2514 @end table
2515
2516 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2517
2518 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2519 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2520 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2521 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2522 the command to be executed.
2523
2524
2525 @node Foreign Groups
2526 @section Foreign Groups
2527 @cindex foreign groups
2528
2529 If you recall how to subscribe to servers (@pxref{Finding the News})
2530 you will remember that @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} and
2531 @code{gnus-select-method} let you write a definition in Emacs Lisp of
2532 what servers you want to see when you start up. The alternate
2533 approach is to use foreign servers and groups. ``Foreign'' here means
2534 they are not coming from the select methods. All foreign server
2535 configuration and subscriptions are stored only in the
2536 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file.
2537
2538 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2539 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2540 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2541 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2542 consulted.
2543
2544 Changes from the group editing commands are stored in
2545 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} (@code{gnus-startup-file}). An alternative is the
2546 variable @code{gnus-parameters}, @xref{Group Parameters}.
2547
2548 @table @kbd
2549
2550 @item G m
2551 @kindex G m (Group)
2552 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2553 @cindex making groups
2554 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2555 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2556 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2557
2558 @item G M
2559 @kindex G M (Group)
2560 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2561 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2562 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2563
2564 @item G r
2565 @kindex G r (Group)
2566 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2567 @cindex renaming groups
2568 Rename the current group to something else
2569 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2570 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2571 on some back ends.
2572
2573 @item G c
2574 @kindex G c (Group)
2575 @cindex customizing
2576 @findex gnus-group-customize
2577 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2578
2579 @item G e
2580 @kindex G e (Group)
2581 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2582 @cindex renaming groups
2583 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2584 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2585
2586 @item G p
2587 @kindex G p (Group)
2588 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2589 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2590 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2591
2592 @item G E
2593 @kindex G E (Group)
2594 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2595 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2596 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2597
2598 @item G d
2599 @kindex G d (Group)
2600 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2601 @cindex nndir
2602 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2603 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2604
2605 @item G h
2606 @kindex G h (Group)
2607 @cindex help group
2608 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2609 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2610
2611 @item G D
2612 @kindex G D (Group)
2613 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2614 @cindex nneething
2615 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2616 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2617 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2618
2619 @item G f
2620 @kindex G f (Group)
2621 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2622 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2623 @cindex nndoc
2624 Make a group based on some file or other
2625 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2626 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2627 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2628 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2629 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2630 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2631 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2632 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2633 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2634
2635 @item G u
2636 @kindex G u (Group)
2637 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2638 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2639 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2640 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2641
2642 @item G w
2643 @kindex G w (Group)
2644 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2645 @cindex Google
2646 @cindex nnweb
2647 @cindex gmane
2648 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2649 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2650 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2651 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2652 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2653 @xref{Web Searches}.
2654
2655 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2656 to a particular group by using a match string like
2657 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2658
2659 @item G R
2660 @kindex G R (Group)
2661 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2662 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2663 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL@.
2664 @xref{RSS}.
2665
2666 @item G DEL
2667 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2668 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2669 This function will delete the current group
2670 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2671 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2672 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2673 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2674 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2675
2676 @item G V
2677 @kindex G V (Group)
2678 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2679 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2680 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2681
2682 @item G v
2683 @kindex G v (Group)
2684 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2685 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2686 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2687 @end table
2688
2689 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2690 methods.
2691
2692 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2693 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2694 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2695 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2696 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2697 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2698 newsgroups.
2699
2700
2701 The following commands create ephemeral groups. They can be called not
2702 only from the Group buffer, but in any Gnus buffer.
2703
2704 @table @code
2705 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2706 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2707 @vindex gnus-gmane-group-download-format
2708 Read an ephemeral group on Gmane.org. The articles are downloaded via
2709 HTTP using the URL specified by @code{gnus-gmane-group-download-format}.
2710 Gnus will prompt you for a group name, the start article number and an
2711 the article range.
2712
2713 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2714 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2715 This command is similar to @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group}, but
2716 the group name and the article number and range are constructed from a
2717 given @acronym{URL}. Supported @acronym{URL} formats include:
2718 @indicateurl{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12300/focus=12399},
2719 @indicateurl{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2720 @indicateurl{http://article.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2721 @indicateurl{http://permalink.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/}, and
2722 @indicateurl{http://news.gmane.org/group/gmane.foo.bar/thread=12345}.
2723
2724 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2725 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2726 Read an Emacs bug report in an ephemeral group. Gnus will prompt for a
2727 bug number. The default is the number at point. The @acronym{URL} is
2728 specified in @code{gnus-bug-group-download-format-alist}.
2729
2730 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2731 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2732 Read a Debian bug report in an ephemeral group. Analog to
2733 @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group}.
2734 @end table
2735
2736 Some of these command are also useful for article buttons, @xref{Article
2737 Buttons}.
2738
2739 Here is an example:
2740 @lisp
2741 (require 'gnus-art)
2742 (add-to-list
2743 'gnus-button-alist
2744 '("#\\([0-9]+\\)\\>" 1
2745 (string-match "\\<emacs\\>" (or gnus-newsgroup-name ""))
2746 gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group 1))
2747 @end lisp
2748
2749
2750 @node Group Parameters
2751 @section Group Parameters
2752 @cindex group parameters
2753
2754 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2755
2756 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
2757 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
2758 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
2759 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
2760 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
2761 Additionally, you can set group parameters via the
2762 @code{gnus-parameters} variable, see below.
2763
2764 Here's an example group parameter list:
2765
2766 @example
2767 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2768 (auto-expire . t))
2769 @end example
2770
2771 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2772 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2773 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2774 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2775
2776 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2777 is an alist of regexps and values.
2778
2779 The following group parameters can be used:
2780
2781 @table @code
2782 @item to-address
2783 @cindex to-address
2784 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2785
2786 @example
2787 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2788 @end example
2789
2790 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2791 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2792 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2793 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2794 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2795
2796 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2797 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2798 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2799 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2800 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2801 list address instead.
2802
2803 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2804
2805 @item to-list
2806 @cindex to-list
2807 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2808
2809 @example
2810 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2811 @end example
2812
2813 It is totally ignored
2814 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2815 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2816
2817 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2818 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2819 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2820 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2821 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2822
2823 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2824 @cindex mail list groups
2825 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2826 entering summary buffer.
2827
2828 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2829
2830 @anchor{subscribed}
2831 @item subscribed
2832 @cindex subscribed
2833 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2834 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2835 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2836 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2837 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2838 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2839 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2840 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2841
2842 @lisp
2843 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2844 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2845 @end lisp
2846
2847 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2848 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2849
2850 @item visible
2851 @cindex visible
2852 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2853 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2854 of whether it has any unread articles.
2855
2856 This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2857 @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2858
2859 @item broken-reply-to
2860 @cindex broken-reply-to
2861 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2862 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2863 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2864 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2865 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2866 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2867
2868 @item to-group
2869 @cindex to-group
2870 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2871 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2872
2873 @item newsgroup
2874 @cindex newsgroup
2875 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2876 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2877 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2878 news group.
2879
2880 @item gcc-self
2881 @cindex gcc-self
2882 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2883 composed messages will be @code{gcc}d to the current group. If
2884 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2885 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "group")} is present, this string will
2886 be inserted literally as a @code{Gcc:} header. It should be a group
2887 name. The @code{gcc-self} value may also be a list of strings and
2888 @code{t}, e.g., @code{(gcc-self "group1" "group2" t)} means to
2889 @code{gcc} the newly composed message into the groups @code{"group1"}
2890 and @code{"group2"}, and into the current group. The @code{gcc-self}
2891 parameter takes precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as
2892 described later (@pxref{Archived Messages}), with the exception for
2893 messages to resend.
2894
2895 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2896 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2897 doesn't accept articles.
2898
2899 @item auto-expire
2900 @cindex auto-expire
2901 @cindex expiring mail
2902 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2903 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2904 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2905
2906 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2907
2908 @item total-expire
2909 @cindex total-expire
2910 @cindex expiring mail
2911 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2912 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2913 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2914 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2915 expiry.
2916
2917 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2918
2919 @item expiry-wait
2920 @cindex expiry-wait
2921 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2922 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2923 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2924 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2925 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2926 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2927 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2928
2929 @item expiry-target
2930 @cindex expiry-target
2931 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2932 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2933
2934 @item score-file
2935 @cindex score file group parameter
2936 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2937 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2938 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2939
2940 @item adapt-file
2941 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2942 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2943 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2944 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2945
2946 @item admin-address
2947 @cindex admin-address
2948 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2949 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2950 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2951 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2952
2953 @item display
2954 @cindex display
2955 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2956 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2957
2958 @table @code
2959 @item all
2960 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2961
2962 @item an integer
2963 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2964 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2965
2966 @item default
2967 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2968 ticked articles.
2969
2970 @item an array
2971 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2972
2973 Here are some examples:
2974
2975 @table @code
2976 @item [unread]
2977 Display only unread articles.
2978
2979 @item [not expire]
2980 Display everything except expirable articles.
2981
2982 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2983 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2984 responded to.
2985 @end table
2986
2987 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2988 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2989 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2990 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2991 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, and @code{unseen}.
2992
2993 @end table
2994
2995 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2996 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2997 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2998
2999 @item comment
3000 @cindex comment
3001 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
3002 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
3003 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
3004
3005 @item charset
3006 @cindex charset
3007 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
3008 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
3009 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
3010
3011 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
3012
3013 @item ignored-charsets
3014 @cindex ignored-charset
3015 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
3016 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
3017 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
3018
3019 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
3020
3021 @item posting-style
3022 @cindex posting-style
3023 You can store additional posting style information for this group
3024 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
3025 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
3026 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
3027 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
3028
3029 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
3030 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
3031 like this in the group parameters:
3032
3033 @example
3034 (posting-style
3035 (name "Funky Name")
3036 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
3037 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
3038 (signature "Funky Signature"))
3039 @end example
3040
3041 If you're using topics to organize your group buffer
3042 (@pxref{Group Topics}), note that posting styles can also be set in
3043 the topics parameters. Posting styles in topic parameters apply to all
3044 groups in this topic. More precisely, the posting-style settings for a
3045 group result from the hierarchical merging of all posting-style
3046 entries in the parameters of this group and all the topics it belongs
3047 to.
3048
3049
3050 @item post-method
3051 @cindex post-method
3052 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
3053 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
3054
3055 @item mail-source
3056 @cindex mail-source
3057 If it is set, and the setting of @code{mail-sources} includes a
3058 @code{group} mail source (@pxref{Mail Sources}), the value is a
3059 mail source for this group.
3060
3061 @item banner
3062 @cindex banner
3063 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
3064 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
3065 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
3066 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
3067 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
3068
3069 @item sieve
3070 @cindex sieve
3071 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
3072 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
3073 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
3074 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
3075
3076 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
3077 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
3078 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
3079 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
3080
3081 @example
3082 if address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com" @{
3083 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3084 @}
3085 @end example
3086
3087 To generate tests for multiple email-addresses use a group parameter
3088 like @code{(sieve address "sender" ("name@@one.org" else@@two.org"))}.
3089 When generating a sieve script (@pxref{Sieve Commands}) Sieve code
3090 like the following is generated:
3091
3092 @example
3093 if address "sender" ["name@@one.org", "else@@two.org"] @{
3094 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3095 @}
3096 @end example
3097
3098 You can also use regexp expansions in the rules:
3099
3100 @example
3101 (sieve header :regex "list-id" "<c++std-\\1.accu.org>")
3102 @end example
3103
3104 See @pxref{Sieve Commands} for commands and variables that might be of
3105 interest in relation to the sieve parameter.
3106
3107 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
3108 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
3109
3110 @item (agent parameters)
3111 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of its parameters to
3112 control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
3113 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
3114 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
3115 minimize the configuration effort.
3116
3117 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
3118 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
3119 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
3120 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
3121 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
3122 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
3123 @code{eval}ed there.
3124
3125 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer
3126 if and only if @var{variable} has been bound as a variable. Otherwise,
3127 only evaluating the form will take place. So, you may want to bind the
3128 variable in advance using @code{defvar} or other if the result of the
3129 form needs to be set to it.
3130
3131 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
3132 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
3133 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
3134 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3135 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3136 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
3137 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3138
3139 @lisp
3140 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3141 @end lisp
3142
3143 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3144 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3145 the subject fields of articles. E.g., if the news group
3146
3147 @example
3148 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3149 @end example
3150
3151 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3152 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3153 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3154 into the group parameters for the group.
3155
3156 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3157 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3158 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group. If
3159 @code{dummy-variable} has been bound (see above), it will be set to the
3160 (meaningless) result of the @code{(ding)} form.
3161
3162 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3163 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3164 following is added to a group parameter
3165
3166 @lisp
3167 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3168 (lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3169 @end lisp
3170
3171 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3172 expired.
3173
3174 @end table
3175
3176 @vindex gnus-parameters
3177 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3178 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3179 case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3180 For example:
3181
3182 @lisp
3183 (setq gnus-parameters
3184 '(("mail\\..*"
3185 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3186 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3187 (gnus-summary-line-format
3188 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3189 (gcc-self . t)
3190 (display . all))
3191
3192 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3193 (to-group . "\\1"))
3194
3195 ("mail\\.me"
3196 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3197
3198 ("list\\..*"
3199 (total-expire . t)
3200 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3201 @end lisp
3202
3203 All clauses that matches the group name will be used, but the last
3204 setting ``wins''. So if you have two clauses that both match the
3205 group name, and both set, say @code{display}, the last setting will
3206 override the first.
3207
3208 Parameters that are strings will be subjected to regexp substitution,
3209 as the @code{to-group} example shows.
3210
3211 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3212 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3213 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3214 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3215 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3216 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3217 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3218 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3219 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3220 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3221 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3222 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3223
3224 You can define different sorting to different groups via
3225 @code{gnus-parameters}. Here is an example to sort an @acronym{NNTP}
3226 group by reverse date to see the latest news at the top and an
3227 @acronym{RSS} group by subject. In this example, the first group is the
3228 Debian daily news group @code{gmane.linux.debian.user.news} from
3229 news.gmane.org. The @acronym{RSS} group corresponds to the Debian
3230 weekly news RSS feed
3231 @url{http://packages.debian.org/unstable/newpkg_main.en.rdf},
3232 @xref{RSS}.
3233
3234 @lisp
3235 (setq
3236 gnus-parameters
3237 '(("nntp.*gmane\\.debian\\.user\\.news"
3238 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3239 (gnus-article-sort-functions '((not gnus-article-sort-by-date)))
3240 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3241 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
3242 ("nnrss.*debian"
3243 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3244 (gnus-article-sort-functions 'gnus-article-sort-by-subject)
3245 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3246 (gnus-use-scoring t)
3247 (gnus-score-find-score-files-function 'gnus-score-find-single)
3248 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%d %I%(%[ %s %]%)\n"))))
3249 @end lisp
3250
3251
3252 @node Listing Groups
3253 @section Listing Groups
3254 @cindex group listing
3255
3256 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3257
3258 @table @kbd
3259
3260 @item l
3261 @itemx A s
3262 @kindex A s (Group)
3263 @kindex l (Group)
3264 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3265 List all groups that have unread articles
3266 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3267 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3268 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3269 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3270 groups).
3271
3272 @item L
3273 @itemx A u
3274 @kindex A u (Group)
3275 @kindex L (Group)
3276 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3277 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3278 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3279 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3280 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3281 unsubscribed groups).
3282
3283 @item A l
3284 @kindex A l (Group)
3285 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3286 List all unread groups on a specific level
3287 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3288 with no unread articles.
3289
3290 @item A k
3291 @kindex A k (Group)
3292 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3293 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3294 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3295 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3296 from the server.
3297
3298 @item A z
3299 @kindex A z (Group)
3300 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3301 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3302
3303 @item A m
3304 @kindex A m (Group)
3305 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3306 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3307 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3308
3309 @item A M
3310 @kindex A M (Group)
3311 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3312 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3313
3314 @item A A
3315 @kindex A A (Group)
3316 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3317 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3318 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3319 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3320 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3321 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3322 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3323 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3324
3325 @item A a
3326 @kindex A a (Group)
3327 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3328 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3329 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3330
3331 @item A d
3332 @kindex A d (Group)
3333 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3334 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3335 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3336
3337 @item A c
3338 @kindex A c (Group)
3339 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3340 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3341
3342 @item A ?
3343 @kindex A ? (Group)
3344 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3345 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3346
3347 @item A !
3348 @kindex A ! (Group)
3349 @findex gnus-group-list-ticked
3350 List all groups with ticked articles (@code{gnus-group-list-ticked}).
3351
3352 @item A /
3353 @kindex A / (Group)
3354 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3355 Further limit groups within the current selection
3356 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}). If you've first limited to groups
3357 with dormant articles with @kbd{A ?}, you can then further limit with
3358 @kbd{A / c}, which will then limit to groups with cached articles,
3359 giving you the groups that have both dormant articles and cached
3360 articles.
3361
3362 @item A f
3363 @kindex A f (Group)
3364 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3365 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3366
3367 @item A p
3368 @kindex A p (Group)
3369 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3370 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3371
3372 @end table
3373
3374 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3375 @cindex visible group parameter
3376 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3377 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3378 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3379 get the same effect.
3380
3381 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3382 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3383 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3384 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3385 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3386
3387
3388 @node Sorting Groups
3389 @section Sorting Groups
3390 @cindex sorting groups
3391
3392 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3393 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3394 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3395 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3396 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3397 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3398 include:
3399
3400 @table @code
3401
3402 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3403 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3404 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3405
3406 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3407 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3408 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3409
3410 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3411 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3412 Sort by group level.
3413
3414 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3415 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3416 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3417
3418 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3419 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3420 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3421 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3422
3423 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3424 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3425 Sort by number of unread articles.
3426
3427 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3428 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3429 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3430
3431 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3432 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3433 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3434
3435
3436 @end table
3437
3438 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3439 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3440 the last one.
3441
3442
3443 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3444 some sorting criteria:
3445
3446 @table @kbd
3447 @item G S a
3448 @kindex G S a (Group)
3449 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3450 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3451 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3452
3453 @item G S u
3454 @kindex G S u (Group)
3455 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3456 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3457 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3458
3459 @item G S l
3460 @kindex G S l (Group)
3461 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3462 Sort the group buffer by group level
3463 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3464
3465 @item G S v
3466 @kindex G S v (Group)
3467 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3468 Sort the group buffer by group score
3469 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3470
3471 @item G S r
3472 @kindex G S r (Group)
3473 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3474 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3475 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3476
3477 @item G S m
3478 @kindex G S m (Group)
3479 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3480 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3481 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3482
3483 @item G S n
3484 @kindex G S n (Group)
3485 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3486 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3487 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3488
3489 @end table
3490
3491 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3492 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3493
3494 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3495 commands will sort in reverse order.
3496
3497 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3498
3499 @table @kbd
3500 @item G P a
3501 @kindex G P a (Group)
3502 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3503 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3504 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3505
3506 @item G P u
3507 @kindex G P u (Group)
3508 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3509 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3510 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3511
3512 @item G P l
3513 @kindex G P l (Group)
3514 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3515 Sort the groups by group level
3516 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3517
3518 @item G P v
3519 @kindex G P v (Group)
3520 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3521 Sort the groups by group score
3522 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3523
3524 @item G P r
3525 @kindex G P r (Group)
3526 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3527 Sort the groups by group rank
3528 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3529
3530 @item G P m
3531 @kindex G P m (Group)
3532 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3533 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3534 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3535
3536 @item G P n
3537 @kindex G P n (Group)
3538 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3539 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3540 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3541
3542 @item G P s
3543 @kindex G P s (Group)
3544 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3545 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3546
3547 @end table
3548
3549 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3550 move groups around.
3551
3552
3553 @node Group Maintenance
3554 @section Group Maintenance
3555 @cindex bogus groups
3556
3557 @table @kbd
3558 @item b
3559 @kindex b (Group)
3560 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3561 Find bogus groups and delete them
3562 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3563
3564 @item F
3565 @kindex F (Group)
3566 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3567 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3568 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3569 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3570 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3571 zombies.
3572
3573 @item C-c C-x
3574 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3575 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3576 @cindex expiring mail
3577 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3578 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3579 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3580 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3581
3582 @item C-c C-M-x
3583 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3584 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3585 @cindex expiring mail
3586 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3587 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3588
3589 @end table
3590
3591
3592 @node Browse Foreign Server
3593 @section Browse Foreign Server
3594 @cindex foreign servers
3595 @cindex browsing servers
3596
3597 @table @kbd
3598 @item B
3599 @kindex B (Group)
3600 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3601 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3602 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3603 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3604 @end table
3605
3606 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3607 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3608 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3609 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3610
3611 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3612
3613 @table @kbd
3614 @item n
3615 @kindex n (Browse)
3616 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3617 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3618
3619 @item p
3620 @kindex p (Browse)
3621 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3622 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3623
3624 @item SPACE
3625 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3626 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3627 Enter the current group and display the first article
3628 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3629
3630 @item RET
3631 @kindex RET (Browse)
3632 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3633 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3634
3635 @item u
3636 @kindex u (Browse)
3637 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3638 @vindex gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method
3639 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3640 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}). You
3641 can affect the way the new group is entered into the Group buffer
3642 using the variable @code{gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method}. See
3643 @pxref{Subscription Methods} for available options.
3644
3645 @item l
3646 @itemx q
3647 @kindex q (Browse)
3648 @kindex l (Browse)
3649 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3650 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3651
3652 @item d
3653 @kindex d (Browse)
3654 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3655 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3656
3657 @item ?
3658 @kindex ? (Browse)
3659 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3660 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3661 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3662
3663 @item DEL
3664 @kindex DEL (Browse)
3665 @findex gnus-browse-delete-group
3666 This function will delete the current group
3667 (@code{gnus-browse-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function
3668 will actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly
3669 remove the group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only
3670 if you are absolutely sure of what you are doing.
3671 @end table
3672
3673
3674 @node Exiting Gnus
3675 @section Exiting Gnus
3676 @cindex exiting Gnus
3677
3678 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3679
3680 @table @kbd
3681 @item z
3682 @kindex z (Group)
3683 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3684 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3685 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3686 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3687
3688 @item q
3689 @kindex q (Group)
3690 @findex gnus-group-exit
3691 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3692 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3693
3694 @item Q
3695 @kindex Q (Group)
3696 @findex gnus-group-quit
3697 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3698 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3699 @end table
3700
3701 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3702 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3703 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3704 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3705 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3706 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3707 exiting Gnus.
3708
3709 Note:
3710
3711 @quotation
3712 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3713 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3714 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3715 plastic chair.
3716 @end quotation
3717
3718
3719 @node Group Topics
3720 @section Group Topics
3721 @cindex topics
3722
3723 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3724 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3725 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3726 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3727 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3728 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3729
3730 @iftex
3731 @iflatex
3732 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3733 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3734 }
3735 @end iflatex
3736 @end iftex
3737
3738 Here's an example:
3739
3740 @example
3741 Gnus
3742 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3743 3: comp.emacs
3744 2: alt.religion.emacs
3745 Naughty Emacs
3746 452: alt.sex.emacs
3747 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3748 Misc
3749 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3750 13: comp.sources.unix
3751 @end example
3752
3753 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3754 @kindex t (Group)
3755 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3756 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3757 is a toggling command.)
3758
3759 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3760 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3761 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3762 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3763 Hot and bothered?
3764
3765 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3766 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3767 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3768
3769 @lisp
3770 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3771 @end lisp
3772
3773 @menu
3774 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3775 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3776 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3777 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3778 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3779 @end menu
3780
3781
3782 @node Topic Commands
3783 @subsection Topic Commands
3784 @cindex topic commands
3785
3786 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3787 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3788 definitions slightly.
3789
3790 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3791 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3792 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3793 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3794 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3795 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3796
3797 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3798 the way you like.
3799
3800 @table @kbd
3801
3802 @item T n
3803 @kindex T n (Topic)
3804 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3805 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3806 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3807
3808 @item T TAB
3809 @itemx TAB
3810 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3811 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3812 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3813 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3814 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3815 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3816
3817 @item M-TAB
3818 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3819 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3820 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3821 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3822
3823 @end table
3824
3825 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3826 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3827 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3828 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3829
3830 @table @kbd
3831
3832 @item C-k
3833 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3834 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3835 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3836 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3837
3838 @item C-y
3839 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3840 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3841 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3842 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3843 before all groups.
3844
3845 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3846 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3847 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3848 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3849 paste. Like I said---E-Z.
3850
3851 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3852 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3853
3854 @end table
3855
3856 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3857 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3858 key.
3859
3860 @table @kbd
3861
3862 @item RET
3863 @kindex RET (Topic)
3864 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3865 @itemx SPACE
3866 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3867 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3868 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3869 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3870 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3871 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3872
3873 @end table
3874
3875 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3876
3877 @table @kbd
3878
3879 @item T m
3880 @kindex T m (Topic)
3881 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3882 Move the current group to some other topic
3883 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3884 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3885
3886 @item T j
3887 @kindex T j (Topic)
3888 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3889 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3890
3891 @item T c
3892 @kindex T c (Topic)
3893 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3894 Copy the current group to some other topic
3895 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3896 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3897
3898 @item T h
3899 @kindex T h (Topic)
3900 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3901 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3902 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3903
3904 @item T s
3905 @kindex T s (Topic)
3906 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3907 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3908 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3909
3910 @item T D
3911 @kindex T D (Topic)
3912 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3913 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3914 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3915 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3916 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3917 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3918 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3919 topic.
3920
3921 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3922 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3923
3924 @item T M
3925 @kindex T M (Topic)
3926 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3927 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3928 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3929
3930 @item T C
3931 @kindex T C (Topic)
3932 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3933 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3934 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3935
3936 @item T H
3937 @kindex T H (Topic)
3938 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3939 Toggle hiding empty topics
3940 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3941
3942 @item T #
3943 @kindex T # (Topic)
3944 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3945 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3946 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3947 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3948
3949 @item T M-#
3950 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3951 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3952 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3953 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3954 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3955
3956 @item C-c C-x
3957 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3958 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3959 @cindex expiring mail
3960 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3961 expiry process (if any)
3962 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3963
3964 @item T r
3965 @kindex T r (Topic)
3966 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3967 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3968
3969 @item T DEL
3970 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3971 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3972 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3973
3974 @item A T
3975 @kindex A T (Topic)
3976 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3977 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3978 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3979
3980 @item T M-n
3981 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3982 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3983 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3984
3985 @item T M-p
3986 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3987 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3988 Go to the previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3989
3990 @item G p
3991 @kindex G p (Topic)
3992 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3993 @cindex group parameters
3994 @cindex topic parameters
3995 @cindex parameters
3996 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3997 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3998
3999 @end table
4000
4001
4002 @node Topic Variables
4003 @subsection Topic Variables
4004 @cindex topic variables
4005
4006 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
4007 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
4008
4009 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
4010 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
4011 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4012 Valid elements are:
4013
4014 @table @samp
4015 @item i
4016 Indentation.
4017 @item n
4018 Topic name.
4019 @item v
4020 Visibility.
4021 @item l
4022 Level.
4023 @item g
4024 Number of groups in the topic.
4025 @item a
4026 Number of unread articles in the topic.
4027 @item A
4028 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
4029 @end table
4030
4031 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
4032 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
4033 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
4034 The default is 2.
4035
4036 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
4037 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
4038
4039 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
4040 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
4041 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
4042
4043
4044 @node Topic Sorting
4045 @subsection Topic Sorting
4046 @cindex topic sorting
4047
4048 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
4049 commands:
4050
4051
4052 @table @kbd
4053 @item T S a
4054 @kindex T S a (Topic)
4055 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
4056 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
4057 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
4058
4059 @item T S u
4060 @kindex T S u (Topic)
4061 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
4062 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
4063 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
4064
4065 @item T S l
4066 @kindex T S l (Topic)
4067 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
4068 Sort the current topic by group level
4069 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
4070
4071 @item T S v
4072 @kindex T S v (Topic)
4073 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
4074 Sort the current topic by group score
4075 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
4076
4077 @item T S r
4078 @kindex T S r (Topic)
4079 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
4080 Sort the current topic by group rank
4081 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
4082
4083 @item T S m
4084 @kindex T S m (Topic)
4085 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
4086 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
4087 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
4088
4089 @item T S e
4090 @kindex T S e (Topic)
4091 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
4092 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
4093 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
4094
4095 @item T S s
4096 @kindex T S s (Topic)
4097 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
4098 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
4099 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
4100 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
4101
4102 @end table
4103
4104 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
4105 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
4106 sorting.
4107
4108
4109 @node Topic Topology
4110 @subsection Topic Topology
4111 @cindex topic topology
4112 @cindex topology
4113
4114 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
4115
4116 @example
4117 @group
4118 Gnus
4119 Emacs -- I wuw it!
4120 3: comp.emacs
4121 2: alt.religion.emacs
4122 Naughty Emacs
4123 452: alt.sex.emacs
4124 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4125 Misc
4126 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4127 13: comp.sources.unix
4128 @end group
4129 @end example
4130
4131 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
4132 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
4133 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
4134 follows:
4135
4136 @lisp
4137 (("Gnus" visible)
4138 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
4139 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
4140 (("Misc" visible)))
4141 @end lisp
4142
4143 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
4144 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
4145 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
4146 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
4147 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
4148 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
4149
4150 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
4151 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
4152 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
4153
4154
4155 @node Topic Parameters
4156 @subsection Topic Parameters
4157 @cindex topic parameters
4158
4159 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
4160 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
4161 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
4162 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
4163 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
4164
4165 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
4166 parameters:
4167
4168 @table @code
4169 @item subscribe
4170 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
4171 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
4172 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
4173 topic.
4174
4175 @item subscribe-level
4176 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
4177 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
4178 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
4179
4180 @end table
4181
4182 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
4183 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
4184 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
4185 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4186
4187 @example
4188 @group
4189 Gnus
4190 Emacs
4191 3: comp.emacs
4192 2: alt.religion.emacs
4193 452: alt.sex.emacs
4194 Relief
4195 452: alt.sex.emacs
4196 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4197 Misc
4198 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4199 13: comp.sources.unix
4200 452: alt.sex.emacs
4201 @end group
4202 @end example
4203
4204 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4205 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4206 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4207 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4208 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4209 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4210
4211 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4212 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4213 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4214 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4215 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4216
4217 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4218 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4219 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4220 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4221 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4222 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4223 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4224 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4225
4226
4227 @node Non-ASCII Group Names
4228 @section Accessing groups of non-English names
4229 @cindex non-ascii group names
4230
4231 There are some news servers that provide groups of which the names are
4232 expressed with their native languages in the world. For instance, in a
4233 certain news server there are some newsgroups of which the names are
4234 spelled in Chinese, where people are talking in Chinese. You can, of
4235 course, subscribe to such news groups using Gnus. Currently Gnus
4236 supports non-@acronym{ASCII} group names not only with the @code{nntp}
4237 back end but also with the @code{nnml} back end and the @code{nnrss}
4238 back end.
4239
4240 Every such group name is encoded by a certain charset in the server
4241 side (in an @acronym{NNTP} server its administrator determines the
4242 charset, but for groups in the other back ends it is determined by you).
4243 Gnus has to display the decoded ones for you in the group buffer and the
4244 article buffer, and needs to use the encoded ones when communicating
4245 with servers. However, Gnus doesn't know what charset is used for each
4246 non-@acronym{ASCII} group name. The following two variables are just
4247 the ones for telling Gnus what charset should be used for each group:
4248
4249 @table @code
4250 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4251 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4252 An alist of select methods and charsets. The default value is
4253 @code{nil}. The names of groups in the server specified by that select
4254 method are all supposed to use the corresponding charset. For example:
4255
4256 @lisp
4257 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4258 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4259 @end lisp
4260
4261 Charsets specified for groups with this variable are preferred to the
4262 ones specified for the same groups with the
4263 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} variable (see below).
4264
4265 A select method can be very long, like:
4266
4267 @lisp
4268 (nntp "gmane"
4269 (nntp-address "news.gmane.org")
4270 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
4271 (nntp-open-connection-function
4272 nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
4273 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
4274 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
4275 ("-C" "-t" "-e" "none"))
4276 (nntp-via-address @dots{}))
4277 @end lisp
4278
4279 In that case, you can truncate it into @code{(nntp "gmane")} in this
4280 variable. That is, it is enough to contain only the back end name and
4281 the server name.
4282
4283 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4284 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4285 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4286 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names.
4287 @code{((".*" . utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported,
4288 otherwise the default is @code{nil}. For example:
4289
4290 @lisp
4291 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4292 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)
4293 (".*" . utf-8)))
4294 @end lisp
4295
4296 Note that this variable is ignored if the match is made with
4297 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist}.
4298 @end table
4299
4300 Those two variables are used also to determine the charset for encoding
4301 and decoding non-@acronym{ASCII} group names that are in the back ends
4302 other than @code{nntp}. It means that it is you who determine it. If
4303 you do nothing, the charset used for group names in those back ends will
4304 all be @code{utf-8} because of the last element of
4305 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4306
4307 There is one more important variable for non-@acronym{ASCII} group
4308 names:
4309
4310 @table @code
4311 @item nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4312 @vindex nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4313 The value of this variable should be a coding system or @code{nil}. The
4314 default is @code{nil} in Emacs, or is the aliasee of the coding system
4315 named @code{file-name} (a certain coding system of which an alias is
4316 @code{file-name}) in XEmacs.
4317
4318 The @code{nnml} back end, the @code{nnrss} back end, the agent, and
4319 the cache use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names in those files and
4320 directories. This variable overrides the value of
4321 @code{file-name-coding-system} which specifies the coding system used
4322 when encoding and decoding those file names and directory names.
4323
4324 In XEmacs (with the @code{mule} feature), @code{file-name-coding-system}
4325 is the only means to specify the coding system used to encode and decode
4326 file names. On the other hand, Emacs uses the value of
4327 @code{default-file-name-coding-system} if @code{file-name-coding-system}
4328 is @code{nil} or it is bound to the value of
4329 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} which is @code{nil}.
4330
4331 Normally the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system} in Emacs or
4332 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} in XEmacs is initialized according
4333 to the locale, so you will need to do nothing if the value is suitable
4334 to encode and decode non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4335
4336 The value of this variable (or @code{default-file-name-coding-system})
4337 does not necessarily need to be the same value that is determined by
4338 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} and
4339 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4340
4341 If @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable is
4342 initialized by default to @code{iso-latin-1} for example, although you
4343 want to subscribe to the groups spelled in Chinese, that is the most
4344 typical case where you have to customize
4345 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}. The @code{utf-8} coding system is
4346 a good candidate for it. Otherwise, you may change the locale in your
4347 system so that @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable
4348 may be initialized to an appropriate value.
4349 @end table
4350
4351 Note that when you copy or move articles from a non-@acronym{ASCII}
4352 group to another group, the charset used to encode and decode group
4353 names should be the same in both groups. Otherwise the Newsgroups
4354 header will be displayed incorrectly in the article buffer.
4355
4356
4357 @node Misc Group Stuff
4358 @section Misc Group Stuff
4359
4360 @menu
4361 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4362 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4363 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4364 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4365 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4366 @end menu
4367
4368 @table @kbd
4369
4370 @item v
4371 @kindex v (Group)
4372 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
4373 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4374 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4375
4376 @lisp
4377 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
4378 (lambda ()
4379 (interactive)
4380 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
4381 @end lisp
4382
4383 On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
4384 @xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
4385
4386 @item ^
4387 @kindex ^ (Group)
4388 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4389 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4390 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4391
4392 @item a
4393 @kindex a (Group)
4394 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4395 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4396 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4397 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4398 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4399 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4400 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4401
4402 @item m
4403 @kindex m (Group)
4404 @findex gnus-group-mail
4405 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4406 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4407 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4408 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4409
4410 @item i
4411 @kindex i (Group)
4412 @findex gnus-group-news
4413 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4414 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4415 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4416
4417 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4418 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4419 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4420 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4421 for this to work though.
4422
4423 @item G z
4424 @kindex G z (Group)
4425 @findex gnus-group-compact-group
4426
4427 Compact the group under point (@code{gnus-group-compact-group}).
4428 Currently implemented only in nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes
4429 gaps between article numbers, hence getting a correct total article
4430 count.
4431
4432 @end table
4433
4434 Variables for the group buffer:
4435
4436 @table @code
4437
4438 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4439 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4440 is called after the group buffer has been
4441 created.
4442
4443 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4444 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4445 is called after the group buffer is
4446 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4447 unnatural way.
4448
4449 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4450 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4451 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4452 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4453
4454 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4455 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4456 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4457 whether they are empty or not.
4458
4459 @end table
4460
4461 @node Scanning New Messages
4462 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4463 @cindex new messages
4464 @cindex scanning new news
4465
4466 @table @kbd
4467
4468 @item g
4469 @kindex g (Group)
4470 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4471 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4472 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4473 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4474 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4475 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4476 back end(s).
4477
4478 @item M-g
4479 @kindex M-g (Group)
4480 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4481 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4482 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4483 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4484 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4485 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4486 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4487
4488 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4489 @cindex activating groups
4490 @item C-c M-g
4491 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4492 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4493
4494 @item R
4495 @kindex R (Group)
4496 @cindex restarting
4497 @findex gnus-group-restart
4498 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4499 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4500 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4501
4502 @end table
4503
4504 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4505 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4506
4507 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4508 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4509 news.
4510
4511
4512 @node Group Information
4513 @subsection Group Information
4514 @cindex group information
4515 @cindex information on groups
4516
4517 @table @kbd
4518
4519
4520 @item H d
4521 @itemx C-c C-d
4522 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4523 @kindex H d (Group)
4524 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4525 @cindex describing groups
4526 @cindex group description
4527 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4528 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4529 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4530
4531 @item M-d
4532 @kindex M-d (Group)
4533 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4534 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4535 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4536
4537 @item H v
4538 @itemx V
4539 @kindex V (Group)
4540 @kindex H v (Group)
4541 @cindex version
4542 @findex gnus-version
4543 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4544
4545 @item ?
4546 @kindex ? (Group)
4547 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4548 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4549
4550 @item C-c C-i
4551 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4552 @cindex info
4553 @cindex manual
4554 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4555 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4556 @end table
4557
4558
4559 @node Group Timestamp
4560 @subsection Group Timestamp
4561 @cindex timestamps
4562 @cindex group timestamps
4563
4564 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4565 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4566 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4567
4568 @lisp
4569 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4570 @end lisp
4571
4572 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4573
4574 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4575 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4576
4577 @lisp
4578 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4579 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4580 @end lisp
4581
4582 This will result in lines looking like:
4583
4584 @example
4585 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4586 0: custom 19961002T012713
4587 @end example
4588
4589 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4590 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4591 something like:
4592
4593 @lisp
4594 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4595 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4596 @end lisp
4597
4598 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4599 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4600 trick:
4601
4602 @lisp
4603 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4604 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4605 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4606 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4607 (if time
4608 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4609 "")))
4610 @end lisp
4611
4612 To see what variables are dynamically bound (like
4613 @code{gnus-tmp-group}), you have to look at the source code. The
4614 variable names aren't guaranteed to be stable over Gnus versions,
4615 either.
4616
4617
4618 @node File Commands
4619 @subsection File Commands
4620 @cindex file commands
4621
4622 @table @kbd
4623
4624 @item r
4625 @kindex r (Group)
4626 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4627 @vindex gnus-init-file
4628 @cindex reading init file
4629 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4630 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4631
4632 @item s
4633 @kindex s (Group)
4634 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4635 @cindex saving .newsrc
4636 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4637 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4638 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4639
4640 @c @item Z
4641 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4642 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4643 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4644
4645 @end table
4646
4647
4648 @node Sieve Commands
4649 @subsection Sieve Commands
4650 @cindex group sieve commands
4651
4652 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4653 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4654 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4655 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4656 script that can be transferred to the server somehow.
4657
4658 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4659 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4660 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4661 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4662 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4663 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4664 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4665 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4666 regenerate the Sieve script.
4667
4668 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4669 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4670 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4671 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4672 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4673 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4674 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4675 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4676 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4677 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4678
4679 @example
4680 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4681 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4682 stop;
4683 @}
4684 @end example
4685
4686 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4687
4688 @table @kbd
4689
4690 @item D g
4691 @kindex D g (Group)
4692 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4693 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4694 @cindex generating sieve script
4695 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4696 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4697
4698 @item D u
4699 @kindex D u (Group)
4700 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4701 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4702 @cindex updating sieve script
4703 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4704 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4705 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4706
4707 @end table
4708
4709
4710 @node Summary Buffer
4711 @chapter Summary Buffer
4712 @cindex summary buffer
4713
4714 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4715 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4716
4717 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4718 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4719
4720 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4721
4722 You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
4723 customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
4724 available in Emacs.
4725
4726 @kindex v (Summary)
4727 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
4728 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4729 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4730 @lisp
4731 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
4732 @end lisp
4733
4734 @menu
4735 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4736 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4737 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4738 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4739 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4740 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4741 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4742 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4743 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4744 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4745 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4746 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4747 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4748 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
4749 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4750 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4751 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4752 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4753 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4754 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4755 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4756 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4757 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4758 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4759 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4760 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4761 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4762 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4763 or reselecting the current group.
4764 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4765 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4766 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4767 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4768 @end menu
4769
4770
4771 @node Summary Buffer Format
4772 @section Summary Buffer Format
4773 @cindex summary buffer format
4774
4775 @iftex
4776 @iflatex
4777 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4778 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4779 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4780 }
4781 @end iflatex
4782 @end iftex
4783
4784 @menu
4785 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4786 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4787 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4788 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4789 @end menu
4790
4791 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4792 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4793 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4794 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4795 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4796 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4797 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4798 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4799 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4800 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4801 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4802
4803 @lisp
4804 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4805 'mail-extract-address-components)
4806 @end lisp
4807
4808 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4809 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4810 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4811 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4812
4813
4814 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4815 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4816
4817 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4818 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4819 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4820 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4821 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4822
4823 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4824 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4825 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4826 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4827 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4828 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4829
4830 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4831
4832 The following format specification characters and extended format
4833 specification(s) are understood:
4834
4835 @table @samp
4836 @item N
4837 Article number.
4838 @item S
4839 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4840 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4841 @item s
4842 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4843 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4844 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4845 @item F
4846 Full @code{From} header.
4847 @item n
4848 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4849 @item f
4850 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4851 From Newsgroups}).
4852 @item a
4853 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4854 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4855 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4856 may be more thorough.
4857 @item A
4858 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4859 the @code{a} spec.
4860 @item L
4861 Number of lines in the article.
4862 @item c
4863 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4864 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4865 @item k
4866 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4867 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4868 @item I
4869 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4870 @item B
4871 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4872 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4873
4874 @example
4875 >
4876 +->
4877 | +->
4878 | | \->
4879 | | \->
4880 | \->
4881 +->
4882 \->
4883 @end example
4884
4885 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4886 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4887 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4888 line-drawing glyphs.
4889 @table @code
4890 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4891 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4892 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4893 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4894
4895 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4896 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4897 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4898 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4899
4900 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4901 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4902 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4903 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4904
4905 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4906 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4907 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4908
4909 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4910 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4911 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4912
4913 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4914 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4915 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4916
4917 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4918 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4919 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4920
4921 @end table
4922
4923 @item T
4924 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4925 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4926 @item [
4927 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4928 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4929 @item ]
4930 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4931 for adopted articles.
4932 @item >
4933 One space for each thread level.
4934 @item <
4935 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4936 @item U
4937 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4938
4939 @item R
4940 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4941 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4942 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4943
4944 @item i
4945 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4946 @item z
4947 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4948 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4949 default level. If the difference between
4950 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4951 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4952 @item V
4953 Total thread score.
4954 @item x
4955 @code{Xref}.
4956 @item D
4957 @code{Date}.
4958 @item d
4959 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4960 @item o
4961 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4962 @item M
4963 @code{Message-ID}.
4964 @item r
4965 @code{References}.
4966 @item t
4967 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4968 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4969 @item e
4970 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4971 article has any children.
4972 @item P
4973 The line number.
4974 @item O
4975 Download mark.
4976 @item *
4977 Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
4978 @item &user-date;
4979 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4980 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4981 @item u
4982 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4983 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4984 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4985 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4986 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4987 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4988 @end table
4989
4990 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4991 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4992 There can only be one such area.
4993
4994 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4995 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4996 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4997 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4998 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4999 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
5000
5001 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
5002 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
5003
5004 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
5005
5006
5007 @node To From Newsgroups
5008 @subsection To From Newsgroups
5009 @cindex To
5010 @cindex Newsgroups
5011
5012 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
5013 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
5014 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
5015 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
5016 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
5017
5018 @enumerate
5019 @item
5020 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
5021 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
5022 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
5023 instance:
5024
5025 @lisp
5026 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5027 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
5028 @end lisp
5029
5030 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
5031 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
5032
5033 @item
5034 @findex gnus-extra-header
5035 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
5036 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
5037 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
5038
5039 @example
5040 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
5041 @end example
5042
5043 @item
5044 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5045 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the
5046 @samp{%f} summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader}
5047 or @code{From} header. The variable may be a regexp or a predicate
5048 function. If this matches the contents of the @code{From}
5049 header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader} headers are
5050 used instead.
5051
5052 To distinguish regular articles from those where the @code{From} field
5053 has been swapped, a string is prefixed to the @code{To} or
5054 @code{Newsgroups} header in the summary line. By default the string is
5055 @samp{-> } for @code{To} and @samp{=> } for @code{Newsgroups}, you can
5056 customize these strings with @code{gnus-summary-to-prefix} and
5057 @code{gnus-summary-newsgroup-prefix}.
5058
5059 @end enumerate
5060
5061 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
5062 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
5063 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
5064 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
5065 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
5066 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g., nnml) to cause
5067 regeneration.
5068
5069 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
5070 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
5071 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
5072 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
5073
5074 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
5075 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
5076
5077 @lisp
5078 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5079 '(To Newsgroups))
5080 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
5081 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
5082 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
5083 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5084 "Your Name Here")
5085 @end lisp
5086
5087 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
5088 to fit your needs.)
5089
5090 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
5091 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
5092 support:
5093
5094 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
5095 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
5096 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
5097
5098 @example
5099 Newsgroups:full
5100 @end example
5101
5102 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
5103 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
5104
5105
5106 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
5107 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
5108
5109 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
5110 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
5111 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
5112 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
5113
5114 Here are the elements you can play with:
5115
5116 @table @samp
5117 @item G
5118 Group name.
5119 @item p
5120 Unprefixed group name.
5121 @item A
5122 Current article number.
5123 @item z
5124 Current article score.
5125 @item V
5126 Gnus version.
5127 @item U
5128 Number of unread articles in this group.
5129 @item e
5130 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
5131 summary buffer.
5132 @item Z
5133 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
5134 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
5135 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
5136 and no unselected ones.
5137 @item g
5138 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
5139 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
5140 @item S
5141 Subject of the current article.
5142 @item u
5143 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
5144 @item s
5145 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
5146 @item d
5147 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5148 @item t
5149 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5150 @item r
5151 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
5152 @item E
5153 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
5154 @end table
5155
5156
5157 @node Summary Highlighting
5158 @subsection Summary Highlighting
5159
5160 @table @code
5161
5162 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5163 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5164 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
5165 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
5166 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5167
5168 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
5169 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
5170 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
5171 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5172
5173 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
5174 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
5175 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
5176 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
5177
5178 @item gnus-summary-highlight
5179 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
5180 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
5181 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
5182 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
5183 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
5184 to something like
5185 @lisp
5186 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
5187 ((> score default) . bold))
5188 @end lisp
5189 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
5190 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
5191 @end table
5192
5193
5194 @node Summary Maneuvering
5195 @section Summary Maneuvering
5196 @cindex summary movement
5197
5198 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
5199 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
5200
5201 None of these commands select articles.
5202
5203 @table @kbd
5204 @item G M-n
5205 @itemx M-n
5206 @kindex M-n (Summary)
5207 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
5208 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
5209 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
5210 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
5211
5212 @item G M-p
5213 @itemx M-p
5214 @kindex M-p (Summary)
5215 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
5216 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
5217 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
5218 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
5219
5220 @item G g
5221 @kindex G g (Summary)
5222 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
5223 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
5224 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
5225 @end table
5226
5227 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
5228 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
5229 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
5230 to the group buffer.
5231
5232 Variables related to summary movement:
5233
5234 @table @code
5235
5236 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
5237 @item gnus-auto-select-next
5238 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
5239 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
5240 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
5241 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
5242 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
5243 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
5244 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
5245 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
5246 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
5247 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
5248 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
5249 @pxref{Group Levels}.
5250
5251 @item gnus-auto-select-same
5252 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
5253 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
5254 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
5255 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
5256 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
5257 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
5258
5259 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
5260
5261 @item gnus-summary-check-current
5262 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
5263 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
5264 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
5265 Instead, they will choose the current article.
5266
5267 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
5268 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
5269 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
5270 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
5271 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
5272 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
5273 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
5274 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
5275 threads.
5276
5277 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
5278 the given number of lines from the top.
5279
5280 @item gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5281 @vindex gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5282 If non-@code{nil}, don't go to the next article when hitting
5283 @kbd{SPC}, and you're at the end of the article.
5284
5285 @end table
5286
5287
5288 @node Choosing Articles
5289 @section Choosing Articles
5290 @cindex selecting articles
5291
5292 @menu
5293 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
5294 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
5295 @end menu
5296
5297
5298 @node Choosing Commands
5299 @subsection Choosing Commands
5300
5301 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
5302 and they all select and display an article.
5303
5304 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
5305 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
5306
5307 @table @kbd
5308 @item SPACE
5309 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5310 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5311 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
5312 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5313
5314 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5315 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5316 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5317
5318 @item G n
5319 @itemx n
5320 @kindex n (Summary)
5321 @kindex G n (Summary)
5322 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5323 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5324 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5325
5326 @item G p
5327 @itemx p
5328 @kindex p (Summary)
5329 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5330 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5331 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5332
5333 @item G N
5334 @itemx N
5335 @kindex N (Summary)
5336 @kindex G N (Summary)
5337 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5338 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5339
5340 @item G P
5341 @itemx P
5342 @kindex P (Summary)
5343 @kindex G P (Summary)
5344 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5345 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5346
5347 @item G C-n
5348 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5349 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5350 Go to the next article with the same subject
5351 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5352
5353 @item G C-p
5354 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5355 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5356 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5357 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5358
5359 @item G f
5360 @itemx .
5361 @kindex G f (Summary)
5362 @kindex . (Summary)
5363 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5364 Go to the first unread article
5365 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5366
5367 @item G b
5368 @itemx ,
5369 @kindex G b (Summary)
5370 @kindex , (Summary)
5371 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5372 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5373 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5374 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5375
5376 @item G l
5377 @itemx l
5378 @kindex l (Summary)
5379 @kindex G l (Summary)
5380 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5381 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5382
5383 @item G o
5384 @kindex G o (Summary)
5385 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5386 @cindex history
5387 @cindex article history
5388 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5389 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5390 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5391 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5392 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5393 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5394
5395 @item G j
5396 @itemx j
5397 @kindex j (Summary)
5398 @kindex G j (Summary)
5399 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5400 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5401 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5402
5403 @end table
5404
5405
5406 @node Choosing Variables
5407 @subsection Choosing Variables
5408
5409 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5410
5411 @table @code
5412 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5413 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5414 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5415 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5416 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5417 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5418
5419 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5420 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5421 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5422 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5423 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5424 hook will do so.
5425
5426 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5427 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5428 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5429 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5430 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5431 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5432 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5433 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5434 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5435 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5436 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5437 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5438 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5439 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5440
5441 @end table
5442
5443
5444 @node Paging the Article
5445 @section Scrolling the Article
5446 @cindex article scrolling
5447
5448 @table @kbd
5449
5450 @item SPACE
5451 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5452 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5453 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5454 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5455 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5456
5457 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5458 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5459 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5460 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5461 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5462 what is considered uninteresting with
5463 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5464 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5465
5466 @item DEL
5467 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5468 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5469 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5470
5471 @item RET
5472 @kindex RET (Summary)
5473 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5474 Scroll the current article one line forward
5475 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5476
5477 @item M-RET
5478 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5479 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5480 Scroll the current article one line backward
5481 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5482
5483 @item A g
5484 @itemx g
5485 @kindex A g (Summary)
5486 @kindex g (Summary)
5487 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5488 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5489 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5490 given a prefix, show a completely ``raw'' article, just the way it
5491 came from the server. If given a prefix twice (i.e., @kbd{C-u C-u
5492 g'}), fetch the current article, but don't run any of the article
5493 treatment functions.
5494
5495 @cindex charset, view article with different charset
5496 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5497 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5498 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5499
5500 @lisp
5501 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5502 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5503 (2 . big5)))
5504 @end lisp
5505
5506 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5507
5508 @item A <
5509 @itemx <
5510 @kindex < (Summary)
5511 @kindex A < (Summary)
5512 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5513 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5514 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5515
5516 @item A >
5517 @itemx >
5518 @kindex > (Summary)
5519 @kindex A > (Summary)
5520 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5521 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5522
5523 @item A s
5524 @itemx s
5525 @kindex A s (Summary)
5526 @kindex s (Summary)
5527 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5528 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5529 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5530
5531 @item h
5532 @kindex h (Summary)
5533 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5534 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5535
5536 @end table
5537
5538
5539 @node Reply Followup and Post
5540 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5541
5542 @menu
5543 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5544 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5545 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5546 * Canceling and Superseding::
5547 @end menu
5548
5549
5550 @node Summary Mail Commands
5551 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5552 @cindex mail
5553 @cindex composing mail
5554
5555 Commands for composing a mail message:
5556
5557 @table @kbd
5558
5559 @item S r
5560 @itemx r
5561 @kindex S r (Summary)
5562 @kindex r (Summary)
5563 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5564 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5565 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5566 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5567 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5568
5569 @item S R
5570 @itemx R
5571 @kindex R (Summary)
5572 @kindex S R (Summary)
5573 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5574 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5575 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5576 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5577 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5578
5579 @item S w
5580 @kindex S w (Summary)
5581 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5582 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5583 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5584 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5585 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5586 present, that's used instead.
5587
5588 @item S W
5589 @kindex S W (Summary)
5590 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5591 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5592 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5593 the process/prefix convention, but only uses the headers from the
5594 first article to determine the recipients.
5595
5596 @item S L
5597 @kindex S L (Summary)
5598 @findex gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original
5599 When replying to a message from a mailing list, send a reply to that
5600 message to the mailing list, and include the original message
5601 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original}).
5602
5603 @item S v
5604 @kindex S v (Summary)
5605 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5606 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5607 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5608 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5609 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5610 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5611
5612 @item S V
5613 @kindex S V (Summary)
5614 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5615 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5616 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5617 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5618
5619 @item S B r
5620 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5621 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5622 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5623 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5624 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5625 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5626 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5627 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5628
5629 @item S B R
5630 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5631 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5632 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5633 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5634 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5635
5636 @item S o m
5637 @itemx C-c C-f
5638 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5639 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5640 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5641 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5642 Forward the current article to some other person
5643 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5644 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5645 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5646 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5647 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5648 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5649 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5650 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5651 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5652 section.
5653
5654 @item S m
5655 @itemx m
5656 @kindex m (Summary)
5657 @kindex S m (Summary)
5658 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5659 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5660 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5661 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5662 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5663
5664 @item S i
5665 @kindex S i (Summary)
5666 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5667 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5668 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5669 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5670
5671 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5672 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5673 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5674 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5675 for this to work though.
5676
5677 @item S D b
5678 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5679 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5680 @cindex bouncing mail
5681 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5682 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5683 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5684 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5685 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5686 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5687 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5688 very well fail, though.
5689
5690 @item S D r
5691 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5692 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5693 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5694 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5695 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5696 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5697 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5698 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5699 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5700 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5701
5702 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5703 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5704 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5705 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5706 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5707
5708 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5709 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5710
5711 @item S D e
5712 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5713 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5714
5715 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5716 if it were a new message before resending.
5717
5718 @item S O m
5719 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5720 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5721 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5722 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5723 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5724
5725 @item S M-c
5726 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5727 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5728 @cindex crossposting
5729 @cindex excessive crossposting
5730 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5731 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5732
5733 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5734 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5735 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5736 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5737 command understands the process/prefix convention
5738 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5739
5740 @end table
5741
5742 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5743 Manual}, for more information.
5744
5745
5746 @node Summary Post Commands
5747 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5748 @cindex post
5749 @cindex composing news
5750
5751 Commands for posting a news article:
5752
5753 @table @kbd
5754 @item S p
5755 @itemx a
5756 @kindex a (Summary)
5757 @kindex S p (Summary)
5758 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5759 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5760 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5761 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5762 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5763
5764 @item S f
5765 @itemx f
5766 @kindex f (Summary)
5767 @kindex S f (Summary)
5768 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5769 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5770 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5771
5772 @item S F
5773 @itemx F
5774 @kindex S F (Summary)
5775 @kindex F (Summary)
5776 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5777 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5778 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5779 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5780 process/prefix convention.
5781
5782 @item S n
5783 @kindex S n (Summary)
5784 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5785 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5786 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5787
5788 @item S N
5789 @kindex S N (Summary)
5790 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5791 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5792 message through mail and include the original message
5793 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5794 the process/prefix convention.
5795
5796 @item S o p
5797 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5798 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5799 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5800 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5801 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5802 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5803 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5804 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5805 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5806 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5807 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5808 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5809 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5810
5811 @item S O p
5812 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5813 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5814 @cindex digests
5815 @cindex making digests
5816 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5817 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5818 process/prefix convention.
5819
5820 @item S u
5821 @kindex S u (Summary)
5822 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5823 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5824 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5825 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5826 @end table
5827
5828 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5829 Manual}, for more information.
5830
5831
5832 @node Summary Message Commands
5833 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5834
5835 @table @kbd
5836 @item S y
5837 @kindex S y (Summary)
5838 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5839 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5840 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5841 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5842 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5843
5844 @end table
5845
5846
5847 @node Canceling and Superseding
5848 @subsection Canceling Articles
5849 @cindex canceling articles
5850 @cindex superseding articles
5851
5852 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5853 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5854
5855 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5856
5857 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5858 @kindex C (Summary)
5859 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5860 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5861 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5862 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5863 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5864 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5865
5866 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5867 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5868 question.
5869
5870 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5871 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5872 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5873
5874 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5875 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5876 message, Message Manual}).
5877
5878 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5879 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5880 your original article.
5881
5882 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5883 @kindex S (Summary)
5884 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5885 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5886 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5887 usual way.
5888
5889 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5890 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5891 have posted almost the same article twice.
5892
5893 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5894 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5895 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5896 to the post buffer (which is called @file{*sent ...*}). There you will
5897 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5898 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5899 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5900 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5901 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5902 canceled/superseded.
5903
5904 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5905
5906 @node Delayed Articles
5907 @section Delayed Articles
5908 @cindex delayed sending
5909 @cindex send delayed
5910
5911 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5912 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5913 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5914 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5915
5916 @lisp
5917 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5918 @end lisp
5919
5920 @findex gnus-delay-article
5921 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5922 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5923 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5924 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5925
5926 @itemize @bullet
5927 @item
5928 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5929 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5930 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5931 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5932
5933 @item
5934 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5935 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5936 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5937
5938 @item
5939 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5940 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5941 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5942 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5943 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5944 that means a time tomorrow.
5945 @end itemize
5946
5947 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5948 couple of variables:
5949
5950 @table @code
5951 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5952 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5953 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5954 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5955
5956 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5957 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5958 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5959 formats described above.
5960
5961 @item gnus-delay-group
5962 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5963 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5964 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5965 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5966
5967 @item gnus-delay-header
5968 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5969 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5970 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5971 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5972 @end table
5973
5974 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5975 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5976 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5977 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5978 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5979
5980 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5981 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5982 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5983 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5984 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5985 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5986 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5987
5988 @table @code
5989 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5990 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5991 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5992 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5993 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5994 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5995 argument is ignored.
5996
5997 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5998 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5999 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
6000 @end table
6001
6002 When delaying an article with @kbd{C-c C-j}, Message mode will
6003 automatically add a @code{"Date"} header with the current time. In
6004 many cases you probably want the @code{"Date"} header to reflect the
6005 time the message is sent instead. To do this, you have to delete
6006 @code{Date} from @code{message-draft-headers}.
6007
6008
6009 @node Marking Articles
6010 @section Marking Articles
6011 @cindex article marking
6012 @cindex article ticking
6013 @cindex marks
6014
6015 There are several marks you can set on an article.
6016
6017 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
6018 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
6019 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
6020
6021 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
6022
6023 @ifinfo
6024 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
6025 @end ifinfo
6026
6027 @menu
6028 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
6029 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
6030 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
6031 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
6032 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
6033 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
6034 @end menu
6035
6036
6037 @node Unread Articles
6038 @subsection Unread Articles
6039
6040 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
6041 other.
6042
6043 @table @samp
6044 @item !
6045 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
6046 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
6047
6048 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
6049 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
6050 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
6051 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
6052 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
6053 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
6054 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
6055
6056 @item ?
6057 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
6058 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
6059
6060 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
6061 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
6062 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
6063 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
6064 messages.
6065
6066 @item SPACE
6067 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
6068 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
6069
6070 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
6071 @end table
6072
6073
6074 @node Read Articles
6075 @subsection Read Articles
6076 @cindex expirable mark
6077
6078 All the following marks mark articles as read.
6079
6080 @table @samp
6081
6082 @item r
6083 @vindex gnus-del-mark
6084 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
6085 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
6086
6087 @item R
6088 @vindex gnus-read-mark
6089 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
6090
6091 @item O
6092 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
6093 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
6094 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
6095
6096 @item K
6097 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
6098 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
6099
6100 @item X
6101 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
6102 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
6103
6104 @item Y
6105 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
6106 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
6107
6108 @item C
6109 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
6110 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
6111
6112 @item G
6113 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
6114 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
6115
6116 @item Q
6117 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
6118 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
6119 Threading}.
6120
6121 @item M
6122 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
6123 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
6124 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
6125
6126 @end table
6127
6128 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
6129 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
6130
6131 One more special mark, though:
6132
6133 @table @samp
6134 @item E
6135 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
6136 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
6137
6138 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
6139 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
6140 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
6141 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
6142 any time.
6143 @end table
6144
6145
6146 @node Other Marks
6147 @subsection Other Marks
6148 @cindex process mark
6149 @cindex bookmarks
6150
6151 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
6152 read or not.
6153
6154 @itemize @bullet
6155
6156 @item
6157 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
6158 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
6159 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
6160 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
6161 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
6162
6163 @item
6164 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
6165 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
6166 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
6167 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
6168
6169 @item
6170 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
6171 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
6172 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
6173
6174 @item
6175 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
6176 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
6177 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6178
6179 @item
6180 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
6181 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
6182 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
6183 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
6184
6185 @item
6186 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
6187 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
6188 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
6189
6190 @item
6191 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
6192 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
6193 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
6194 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
6195 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
6196 use.)
6197
6198 @item
6199 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
6200 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
6201 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
6202 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
6203 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
6204 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
6205
6206 @item
6207 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
6208 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
6209 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
6210 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
6211 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
6212 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
6213 use.)
6214
6215 @item
6216 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
6217 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
6218 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
6219 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
6220 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
6221
6222 @item
6223 @vindex gnus-process-mark
6224 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
6225 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
6226 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
6227 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
6228 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
6229
6230 @end itemize
6231
6232 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
6233 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
6234 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
6235
6236 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
6237 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
6238 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
6239
6240
6241 @node Setting Marks
6242 @subsection Setting Marks
6243 @cindex setting marks
6244
6245 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
6246
6247 @table @kbd
6248 @item M c
6249 @itemx M-u
6250 @kindex M c (Summary)
6251 @kindex M-u (Summary)
6252 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
6253 @cindex mark as unread
6254 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
6255 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
6256 article as unread.
6257
6258 @item M t
6259 @itemx !
6260 @kindex ! (Summary)
6261 @kindex M t (Summary)
6262 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
6263 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
6264 @xref{Article Caching}.
6265
6266 @item M ?
6267 @itemx ?
6268 @kindex ? (Summary)
6269 @kindex M ? (Summary)
6270 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
6271 Mark the current article as dormant
6272 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6273
6274 @item M d
6275 @itemx d
6276 @kindex M d (Summary)
6277 @kindex d (Summary)
6278 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
6279 Mark the current article as read
6280 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
6281
6282 @item D
6283 @kindex D (Summary)
6284 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
6285 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
6286 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
6287
6288 @item M k
6289 @itemx k
6290 @kindex k (Summary)
6291 @kindex M k (Summary)
6292 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
6293 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
6294 and then select the next unread article
6295 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
6296
6297 @item M K
6298 @itemx C-k
6299 @kindex M K (Summary)
6300 @kindex C-k (Summary)
6301 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
6302 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
6303 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
6304
6305 @item M C
6306 @kindex M C (Summary)
6307 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
6308 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
6309 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
6310
6311 @item M C-c
6312 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
6313 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6314 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6315 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6316
6317 @item M H
6318 @kindex M H (Summary)
6319 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6320 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6321 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6322
6323 @item M h
6324 @kindex M h (Summary)
6325 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6326 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6327 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6328
6329 @item C-w
6330 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6331 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6332 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6333 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6334
6335 @item M V k
6336 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6337 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6338 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6339 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6340
6341 @item M e
6342 @itemx E
6343 @kindex M e (Summary)
6344 @kindex E (Summary)
6345 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6346 Mark the current article as expirable
6347 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6348
6349 @item M b
6350 @kindex M b (Summary)
6351 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6352 Set a bookmark in the current article
6353 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6354
6355 @item M B
6356 @kindex M B (Summary)
6357 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6358 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6359 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6360
6361 @item M V c
6362 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6363 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6364 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6365 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6366
6367 @item M V u
6368 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6369 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6370 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6371 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6372
6373 @item M V m
6374 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6375 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6376 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6377 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6378 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6379 @end table
6380
6381 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6382 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6383 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6384 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6385 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6386 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6387 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6388 The default is @code{t}.
6389
6390
6391 @node Generic Marking Commands
6392 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6393
6394 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) to
6395 go to the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6396 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article.
6397 And even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6398 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6399 well.
6400
6401 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6402 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6403 command should do.
6404
6405 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6406 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6407 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6408 to list in this manual.
6409
6410 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6411 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6412 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6413 article, you could say something like:
6414
6415 @lisp
6416 @group
6417 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6418 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6419 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6420 @end group
6421 @end lisp
6422
6423 @noindent
6424 or
6425
6426 @lisp
6427 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6428 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6429 @end lisp
6430
6431
6432 @node Setting Process Marks
6433 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6434 @cindex setting process marks
6435
6436 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6437 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6438 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6439 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6440 articles into the cache. For more information,
6441 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6442
6443 @table @kbd
6444
6445 @item M P p
6446 @itemx #
6447 @kindex # (Summary)
6448 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6449 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6450 Mark the current article with the process mark
6451 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6452 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6453
6454 @item M P u
6455 @itemx M-#
6456 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6457 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6458 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6459 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6460
6461 @item M P U
6462 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6463 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6464 Remove the process mark from all articles
6465 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6466
6467 @item M P i
6468 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6469 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6470 Invert the list of process marked articles
6471 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6472
6473 @item M P R
6474 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6475 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6476 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6477 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6478
6479 @item M P G
6480 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6481 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6482 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6483 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6484
6485 @item M P r
6486 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6487 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6488 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6489
6490 @item M P g
6491 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6492 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6493 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6494
6495 @item M P t
6496 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6497 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6498 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6499 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6500
6501 @item M P T
6502 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6503 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6504 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6505 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6506
6507 @item M P v
6508 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6509 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6510 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6511 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6512
6513 @item M P s
6514 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6515 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6516 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6517
6518 @item M P S
6519 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6520 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6521 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6522 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6523
6524 @item M P a
6525 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6526 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6527 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6528
6529 @item M P b
6530 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6531 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6532 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6533 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6534
6535 @item M P k
6536 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6537 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6538 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6539 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6540
6541 @item M P y
6542 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6543 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6544 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6545 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6546
6547 @item M P w
6548 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6549 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6550 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6551 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6552
6553 @end table
6554
6555 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6556 set process marks based on article body contents.
6557
6558
6559 @node Limiting
6560 @section Limiting
6561 @cindex limiting
6562
6563 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6564 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6565 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6566 buffer.
6567
6568 Limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched from
6569 the servers. These commands don't query the server for additional
6570 articles.
6571
6572 @table @kbd
6573
6574 @item / /
6575 @itemx / s
6576 @kindex / / (Summary)
6577 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6578 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6579 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6580 matching articles.
6581
6582 @item / a
6583 @kindex / a (Summary)
6584 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6585 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6586 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6587 matching articles.
6588
6589 @item / R
6590 @kindex / R (Summary)
6591 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient
6592 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some recipient
6593 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient}). If given a prefix, exclude
6594 matching articles.
6595
6596 @item / A
6597 @kindex / A (Summary)
6598 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-address
6599 Limit the summary buffer to articles in which contents of From, To or Cc
6600 header match a given address (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-address}). If
6601 given a prefix, exclude matching articles.
6602
6603 @item / S
6604 @kindex / S (Summary)
6605 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons
6606 Limit the summary buffer to articles that aren't part of any displayed
6607 threads (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons}). If given a prefix,
6608 limit to articles that are part of displayed threads.
6609
6610 @item / x
6611 @kindex / x (Summary)
6612 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6613 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6614 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6615 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6616 matching articles.
6617
6618 @item / u
6619 @itemx x
6620 @kindex / u (Summary)
6621 @kindex x (Summary)
6622 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6623 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6624 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6625 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6626 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6627
6628 @item / m
6629 @kindex / m (Summary)
6630 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6631 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6632 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6633
6634 @item / t
6635 @kindex / t (Summary)
6636 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6637 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6638 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6639 articles younger than that number of days.
6640
6641 @item / n
6642 @kindex / n (Summary)
6643 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6644 With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
6645 articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
6646 instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
6647
6648 @item / w
6649 @kindex / w (Summary)
6650 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6651 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6652 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6653 the stack.
6654
6655 @item / .
6656 @kindex / . (Summary)
6657 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6658 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6659 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6660
6661 @item / v
6662 @kindex / v (Summary)
6663 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6664 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6665 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6666
6667 @item / p
6668 @kindex / p (Summary)
6669 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6670 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6671 group parameter predicate
6672 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6673 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6674
6675 @item / r
6676 @kindex / r (Summary)
6677 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-replied
6678 Limit the summary buffer to replied articles
6679 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-replied}). If given a prefix, exclude
6680 replied articles.
6681
6682 @item / E
6683 @itemx M S
6684 @kindex M S (Summary)
6685 @kindex / E (Summary)
6686 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6687 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6688 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6689
6690 @item / D
6691 @kindex / D (Summary)
6692 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6693 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6694 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6695
6696 @item / *
6697 @kindex / * (Summary)
6698 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6699 Include all cached articles in the limit
6700 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6701
6702 @item / d
6703 @kindex / d (Summary)
6704 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6705 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6706 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6707
6708 @item / M
6709 @kindex / M (Summary)
6710 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6711 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6712
6713 @item / T
6714 @kindex / T (Summary)
6715 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6716 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6717
6718 @item / c
6719 @kindex / c (Summary)
6720 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6721 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6722 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6723
6724 @item / C
6725 @kindex / C (Summary)
6726 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6727 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6728 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6729 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6730
6731 @item / b
6732 @kindex / b (Summary)
6733 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies
6734 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have bodies that match a
6735 certain regexp (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies}). If given a
6736 prefix, reverse the limit. This command is quite slow since it
6737 requires selecting each article to find the matches.
6738
6739 @item / h
6740 @kindex / h (Summary)
6741 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-headers
6742 Like the previous command, only limit to headers instead
6743 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-headers}).
6744
6745 @end table
6746
6747
6748 The following commands aren't limiting commands, but use the @kbd{/}
6749 prefix as well.
6750
6751 @table @kbd
6752 @item / N
6753 @kindex / N (Summary)
6754 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6755 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6756 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6757
6758 @item / o
6759 @kindex / o (Summary)
6760 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6761 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6762 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6763
6764 @end table
6765
6766
6767 @node Threading
6768 @section Threading
6769 @cindex threading
6770 @cindex article threading
6771
6772 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6773 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6774 hierarchical fashion.
6775
6776 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6777 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6778 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6779 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6780 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6781 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6782 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6783
6784 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6785
6786 @table @dfn
6787 @item root
6788 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6789
6790 @item thread
6791 A tree-like article structure.
6792
6793 @item sub-thread
6794 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6795
6796 @item loose threads
6797 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6798 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6799 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6800 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6801 called loose threads.
6802
6803 @item thread gathering
6804 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6805
6806 @item sparse threads
6807 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6808 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6809
6810 @end table
6811
6812
6813 @menu
6814 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6815 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6816 @end menu
6817
6818
6819 @node Customizing Threading
6820 @subsection Customizing Threading
6821 @cindex customizing threading
6822
6823 @menu
6824 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6825 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6826 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6827 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6828 @end menu
6829
6830
6831 @node Loose Threads
6832 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6833 @cindex <
6834 @cindex >
6835 @cindex loose threads
6836
6837 @table @code
6838 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6839 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6840 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6841 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6842 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6843 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6844
6845 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6846 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6847 There are four possible values:
6848
6849 @iftex
6850 @iflatex
6851 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6852 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6853 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6854 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6855 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6856 }
6857 @end iflatex
6858 @end iftex
6859
6860 @cindex adopting articles
6861
6862 @table @code
6863
6864 @item adopt
6865 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6866 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6867 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6868 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6869
6870 @item dummy
6871 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6872 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6873 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6874 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6875 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6876 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6877 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6878 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6879 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6880 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6881
6882 @item empty
6883 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6884 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6885 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6886 Buffer Format}).)
6887
6888 @item none
6889 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6890 display them after one another.
6891
6892 @item nil
6893 Don't gather loose threads.
6894 @end table
6895
6896 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6897 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6898 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6899 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6900 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6901 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6902 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6903 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6904 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6905 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6906 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6907
6908 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6909 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6910 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6911 Matching}).
6912
6913 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6914 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6915 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6916 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6917 simplification is used.
6918
6919 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6920 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6921 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6922 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6923
6924 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6925 @lisp
6926 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6927 (concat
6928 "\\`\\[?\\("
6929 (mapconcat
6930 'identity
6931 '("looking"
6932 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6933 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6934 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6935 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6936 ;; ...
6937 )
6938 "\\|")
6939 "\\)\\s *\\("
6940 (mapconcat 'identity
6941 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6942 "\\|")
6943 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6944 @end lisp
6945
6946 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6947 subjects.
6948
6949 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6950 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6951 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6952 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6953 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6954 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6955
6956 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6957
6958 @table @code
6959 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6960 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6961 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6962
6963 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6964 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6965 Simplify fuzzily.
6966
6967 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6968 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6969 Remove excessive whitespace.
6970
6971 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6972 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6973 Remove all whitespace.
6974 @end table
6975
6976 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6977
6978
6979 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6980 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6981 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6982 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6983 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6984 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6985 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6986 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6987
6988 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6989 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6990 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6991 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6992 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6993 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6994 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6995 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6996 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6997 cholera:
6998
6999 @table @code
7000 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
7001 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
7002 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
7003 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
7004
7005 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
7006 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
7007 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
7008 @end table
7009
7010 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
7011 something like:
7012
7013 @lisp
7014 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
7015 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
7016 @end lisp
7017
7018 @end table
7019
7020
7021 @node Filling In Threads
7022 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
7023
7024 @table @code
7025 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
7026 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
7027 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
7028 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
7029 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
7030 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
7031 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
7032 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
7033 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
7034 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
7035 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
7036 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
7037 do about that.
7038
7039 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
7040 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
7041 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
7042
7043 The server has to support @acronym{NOV} for any of this to work.
7044
7045 @cindex Gmane, gnus-fetch-old-headers
7046 This feature can seriously impact performance it ignores all locally
7047 cached header entries. Setting it to @code{t} for groups for a server
7048 that doesn't expire articles (such as news.gmane.org), leads to very
7049 slow summary generation.
7050
7051 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7052 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7053 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
7054 newsgroups.
7055
7056 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
7057 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
7058 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
7059 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
7060 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
7061 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
7062 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
7063 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
7064 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
7065 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
7066 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
7067 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
7068 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
7069 @code{nil} by default.
7070
7071 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
7072 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
7073 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
7074 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
7075 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
7076 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
7077 web-based groups.
7078
7079 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
7080 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
7081 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
7082
7083 @end table
7084
7085
7086 @node More Threading
7087 @subsubsection More Threading
7088
7089 @table @code
7090 @item gnus-show-threads
7091 @vindex gnus-show-threads
7092 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
7093 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
7094 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
7095 slower and more awkward.
7096
7097 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7098 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7099 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
7100 generated.
7101
7102 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
7103 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
7104 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
7105
7106 Here's an example:
7107
7108 @lisp
7109 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7110 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
7111 gnus-article-unseen-p))
7112 @end lisp
7113
7114 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
7115 unread, but you get my drift.)
7116
7117
7118 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
7119 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
7120 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
7121 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
7122 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
7123 threads are expunged.
7124
7125 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
7126 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
7127 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
7128 will be hidden.
7129
7130 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7131 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7132 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
7133 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
7134 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
7135 result in a new thread.
7136
7137 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
7138 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
7139 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
7140 The default is 4.
7141
7142 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7143 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7144 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
7145 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
7146 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
7147 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
7148 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
7149 Setting this variable to an alternate value
7150 (e.g., @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
7151 appropriate hook (e.g., @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
7152 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
7153
7154 @end table
7155
7156
7157 @node Low-Level Threading
7158 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
7159
7160 @table @code
7161
7162 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
7163 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
7164 Hook run before parsing any headers.
7165
7166 @item gnus-alter-header-function
7167 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
7168 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
7169 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
7170 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
7171 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
7172 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
7173 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
7174 meaningful. Here's one example:
7175
7176 @lisp
7177 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
7178
7179 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
7180 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
7181 (when (string-match
7182 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
7183 (mail-header-set-id
7184 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
7185 header))))
7186 @end lisp
7187
7188 @end table
7189
7190
7191 @node Thread Commands
7192 @subsection Thread Commands
7193 @cindex thread commands
7194
7195 @table @kbd
7196
7197 @item T k
7198 @itemx C-M-k
7199 @kindex T k (Summary)
7200 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
7201 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
7202 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
7203 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
7204 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
7205 articles instead.
7206
7207 @item T l
7208 @itemx C-M-l
7209 @kindex T l (Summary)
7210 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
7211 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
7212 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
7213 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
7214
7215 @item T i
7216 @kindex T i (Summary)
7217 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
7218 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
7219 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
7220
7221 @item T #
7222 @kindex T # (Summary)
7223 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
7224 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
7225 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
7226
7227 @item T M-#
7228 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
7229 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
7230 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
7231 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
7232
7233 @item T T
7234 @kindex T T (Summary)
7235 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
7236 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
7237
7238 @item T s
7239 @kindex T s (Summary)
7240 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
7241 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
7242 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
7243
7244 @item T h
7245 @kindex T h (Summary)
7246 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
7247 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
7248
7249 @item T S
7250 @kindex T S (Summary)
7251 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
7252 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
7253
7254 @item T H
7255 @kindex T H (Summary)
7256 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
7257 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
7258
7259 @item T t
7260 @kindex T t (Summary)
7261 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
7262 Re-thread the current article's thread
7263 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
7264 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
7265
7266 @item T ^
7267 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
7268 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
7269 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
7270 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
7271
7272 @item T M-^
7273 @kindex T M-^ (Summary)
7274 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-children
7275 Make the current article the parent of the marked articles
7276 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-children}).
7277
7278 @end table
7279
7280 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
7281 understand the numeric prefix.
7282
7283 @table @kbd
7284
7285 @item T n
7286 @kindex T n (Summary)
7287 @itemx C-M-f
7288 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
7289 @itemx M-down
7290 @kindex M-down (Summary)
7291 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
7292 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
7293
7294 @item T p
7295 @kindex T p (Summary)
7296 @itemx C-M-b
7297 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
7298 @itemx M-up
7299 @kindex M-up (Summary)
7300 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
7301 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
7302
7303 @item T d
7304 @kindex T d (Summary)
7305 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
7306 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
7307
7308 @item T u
7309 @kindex T u (Summary)
7310 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
7311 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
7312
7313 @item T o
7314 @kindex T o (Summary)
7315 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
7316 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
7317 @end table
7318
7319 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
7320 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
7321 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
7322 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
7323 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
7324 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
7325 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
7326 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
7327 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
7328 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
7329 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
7330 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
7331 Matching}).
7332
7333
7334 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
7335 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
7336
7337 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
7338 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
7339 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
7340 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7341 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
7342 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient
7343 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7344 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
7345 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
7346 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
7347 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
7348 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
7349 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
7350 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
7351 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
7352
7353 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
7354 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
7355 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient},
7356 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
7357 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date},
7358 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
7359 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
7360 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
7361 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
7362 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
7363
7364 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
7365 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
7366 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread. Exceptions
7367 to this rule are @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number} and
7368 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date}.
7369
7370 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
7371 last function in the list. You should probably always include
7372 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
7373 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
7374 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
7375 ascending article order.
7376
7377 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
7378 by number, you could do something like:
7379
7380 @lisp
7381 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7382 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7383 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7384 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7385 @end lisp
7386
7387 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7388 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7389 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7390 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7391 which the articles arrived.
7392
7393 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7394 say something like:
7395
7396 @lisp
7397 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7398 '((not gnus-thread-sort-by-number)
7399 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7400 @end lisp
7401
7402 By default, threads including their subthreads are sorted according to
7403 the value of @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}. By customizing
7404 @code{gnus-subthread-sort-functions} you can define a custom sorting
7405 order for subthreads. This allows for example to sort threads from
7406 high score to low score in the summary buffer, but to have subthreads
7407 still sorted chronologically from old to new without taking their
7408 score into account.
7409
7410 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7411 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7412 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7413 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7414 tickles your fancy.
7415
7416 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7417 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7418 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-date
7419 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7420 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7421 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7422 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7423 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7424 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-number
7425 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7426 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7427 variable. It is very similar to the
7428 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7429 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7430 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7431 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7432 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7433 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7434 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7435
7436 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7437 say something like:
7438
7439 @lisp
7440 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7441 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7442 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7443 @end lisp
7444
7445 You can define group specific sorting via @code{gnus-parameters},
7446 @xref{Group Parameters}.
7447
7448
7449 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7450 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7451 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7452 @cindex article pre-fetch
7453 @cindex pre-fetch
7454
7455 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7456 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7457 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7458 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7459 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7460
7461 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7462 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7463
7464 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7465 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7466 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7467 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7468 connection is blocked.
7469
7470 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7471 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7472 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7473 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7474
7475 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7476 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7477 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7478 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7479 extra connection.
7480
7481 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7482 you really want to.
7483
7484 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7485 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7486 happen automatically.
7487
7488 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7489 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7490 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7491 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7492 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7493 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7494 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7495
7496 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7497 @findex gnus-async-unread-p
7498 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7499 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7500 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7501 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7502 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-unread-p}, which
7503 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7504 article data structure as the only parameter.
7505
7506 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7507 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7508
7509 @lisp
7510 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7511 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7512 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7513 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7514 100)))
7515
7516 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7517 @end lisp
7518
7519 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7520 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7521 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7522
7523 @vindex gnus-async-post-fetch-function
7524 @findex gnus-html-prefetch-images
7525 After an article has been prefetched, this
7526 @code{gnus-async-post-fetch-function} will be called. The buffer will
7527 be narrowed to the region of the article that was fetched. A useful
7528 value would be @code{gnus-html-prefetch-images}, which will prefetch
7529 and store images referenced in the article, so that you don't have to
7530 wait for them to be fetched when you read the article. This is useful
7531 for @acronym{HTML} messages that have external images.
7532
7533 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7534 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7535 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7536 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7537
7538 @table @code
7539 @item read
7540 Remove articles when they are read.
7541
7542 @item exit
7543 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7544 @end table
7545
7546 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7547
7548 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7549 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7550 @c from the next group.
7551
7552
7553 @node Article Caching
7554 @section Article Caching
7555 @cindex article caching
7556 @cindex caching
7557
7558 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7559 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7560 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7561 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7562 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7563
7564 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7565
7566 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7567 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7568 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7569 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7570 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7571 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7572 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7573 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7574
7575 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7576 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7577 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7578 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7579 as dormant, and don't worry.
7580
7581 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7582
7583 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7584 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7585 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7586 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7587 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7588 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7589 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7590 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7591 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7592 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7593
7594 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7595 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7596 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7597 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7598 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7599 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7600 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7601 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7602 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7603 not then be downloaded by this command.
7604
7605 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7606 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7607 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7608 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7609 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7610 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7611
7612 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7613 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7614 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7615 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7616 variables, the group is not cached.
7617
7618 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7619 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7620 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7621 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7622 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7623 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7624 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7625 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7626 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7627 file.
7628
7629 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7630 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7631 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7632 where, isn't that cool?
7633
7634 @node Persistent Articles
7635 @section Persistent Articles
7636 @cindex persistent articles
7637
7638 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7639 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7640 useful in my opinion.
7641
7642 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7643 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7644 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7645 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7646 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7647 the expiry going on at the news server.
7648
7649 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7650 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7651 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7652
7653 @table @kbd
7654
7655 @item *
7656 @kindex * (Summary)
7657 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7658 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7659
7660 @item M-*
7661 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7662 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7663 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7664 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7665 article.
7666 @end table
7667
7668 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7669
7670 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7671 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7672 interested in persistent articles:
7673
7674 @lisp
7675 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7676 @end lisp
7677
7678 @node Sticky Articles
7679 @section Sticky Articles
7680 @cindex sticky articles
7681
7682 When you select an article the current article buffer will be reused
7683 according to the value of the variable
7684 @code{gnus-single-article-buffer}. If its value is non-@code{nil} (the
7685 default) all articles reuse the same article buffer. Else each group
7686 has its own article buffer.
7687
7688 This implies that it's not possible to have more than one article buffer
7689 in a group at a time. But sometimes you might want to display all the
7690 latest emails from your mother, your father, your aunt, your uncle and
7691 your 17 cousins to coordinate the next Christmas party.
7692
7693 That's where sticky articles come in handy. A sticky article buffer
7694 basically is a normal article buffer, but it won't be reused when you
7695 select another article. You can make an article sticky with:
7696
7697 @table @kbd
7698 @item A S
7699 @kindex A S (Summary)
7700 @findex gnus-sticky-article
7701 Make the current article sticky. If a prefix arg is given, ask for a
7702 name for this sticky article buffer.
7703 @end table
7704
7705 To close a sticky article buffer you can use these commands:
7706
7707 @table @kbd
7708 @item q
7709 @kindex q (Article)
7710 @findex bury-buffer
7711 Puts this sticky article buffer at the end of the list of all buffers.
7712
7713 @item k
7714 @kindex k (Article)
7715 @findex gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffer
7716 Kills this sticky article buffer.
7717 @end table
7718
7719 To kill all sticky article buffers you can use:
7720
7721 @defun gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffers ARG
7722 Kill all sticky article buffers.
7723 If a prefix ARG is given, ask for confirmation.
7724 @end defun
7725
7726 @node Article Backlog
7727 @section Article Backlog
7728 @cindex backlog
7729 @cindex article backlog
7730
7731 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7732 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7733 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7734 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7735 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7736 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7737 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7738 increase memory usage some.
7739
7740 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7741 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7742 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7743 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7744 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7745 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7746 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7747
7748 The default value is 20.
7749
7750
7751 @node Saving Articles
7752 @section Saving Articles
7753 @cindex saving articles
7754
7755 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7756 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7757 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7758 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7759 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7760
7761 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7762 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7763 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7764
7765 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7766 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7767 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7768
7769 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7770 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7771 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7772 deleted before saving.
7773
7774 @table @kbd
7775
7776 @item O o
7777 @itemx o
7778 @kindex O o (Summary)
7779 @kindex o (Summary)
7780 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7781 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7782 Save the current article using the default article saver
7783 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7784
7785 @item O m
7786 @kindex O m (Summary)
7787 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7788 Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
7789 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7790
7791 @item O r
7792 @kindex O r (Summary)
7793 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7794 Save the current article in Rmail format
7795 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}). This is mbox since Emacs 23,
7796 Babyl in older versions.
7797
7798 @item O f
7799 @kindex O f (Summary)
7800 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7801 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7802 Save the current article in plain file format
7803 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7804
7805 @item O F
7806 @kindex O F (Summary)
7807 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7808 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7809 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7810
7811 @item O b
7812 @kindex O b (Summary)
7813 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7814 Save the current article body in plain file format
7815 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7816
7817 @item O h
7818 @kindex O h (Summary)
7819 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7820 Save the current article in mh folder format
7821 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7822
7823 @item O v
7824 @kindex O v (Summary)
7825 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7826 Save the current article in a VM folder
7827 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7828
7829 @item O p
7830 @itemx |
7831 @kindex O p (Summary)
7832 @kindex | (Summary)
7833 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7834 @vindex gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command
7835 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7836 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7837 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7838 complete headers in the piped output. The symbolic prefix @code{r} is
7839 special; it lets this command pipe a raw article including all headers.
7840 The @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} variable can be set
7841 to a string containing the default command and options (default
7842 @code{nil}).
7843
7844 @item O P
7845 @kindex O P (Summary)
7846 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7847 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7848 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7849 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7850 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7851 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7852 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7853
7854 @end table
7855
7856 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7857 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7858 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7859 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7860 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7861 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7862 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7863 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7864 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7865 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7866 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7867 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7868 files.
7869
7870
7871 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7872 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7873 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
7874 functions below, or you can create your own.
7875
7876 @table @code
7877
7878 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7879 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7880 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7881 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7882 This is the default format, that used by the Rmail package. Since Emacs
7883 23, Rmail uses standard mbox format. Before this, it used the
7884 @dfn{Babyl} format. Accordingly, this command writes mbox format since
7885 Emacs 23, unless appending to an existing Babyl file. In older versions
7886 of Emacs, it always uses Babyl format. Uses the function in the
7887 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7888 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7889
7890 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7891 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7892 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7893 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7894 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7895 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7896
7897 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7898 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7899 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7900 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7901 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7902 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7903 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7904
7905 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7906 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7907 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7908 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7909 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7910 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7911
7912 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7913 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7914 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7915 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7916 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7917
7918 @item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7919 @findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7920 Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7921 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7922 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7923 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7924
7925 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7926 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7927 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7928 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7929 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7930 @cindex rcvstore
7931 @cindex MH folders
7932 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7933 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7934 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7935 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7936 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7937
7938 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7939 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7940 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7941 reader to use this setting.
7942
7943 @item gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7944 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7945 Pipe the article to a shell command. This function takes optional two
7946 arguments COMMAND and RAW@. Valid values for COMMAND include:
7947
7948 @itemize @bullet
7949 @item a string@*
7950 The executable command name and possibly arguments.
7951 @item @code{nil}@*
7952 You will be prompted for the command in the minibuffer.
7953 @item the symbol @code{default}@*
7954 It will be replaced with the command which the variable
7955 @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} holds or the command
7956 last used for saving.
7957 @end itemize
7958
7959 Non-@code{nil} value for RAW overrides @code{:decode} and
7960 @code{:headers} properties (see below) and the raw article including all
7961 headers will be piped.
7962 @end table
7963
7964 The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
7965
7966 @table @code
7967 @item :decode
7968 The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
7969 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
7970 @code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
7971 @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file},
7972 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}, and
7973 @code{gnus-summary-save-in-pipe}.
7974
7975 @item :function
7976 The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
7977 overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
7978 articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
7979 @code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
7980 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
7981 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7982
7983 @item :headers
7984 The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
7985 specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
7986 @code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
7987 headers should be saved.
7988 @end table
7989
7990 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7991 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7992 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7993 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7994 default.
7995
7996 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7997 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7998 available functions that generate names:
7999
8000 @table @code
8001
8002 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
8003 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
8004 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
8005
8006 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
8007 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
8008 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
8009
8010 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
8011 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
8012 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
8013
8014 @item gnus-plain-save-name
8015 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
8016 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
8017
8018 @item gnus-sender-save-name
8019 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
8020 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
8021 @end table
8022
8023 @vindex gnus-split-methods
8024 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
8025 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
8026 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
8027 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
8028 like:
8029
8030 @lisp
8031 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
8032 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
8033 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
8034 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
8035 @end lisp
8036
8037 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
8038 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
8039 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
8040 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
8041 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
8042 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
8043 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
8044 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
8045 called returns a string or a list of strings.
8046
8047 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
8048 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
8049 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
8050 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
8051
8052 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
8053 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
8054 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
8055 name.
8056
8057 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
8058 lots of mail groups called things like
8059 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
8060 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
8061 following will do just that:
8062
8063 @lisp
8064 (defun my-save-name (group)
8065 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
8066 (substring group (match-end 0))))
8067
8068 (setq gnus-split-methods
8069 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
8070 (my-save-name)))
8071 @end lisp
8072
8073
8074 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
8075 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
8076 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
8077 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
8078 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
8079 all the files in the top level directory
8080 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
8081 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
8082 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
8083 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
8084
8085 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
8086 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
8087 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
8088 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
8089 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
8090 for kill files.
8091
8092 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
8093 a spool, you could
8094
8095 @lisp
8096 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
8097 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
8098 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
8099 @end lisp
8100
8101 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
8102 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
8103 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
8104 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
8105
8106
8107 @node Decoding Articles
8108 @section Decoding Articles
8109 @cindex decoding articles
8110
8111 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
8112 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
8113
8114 @menu
8115 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
8116 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
8117 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
8118 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
8119 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
8120 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
8121 @end menu
8122
8123 @cindex series
8124 @cindex article series
8125 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
8126 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
8127 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
8128 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
8129 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
8130
8131 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
8132 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
8133 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
8134
8135 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
8136 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
8137 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
8138
8139 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
8140 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
8141 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
8142
8143
8144 @node Uuencoded Articles
8145 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
8146 @cindex uudecode
8147 @cindex uuencoded articles
8148
8149 @table @kbd
8150
8151 @item X u
8152 @kindex X u (Summary)
8153 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
8154 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
8155 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
8156
8157 @item X U
8158 @kindex X U (Summary)
8159 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
8160 Uudecodes and saves the current series
8161 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8162
8163 @item X v u
8164 @kindex X v u (Summary)
8165 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
8166 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
8167
8168 @item X v U
8169 @kindex X v U (Summary)
8170 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
8171 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
8172 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
8173
8174 @end table
8175
8176 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
8177 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
8178 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
8179 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
8180 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8181
8182 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
8183 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
8184 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
8185 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
8186 @kbd{X u}.
8187
8188 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
8189 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
8190 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
8191 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
8192 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
8193 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
8194 off.
8195
8196
8197 @node Shell Archives
8198 @subsection Shell Archives
8199 @cindex unshar
8200 @cindex shell archives
8201 @cindex shared articles
8202
8203 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
8204 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
8205 some commands to deal with these:
8206
8207 @table @kbd
8208
8209 @item X s
8210 @kindex X s (Summary)
8211 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
8212 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
8213
8214 @item X S
8215 @kindex X S (Summary)
8216 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
8217 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
8218
8219 @item X v s
8220 @kindex X v s (Summary)
8221 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
8222 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
8223
8224 @item X v S
8225 @kindex X v S (Summary)
8226 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
8227 Unshars, views and saves the current series
8228 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
8229 @end table
8230
8231
8232 @node PostScript Files
8233 @subsection PostScript Files
8234 @cindex PostScript
8235
8236 @table @kbd
8237
8238 @item X p
8239 @kindex X p (Summary)
8240 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
8241 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
8242
8243 @item X P
8244 @kindex X P (Summary)
8245 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
8246 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
8247 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
8248
8249 @item X v p
8250 @kindex X v p (Summary)
8251 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
8252 View the current PostScript series
8253 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
8254
8255 @item X v P
8256 @kindex X v P (Summary)
8257 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
8258 View and save the current PostScript series
8259 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
8260 @end table
8261
8262
8263 @node Other Files
8264 @subsection Other Files
8265
8266 @table @kbd
8267 @item X o
8268 @kindex X o (Summary)
8269 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
8270 Save the current series
8271 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
8272
8273 @item X b
8274 @kindex X b (Summary)
8275 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
8276 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
8277 doesn't really work yet.
8278
8279 @item X Y
8280 @kindex X Y (Summary)
8281 @findex gnus-uu-decode-yenc
8282 yEnc-decode the current series and save it (@code{gnus-uu-decode-yenc}).
8283 @end table
8284
8285
8286 @node Decoding Variables
8287 @subsection Decoding Variables
8288
8289 Adjective, not verb.
8290
8291 @menu
8292 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
8293 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
8294 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
8295 @end menu
8296
8297
8298 @node Rule Variables
8299 @subsubsection Rule Variables
8300 @cindex rule variables
8301
8302 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
8303 variables are of the form
8304
8305 @lisp
8306 (list '(regexp1 command2)
8307 '(regexp2 command2)
8308 ...)
8309 @end lisp
8310
8311 @table @code
8312
8313 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8314 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8315 @cindex sox
8316 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
8317 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
8318 say something like:
8319 @lisp
8320 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8321 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
8322 @end lisp
8323
8324 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8325 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8326 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
8327 user and default view rules.
8328
8329 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8330 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8331 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
8332 archives.
8333 @end table
8334
8335
8336 @node Other Decode Variables
8337 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
8338
8339 @table @code
8340 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8341
8342 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8343 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
8344 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
8345 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
8346 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
8347
8348 @table @code
8349
8350 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
8351 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
8352 View the file.
8353
8354 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
8355 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
8356 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
8357 @end table
8358
8359 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8360 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8361 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
8362 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
8363 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
8364 time.
8365
8366 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8367 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8368 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
8369
8370 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8371 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8372 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
8373 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
8374 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
8375 kludgy.
8376
8377 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8378 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8379 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
8380
8381 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8382 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8383 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
8384 looking for files to display.
8385
8386 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
8387 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
8388 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
8389 after viewing it.
8390
8391 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8392 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8393 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
8394 rules.
8395
8396 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8397 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8398 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
8399 unpacking commands.
8400
8401 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8402 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8403 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
8404 from articles.
8405
8406 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8407 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8408 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
8409 decoded articles as unread.
8410
8411 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8412 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8413 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
8414 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
8415
8416 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8417 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8418 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
8419
8420 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8421 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8422 @cindex metamail
8423 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
8424 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
8425 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
8426 @code{metamail} for viewing.
8427
8428 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8429 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8430 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
8431 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
8432 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
8433 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
8434 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
8435 simply dropped them.
8436
8437 @end table
8438
8439
8440 @node Uuencoding and Posting
8441 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
8442
8443 @table @code
8444
8445 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8446 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8447 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
8448 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
8449 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
8450 for you when you post the article.
8451
8452 @item gnus-uu-post-length
8453 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
8454 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
8455 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
8456
8457 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
8458 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
8459 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
8460 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
8461 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
8462 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
8463 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
8464
8465 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8466 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8467 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
8468 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
8469 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
8470 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
8471 Default is @code{t}.
8472
8473 @end table
8474
8475
8476 @node Viewing Files
8477 @subsection Viewing Files
8478 @cindex viewing files
8479 @cindex pseudo-articles
8480
8481 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
8482 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
8483 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
8484 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
8485 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
8486 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
8487 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
8488
8489 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
8490 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
8491 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
8492 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
8493
8494 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
8495 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
8496 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
8497
8498 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
8499 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
8500 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
8501 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
8502 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
8503
8504 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
8505 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
8506 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
8507 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
8508 a list of parameters to that command.
8509
8510 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
8511 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
8512 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
8513
8514 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
8515 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
8516 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
8517
8518
8519 @node Article Treatment
8520 @section Article Treatment
8521
8522 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8523 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8524 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8525 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8526 these articles easier.
8527
8528 @menu
8529 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8530 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8531 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8532 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8533 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8534 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8535 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8536 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8537 * Article Display:: Display various stuff:
8538 X-Face, Picons, Gravatars, Smileys.
8539 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8540 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8541 @end menu
8542
8543
8544 @node Article Highlighting
8545 @subsection Article Highlighting
8546 @cindex highlighting
8547
8548 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8549 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8550
8551 @table @kbd
8552
8553 @item W H a
8554 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8555 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8556 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8557 Do much highlighting of the current article
8558 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8559 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8560
8561 @item W H h
8562 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8563 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8564 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8565 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8566 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8567 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8568 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8569 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8570 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8571 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8572 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8573 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8574
8575 @item W H c
8576 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8577 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8578 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8579
8580 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8581
8582 @table @code
8583 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8584
8585 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8586 If the article size in bytes is bigger than this variable (which is
8587 25000 by default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8588
8589 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8590 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8591 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8592
8593 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8594 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8595 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8596 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8597 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8598 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8599
8600 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8601 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8602 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8603
8604 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8605 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8606 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8607
8608 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8609 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8610 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8611 that it's a citation.
8612
8613 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8614 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8615 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8616
8617 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8618 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8619 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8620
8621 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8622 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8623 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8624 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8625
8626 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8627 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8628 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8629 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8630 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8631 is @code{t}.
8632
8633 @end table
8634
8635
8636 @item W H s
8637 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8638 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8639 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8640 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8641 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8642 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8643 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8644 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8645 default.
8646
8647 @end table
8648
8649 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8650
8651
8652 @node Article Fontisizing
8653 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8654 @cindex emphasis
8655 @cindex article emphasis
8656
8657 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8658 @kindex W e (Summary)
8659 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8660 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8661 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8662 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8663
8664 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8665 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8666 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8667 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8668 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8669 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8670 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8671 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8672 highlighting.
8673
8674 @lisp
8675 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8676 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8677 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8678 @end lisp
8679
8680 @cindex slash
8681 @cindex asterisk
8682 @cindex underline
8683 @cindex /
8684 @cindex *
8685
8686 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8687 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8688 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8689 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8690 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8691 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8692 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8693 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8694 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8695 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8696 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8697 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8698 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8699
8700 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8701 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8702 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8703 say something like:
8704
8705 @lisp
8706 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8707 @end lisp
8708
8709 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8710
8711 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8712 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8713 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8714 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8715
8716 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8717
8718
8719 @node Article Hiding
8720 @subsection Article Hiding
8721 @cindex article hiding
8722
8723 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8724 too much cruft in most articles.
8725
8726 @table @kbd
8727
8728 @item W W a
8729 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8730 @findex gnus-article-hide
8731 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8732 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8733 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8734
8735 @item W W h
8736 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8737 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8738 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8739 Headers}.
8740
8741 @item W W b
8742 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8743 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8744 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8745 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8746
8747 @item W W s
8748 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8749 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8750 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8751 Signature}.
8752
8753 @item W W l
8754 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8755 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8756 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8757 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8758 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8759 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8760 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8761 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8762
8763 @table @code
8764
8765 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8766 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8767 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8768 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8769
8770 @end table
8771
8772 @item W W P
8773 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8774 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8775 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8776 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8777
8778 @item W W B
8779 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8780 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8781 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8782 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8783 @cindex banner
8784 @cindex OneList
8785 @cindex stripping advertisements
8786 @cindex advertisements
8787 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8788 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8789 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8790 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8791 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8792 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8793 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8794 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8795 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8796 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8797 used.
8798
8799 For instance:
8800
8801 @lisp
8802 (setq gnus-article-banner-alist
8803 ((googleGroups .
8804 "^\n*--~--~---------\\(.+\n\\)+")))
8805 @end lisp
8806
8807 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8808 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8809 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8810
8811 @table @code
8812
8813 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8814 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8815 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8816 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8817 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8818 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8819 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8820 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8821 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8822 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8823 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8824
8825 @lisp
8826 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8827 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8828 @end lisp
8829
8830 @end table
8831
8832 @item W W c
8833 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8834 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8835 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8836 customizing the hiding:
8837
8838 @table @code
8839
8840 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8841 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8842 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8843 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8844 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8845 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8846 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8847 specs are valid:
8848
8849 @table @samp
8850 @item b
8851 Starting point of the hidden text.
8852 @item e
8853 Ending point of the hidden text.
8854 @item l
8855 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8856 @item n
8857 Number of lines of hidden text.
8858 @end table
8859
8860 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8861 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8862 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8863 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8864 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8865
8866 @end table
8867
8868 @item W W C-c
8869 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8870 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8871
8872 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8873 following two variables:
8874
8875 @table @code
8876 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8877 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8878 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8879 50), hide the cited text.
8880
8881 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8882 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8883 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8884 is hidden.
8885 @end table
8886
8887 @item W W C
8888 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8889 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8890 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8891 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8892 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8893 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8894
8895 @end table
8896
8897 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8898 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8899 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8900
8901 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8902 citation customization.
8903
8904 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8905 automatically.
8906
8907
8908 @node Article Washing
8909 @subsection Article Washing
8910 @cindex washing
8911 @cindex article washing
8912
8913 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8914 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8915
8916 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8917 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8918 Cleaner, perhaps.
8919
8920 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8921 articles by default.
8922
8923 @table @kbd
8924
8925 @item C-u g
8926 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8927 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8928 the server.
8929
8930 @item g
8931 Force redisplaying of the current article
8932 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8933 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8934 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8935 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8936
8937 @item W l
8938 @kindex W l (Summary)
8939 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8940 Remove page breaks from the current article
8941 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8942 delimiters.
8943
8944 @item W r
8945 @kindex W r (Summary)
8946 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8947 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8948 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8949 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8950 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8951 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8952
8953 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8954 positions in the alphabet, e.g., @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8955 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8956 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8957
8958 @item W m
8959 @kindex W m (Summary)
8960 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8961 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8962
8963 @item W i
8964 @kindex W i (Summary)
8965 @findex gnus-summary-idna-message
8966 Decode IDNA encoded domain names in the current articles. IDNA
8967 encoded domain names looks like @samp{xn--bar}. If a string remain
8968 unencoded after running invoking this, it is likely an invalid IDNA
8969 string (@samp{xn--bar} is invalid). You must have GNU Libidn
8970 (@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/}) installed for this command
8971 to work.
8972
8973 @item W t
8974 @item t
8975 @kindex W t (Summary)
8976 @kindex t (Summary)
8977 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8978 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8979 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8980
8981 @item W v
8982 @kindex W v (Summary)
8983 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8984 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8985 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8986
8987 @item W o
8988 @kindex W o (Summary)
8989 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8990 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8991
8992 @item W d
8993 @kindex W d (Summary)
8994 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8995 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8996 @cindex Smartquotes
8997 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8998 @cindex Latin 1
8999 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
9000 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
9001 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
9002 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
9003 interactively.
9004
9005 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
9006 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
9007 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
9008 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
9009
9010 @item W U
9011 @kindex W U (Summary)
9012 @findex gnus-article-treat-non-ascii
9013 @cindex Unicode
9014 @cindex Non-@acronym{ASCII}
9015 Translate many non-@acronym{ASCII} characters into their
9016 @acronym{ASCII} equivalents (@code{gnus-article-treat-non-ascii}).
9017 This is mostly useful if you're on a terminal that has a limited font
9018 and doesn't show accented characters, ``advanced'' punctuation, and the
9019 like. For instance, @samp{»} is translated into @samp{>>}, and so on.
9020
9021 @item W Y f
9022 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
9023 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
9024 @cindex Outlook Express
9025 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
9026 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
9027 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
9028
9029 @item W Y u
9030 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
9031 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
9032 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
9033 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
9034 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
9035 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
9036 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
9037 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
9038 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
9039 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
9040
9041 @item W Y a
9042 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
9043 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
9044 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
9045 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
9046
9047 @item W Y c
9048 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
9049 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
9050 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
9051 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
9052
9053 @item W w
9054 @kindex W w (Summary)
9055 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
9056 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
9057
9058 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
9059 when filling.
9060
9061 @item W Q
9062 @kindex W Q (Summary)
9063 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
9064 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
9065
9066 @item W C
9067 @kindex W C (Summary)
9068 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
9069 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
9070 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
9071
9072 @item W c
9073 @kindex W c (Summary)
9074 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
9075 Translate CRLF pairs (i.e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
9076 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
9077 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
9078 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
9079
9080 @item W q
9081 @kindex W q (Summary)
9082 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
9083 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
9084 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
9085 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
9086 makes strings like @samp{déjà vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu},
9087 which doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually
9088 done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9089 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9090 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9091
9092 @item W 6
9093 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
9094 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
9095 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
9096 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
9097 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
9098 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9099 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9100 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9101
9102 @item W Z
9103 @kindex W Z (Summary)
9104 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
9105 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
9106 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
9107 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
9108
9109 @item W A
9110 @kindex W A (Summary)
9111 @findex gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences
9112 @cindex @acronym{ANSI} control sequences
9113 Translate @acronym{ANSI} SGR control sequences into overlays or
9114 extents (@code{gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences}). @acronym{ANSI}
9115 sequences are used in some Chinese hierarchies for highlighting.
9116
9117 @item W u
9118 @kindex W u (Summary)
9119 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
9120 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
9121 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
9122 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
9123 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
9124
9125 @item W h
9126 @kindex W h (Summary)
9127 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
9128 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
9129 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9130 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
9131
9132 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
9133 the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
9134 (@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
9135
9136 The default is to use the function specified by
9137 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
9138 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
9139 @acronym{HTML}. Pre-defined functions you can use include:
9140
9141 @table @code
9142 @item shr
9143 Use Gnus simple html renderer.
9144
9145 @item gnus-w3m
9146 Use Gnus rendered based on w3m.
9147
9148 @item w3m
9149 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
9150
9151 @item w3m-standalone
9152 Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
9153
9154 @item links
9155 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
9156
9157 @item lynx
9158 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
9159
9160 @item html2text
9161 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
9162
9163 @end table
9164
9165 @item W b
9166 @kindex W b (Summary)
9167 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
9168 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
9169 @xref{Article Buttons}.
9170
9171 @item W B
9172 @kindex W B (Summary)
9173 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
9174 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
9175 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
9176
9177 @item W p
9178 @kindex W p (Summary)
9179 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
9180 Verify a signed control message
9181 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
9182 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
9183 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
9184 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
9185 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
9186 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
9187
9188 @item W s
9189 @kindex W s (Summary)
9190 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
9191 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
9192 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
9193 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
9194
9195 @item W a
9196 @kindex W a (Summary)
9197 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
9198 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
9199 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
9200
9201 @item W E l
9202 @kindex W E l (Summary)
9203 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
9204 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
9205 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
9206
9207 @item W E m
9208 @kindex W E m (Summary)
9209 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
9210 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
9211 lines with a single empty line.
9212 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
9213
9214 @item W E t
9215 @kindex W E t (Summary)
9216 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
9217 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
9218 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
9219
9220 @item W E a
9221 @kindex W E a (Summary)
9222 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
9223 Do all the three commands above
9224 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
9225
9226 @item W E A
9227 @kindex W E A (Summary)
9228 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
9229 Remove all blank lines
9230 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
9231
9232 @item W E s
9233 @kindex W E s (Summary)
9234 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
9235 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
9236 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
9237
9238 @item W E e
9239 @kindex W E e (Summary)
9240 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
9241 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
9242 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
9243
9244 @end table
9245
9246 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
9247
9248
9249 @node Article Header
9250 @subsection Article Header
9251
9252 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
9253
9254 @table @kbd
9255
9256 @item W G u
9257 @kindex W G u (Summary)
9258 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
9259 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
9260
9261 @item W G n
9262 @kindex W G n (Summary)
9263 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
9264 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
9265 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
9266
9267 @item W G f
9268 @kindex W G f (Summary)
9269 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
9270 Fold all the message headers
9271 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
9272
9273 @item W E w
9274 @kindex W E w (Summary)
9275 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
9276 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
9277 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
9278
9279 @end table
9280
9281
9282 @node Article Buttons
9283 @subsection Article Buttons
9284 @cindex buttons
9285
9286 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
9287 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
9288 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
9289 button on these references.
9290
9291 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9292 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
9293 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
9294 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
9295 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
9296
9297 @table @code
9298
9299 @item gnus-button-alist
9300 @vindex gnus-button-alist
9301 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
9302
9303 @lisp
9304 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9305 @end lisp
9306
9307 @table @var
9308
9309 @item regexp
9310 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
9311 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
9312 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
9313 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
9314 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
9315
9316 @item button-par
9317 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
9318 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
9319 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
9320
9321 @item use-p
9322 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
9323 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
9324 avoid false matches. Often variables named
9325 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
9326 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
9327
9328 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
9329
9330 @item function
9331 This function will be called when you click on this button.
9332
9333 @item data-par
9334 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
9335 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
9336
9337 @end table
9338
9339 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
9340
9341 @lisp
9342 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
9343 @end lisp
9344
9345 @item gnus-header-button-alist
9346 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
9347 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
9348 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
9349 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
9350
9351 @lisp
9352 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9353 @end lisp
9354
9355 @var{header} is a regular expression.
9356 @end table
9357
9358 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
9359
9360 @table @code
9361 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
9362 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
9363
9364 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
9365
9366 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
9367 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
9368 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
9369 default values of the variables above.
9370
9371 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
9372
9373 @item gnus-button-man-handler
9374 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9375 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
9376 argument with a string naming the man page.
9377
9378 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
9379
9380 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9381 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9382 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
9383
9384 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9385 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9386 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
9387 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
9388 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
9389 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
9390 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
9391 @code{ask}, always query the user what to do. If it is a function, this
9392 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
9393 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
9394 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
9395 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9396
9397 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9398 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9399 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
9400 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
9401 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
9402 string is invalid.
9403
9404 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9405 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9406 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
9407 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9408
9409 @c Misc stuff
9410
9411 @item gnus-article-button-face
9412 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
9413 Face used on buttons.
9414
9415 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
9416 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
9417 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
9418
9419 @end table
9420
9421 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
9422
9423
9424 @node Article Button Levels
9425 @subsection Article button levels
9426 @cindex button levels
9427 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
9428 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
9429 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
9430 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
9431 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
9432 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
9433 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
9434 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
9435
9436 @lisp
9437 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
9438 (setq gnus-parameters
9439 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
9440 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
9441 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
9442 @end lisp
9443
9444 @table @code
9445
9446 @item gnus-button-browse-level
9447 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
9448 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
9449 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
9450 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
9451 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
9452
9453 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
9454 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
9455 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
9456 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
9457 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
9458 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
9459 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
9460 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
9461 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
9462 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
9463 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
9464 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
9465 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
9466
9467 @item gnus-button-man-level
9468 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
9469 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
9470 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
9471
9472 @item gnus-button-message-level
9473 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
9474 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
9475 Related variables and functions include
9476 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
9477 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
9478 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
9479 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
9480
9481 @end table
9482
9483
9484 @node Article Date
9485 @subsection Article Date
9486
9487 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
9488 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
9489 when the article was sent.
9490
9491 @table @kbd
9492
9493 @item W T u
9494 @kindex W T u (Summary)
9495 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
9496 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
9497 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
9498
9499 @item W T i
9500 @kindex W T i (Summary)
9501 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
9502 @cindex ISO 8601
9503 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
9504 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
9505
9506 @item W T l
9507 @kindex W T l (Summary)
9508 @findex gnus-article-date-local
9509 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
9510
9511 @item W T p
9512 @kindex W T p (Summary)
9513 @findex gnus-article-date-english
9514 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
9515 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
9516
9517 @item W T s
9518 @kindex W T s (Summary)
9519 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
9520 @findex gnus-article-date-user
9521 @findex format-time-string
9522 Display the date using a user-defined format
9523 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
9524 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
9525 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
9526 for a list of possible format specs.
9527
9528 @item W T e
9529 @kindex W T e (Summary)
9530 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
9531 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
9532 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
9533 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
9534 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9535
9536 @example
9537 Date: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
9538 @end example
9539
9540 To make this line updated continually, set the
9541 @code{gnus-article-update-date-headers} variable to the frequency in
9542 seconds (the default is @code{nil}).
9543
9544 @item W T o
9545 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9546 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9547 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9548 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9549 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9550 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9551 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9552
9553 @end table
9554
9555 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9556 preferred format automatically.
9557
9558
9559 @node Article Display
9560 @subsection Article Display
9561 @cindex picons
9562 @cindex x-face
9563 @cindex smileys
9564 @cindex gravatars
9565
9566 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9567 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9568
9569 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9570 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9571
9572 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9573 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9574
9575 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9576 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9577
9578 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9579 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9580
9581 Gravatars reside on-line and are fetched from
9582 @uref{http://www.gravatar.com/} (@pxref{Gravatars}).
9583
9584 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9585 they'll be removed.
9586
9587 @table @kbd
9588 @item W D x
9589 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9590 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9591 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9592 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9593
9594 @item W D d
9595 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9596 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9597 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9598 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9599
9600 @item W D s
9601 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9602 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9603 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9604
9605 @item W D f
9606 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9607 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9608 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9609
9610 @item W D m
9611 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9612 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9613 Piconify all mail headers (i.e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9614 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9615
9616 @item W D n
9617 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9618 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9619 Piconify all news headers (i.e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9620 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9621
9622 @item W D g
9623 @kindex W D g (Summary)
9624 @findex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
9625 Gravatarify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
9626
9627 @item W D h
9628 @kindex W D h (Summary)
9629 @findex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
9630 Gravatarify all mail headers (i.e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9631 (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
9632
9633 @item W D D
9634 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9635 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9636 Remove all images from the article buffer
9637 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9638
9639 @item W D W
9640 @kindex W D W (Summary)
9641 @findex gnus-html-show-images
9642 If you're reading an @acronym{HTML} article rendered with
9643 @code{gnus-article-html}, then you can insert any blocked images in
9644 the buffer with this command.
9645 (@code{gnus-html-show-images}).
9646
9647 @end table
9648
9649
9650
9651 @node Article Signature
9652 @subsection Article Signature
9653 @cindex signatures
9654 @cindex article signature
9655
9656 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9657 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9658 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9659 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9660 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9661 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9662 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9663 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9664 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9665
9666 @lisp
9667 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9668 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9669 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9670 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9671 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9672 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9673 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9674 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9675 @end lisp
9676
9677 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9678 positives.
9679
9680 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9681 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9682 signature when displaying articles.
9683
9684 @enumerate
9685 @item
9686 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9687 that integer.
9688 @item
9689 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9690 than that number.
9691 @item
9692 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9693 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9694 @item
9695 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9696 in question is not a signature.
9697 @end enumerate
9698
9699 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9700 listed above. Here's an example:
9701
9702 @lisp
9703 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9704 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9705 @end lisp
9706
9707 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9708 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9709 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9710 signature after all.
9711
9712
9713 @node Article Miscellanea
9714 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9715
9716 @table @kbd
9717 @item A t
9718 @kindex A t (Summary)
9719 @findex gnus-article-babel
9720 Translate the article from one language to another
9721 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9722
9723 @end table
9724
9725
9726 @node MIME Commands
9727 @section MIME Commands
9728 @cindex MIME decoding
9729 @cindex attachments
9730 @cindex viewing attachments
9731
9732 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9733 instance, @kbd{3 K v} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9734
9735 @table @kbd
9736 @item b
9737 @itemx K v
9738 @kindex b (Summary)
9739 @kindex K v (Summary)
9740 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9741
9742 @item K o
9743 @kindex K o (Summary)
9744 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9745
9746 @item K O
9747 @kindex K O (Summary)
9748 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} part and strip it
9749 from the article. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred
9750 via the message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
9751
9752 @item K r
9753 @kindex K r (Summary)
9754 Replace the @acronym{MIME} part with an external body.
9755
9756 @item K d
9757 @kindex K d (Summary)
9758 Delete the @acronym{MIME} part and add some information about the
9759 removed part.
9760
9761 @item K c
9762 @kindex K c (Summary)
9763 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9764
9765 @item K e
9766 @kindex K e (Summary)
9767 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9768
9769 @item K i
9770 @kindex K i (Summary)
9771 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9772
9773 @item K |
9774 @kindex K | (Summary)
9775 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9776 @end table
9777
9778 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9779 the same manner:
9780
9781 @table @kbd
9782 @item K H
9783 @kindex K H (Summary)
9784 @findex gnus-article-browse-html-article
9785 View @samp{text/html} parts of the current article with a WWW browser.
9786 Inline images embedded in a message using the @code{cid} scheme, as they
9787 are generally considered to be safe, will be processed properly. The
9788 message header is added to the beginning of every @acronym{HTML} part
9789 unless the prefix argument is given.
9790
9791 Warning: Spammers use links to images (using the @code{http} scheme) in
9792 @acronym{HTML} articles to verify whether you have read the message. As
9793 this command passes the @acronym{HTML} content to the browser without
9794 eliminating these ``web bugs'' you should only use it for mails from
9795 trusted senders.
9796
9797 If you always want to display @acronym{HTML} parts in the browser, set
9798 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} to @code{nil}.
9799
9800 This command creates temporary files to pass @acronym{HTML} contents
9801 including images if any to the browser, and deletes them when exiting
9802 the group (if you want).
9803
9804 @item K b
9805 @kindex K b (Summary)
9806 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9807 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9808 parts.
9809
9810 @item W M h
9811 @kindex W M h (Summary)
9812 @findex gnus-mime-buttonize-attachments-in-header
9813 @vindex gnus-mime-display-attachment-buttons-in-header
9814 Display @acronym{MIME} part buttons in the end of the header of an
9815 article (@code{gnus-mime-buttonize-attachments-in-header}). This
9816 command toggles the display. Note that buttons to be added to the
9817 header are only the ones that aren't inlined in the body. If you want
9818 those buttons always to be displayed, set
9819 @code{gnus-mime-display-attachment-buttons-in-header} to non-@code{nil}.
9820 The default is @code{t}. To change the appearance of buttons, customize
9821 @code{gnus-header-face-alist}.
9822
9823 @item K m
9824 @kindex K m (Summary)
9825 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9826 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9827 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9828 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9829 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9830
9831 @item X m
9832 @kindex X m (Summary)
9833 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9834 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9835 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9836 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9837
9838 @item M-t
9839 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9840 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9841 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9842 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9843
9844 @item W M w
9845 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9846 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9847 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9848 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9849
9850 @item W M c
9851 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9852 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9853 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9854 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9855
9856 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9857 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9858 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9859 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9860 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9861 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9862
9863 @item W M v
9864 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9865 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9866 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9867 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9868
9869 @end table
9870
9871 Relevant variables:
9872
9873 @table @code
9874 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9875 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9876 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9877 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9878 @code{nil}.
9879
9880 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9881
9882 @lisp
9883 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9884 '("text/x-vcard"))
9885 @end lisp
9886
9887 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9888 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9889 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9890 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9891 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9892 default is @code{t}.
9893
9894 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9895 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9896 @cindex uuencode
9897 @cindex yEnc
9898 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9899 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9900 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9901 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9902 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
9903 single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
9904 for encoding in Gnus.
9905
9906 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9907 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9908 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9909 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9910 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9911 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9912 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9913 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9914
9915 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9916 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9917 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9918 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9919 displayed. This variable overrides
9920 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9921 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9922 is @code{nil}.
9923
9924 E.g., to see security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9925 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9926 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9927
9928 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9929 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9930 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9931 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9932 Emacs MIME Manual}).
9933
9934 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9935 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9936 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9937 default value is @code{nil}.
9938
9939 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9940 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9941 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9942 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9943 users to gather information from the article (e.g., add Vcard info to
9944 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e.g., automatically
9945 save all jpegs into some directory).
9946
9947 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9948
9949 @lisp
9950 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9951 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9952 (with-temp-buffer
9953 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9954 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9955 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9956 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9957 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9958 @end lisp
9959
9960 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9961 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9962 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9963
9964 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9965 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9966 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9967
9968 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9969 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9970 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9971
9972 If displaying @samp{text/html} is discouraged, see
9973 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9974 "multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9975 @code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9976 emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
9977
9978 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9979 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9980 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9981 overrides @code{nil} values of
9982 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9983 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9984
9985 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9986 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9987 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9988 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9989
9990 Ready-made functions include@*
9991 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9992 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9993 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9994 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9995 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9996 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9997 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9998 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9999 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
10000 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
10001 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
10002 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
10003
10004 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
10005 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
10006
10007 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
10008 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
10009 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
10010
10011 @lisp
10012 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
10013 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
10014 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
10015 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
10016 @end lisp
10017
10018 @noindent
10019 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
10020
10021 @end table
10022
10023
10024 @node Charsets
10025 @section Charsets
10026 @cindex charsets
10027
10028 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
10029 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
10030 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
10031 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
10032 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
10033 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
10034 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
10035
10036 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
10037 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
10038 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
10039 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
10040
10041 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
10042 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
10043 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
10044 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
10045 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
10046 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
10047 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
10048 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
10049 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
10050
10051 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
10052 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
10053 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
10054 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
10055 quoted-printable header encoding.
10056
10057 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
10058 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
10059 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
10060
10061 @table @var
10062 @item test
10063 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
10064 variable to query,
10065 @item header
10066 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
10067 means encode all charsets),
10068 @item body-list
10069 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
10070 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
10071 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
10072 @end table
10073
10074 @cindex Russian
10075 @cindex koi8-r
10076 @cindex koi8-u
10077 @cindex iso-8859-5
10078 @cindex coding system aliases
10079 @cindex preferred charset
10080
10081 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
10082 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
10083 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
10084
10085 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
10086
10087 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
10088 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
10089
10090 @lisp
10091 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
10092 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
10093 @end lisp
10094
10095 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
10096 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
10097
10098 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
10099
10100 @lisp
10101 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
10102 @end lisp
10103
10104 This will almost do the right thing.
10105
10106 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
10107 something like
10108
10109 @lisp
10110 (codepage-setup 1251)
10111 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
10112 @end lisp
10113
10114
10115 @node Article Commands
10116 @section Article Commands
10117
10118 @table @kbd
10119
10120 @item A P
10121 @cindex PostScript
10122 @cindex printing
10123 @kindex A P (Summary)
10124 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
10125 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
10126 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
10127 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
10128 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
10129 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
10130
10131 @item A C
10132 @vindex gnus-fetch-partial-articles
10133 @findex gnus-summary-show-complete-article
10134 If @code{<backend>-fetch-partial-articles} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
10135 fetch partial articles, if the backend it fetches them from supports
10136 it. Currently only @code{nnimap} does. If you're looking at a
10137 partial article, and want to see the complete article instead, then
10138 the @kbd{A C} command (@code{gnus-summary-show-complete-article}) will
10139 do so.
10140
10141 @end table
10142
10143
10144 @node Summary Sorting
10145 @section Summary Sorting
10146 @cindex summary sorting
10147
10148 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
10149 can't really see why you'd want that.
10150
10151 @table @kbd
10152
10153 @item C-c C-s C-n
10154 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10155 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
10156 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
10157
10158 @item C-c C-s C-m C-n
10159 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10160 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number
10161 Sort by most recent article number
10162 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number}).
10163
10164 @item C-c C-s C-a
10165 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
10166 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
10167 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
10168
10169 @item C-c C-s C-t
10170 @kindex C-c C-s C-t (Summary)
10171 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient
10172 Sort by recipient (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient}).
10173
10174 @item C-c C-s C-s
10175 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
10176 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
10177 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
10178
10179 @item C-c C-s C-d
10180 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
10181 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
10182 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
10183
10184 @item C-c C-s C-m C-d
10185 @kindex C-c C-s C-m C-d (Summary)
10186 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date
10187 Sort by most recent date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date}).
10188
10189 @item C-c C-s C-l
10190 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
10191 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
10192 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
10193
10194 @item C-c C-s C-c
10195 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
10196 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
10197 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
10198
10199 @item C-c C-s C-i
10200 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
10201 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
10202 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
10203
10204 @item C-c C-s C-r
10205 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
10206 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
10207 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
10208
10209 @item C-c C-s C-o
10210 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
10211 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
10212 Sort using the default sorting method
10213 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
10214 @end table
10215
10216 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
10217 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
10218 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
10219 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
10220 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
10221 Commands}).
10222
10223 If a prefix argument if given, the sort order is reversed.
10224
10225
10226 @node Finding the Parent
10227 @section Finding the Parent
10228 @cindex parent articles
10229 @cindex referring articles
10230
10231 @table @kbd
10232 @item ^
10233 @kindex ^ (Summary)
10234 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
10235 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
10236 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
10237 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
10238 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
10239 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
10240 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
10241 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
10242 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
10243
10244 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
10245 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
10246 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
10247 grandparent and the great-grandparent of the current article. If you say
10248 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the great-grandparent of the current
10249 article.
10250
10251 @item A R (Summary)
10252 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
10253 @kindex A R (Summary)
10254 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
10255 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
10256
10257 @item A T (Summary)
10258 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
10259 @kindex A T (Summary)
10260 Display the full thread where the current article appears
10261 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
10262 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
10263 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
10264 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
10265 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
10266 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
10267
10268 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
10269 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i.e.,
10270 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
10271 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
10272 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
10273 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
10274
10275 @item M-^ (Summary)
10276 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
10277 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
10278 @cindex Message-ID
10279 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
10280 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
10281 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
10282 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
10283 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
10284 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
10285
10286 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
10287 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
10288 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
10289 @end table
10290
10291 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
10292 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
10293 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
10294 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
10295 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
10296 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
10297 necessary.
10298
10299 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
10300 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
10301 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
10302 match.
10303
10304 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
10305 then ask Google if that fails:
10306
10307 @lisp
10308 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
10309 '(current
10310 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
10311 @end lisp
10312
10313 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
10314 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
10315 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
10316 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
10317 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
10318 group. @code{nnmh} does not support this at all.
10319
10320 Fortunately, the special @code{nnregistry} back end is able to locate
10321 articles in any groups, regardless of their back end (@pxref{Registry
10322 Article Refer Method, fetching by @code{Message-ID} using the
10323 registry}).
10324
10325 @node Alternative Approaches
10326 @section Alternative Approaches
10327
10328 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
10329 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
10330
10331 @menu
10332 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
10333 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
10334 @end menu
10335
10336
10337 @node Pick and Read
10338 @subsection Pick and Read
10339 @cindex pick and read
10340
10341 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
10342 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
10343 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
10344 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
10345
10346 @findex gnus-pick-mode
10347 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
10348 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
10349 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
10350 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
10351 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
10352
10353 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
10354
10355 @table @kbd
10356 @item .
10357 @kindex . (Pick)
10358 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
10359 Pick the article or thread on the current line
10360 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10361 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
10362 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
10363 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
10364 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
10365 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
10366
10367 @item SPACE
10368 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
10369 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
10370 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
10371 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
10372
10373 @item u
10374 @kindex u (Pick)
10375 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
10376 Unpick the thread or article
10377 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10378 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
10379 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
10380 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
10381 the thread or article at that line.
10382
10383 @item RET
10384 @kindex RET (Pick)
10385 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
10386 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
10387 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
10388 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
10389 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
10390 will still be visible when you are reading.
10391
10392 @end table
10393
10394 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
10395 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
10396 which is mapped to the same function
10397 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
10398
10399 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
10400
10401 @lisp
10402 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
10403 @end lisp
10404
10405 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
10406 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
10407
10408 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
10409 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
10410 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
10411
10412 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
10413 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
10414 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
10415 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
10416 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
10417 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
10418 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
10419
10420
10421 @node Binary Groups
10422 @subsection Binary Groups
10423 @cindex binary groups
10424
10425 @findex gnus-binary-mode
10426 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
10427 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
10428 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
10429 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
10430 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
10431 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
10432
10433 @kindex g (Binary)
10434 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
10435 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
10436 command, when you have turned on this mode
10437 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
10438
10439 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
10440 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
10441
10442
10443 @node Tree Display
10444 @section Tree Display
10445 @cindex trees
10446
10447 @vindex gnus-use-trees
10448 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
10449 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
10450 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
10451 in the tree buffer.
10452
10453 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
10454
10455 @table @code
10456 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
10457 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
10458 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
10459
10460 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10461 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10462 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
10463 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
10464 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
10465
10466 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
10467 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
10468 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
10469 default is @code{modeline}.
10470
10471 @item gnus-tree-line-format
10472 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
10473 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
10474 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
10475 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
10476 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
10477 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
10478
10479 Valid specs are:
10480
10481 @table @samp
10482 @item n
10483 The name of the poster.
10484 @item f
10485 The @code{From} header.
10486 @item N
10487 The number of the article.
10488 @item [
10489 The opening bracket.
10490 @item ]
10491 The closing bracket.
10492 @item s
10493 The subject.
10494 @end table
10495
10496 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
10497
10498 Variables related to the display are:
10499
10500 @table @code
10501 @item gnus-tree-brackets
10502 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
10503 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
10504 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
10505 @example
10506 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
10507 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
10508 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
10509 @end example
10510 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
10511
10512 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10513 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10514 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
10515 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
10516
10517 @end table
10518
10519 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
10520 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
10521 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
10522 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
10523 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
10524 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
10525 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
10526 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
10527 other windows displayed next to it.
10528
10529 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
10530 at all times:
10531
10532 @lisp
10533 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
10534 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
10535 @end lisp
10536
10537 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
10538 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
10539 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10540 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
10541 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
10542 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
10543 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
10544
10545 @end table
10546
10547 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
10548
10549 @example
10550 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
10551 | \[Jan]
10552 | \[odd]-[Eri]
10553 | \(***)-[Eri]
10554 | \[odd]-[Paa]
10555 \[Bjo]
10556 \[Gun]
10557 \[Gun]-[Jor]
10558 @end example
10559
10560 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
10561
10562 @example
10563 @group
10564 @{***@}
10565 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
10566 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
10567 |--\-----\-----\ |
10568 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
10569 | | |--\
10570 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
10571 |
10572 [Paa]
10573 @end group
10574 @end example
10575
10576 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
10577 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
10578 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
10579
10580 @lisp
10581 (setq gnus-use-trees t
10582 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10583 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
10584 (gnus-add-configuration
10585 '(article
10586 (vertical 1.0
10587 (horizontal 0.25
10588 (summary 0.75 point)
10589 (tree 1.0))
10590 (article 1.0))))
10591 @end lisp
10592
10593 @xref{Window Layout}.
10594
10595
10596 @node Mail Group Commands
10597 @section Mail Group Commands
10598 @cindex mail group commands
10599
10600 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
10601 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
10602
10603 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
10604 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10605
10606 @table @kbd
10607
10608 @item B e
10609 @kindex B e (Summary)
10610 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
10611 @cindex expiring mail
10612 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
10613 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
10614 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
10615 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
10616
10617 @item B C-M-e
10618 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
10619 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
10620 @cindex expiring mail
10621 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
10622 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
10623 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
10624 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
10625
10626 @item B DEL
10627 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
10628 @cindex deleting mail
10629 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
10630 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
10631 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
10632 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10633 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
10634
10635 @item B m
10636 @kindex B m (Summary)
10637 @cindex move mail
10638 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
10639 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10640 Move the article from one mail group to another
10641 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10642 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10643
10644 @item B c
10645 @kindex B c (Summary)
10646 @cindex copy mail
10647 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10648 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10649 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10650 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10651 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10652
10653 @item B B
10654 @kindex B B (Summary)
10655 @cindex crosspost mail
10656 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10657 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10658 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10659 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10660 be properly updated.
10661
10662 @item B i
10663 @kindex B i (Summary)
10664 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10665 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10666 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10667 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10668
10669 @item B I
10670 @kindex B I (Summary)
10671 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10672 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10673 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10674 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10675
10676 @item B r
10677 @kindex B r (Summary)
10678 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10679 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10680 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10681 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10682 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10683 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10684 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10685 (which is the default).
10686
10687 @item B w
10688 @itemx e
10689 @kindex B w (Summary)
10690 @kindex e (Summary)
10691 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10692 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10693 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10694 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10695 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10696 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10697 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10698
10699 @item B q
10700 @kindex B q (Summary)
10701 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10702 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10703 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10704 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10705
10706 @item B t
10707 @kindex B t (Summary)
10708 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10709 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10710 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10711
10712 @item B p
10713 @kindex B p (Summary)
10714 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10715 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10716 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10717 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10718 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10719 article from your news server (or rather, from
10720 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10721 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10722 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10723 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10724 just not have arrived yet.
10725
10726 @item K E
10727 @kindex K E (Summary)
10728 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10729 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10730 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10731 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10732 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10733
10734 @end table
10735
10736 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10737 @cindex moving articles
10738 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10739 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10740 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10741 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10742 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10743 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10744 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10745
10746 @lisp
10747 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10748 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10749 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10750 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10751 @end lisp
10752
10753
10754 @node Various Summary Stuff
10755 @section Various Summary Stuff
10756
10757 @menu
10758 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10759 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10760 * Summary Generation Commands::
10761 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10762 @end menu
10763
10764 @table @code
10765 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10766 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10767 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10768 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10769 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10770 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10771
10772 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10773 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10774 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10775 current article.
10776
10777 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10778 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10779 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10780
10781 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10782 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10783 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10784 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10785 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10786 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10787 have been set.
10788
10789 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10790 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10791 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10792 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10793 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10794
10795 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10796 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10797 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10798 generated.
10799
10800 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10801 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10802 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10803 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10804 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10805 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10806 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10807 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10808 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10809 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10810
10811 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10812 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10813 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10814 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10815 list of articles to be selected.
10816
10817 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10818 the list in one particular group:
10819
10820 @lisp
10821 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10822 (if (string= group "some.group")
10823 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10824 articles))
10825 @end lisp
10826
10827 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10828 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10829 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10830 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10831 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10832 buffer is active.
10833
10834 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10835 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10836 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10837 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10838 variable will be used instead.
10839
10840 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10841 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10842 buffers. For example:
10843
10844 @lisp
10845 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10846 '(message-use-followup-to
10847 (gnus-visible-headers .
10848 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10849 @end lisp
10850
10851 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10852
10853 @end table
10854
10855
10856 @node Summary Group Information
10857 @subsection Summary Group Information
10858
10859 @table @kbd
10860
10861 @item H d
10862 @kindex H d (Summary)
10863 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10864 Give a brief description of the current group
10865 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10866 rereading the description from the server.
10867
10868 @item H h
10869 @kindex H h (Summary)
10870 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10871 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10872 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10873
10874 @item H i
10875 @kindex H i (Summary)
10876 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10877 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10878 @end table
10879
10880
10881 @node Searching for Articles
10882 @subsection Searching for Articles
10883
10884 @table @kbd
10885
10886 @item M-s
10887 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10888 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10889 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10890 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10891
10892 @item M-r
10893 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10894 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10895 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10896 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10897
10898 @item M-S
10899 @kindex M-S (Summary)
10900 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward
10901 Repeat the previous search forwards
10902 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward}).
10903
10904 @item M-R
10905 @kindex M-R (Summary)
10906 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward
10907 Repeat the previous search backwards
10908 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward}).
10909
10910 @item &
10911 @kindex & (Summary)
10912 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10913 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10914 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10915 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10916 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10917 search backward instead.
10918
10919 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10920 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10921
10922 @item M-&
10923 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10924 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10925 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10926 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10927 @end table
10928
10929 @node Summary Generation Commands
10930 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10931
10932 @table @kbd
10933
10934 @item Y g
10935 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10936 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10937 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10938
10939 @item Y c
10940 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10941 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10942 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10943 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10944
10945 @item Y d
10946 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10947 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10948 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10949 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10950
10951 @item Y t
10952 @kindex Y t (Summary)
10953 @findex gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles
10954 Pull all ticked articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10955 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles}).
10956
10957 @end table
10958
10959
10960 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10961 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10962
10963 @table @kbd
10964
10965 @item A D
10966 @itemx C-d
10967 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10968 @kindex A D (Summary)
10969 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10970 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10971 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10972 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10973 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10974 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10975 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10976 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10977 fashion.
10978
10979 @vindex gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit
10980 The variable @code{gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit} controls what
10981 article should be selected after exiting a digest group. Valid values
10982 include:
10983
10984 @table @code
10985 @item next
10986 Select the next article.
10987
10988 @item next-unread
10989 Select the next unread article.
10990
10991 @item next-noselect
10992 Move the cursor to the next article. This is the default.
10993
10994 @item next-unread-noselect
10995 Move the cursor to the next unread article.
10996 @end table
10997
10998 If it has any other value or there is no next (unread) article, the
10999 article selected before entering to the digest group will appear.
11000
11001 @item C-M-d
11002 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
11003 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
11004 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
11005 several documents into one biiig group
11006 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
11007 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
11008 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
11009 command understands the process/prefix convention
11010 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
11011
11012 @item C-t
11013 @kindex C-t (Summary)
11014 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
11015 Toggle truncation of summary lines
11016 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
11017 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
11018 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
11019
11020 @item =
11021 @kindex = (Summary)
11022 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
11023 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
11024 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
11025
11026 @item C-M-e
11027 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
11028 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
11029 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11030 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
11031
11032 @item C-M-a
11033 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
11034 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
11035 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11036 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
11037
11038 @end table
11039
11040
11041 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
11042 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
11043 @cindex summary exit
11044 @cindex exiting groups
11045
11046 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
11047 group and return you to the group buffer.
11048
11049 @table @kbd
11050
11051 @item Z Z
11052 @itemx Z Q
11053 @itemx q
11054 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
11055 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
11056 @kindex q (Summary)
11057 @findex gnus-summary-exit
11058 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
11059 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
11060 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
11061 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
11062 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
11063 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
11064 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
11065 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
11066 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
11067 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
11068 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
11069
11070 @item Z E
11071 @itemx Q
11072 @kindex Z E (Summary)
11073 @kindex Q (Summary)
11074 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
11075 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
11076 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
11077
11078 @item Z c
11079 @itemx c
11080 @kindex Z c (Summary)
11081 @kindex c (Summary)
11082 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
11083 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
11084 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
11085 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
11086
11087 @item Z C
11088 @kindex Z C (Summary)
11089 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
11090 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
11091 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
11092
11093 @item Z n
11094 @kindex Z n (Summary)
11095 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
11096 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
11097 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
11098
11099 @item Z p
11100 @kindex Z p (Summary)
11101 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group
11102 Mark all articles as read and go to the previous group
11103 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group}).
11104
11105 @item Z R
11106 @itemx C-x C-s
11107 @kindex Z R (Summary)
11108 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
11109 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
11110 Exit this group, and then enter it again
11111 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
11112 all articles, both read and unread.
11113
11114 @item Z G
11115 @itemx M-g
11116 @kindex Z G (Summary)
11117 @kindex M-g (Summary)
11118 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
11119 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
11120 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
11121 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
11122 articles, both read and unread.
11123
11124 @item Z N
11125 @kindex Z N (Summary)
11126 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
11127 Exit the group and go to the next group
11128 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
11129
11130 @item Z P
11131 @kindex Z P (Summary)
11132 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
11133 Exit the group and go to the previous group
11134 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
11135
11136 @item Z s
11137 @kindex Z s (Summary)
11138 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
11139 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
11140 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
11141 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
11142 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
11143 @end table
11144
11145 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
11146 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
11147 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
11148 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
11149
11150 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
11151 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
11152 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
11153 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
11154 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
11155 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
11156 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
11157 something like @file{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
11158 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
11159 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
11160 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
11161 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
11162
11163 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
11164
11165 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
11166 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
11167 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.)@: when you exit the
11168 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
11169 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
11170 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
11171 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
11172 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
11173 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
11174
11175
11176 @node Crosspost Handling
11177 @section Crosspost Handling
11178
11179 @cindex velveeta
11180 @cindex spamming
11181 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
11182 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
11183 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
11184 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
11185 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
11186 heinous crime.
11187
11188 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
11189 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
11190 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
11191 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
11192 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
11193
11194 @cindex cross-posting
11195 @cindex Xref
11196 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
11197 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
11198 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
11199 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
11200 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
11201 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
11202 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
11203 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
11204 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
11205 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
11206 the cross reference mechanism.
11207
11208 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
11209 @cindex overview.fmt
11210 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
11211 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
11212 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
11213 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
11214 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
11215 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
11216 overview files.
11217
11218 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
11219 set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
11220 considerably. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
11221
11222 C'est la vie.
11223
11224 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
11225
11226
11227 @node Duplicate Suppression
11228 @section Duplicate Suppression
11229
11230 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
11231 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
11232 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
11233 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
11234 reasons.
11235
11236 @enumerate
11237 @item
11238 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
11239 is evil and not very common.
11240
11241 @item
11242 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
11243 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
11244
11245 @item
11246 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
11247 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
11248
11249 @item
11250 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
11251 @end enumerate
11252
11253 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
11254 well, but these four are the most common situations.
11255
11256 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
11257 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
11258 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
11259 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
11260 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
11261 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
11262 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
11263 once.
11264
11265 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
11266 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
11267 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
11268 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
11269 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
11270 saw the article in.
11271
11272 @table @code
11273 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
11274 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
11275 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
11276
11277 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
11278 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
11279 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
11280 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
11281 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
11282 session are suppressed.
11283
11284 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
11285 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
11286 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
11287 suppression list. The default is 10000.
11288
11289 @item gnus-duplicate-file
11290 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
11291 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
11292 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
11293 @end table
11294
11295 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
11296 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
11297 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
11298 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
11299 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
11300 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
11301 to you to figure out, I think.
11302
11303 @node Security
11304 @section Security
11305
11306 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
11307 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
11308 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
11309 things to work:
11310
11311 @enumerate
11312 @item
11313 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
11314 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG@. The Lisp interface
11315 to GnuPG included with Emacs is called EasyPG (@pxref{Top, ,EasyPG,
11316 epa, EasyPG Assistant user's manual}), but PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg,
11317 PGG Manual}), and Mailcrypt are also supported.
11318
11319 @item
11320 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL@. OpenSSL 0.9.6
11321 or newer is recommended.
11322
11323 @end enumerate
11324
11325 The variables that control security functionality on reading/composing
11326 messages include:
11327
11328 @table @code
11329 @item mm-verify-option
11330 @vindex mm-verify-option
11331 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
11332 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
11333 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11334
11335 @item mm-decrypt-option
11336 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
11337 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
11338 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
11339 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11340
11341 @item mm-sign-option
11342 @vindex mm-sign-option
11343 Option of creating signed parts. @code{nil}, use default signing
11344 keys; @code{guided}, ask user to select signing keys from the menu.
11345
11346 @item mm-encrypt-option
11347 @vindex mm-encrypt-option
11348 Option of creating encrypted parts. @code{nil}, use the first
11349 public-key matching the @samp{From:} header as the recipient;
11350 @code{guided}, ask user to select recipient keys from the menu.
11351
11352 @item mml1991-use
11353 @vindex mml1991-use
11354 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11355 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but @code{pgg},
11356 and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported although
11357 deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available interface in
11358 this order.
11359
11360 @item mml2015-use
11361 @vindex mml2015-use
11362 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11363 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but
11364 @code{pgg}, and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported
11365 although deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available
11366 interface in this order.
11367
11368 @end table
11369
11370 By default the buttons that display security information are not
11371 shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
11372 @kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
11373 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
11374 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
11375 permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
11376 how to customize these variables to always display security
11377 information.
11378
11379 @cindex snarfing keys
11380 @cindex importing PGP keys
11381 @cindex PGP key ring import
11382 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
11383 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
11384 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
11385 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
11386 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
11387 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
11388 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
11389 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
11390 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
11391
11392 @example
11393 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
11394 @end example
11395 @noindent
11396 This happens to also be the default action defined in
11397 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
11398
11399 More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
11400 encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
11401 (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
11402
11403 @node Mailing List
11404 @section Mailing List
11405 @cindex mailing list
11406 @cindex RFC 2396
11407
11408 @kindex A M (summary)
11409 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
11410 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
11411 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
11412 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
11413 summary buffer.
11414
11415 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
11416
11417 @table @kbd
11418
11419 @item C-c C-n h
11420 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
11421 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
11422 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
11423
11424 @item C-c C-n s
11425 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
11426 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
11427 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
11428
11429 @item C-c C-n u
11430 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
11431 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
11432 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
11433 field exists.
11434
11435 @item C-c C-n p
11436 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
11437 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
11438 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
11439
11440 @item C-c C-n o
11441 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
11442 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
11443 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
11444
11445 @item C-c C-n a
11446 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
11447 @findex gnus-mailing-list-archive
11448 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
11449
11450 @end table
11451
11452
11453 @node Article Buffer
11454 @chapter Article Buffer
11455 @cindex article buffer
11456
11457 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
11458 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
11459 tell Gnus otherwise.
11460
11461 @menu
11462 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
11463 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
11464 * HTML:: Reading @acronym{HTML} messages.
11465 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
11466 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
11467 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
11468 @end menu
11469
11470
11471 @node Hiding Headers
11472 @section Hiding Headers
11473 @cindex hiding headers
11474 @cindex deleting headers
11475
11476 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
11477 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
11478
11479 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
11480 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
11481 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
11482 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
11483 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
11484 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
11485 @code{References}, etc.@: ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
11486 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
11487 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
11488
11489 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
11490
11491 @table @code
11492
11493 @item gnus-visible-headers
11494 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
11495 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
11496 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
11497 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
11498
11499 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
11500 the article and the subject, you'd say:
11501
11502 @lisp
11503 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
11504 @end lisp
11505
11506 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11507 remain visible.
11508
11509 @item gnus-ignored-headers
11510 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
11511 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
11512 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
11513 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
11514 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
11515
11516 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
11517 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
11518
11519 @lisp
11520 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
11521 @end lisp
11522
11523 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11524 be removed.
11525
11526 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
11527 variable will have no effect.
11528
11529 @end table
11530
11531 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
11532 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
11533 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
11534 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
11535 the headers are to be displayed.
11536
11537 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
11538 and then the subject, you might say something like:
11539
11540 @lisp
11541 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
11542 @end lisp
11543
11544 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
11545 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
11546
11547 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
11548 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
11549 You can hide further boring headers by setting
11550 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
11551 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
11552 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
11553 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
11554 from sight.
11555
11556 These conditions are:
11557 @table @code
11558 @item empty
11559 Remove all empty headers.
11560 @item followup-to
11561 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
11562 @code{Newsgroups} header.
11563 @item reply-to
11564 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
11565 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
11566 parameter is set.
11567 @item newsgroups
11568 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
11569 name.
11570 @item to-address
11571 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11572 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
11573 @item to-list
11574 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11575 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11576 @item cc-list
11577 Remove the @code{Cc} header if it only contains the address identical to
11578 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11579 @item date
11580 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
11581 old.
11582 @item long-to
11583 Remove the @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} header if it is very long.
11584 @item many-to
11585 Remove all @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} headers if there are more than one.
11586 @end table
11587
11588 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
11589
11590 @lisp
11591 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
11592 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
11593 @end lisp
11594
11595 This is also the default value for this variable.
11596
11597
11598 @node Using MIME
11599 @section Using MIME
11600 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11601
11602 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
11603 while people stand around yawning.
11604
11605 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
11606 while all newsreaders die of fear.
11607
11608 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
11609 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
11610 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
11611
11612 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
11613 @findex gnus-display-mime
11614 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
11615 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
11616 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
11617 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
11618
11619 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
11620 @acronym{MIME} button:
11621
11622 @table @kbd
11623 @findex gnus-article-press-button
11624 @item RET (Article)
11625 @kindex RET (Article)
11626 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
11627 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
11628 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
11629 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
11630 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
11631 object is displayed inline.
11632
11633 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
11634 @item M-RET (Article)
11635 @kindex M-RET (Article)
11636 @itemx v (Article)
11637 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11638 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
11639
11640 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
11641 @item t (Article)
11642 @kindex t (Article)
11643 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
11644 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
11645
11646 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
11647 @item C (Article)
11648 @kindex C (Article)
11649 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11650 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
11651
11652 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
11653 @item o (Article)
11654 @kindex o (Article)
11655 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
11656 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
11657
11658 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
11659 @item C-o (Article)
11660 @kindex C-o (Article)
11661 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
11662 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
11663 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
11664 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
11665 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
11666 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
11667
11668 @findex gnus-mime-replace-part
11669 @item r (Article)
11670 @kindex r (Article)
11671 Prompt for a file name, replace the @acronym{MIME} object with an
11672 external body referring to the file via the message/external-body
11673 @acronym{MIME} type. (@code{gnus-mime-replace-part}).
11674
11675 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
11676 @item d (Article)
11677 @kindex d (Article)
11678 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
11679 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
11680 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
11681
11682 @c FIXME: gnus-auto-select-part should be documented here
11683
11684 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
11685 @item c (Article)
11686 @kindex c (Article)
11687 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
11688 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). If given a prefix, copy the raw contents
11689 without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual
11690 charset stuff (see @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in
11691 @ref{Paging the Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
11692 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
11693 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
11694 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11695
11696 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
11697 @item p (Article)
11698 @kindex p (Article)
11699 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
11700 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
11701 @file{.mailcap} file.
11702
11703 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
11704 @item i (Article)
11705 @kindex i (Article)
11706 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11707 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as @samp{text/plain}. If given a prefix, insert
11708 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11709 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11710 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11711 Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and @file{.bz2} are
11712 automatically decompressed depending on @code{jka-compr} regardless of
11713 @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed Files,, Accessing
11714 Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11715
11716 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11717 @item E (Article)
11718 @kindex E (Article)
11719 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11720 viewer is available, use an external viewer
11721 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11722
11723 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11724 @item e (Article)
11725 @kindex e (Article)
11726 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11727 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11728
11729 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11730 @item | (Article)
11731 @kindex | (Article)
11732 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11733
11734 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11735 @item . (Article)
11736 @kindex . (Article)
11737 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11738 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11739
11740 @end table
11741
11742 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11743 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11744 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11745
11746 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11747 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11748 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11749 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11750 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11751 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11752 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11753 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11754 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11755
11756 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11757
11758 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11759
11760
11761 @node HTML
11762 @section @acronym{HTML}
11763 @cindex @acronym{HTML}
11764
11765 Gnus can display @acronym{HTML} articles nicely formatted in the
11766 article buffer. There are many methods for doing that, but two of
11767 them are kind of default methods.
11768
11769 If your Emacs copy has been built with libxml2 support, then Gnus uses
11770 Emacs' built-in, plain elisp Simple HTML Renderer @code{shr}
11771 @footnote{@code{shr} displays colors as declared in the @acronym{HTML}
11772 article but tries to adjust them in order to be readable. If you
11773 prefer more contrast, @xref{FAQ 4-16}.} which is also used by Emacs'
11774 browser EWW (@pxref{EWW, ,EWW, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
11775
11776 If your Emacs copy lacks libxml2 support but you have @code{w3m}
11777 installed on your system, Gnus uses that to render @acronym{HTML} mail
11778 and display the results in the article buffer (@code{gnus-w3m}).
11779
11780 For a complete overview, consult @xref{Display Customization, ,Display
11781 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. This section only
11782 describes the default method.
11783
11784 @table @code
11785 @item mm-text-html-renderer
11786 @vindex mm-text-html-renderer
11787 If set to @code{shr}, Gnus uses its own simple @acronym{HTML}
11788 renderer. If set to @code{gnus-w3m}, it uses @code{w3m}.
11789
11790 @item gnus-blocked-images
11791 @vindex gnus-blocked-images
11792 External images that have @acronym{URL}s that match this regexp won't
11793 be fetched and displayed. For instance, to block all @acronym{URL}s
11794 that have the string ``ads'' in them, do the following:
11795
11796 @lisp
11797 (setq gnus-blocked-images "ads")
11798 @end lisp
11799
11800 This can also be a function to be evaluated. If so, it will be
11801 called with the group name as the parameter. The default value is
11802 @code{gnus-block-private-groups}, which will return @samp{"."} for
11803 anything that isn't a newsgroup. This means that no external images
11804 will be fetched as a result of reading mail, so that nobody can use
11805 web bugs (and the like) to track whether you've read email.
11806
11807 Also @pxref{Misc Article} for @code{gnus-inhibit-images}.
11808
11809 @item gnus-html-cache-directory
11810 @vindex gnus-html-cache-directory
11811 Gnus will download and cache images according to how
11812 @code{gnus-blocked-images} is set. These images will be stored in
11813 this directory.
11814
11815 @item gnus-html-cache-size
11816 @vindex gnus-html-cache-size
11817 When @code{gnus-html-cache-size} bytes have been used in that
11818 directory, the oldest files will be deleted. The default is 500MB.
11819
11820 @item gnus-html-frame-width
11821 @vindex gnus-html-frame-width
11822 The width to use when rendering HTML@. The default is 70.
11823
11824 @item gnus-max-image-proportion
11825 @vindex gnus-max-image-proportion
11826 How big pictures displayed are in relation to the window they're in.
11827 A value of 0.7 (the default) means that they are allowed to take up
11828 70% of the width and height of the window. If they are larger than
11829 this, and Emacs supports it, then the images will be rescaled down to
11830 fit these criteria.
11831
11832 @end table
11833
11834 To use this, make sure that you have @code{w3m} and @code{curl}
11835 installed. If you have, then Gnus should display @acronym{HTML}
11836 automatically.
11837
11838
11839
11840 @node Customizing Articles
11841 @section Customizing Articles
11842 @cindex article customization
11843
11844 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11845 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11846 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11847 called automatically when you select the articles.
11848
11849 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11850 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11851 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11852 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11853
11854 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11855 for sensible values.
11856
11857 @enumerate
11858 @item
11859 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11860
11861 @item
11862 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11863
11864 @item
11865 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11866
11867 @item
11868 @code{first}: Do this treatment on the first body part.
11869
11870 @item
11871 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last body part.
11872
11873 @item
11874 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11875 than this number.
11876
11877 @item
11878 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11879 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11880 regexps in the list.
11881
11882 @item
11883 A list where the first element is not a string:
11884
11885 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11886 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11887 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11888
11889 @lisp
11890 (or last
11891 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11892 @end lisp
11893
11894 @item
11895 A function: the function is called with no arguments and should return
11896 @code{nil} or non-@code{nil}. The current article is available in the
11897 buffer named by @code{gnus-article-buffer}.
11898
11899 @end enumerate
11900
11901 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11902 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11903 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11904 considered to contain just a single part.
11905
11906 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11907 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11908 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11909 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11910 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11911 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11912 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11913
11914 @ifinfo
11915 @c Avoid sort of redundant entries in the same section for the printed
11916 @c manual, but add them in info to allow 'i gnus-treat-foo-bar RET' or
11917 @c 'i foo-bar'.
11918 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize
11919 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize-head
11920 @vindex gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences
11921 @vindex gnus-treat-overstrike
11922 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-cr
11923 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body
11924 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines
11925 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines
11926 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-pem
11927 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines
11928 @vindex gnus-treat-unsplit-urls
11929 @vindex gnus-treat-wash-html
11930 @vindex gnus-treat-date
11931 @vindex gnus-treat-from-picon
11932 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-picon
11933 @vindex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
11934 @vindex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
11935 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
11936 @vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
11937 @vindex gnus-treat-body-boundary
11938 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11939 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11940 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11941 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11942 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11943 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11944 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11945 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11946 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11947 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11948 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11949 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11950 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11951 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11952 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11953 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11954 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11955 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11956 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11957 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11958 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11959 @end ifinfo
11960
11961 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11962 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11963 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11964 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11965
11966 @table @code
11967 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11968 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11969
11970 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11971
11972 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11973 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11974 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11975 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11976 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, first, integer)
11977 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11978 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11979 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11980 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11981 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11982
11983 @xref{Article Washing}.
11984
11985 @item gnus-treat-date (head)
11986
11987 This will transform/add date headers according to the
11988 @code{gnus-article-date-headers} variable. This is a list of Date
11989 headers to display. The formats available are:
11990
11991 @table @code
11992 @item ut
11993 Universal time, aka GMT, aka ZULU.
11994
11995 @item local
11996 The user's local time zone.
11997
11998 @item english
11999 A semi-readable English sentence.
12000
12001 @item lapsed
12002 The time elapsed since the message was posted.
12003
12004 @item combined-lapsed
12005 Both the original date header and a (shortened) elapsed time.
12006
12007 @item original
12008 The original date header.
12009
12010 @item iso8601
12011 ISO8601 format, i.e., ``2010-11-23T22:05:21''.
12012
12013 @item user-defined
12014 A format done according to the @code{gnus-article-time-format}
12015 variable.
12016
12017 @end table
12018
12019 @xref{Article Date}.
12020
12021 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
12022 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
12023 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
12024
12025 @xref{Picons}.
12026
12027 @item gnus-treat-from-gravatar (head)
12028 @item gnus-treat-mail-gravatar (head)
12029
12030 @xref{Gravatars}.
12031
12032 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
12033
12034 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
12035
12036 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
12037 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
12038 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
12039
12040 @xref{Smileys}.
12041
12042 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
12043 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
12044
12045 @xref{X-Face}.
12046
12047 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
12048 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
12049
12050 @xref{Face}.
12051
12052 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
12053 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
12054 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
12055 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
12056 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
12057 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
12058 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
12059 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
12060 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
12061 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
12062 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
12063 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
12064 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
12065 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
12066 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
12067 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
12068 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
12069 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
12070 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
12071 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
12072
12073 @xref{Article Hiding}.
12074
12075 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
12076 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
12077 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
12078 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
12079 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
12080 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
12081
12082 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
12083
12084 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
12085 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
12086 @item gnus-treat-ansi-sequences (t)
12087 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
12088 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
12089
12090 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
12091 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
12092 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
12093 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
12094 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
12095 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
12096 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
12097 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
12098
12099 @xref{Article Header}.
12100
12101
12102 @end table
12103
12104 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
12105 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
12106 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
12107 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
12108 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
12109 everything.
12110
12111
12112 @node Article Keymap
12113 @section Article Keymap
12114
12115 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
12116 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
12117 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
12118 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
12119 buffer.
12120
12121 @kindex v (Article)
12122 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
12123 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
12124 command or better use it as a prefix key.
12125
12126 A few additional keystrokes are available:
12127
12128 @table @kbd
12129
12130 @item SPACE
12131 @kindex SPACE (Article)
12132 @findex gnus-article-next-page
12133 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
12134 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
12135
12136 @item DEL
12137 @kindex DEL (Article)
12138 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
12139 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
12140 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
12141
12142 @item C-c ^
12143 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
12144 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
12145 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
12146 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
12147 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
12148
12149 @item C-c C-m
12150 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
12151 @findex gnus-article-mail
12152 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
12153 given a prefix, include the mail.
12154
12155 @item s
12156 @kindex s (Article)
12157 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
12158 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
12159 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
12160
12161 @item ?
12162 @kindex ? (Article)
12163 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
12164 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
12165 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
12166
12167 @item TAB
12168 @kindex TAB (Article)
12169 @findex gnus-article-next-button
12170 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
12171 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
12172
12173 @item M-TAB
12174 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
12175 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
12176 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
12177
12178 @item R
12179 @kindex R (Article)
12180 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
12181 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
12182 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If the region is active,
12183 only yank the text in the region.
12184
12185 @item S W
12186 @kindex S W (Article)
12187 @findex gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original
12188 Send a wide reply to the current article and yank the current article
12189 (@code{gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original}). If the region is
12190 active, only yank the text in the region.
12191
12192 @item F
12193 @kindex F (Article)
12194 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
12195 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
12196 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If the region is active,
12197 only yank the text in the region.
12198
12199
12200 @end table
12201
12202
12203 @node Misc Article
12204 @section Misc Article
12205
12206 @table @code
12207
12208 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
12209 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
12210 @cindex article buffers, several
12211 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
12212 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
12213 article buffer.
12214
12215 @item gnus-widen-article-window
12216 @cindex gnus-widen-article-window
12217 If non-@code{nil}, selecting the article buffer with the @kbd{h}
12218 command will ``widen'' the article window to take the entire frame.
12219
12220 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
12221 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
12222 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
12223 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
12224 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
12225
12226 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
12227 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
12228 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
12229 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
12230 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
12231 the contents of the article buffer.
12232
12233 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
12234 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
12235 Hook called in article mode buffers.
12236
12237 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12238 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12239 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
12240 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
12241
12242 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
12243 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
12244 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
12245 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
12246
12247 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
12248 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
12249 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
12250 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
12251 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
12252 with two extensions:
12253
12254 @table @samp
12255
12256 @item w
12257 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
12258 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
12259 performed. The characters and their meaning:
12260
12261 @table @samp
12262
12263 @item c
12264 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
12265
12266 @item h
12267 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
12268
12269 @item p
12270 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
12271 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
12272 security status, i.e., good or bad signature.)
12273
12274 @item s
12275 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
12276
12277 @item o
12278 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
12279
12280 @item e
12281 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasized strings in the article buffer.
12282
12283 @end table
12284
12285 @item m
12286 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
12287
12288 @end table
12289
12290 @vindex gnus-break-pages
12291
12292 @item gnus-break-pages
12293 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
12294 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
12295 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
12296 paging will not be done.
12297
12298 @item gnus-page-delimiter
12299 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
12300 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
12301 (formfeed).
12302
12303 @cindex IDNA
12304 @cindex internationalized domain names
12305 @vindex gnus-use-idna
12306 @item gnus-use-idna
12307 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
12308 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
12309 @samp{Cc} headers. @xref{IDNA, ,IDNA,message, The Message Manual},
12310 for how to compose such messages. This requires
12311 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
12312 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
12313
12314 @vindex gnus-inhibit-images
12315 @item gnus-inhibit-images
12316 If this is non-@code{nil}, inhibit displaying of images inline in the
12317 article body. It is effective to images that are in articles as
12318 @acronym{MIME} parts, and images in @acronym{HTML} articles rendered
12319 when @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization,
12320 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) is
12321 @code{shr} or @code{gnus-w3m}.
12322
12323 @end table
12324
12325
12326 @node Composing Messages
12327 @chapter Composing Messages
12328 @cindex composing messages
12329 @cindex messages
12330 @cindex mail
12331 @cindex sending mail
12332 @cindex reply
12333 @cindex followup
12334 @cindex post
12335 @cindex using gpg
12336 @cindex using s/mime
12337 @cindex using smime
12338
12339 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
12340 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
12341 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
12342 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
12343 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
12344 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
12345
12346 @menu
12347 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
12348 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
12349 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
12350 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
12351 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
12352 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
12353 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
12354 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
12355 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
12356 @end menu
12357
12358 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
12359 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
12360
12361
12362 @node Mail
12363 @section Mail
12364
12365 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
12366
12367 @table @code
12368 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
12369 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
12370 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
12371 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
12372 @code{nil} include all headers.
12373
12374 @item gnus-add-to-list
12375 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
12376 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
12377 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
12378
12379 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12380 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12381 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
12382 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
12383 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
12384 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
12385 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
12386 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
12387
12388 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
12389 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
12390
12391 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12392 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12393 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
12394 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
12395 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
12396
12397 @end table
12398
12399
12400 @node Posting Server
12401 @section Posting Server
12402
12403 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
12404 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
12405
12406 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
12407
12408 It can be quite complicated.
12409
12410 @vindex gnus-post-method
12411 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
12412 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
12413 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
12414 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
12415 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
12416 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
12417 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
12418 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
12419 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
12420
12421 @lisp
12422 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
12423 @end lisp
12424
12425 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
12426 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
12427 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
12428 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
12429
12430 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
12431 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
12432
12433 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
12434 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
12435 for posting.
12436
12437 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
12438 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
12439
12440 @vindex message-send-mail-function
12441 When sending mail, Message invokes the function specified by the
12442 variable @code{message-send-mail-function}. Gnus tries to set it to a
12443 value suitable for your system.
12444 @xref{Mail Variables, ,Mail Variables,message,Message manual}, for more
12445 information.
12446
12447
12448 @node POP before SMTP
12449 @section POP before SMTP
12450 @cindex pop before smtp
12451 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
12452
12453 Does your @acronym{ISP} use @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
12454 authentication? This authentication method simply requires you to
12455 contact the @acronym{POP} server before sending email. To do that,
12456 put the following lines in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
12457
12458 @lisp
12459 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
12460 @end lisp
12461
12462 @noindent
12463 The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function does @acronym{POP}
12464 authentication according to the value of @code{mail-sources} without
12465 fetching mails, just before sending a mail. @xref{Mail Sources}.
12466
12467 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
12468 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
12469 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
12470 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
12471 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
12472 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
12473
12474 @lisp
12475 (setq mail-source-primary-source
12476 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12477 :password "secret"))
12478 @end lisp
12479
12480 @noindent
12481 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
12482 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
12483
12484 @lisp
12485 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
12486 (lambda ()
12487 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
12488 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12489 :password "secret")))
12490 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
12491 @end lisp
12492
12493
12494 @node Mail and Post
12495 @section Mail and Post
12496
12497 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
12498 posting:
12499
12500 @table @code
12501 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
12502 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
12503 @cindex mailing lists
12504
12505 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
12506 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
12507 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
12508 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
12509 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
12510 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
12511 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
12512 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
12513 still a pain, though.
12514
12515 @item gnus-user-agent
12516 @vindex gnus-user-agent
12517 @cindex User-Agent
12518
12519 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
12520 User-Agent header. It can be a list of symbols or a string. Valid
12521 symbols are @code{gnus} (show Gnus version) and @code{emacs} (show Emacs
12522 version). In addition to the Emacs version, you can add @code{codename}
12523 (show (S)XEmacs codename) or either @code{config} (show system
12524 configuration) or @code{type} (show system type). If you set it to a
12525 string, be sure to use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
12526
12527 @end table
12528
12529 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
12530 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
12531 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
12532
12533 @cindex ispell
12534 @findex ispell-message
12535 @lisp
12536 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
12537 @end lisp
12538
12539 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
12540 you're in, you could say something like the following:
12541
12542 @lisp
12543 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
12544 (lambda ()
12545 (cond
12546 ((string-match
12547 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
12548 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
12549 (t
12550 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
12551 @end lisp
12552
12553 Modify to suit your needs.
12554
12555 @vindex gnus-message-highlight-citation
12556 If @code{gnus-message-highlight-citation} is @code{t}, different levels of
12557 citations are highlighted like in Gnus article buffers also in message
12558 mode buffers.
12559
12560 @node Archived Messages
12561 @section Archived Messages
12562 @cindex archived messages
12563 @cindex sent messages
12564
12565 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
12566 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
12567 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
12568 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}. The
12569 default is @code{"sent.%Y-%m"}, which gives you one archive group per month.
12570
12571 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
12572 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
12573 Group Commands}).
12574
12575 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
12576 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
12577 use to store sent messages. The default is @code{"archive"}, and when
12578 actually being used it is expanded into:
12579
12580 @lisp
12581 (nnfolder "archive"
12582 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
12583 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
12584 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
12585 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
12586 @end lisp
12587
12588 @quotation
12589 @vindex gnus-update-message-archive-method
12590 Note: a server like this is saved in the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file first
12591 so that it may be used as a real method of the server which is named
12592 @code{"archive"} (that is, for the case where
12593 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} is set to @code{"archive"}) ever
12594 since. If it once has been saved, it will never be updated by default
12595 even if you change the value of @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12596 afterward. Therefore, the server @code{"archive"} doesn't necessarily
12597 mean the @code{nnfolder} server like this at all times. If you want the
12598 saved method to reflect always the value of
12599 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, set the
12600 @code{gnus-update-message-archive-method} variable to a non-@code{nil}
12601 value. The default value of this variable is @code{nil}.
12602 @end quotation
12603
12604 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
12605 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
12606 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
12607 directory chosen, you could say something like:
12608
12609 @lisp
12610 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
12611 '(nnfolder "archive"
12612 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
12613 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
12614 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
12615 @end lisp
12616
12617 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
12618 @cindex Gcc
12619 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
12620 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
12621 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
12622
12623 This variable can be used to do the following:
12624
12625 @table @asis
12626 @item a string
12627 Messages will be saved in that group.
12628
12629 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
12630 message will not be stored in the select method given by
12631 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
12632 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12633 has the default value shown above. Then setting
12634 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
12635 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
12636 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
12637 @samp{nnml:foo}.
12638
12639 @item a list of strings
12640 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
12641
12642 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
12643 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
12644
12645 @item @code{nil}
12646 No message archiving will take place.
12647 @end table
12648
12649 Let's illustrate:
12650
12651 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
12652 @lisp
12653 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
12654 @end lisp
12655
12656 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
12657 @lisp
12658 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
12659 @end lisp
12660
12661 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
12662 @lisp
12663 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12664 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
12665 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
12666 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
12667 @end lisp
12668
12669 More complex stuff:
12670 @lisp
12671 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12672 '((if (message-news-p)
12673 "misc-news"
12674 "misc-mail")))
12675 @end lisp
12676
12677 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
12678 messages in one file per month:
12679
12680 @lisp
12681 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12682 '((if (message-news-p)
12683 "misc-news"
12684 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
12685 @end lisp
12686
12687 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
12688 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
12689 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
12690 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
12691 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
12692 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
12693 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
12694 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
12695 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
12696 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
12697
12698 @table @code
12699 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12700 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12701 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
12702
12703 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12704 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12705 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
12706 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
12707 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
12708 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
12709 changed in the future.
12710
12711 @item gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12712 @vindex gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12713 Like the @code{gcc-self} group parameter, applied only for unmodified
12714 messages that @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} (@pxref{Summary Mail
12715 Commands}) resends. Non-@code{nil} value of this variable takes
12716 precedence over any existing @code{Gcc} header.
12717
12718 If this is @code{none}, no @code{Gcc} copy will be made. If this is
12719 @code{t}, messages resent will be @code{Gcc} copied to the current
12720 group. If this is a string, it specifies a group to which resent
12721 messages will be @code{Gcc} copied. If this is @code{nil}, @code{Gcc}
12722 will be done according to existing @code{Gcc} header(s), if any. If
12723 this is @code{no-gcc-self}, that is the default, resent messages will be
12724 @code{Gcc} copied to groups that existing @code{Gcc} header specifies,
12725 except for the current group.
12726
12727 @item gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12728 @vindex gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12729 @itemx gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12730 @vindex gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12731
12732 These hooks are run before/after encoding the message body of the Gcc
12733 copy of a sent message. The current buffer (when the hook is run)
12734 contains the message including the message header. Changes made to
12735 the message will only affect the Gcc copy, but not the original
12736 message. You can use these hooks to edit the copy (and influence
12737 subsequent transformations), e.g., remove MML secure tags
12738 (@pxref{Signing and encrypting}).
12739
12740 @end table
12741
12742
12743 @node Posting Styles
12744 @section Posting Styles
12745 @cindex posting styles
12746 @cindex styles
12747
12748 All them variables, they make my head swim.
12749
12750 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
12751 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
12752 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
12753 on?
12754
12755 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
12756 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
12757 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
12758 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
12759 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
12760 variable:
12761
12762 @lisp
12763 ((".*"
12764 (signature "Peace and happiness")
12765 (organization "What me?"))
12766 ("^comp"
12767 (signature "Death to everybody"))
12768 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
12769 (organization "Emacs is it")))
12770 @end lisp
12771
12772 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
12773 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
12774 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
12775 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
12776 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
12777 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
12778 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
12779 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
12780
12781 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
12782 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
12783 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
12784 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
12785 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
12786 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
12787 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
12788 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
12789 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
12790 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
12791 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
12792 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
12793 said to @dfn{match}.
12794
12795 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
12796 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
12797 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
12798 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
12799 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
12800 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
12801 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
12802 name can be one of:
12803
12804 @itemize @bullet
12805 @item @code{signature}
12806 @item @code{signature-file}
12807 @item @code{x-face-file}
12808 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
12809 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
12810 @item @code{body}
12811 @end itemize
12812
12813 Note that the @code{signature-file} attribute honors the variable
12814 @code{message-signature-directory}.
12815
12816 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
12817 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
12818 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
12819 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
12820 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
12821
12822 The attribute value can be a string, a function with zero arguments
12823 (the return value will be used), a variable (its value will be used)
12824 or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value will be
12825 used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
12826 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current
12827 article are available through the @code{message-reply-headers}
12828 variable, which is a vector of the following headers: number subject
12829 from date id references chars lines xref extra.
12830
12831 In the case of a string value, if the @code{match} is a regular
12832 expression, or if it takes the form @code{(header @var{match}
12833 @var{regexp})}, a @samp{gnus-match-substitute-replacement} is proceed
12834 on the value to replace the positional parameters @samp{\@var{n}} by
12835 the corresponding parenthetical matches (see @xref{Replacing Match,,
12836 Replacing the Text that Matched, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference
12837 Manual}.)
12838
12839 @vindex message-reply-headers
12840
12841 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
12842 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
12843 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
12844
12845 @findex message-mail-p
12846 @findex message-news-p
12847
12848 So here's a new example:
12849
12850 @lisp
12851 (setq gnus-posting-styles
12852 '((".*"
12853 (signature-file "~/.signature")
12854 (name "User Name")
12855 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
12856 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
12857 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
12858 ("^rec.humor"
12859 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
12860 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
12861 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
12862 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
12863 (signature my-news-signature))
12864 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
12865 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
12866 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
12867 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
12868 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
12869 ;; @r{Reply to a message from the same subaddress the message}
12870 ;; @r{was sent to.}
12871 ((header "x-original-to" "me\\(\\+.+\\)@@example.org")
12872 (address "me\\1@@example.org"))
12873 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
12874 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
12875 (address "user@@bar.foo")
12876 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
12877 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
12878 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
12879 ("nnml:.*"
12880 (From (with-current-buffer gnus-article-buffer
12881 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
12882 ("^nn.+:"
12883 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
12884 @end lisp
12885
12886 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
12887 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
12888 if you fill many roles.
12889 You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
12890 @xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
12891
12892 Of particular interest in the ``work-mail'' style is the
12893 @samp{X-Message-SMTP-Method} header. It specifies how to send the
12894 outgoing email. You may want to sent certain emails through certain
12895 @acronym{SMTP} servers due to company policies, for instance.
12896 @xref{Mail Variables, ,Message Variables, message, Message Manual}.
12897
12898
12899 @node Drafts
12900 @section Drafts
12901 @cindex drafts
12902
12903 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
12904 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
12905 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
12906 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
12907 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
12908
12909 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
12910 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
12911 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
12912 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
12913 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
12914 group.)
12915
12916 @cindex nndraft
12917 @vindex nndraft-directory
12918 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
12919 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
12920 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
12921 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
12922 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
12923 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
12924
12925 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
12926 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
12927 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
12928 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
12929 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
12930 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
12931 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
12932 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
12933 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
12934
12935 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
12936 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
12937 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
12938 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
12939 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
12940 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
12941 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
12942 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
12943 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
12944 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
12945 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
12946 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
12947 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
12948 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12949 @c
12950 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12951 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12952 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
12953
12954 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12955 @kindex D e (Draft)
12956 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12957 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12958 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12959
12960 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12961 Articles}).
12962
12963 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12964 @kindex D s (Draft)
12965 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
12966 @kindex D S (Draft)
12967 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12968 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12969 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12970 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12971 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12972 in the buffer.
12973
12974 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12975 @kindex D t (Draft)
12976 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12977 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12978 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12979
12980 Finally, if you want to delete a draft, use the normal @kbd{B DEL}
12981 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
12982
12983
12984 @node Rejected Articles
12985 @section Rejected Articles
12986 @cindex rejected articles
12987
12988 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12989 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12990 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12991 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12992
12993 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12994 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12995 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12996 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12997 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12998
12999 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
13000 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
13001 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
13002
13003 @node Signing and encrypting
13004 @section Signing and encrypting
13005 @cindex using gpg
13006 @cindex using s/mime
13007 @cindex using smime
13008
13009 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
13010 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
13011 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
13012 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
13013
13014 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
13015 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
13016 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
13017 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
13018 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
13019 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
13020 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
13021 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
13022 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
13023 automatically encrypted messages.
13024
13025 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
13026 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
13027 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
13028
13029 @table @kbd
13030
13031 @item C-c C-m s s
13032 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
13033 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
13034
13035 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
13036
13037 @item C-c C-m s o
13038 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
13039 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
13040
13041 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
13042
13043 @item C-c C-m s p
13044 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
13045 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
13046
13047 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
13048
13049 @item C-c C-m c s
13050 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
13051 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
13052
13053 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
13054
13055 @item C-c C-m c o
13056 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
13057 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
13058
13059 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
13060
13061 @item C-c C-m c p
13062 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
13063 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
13064
13065 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
13066
13067 @item C-c C-m C-n
13068 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
13069 @findex mml-unsecure-message
13070 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
13071
13072 @end table
13073
13074 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
13075
13076 @node Select Methods
13077 @chapter Select Methods
13078 @cindex foreign groups
13079 @cindex select methods
13080
13081 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
13082 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
13083 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
13084 personal mail group.
13085
13086 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
13087 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
13088 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g., @code{nntp},
13089 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
13090 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
13091 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
13092
13093 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
13094 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
13095
13096 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
13097 group as.
13098
13099 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
13100 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
13101 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
13102 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
13103 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
13104
13105 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
13106
13107 @menu
13108 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
13109 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
13110 * Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
13111 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
13112 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
13113 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
13114 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
13115 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
13116 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
13117 @end menu
13118
13119
13120 @node Server Buffer
13121 @section Server Buffer
13122
13123 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
13124 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
13125 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
13126 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
13127 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
13128 back end represents a virtual server.
13129
13130 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
13131 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
13132 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
13133 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
13134
13135 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
13136 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
13137 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
13138 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
13139 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
13140 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
13141 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
13142
13143 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
13144 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
13145
13146 @menu
13147 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
13148 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
13149 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
13150 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
13151 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
13152 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
13153 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
13154 @end menu
13155
13156 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
13157 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
13158
13159
13160 @node Server Buffer Format
13161 @subsection Server Buffer Format
13162 @cindex server buffer format
13163
13164 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
13165 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
13166 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
13167 variable, with some simple extensions:
13168
13169 @table @samp
13170
13171 @item h
13172 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
13173
13174 @item n
13175 The name of this server.
13176
13177 @item w
13178 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
13179
13180 @item s
13181 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
13182
13183 @item a
13184 Whether this server is agentized.
13185 @end table
13186
13187 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
13188 The mode line can also be customized by using the
13189 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
13190 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
13191
13192 @table @samp
13193 @item S
13194 Server name.
13195
13196 @item M
13197 Server method.
13198 @end table
13199
13200 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
13201
13202
13203 @node Server Commands
13204 @subsection Server Commands
13205 @cindex server commands
13206
13207 @table @kbd
13208
13209 @item v
13210 @kindex v (Server)
13211 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
13212 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
13213 command or better use it as a prefix key.
13214
13215 @item a
13216 @kindex a (Server)
13217 @findex gnus-server-add-server
13218 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
13219
13220 @item e
13221 @kindex e (Server)
13222 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
13223 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
13224
13225 @item S
13226 @kindex S (Server)
13227 @findex gnus-server-show-server
13228 Show the definition of a server (@code{gnus-server-show-server}).
13229
13230 @item SPACE
13231 @kindex SPACE (Server)
13232 @findex gnus-server-read-server
13233 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
13234
13235 @item q
13236 @kindex q (Server)
13237 @findex gnus-server-exit
13238 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
13239
13240 @item k
13241 @kindex k (Server)
13242 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
13243 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
13244
13245 @item y
13246 @kindex y (Server)
13247 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
13248 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
13249
13250 @item c
13251 @kindex c (Server)
13252 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13253 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
13254
13255 @item l
13256 @kindex l (Server)
13257 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
13258 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
13259
13260 @item s
13261 @kindex s (Server)
13262 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
13263 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
13264 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
13265 servers.
13266
13267 @item g
13268 @kindex g (Server)
13269 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
13270 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
13271 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
13272 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
13273
13274 @item z
13275 @kindex z (Server)
13276 @findex gnus-server-compact-server
13277
13278 Compact all groups in the server under point
13279 (@code{gnus-server-compact-server}). Currently implemented only in
13280 nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes gaps between article numbers,
13281 hence getting a correct total article count.
13282
13283 @end table
13284
13285 Some more commands for closing, disabling, and re-opening servers are
13286 listed in @ref{Unavailable Servers}.
13287
13288
13289 @node Example Methods
13290 @subsection Example Methods
13291
13292 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
13293
13294 @lisp
13295 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
13296 @end lisp
13297
13298 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
13299
13300 @lisp
13301 (nnspool "")
13302 @end lisp
13303
13304 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
13305 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
13306 will.
13307
13308 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
13309 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
13310
13311 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
13312 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
13313 look like then:
13314
13315 @lisp
13316 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
13317 @end lisp
13318
13319 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
13320 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
13321
13322 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
13323 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
13324 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
13325 your private mail:
13326
13327 @lisp
13328 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
13329 @end lisp
13330
13331 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
13332 that.)
13333
13334 Here's the method for a public spool:
13335
13336 @lisp
13337 (nnmh "public"
13338 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
13339 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
13340 @end lisp
13341
13342 @cindex proxy
13343 @cindex firewall
13344
13345 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
13346 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
13347 on the firewall machine and connect with
13348 @uref{http://netcat.sourceforge.net/, netcat} from there to the
13349 @acronym{NNTP} server.
13350 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
13351 should probably look something like this:
13352
13353 @lisp
13354 (nntp "firewall"
13355 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)
13356 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
13357 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host"))
13358 @end lisp
13359
13360 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
13361 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
13362 configuration to the example above:
13363
13364 @lisp
13365 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13366 @end lisp
13367
13368 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}. Here's an example for
13369 an indirect connection:
13370
13371 @lisp
13372 (setq gnus-select-method
13373 '(nntp "indirect"
13374 (nntp-address "news.server.example")
13375 (nntp-via-user-name "intermediate_user_name")
13376 (nntp-via-address "intermediate.host.example")
13377 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13378 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches ("-C"))
13379 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)))
13380 @end lisp
13381
13382 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
13383 provide automatic authorization, of course.
13384
13385 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
13386 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
13387 netcat connection to the news server as follows:
13388
13389 @lisp
13390 (nntp "outside"
13391 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13392 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13393 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13394 @end lisp
13395
13396
13397 @node Creating a Virtual Server
13398 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
13399
13400 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
13401 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
13402
13403 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
13404 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
13405 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
13406
13407 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
13408
13409 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
13410 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
13411 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
13412 will contain the following:
13413
13414 @lisp
13415 (nnml "cache")
13416 @end lisp
13417
13418 Change that to:
13419
13420 @lisp
13421 (nnml "cache"
13422 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
13423 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
13424 @end lisp
13425
13426 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
13427 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
13428 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
13429
13430
13431 @node Server Variables
13432 @subsection Server Variables
13433 @cindex server variables
13434 @cindex server parameters
13435
13436 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
13437 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
13438 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
13439 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
13440 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
13441
13442 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
13443 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
13444 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
13445 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
13446 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
13447 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
13448 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
13449 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
13450 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
13451
13452 @lisp
13453 (nnml "public"
13454 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
13455 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
13456 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
13457 @end lisp
13458
13459 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
13460
13461 @node Servers and Methods
13462 @subsection Servers and Methods
13463
13464 Wherever you would normally use a select method
13465 (e.g., @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
13466 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
13467 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
13468 over.
13469
13470
13471 @node Unavailable Servers
13472 @subsection Unavailable Servers
13473
13474 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
13475 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
13476 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
13477 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
13478 actually the case or not.
13479
13480 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
13481 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
13482 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
13483 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
13484 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
13485 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
13486 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
13487 it will regard that server as ``down''.
13488
13489 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
13490 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
13491
13492 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
13493 with the following commands:
13494
13495 @table @kbd
13496
13497 @item O
13498 @kindex O (Server)
13499 @findex gnus-server-open-server
13500 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
13501 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
13502
13503 @item C
13504 @kindex C (Server)
13505 @findex gnus-server-close-server
13506 Close the connection (if any) to the server
13507 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
13508
13509 @item D
13510 @kindex D (Server)
13511 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
13512 Mark the current server as unreachable
13513 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
13514
13515 @item M-o
13516 @kindex M-o (Server)
13517 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
13518 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
13519 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
13520
13521 @item M-c
13522 @kindex M-c (Server)
13523 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
13524 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
13525 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
13526
13527 @item R
13528 @kindex R (Server)
13529 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
13530 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
13531 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
13532
13533 @item c
13534 @kindex c (Server)
13535 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13536 Copy a server and give it a new name
13537 (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}). This can be useful if you have a
13538 complex method definition, and want to use the same definition towards
13539 a different (physical) server.
13540
13541 @item L
13542 @kindex L (Server)
13543 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
13544 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
13545
13546 @end table
13547
13548
13549 @node Getting News
13550 @section Getting News
13551 @cindex reading news
13552 @cindex news back ends
13553
13554 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
13555 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
13556 or it can read from a local spool.
13557
13558 @menu
13559 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13560 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
13561 @end menu
13562
13563
13564 @node NNTP
13565 @subsection NNTP
13566 @cindex nntp
13567
13568 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
13569 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
13570 server as the, uhm, address.
13571
13572 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
13573 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
13574 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
13575 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
13576
13577 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
13578 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
13579 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
13580
13581 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
13582 server:
13583
13584 @table @code
13585
13586 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
13587 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
13588 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
13589 @cindex authinfo
13590 @cindex authentication
13591 @cindex nntp authentication
13592 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
13593 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
13594 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
13595 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
13596 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
13597 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
13598 present in this hook.
13599
13600 @item nntp-authinfo-function
13601 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
13602 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
13603 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
13604 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
13605 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
13606 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
13607 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
13608 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
13609 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
13610 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
13611 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
13612
13613 @enumerate
13614 @item
13615 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
13616
13617 @item
13618 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
13619
13620 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
13621 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
13622 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
13623 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
13624 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
13625 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
13626 @samp{force} is explained below.
13627
13628 @end enumerate
13629
13630 Here's an example file:
13631
13632 @example
13633 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
13634 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
13635 @end example
13636
13637 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
13638 have to be first, for instance.
13639
13640 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
13641 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
13642 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
13643 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
13644 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
13645 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
13646 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
13647
13648 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
13649 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
13650
13651 @example
13652 default force yes
13653 @end example
13654
13655 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
13656 previously mentioned.
13657
13658 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
13659
13660 @item nntp-server-action-alist
13661 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
13662 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
13663 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
13664 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
13665
13666 @lisp
13667 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
13668 '(("innd" (ding))))
13669 @end lisp
13670
13671 You probably don't want to do that, though.
13672
13673 The default value is
13674
13675 @lisp
13676 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
13677 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
13678 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
13679 @end lisp
13680
13681 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
13682 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
13683
13684 @item nntp-maximum-request
13685 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
13686 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
13687 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
13688 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
13689 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
13690 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
13691 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
13692
13693 @item nntp-connection-timeout
13694 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
13695 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
13696 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
13697 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
13698 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
13699 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
13700 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
13701 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
13702 no timeouts are done.
13703
13704 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
13705 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
13706 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
13707 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
13708 can be used.
13709
13710 @item nntp-xover-commands
13711 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
13712 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
13713 @cindex XOVER
13714 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
13715 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
13716 "XOVERVIEW")}.
13717
13718 @item nntp-nov-gap
13719 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
13720 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
13721 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
13722 if you have read articles 2--5000 in the group, and only want to read
13723 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
13724 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
13725 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
13726 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
13727 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
13728 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
13729 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
13730
13731 @item nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13732 @vindex nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13733 When Gnus refers to an article having the @code{Message-ID} that a user
13734 specifies or having the @code{Message-ID} of the parent article of the
13735 current one (@pxref{Finding the Parent}), Gnus sends a @code{HEAD}
13736 command to the @acronym{NNTP} server to know where it is, and the server
13737 returns the data containing the pairs of a group and an article number
13738 in the @code{Xref} header. Gnus normally uses the article number to
13739 refer to the article if the data shows that that article is in the
13740 current group, while it uses the @code{Message-ID} otherwise. However,
13741 some news servers, e.g., ones running Diablo, run multiple engines
13742 having the same articles but article numbers are not kept synchronized
13743 between them. In that case, the article number that appears in the
13744 @code{Xref} header varies by which engine is chosen, so you cannot refer
13745 to the parent article that is in the current group, for instance. If
13746 you connect to such a server, set this variable to a non-@code{nil}
13747 value, and Gnus never uses article numbers. For example:
13748
13749 @lisp
13750 (setq gnus-select-method
13751 '(nntp "newszilla"
13752 (nntp-address "newszilla.example.com")
13753 (nntp-xref-number-is-evil t)
13754 @dots{}))
13755 @end lisp
13756
13757 The default value of this server variable is @code{nil}.
13758
13759 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
13760 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
13761 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13762
13763 @item nntp-record-commands
13764 @vindex nntp-record-commands
13765 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
13766 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @file{*nntp-log*}
13767 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
13768 that doesn't seem to work.
13769
13770 @item nntp-open-connection-function
13771 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
13772 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
13773 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
13774 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
13775 Seven pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped
13776 in two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
13777 indirect ones (three pre-made).
13778
13779 @item nntp-never-echoes-commands
13780 @vindex nntp-never-echoes-commands
13781 Non-@code{nil} means the nntp server never echoes commands. It is
13782 reported that some nntps server doesn't echo commands. So, you may want
13783 to set this to non-@code{nil} in the method for such a server setting
13784 @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream} for
13785 example. The default value is @code{nil}. Note that the
13786 @code{nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands} variable
13787 overrides the @code{nil} value of this variable.
13788
13789 @item nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13790 @vindex nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13791 List of functions that never echo commands. Add or set a function which
13792 you set to @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to this list if it does
13793 not echo commands. Note that a non-@code{nil} value of the
13794 @code{nntp-never-echoes-commands} variable overrides this variable. The
13795 default value is @code{(nntp-open-network-stream)}.
13796
13797 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
13798 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
13799 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
13800 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
13801 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
13802 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
13803 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
13804
13805 @lisp
13806 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
13807 @end lisp
13808
13809 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID@. This works for
13810 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
13811
13812 @item nntp-server-list-active-group
13813 If @code{nil}, then always use @samp{GROUP} instead of @samp{LIST
13814 ACTIVE}. This is usually slower, but on misconfigured servers that
13815 don't update their active files often, this can help.
13816
13817
13818 @end table
13819
13820 @menu
13821 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
13822 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
13823 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
13824 @end menu
13825
13826
13827 @node Direct Functions
13828 @subsubsection Direct Functions
13829 @cindex direct connection functions
13830
13831 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
13832 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
13833 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
13834 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13835
13836 @table @code
13837 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
13838 @item nntp-open-network-stream
13839 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
13840 remote system. If both Emacs and the server supports it, the
13841 connection will be upgraded to an encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS}
13842 connection automatically.
13843
13844 @item network-only
13845 The same as the above, but don't do automatic @acronym{STARTTLS} upgrades.
13846
13847 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
13848 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
13849 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13850 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GnuTLS}
13851 installed. You then define a server as follows:
13852
13853 @lisp
13854 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13855 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
13856 ;;
13857 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13858 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
13859 (nntp-port-number 563)
13860 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13861 @end lisp
13862
13863 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
13864 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
13865 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13866 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL}
13867 @ignore
13868 @c Defunct URL, ancient package, so don't mention it.
13869 or @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay}
13870 @end ignore
13871 installed. You then define a server as follows:
13872
13873 @lisp
13874 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13875 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
13876 ;;
13877 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13878 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
13879 (nntp-port-number 563)
13880 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13881 @end lisp
13882
13883 @findex nntp-open-netcat-stream
13884 @item nntp-open-netcat-stream
13885 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server using the @code{netcat}
13886 program. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have
13887 the default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
13888 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
13889 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
13890 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
13891
13892 @lisp
13893 (nntp "socksified"
13894 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13895 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13896 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13897 @end lisp
13898
13899 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
13900 session, which is not a good idea.
13901
13902 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
13903 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
13904 Like @code{nntp-open-netcat-stream}, but uses @code{telnet} rather than
13905 @code{netcat}. @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things
13906 like line-end-conversion, but sometimes netcat is simply
13907 not available. The previous example would turn into:
13908
13909 @lisp
13910 (nntp "socksified"
13911 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13912 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
13913 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
13914 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
13915 @end lisp
13916 @end table
13917
13918
13919 @node Indirect Functions
13920 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
13921 @cindex indirect connection functions
13922
13923 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
13924 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13925 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
13926 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
13927 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
13928 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13929
13930 @table @code
13931 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13932 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13933 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then uses @code{netcat} to connect
13934 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
13935 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
13936
13937 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat}-specific variables:
13938
13939 @table @code
13940 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13941 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13942 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13943 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13944
13945 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13946 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13947 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13948 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
13949 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
13950 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections.
13951 @end table
13952
13953 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13954 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13955 Does essentially the same, but uses @code{telnet} instead of @samp{netcat}
13956 to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the intermediate host.
13957 @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things like
13958 line-end-conversion, but sometimes @code{netcat} is simply not available.
13959
13960 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13961
13962 @table @code
13963 @item nntp-telnet-command
13964 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
13965 Command used to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the
13966 intermediate host. The default is @samp{telnet}.
13967
13968 @item nntp-telnet-switches
13969 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13970 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13971 @code{nntp-telnet-command} command. The default is @code{("-8")}.
13972
13973 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13974 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13975 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13976 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13977
13978 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13979 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13980 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13981 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. If you use @samp{ssh}, you may need to set
13982 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
13983 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
13984 host. The default is @code{nil}.
13985 @end table
13986
13987 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13988 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13989
13990 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13991 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13992 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
13993 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
13994
13995 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13996
13997 @table @code
13998 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
13999 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
14000 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
14001 @samp{telnet}.
14002
14003 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
14004 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
14005 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
14006 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
14007
14008 @item nntp-via-user-password
14009 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
14010 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
14011
14012 @item nntp-via-envuser
14013 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
14014 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
14015 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
14016 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
14017
14018 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
14019 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
14020 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
14021 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
14022
14023 @end table
14024
14025 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
14026 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
14027 @end table
14028
14029
14030 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
14031 functions:
14032
14033 @table @code
14034
14035 @item nntp-via-user-name
14036 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
14037 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
14038
14039 @item nntp-via-address
14040 @vindex nntp-via-address
14041 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
14042
14043 @end table
14044
14045
14046 @node Common Variables
14047 @subsubsection Common Variables
14048
14049 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
14050 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
14051 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
14052 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
14053 variables individually).
14054
14055 @table @code
14056
14057 @item nntp-pre-command
14058 @vindex nntp-pre-command
14059 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
14060 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
14061 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
14062 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
14063
14064 @item nntp-address
14065 @vindex nntp-address
14066 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
14067
14068 @item nntp-port-number
14069 @vindex nntp-port-number
14070 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14071 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
14072 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
14073 than named ports (i.e., use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
14074 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
14075 not work with named ports.
14076
14077 @item nntp-end-of-line
14078 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
14079 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
14080 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
14081 using a non native telnet connection function.
14082
14083 @item nntp-netcat-command
14084 @vindex nntp-netcat-command
14085 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
14086 @samp{netcat}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
14087 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14088 @samp{nc}.
14089
14090 @item nntp-netcat-switches
14091 @vindex nntp-netcat-switches
14092 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-netcat-command}. The default
14093 is @samp{()}.
14094
14095 @end table
14096
14097 @node News Spool
14098 @subsection News Spool
14099 @cindex nnspool
14100 @cindex news spool
14101
14102 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
14103 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
14104 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
14105 instance.
14106
14107 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
14108 anything else) as the address.
14109
14110 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
14111 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
14112 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
14113 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
14114
14115 @table @code
14116
14117 @item nnspool-inews-program
14118 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
14119 Program used to post an article.
14120
14121 @item nnspool-inews-switches
14122 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
14123 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
14124
14125 @item nnspool-spool-directory
14126 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
14127 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
14128 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
14129
14130 @item nnspool-nov-directory
14131 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
14132 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
14133 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
14134
14135 @item nnspool-lib-dir
14136 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
14137 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
14138
14139 @item nnspool-active-file
14140 @vindex nnspool-active-file
14141 The name of the active file.
14142
14143 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
14144 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
14145 The name of the group descriptions file.
14146
14147 @item nnspool-history-file
14148 @vindex nnspool-history-file
14149 The name of the news history file.
14150
14151 @item nnspool-active-times-file
14152 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
14153 The name of the active date file.
14154
14155 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
14156 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
14157 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
14158 that it finds.
14159
14160 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14161 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14162 @cindex sed
14163 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
14164 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
14165 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
14166 there.
14167
14168 @end table
14169
14170
14171 @node Using IMAP
14172 @section Using IMAP
14173 @cindex imap
14174
14175 The most popular mail backend is probably @code{nnimap}, which
14176 provides access to @acronym{IMAP} servers. @acronym{IMAP} servers
14177 store mail remotely, so the client doesn't store anything locally.
14178 This means that it's a convenient choice when you're reading your mail
14179 from different locations, or with different user agents.
14180
14181 @menu
14182 * Connecting to an IMAP Server:: Getting started with @acronym{IMAP}.
14183 * Customizing the IMAP Connection:: Variables for @acronym{IMAP} connection.
14184 * Client-Side IMAP Splitting:: Put mail in the correct mail box.
14185 * Support for IMAP Extensions:: Getting extensions and labels from servers.
14186 @end menu
14187
14188
14189 @node Connecting to an IMAP Server
14190 @subsection Connecting to an IMAP Server
14191
14192 Connecting to an @acronym{IMAP} can be very easy. Type @kbd{B} in the
14193 group buffer, or (if your primary interest is reading email), say
14194 something like:
14195
14196 @example
14197 (setq gnus-select-method
14198 '(nnimap "imap.gmail.com"))
14199 @end example
14200
14201 You'll be prompted for a user name and password. If you grow tired of
14202 that, then add the following to your @file{~/.authinfo} file:
14203
14204 @example
14205 machine imap.gmail.com login <username> password <password> port imap
14206 @end example
14207
14208 That should basically be it for most users.
14209
14210
14211 @node Customizing the IMAP Connection
14212 @subsection Customizing the IMAP Connection
14213
14214 Here's an example method that's more complex:
14215
14216 @example
14217 (nnimap "imap.gmail.com"
14218 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14219 (nnimap-split-methods default)
14220 (nnimap-expunge t)
14221 (nnimap-stream ssl))
14222 @end example
14223
14224 @table @code
14225 @item nnimap-address
14226 The address of the server, like @samp{imap.gmail.com}.
14227
14228 @item nnimap-server-port
14229 If the server uses a non-standard port, that can be specified here. A
14230 typical port would be @code{"imap"} or @code{"imaps"}.
14231
14232 @item nnimap-stream
14233 How @code{nnimap} should connect to the server. Possible values are:
14234
14235 @table @code
14236 @item undecided
14237 This is the default, and this first tries the @code{ssl} setting, and
14238 then tries the @code{network} setting.
14239
14240 @item ssl
14241 This uses standard @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14242
14243 @item network
14244 Non-encrypted and unsafe straight socket connection, but will upgrade
14245 to encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} if both Emacs and the server
14246 supports it.
14247
14248 @item starttls
14249 Encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} over the normal @acronym{IMAP} port.
14250
14251 @item shell
14252 If you need to tunnel via other systems to connect to the server, you
14253 can use this option, and customize @code{nnimap-shell-program} to be
14254 what you need.
14255
14256 @item plain
14257 Non-encrypted and unsafe straight socket connection.
14258 @acronym{STARTTLS} will not be used even if it is available.
14259
14260 @end table
14261
14262 @item nnimap-authenticator
14263 Some @acronym{IMAP} servers allow anonymous logins. In that case,
14264 this should be set to @code{anonymous}. If this variable isn't set,
14265 the normal login methods will be used. If you wish to specify a
14266 specific login method to be used, you can set this variable to either
14267 @code{login} (the traditional @acronym{IMAP} login method),
14268 @code{plain} or @code{cram-md5}.
14269
14270 @item nnimap-expunge
14271 If non-@code{nil}, expunge articles after deleting them. This is always done
14272 if the server supports UID EXPUNGE, but it's not done by default on
14273 servers that doesn't support that command.
14274
14275 @item nnimap-streaming
14276 Virtually all @acronym{IMAP} server support fast streaming of data.
14277 If you have problems connecting to the server, try setting this to
14278 @code{nil}.
14279
14280 @item nnimap-fetch-partial-articles
14281 If non-@code{nil}, fetch partial articles from the server. If set to
14282 a string, then it's interpreted as a regexp, and parts that have
14283 matching types will be fetched. For instance, @samp{"text/"} will
14284 fetch all textual parts, while leaving the rest on the server.
14285
14286 @item nnimap-record-commands
14287 If non-@code{nil}, record all @acronym{IMAP} commands in the
14288 @samp{"*imap log*"} buffer.
14289
14290 @end table
14291
14292
14293 @node Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14294 @subsection Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14295
14296 Many people prefer to do the sorting/splitting of mail into their mail
14297 boxes on the @acronym{IMAP} server. That way they don't have to
14298 download the mail they're not all that interested in.
14299
14300 If you do want to do client-side mail splitting, then the following
14301 variables are relevant:
14302
14303 @table @code
14304 @item nnimap-inbox
14305 This is the @acronym{IMAP} mail box that will be scanned for new
14306 mail. This can also be a list of mail box names.
14307
14308 @item nnimap-split-methods
14309 Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-methods} (@pxref{Splitting
14310 Mail}), except the symbol @code{default}, which means that it should
14311 use the value of the @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable.
14312
14313 @item nnimap-split-fancy
14314 Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
14315
14316 @item nnimap-unsplittable-articles
14317 List of flag symbols to ignore when doing splitting. That is,
14318 articles that have these flags won't be considered when splitting.
14319 The default is @samp{(%Deleted %Seen)}.
14320
14321 @end table
14322
14323 Here's a complete example @code{nnimap} backend with a client-side
14324 ``fancy'' splitting method:
14325
14326 @example
14327 (nnimap "imap.example.com"
14328 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14329 (nnimap-split-fancy
14330 (| ("MailScanner-SpamCheck" "spam" "spam.detected")
14331 (to "foo@@bar.com" "foo")
14332 "undecided")))
14333 @end example
14334
14335
14336 @node Support for IMAP Extensions
14337 @subsection Support for IMAP Extensions
14338
14339 @cindex Gmail
14340 @cindex X-GM-LABELS
14341 @cindex IMAP labels
14342
14343 If you're using Google's Gmail, you may want to see your Gmail labels
14344 when reading your mail. Gnus can give you this information if you ask
14345 for @samp{X-GM-LABELS} in the variable @code{gnus-extra-headers}. For
14346 example:
14347
14348 @example
14349 (setq gnus-extra-headers
14350 '(To Newsgroups X-GM-LABELS))
14351 @end example
14352
14353 This will result in Gnus storing your labels in message header
14354 structures for later use. The content is always a parenthesized
14355 (possible empty) list.
14356
14357
14358
14359 @node Getting Mail
14360 @section Getting Mail
14361 @cindex reading mail
14362 @cindex mail
14363
14364 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD@? But of
14365 course.
14366
14367 @menu
14368 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
14369 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
14370 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
14371 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
14372 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
14373 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
14374 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
14375 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
14376 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
14377 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
14378 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
14379 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
14380 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
14381 @end menu
14382
14383
14384 @node Mail in a Newsreader
14385 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
14386
14387 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
14388 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
14389 of a culture shock.
14390
14391 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
14392 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
14393
14394 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
14395 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
14396 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
14397 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
14398
14399 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
14400
14401 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
14402 deleted? How awful!
14403
14404 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
14405 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
14406 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
14407 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
14408 Mail}.
14409
14410 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
14411 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
14412 they want to treat a message.
14413
14414 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
14415 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
14416 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
14417 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
14418 archived somewhere else.
14419
14420 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
14421 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
14422 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
14423 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
14424 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
14425
14426 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
14427 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
14428 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
14429
14430 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
14431 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
14432 differently.
14433
14434 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
14435 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
14436 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
14437 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
14438 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
14439
14440 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
14441 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
14442 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
14443 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
14444 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
14445 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
14446 You Do.)
14447
14448
14449 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
14450 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
14451
14452 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
14453 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
14454 and things will happen automatically.
14455
14456 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
14457 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14458
14459 @lisp
14460 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
14461 @end lisp
14462
14463 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
14464 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
14465 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
14466 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
14467 like any other group.
14468
14469 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
14470
14471 @lisp
14472 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14473 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14474 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14475 ("other" "")))
14476 @end lisp
14477
14478 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
14479 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
14480 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
14481 last group.
14482
14483 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
14484 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
14485 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
14486
14487
14488 @node Splitting Mail
14489 @subsection Splitting Mail
14490 @cindex splitting mail
14491 @cindex mail splitting
14492 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
14493
14494 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
14495 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
14496 to be split into groups.
14497
14498 @lisp
14499 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14500 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14501 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14502 ("mail.other" "")))
14503 @end lisp
14504
14505 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
14506 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
14507 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
14508 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
14509 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
14510 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
14511 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
14512
14513 @lisp
14514 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
14515 @end lisp
14516
14517 @noindent
14518 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
14519 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14520
14521 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
14522 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
14523 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
14524 mail belongs in that group.
14525
14526 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
14527 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
14528 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
14529 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
14530 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
14531 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
14532 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
14533 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
14534 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
14535 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
14536
14537 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
14538 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
14539 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
14540 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
14541 thinks should carry this mail message.
14542
14543 This variable can also be a fancy split method. For the syntax,
14544 see @ref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14545
14546 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
14547 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
14548 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
14549 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
14550
14551 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
14552 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
14553 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
14554 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
14555 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
14556
14557 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
14558 @cindex crosspost
14559 @cindex links
14560 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
14561 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
14562 links. If that's the case for you, set
14563 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
14564 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
14565
14566 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
14567 @findex nnmail-split-history
14568 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
14569 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
14570 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
14571 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
14572 Group Commands}).
14573
14574 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
14575 Header lines longer than the value of
14576 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
14577 function.
14578
14579 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
14580 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
14581 By default, splitting does not decode headers, so you can not match on
14582 non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. But it is useful if you want to match
14583 articles based on the raw header data. To enable it, set the
14584 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} variable to a non-@code{nil} value.
14585 In addition, the value of the @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset}
14586 variable is used for decoding non-@acronym{MIME} encoded string when
14587 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} is non-@code{nil}. The default
14588 value is @code{nil} which means not to decode non-@acronym{MIME} encoded
14589 string. A suitable value for you will be @code{undecided} or be the
14590 charset used normally in mails you are interested in.
14591
14592 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14593 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
14594 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
14595 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
14596 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
14597 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
14598 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
14599 other kinds of entries.)
14600
14601 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
14602 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
14603 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
14604 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
14605 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
14606 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
14607 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
14608 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
14609 month's rent money.
14610
14611
14612 @node Mail Sources
14613 @subsection Mail Sources
14614
14615 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
14616 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
14617 maildir, for instance.
14618
14619 @menu
14620 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
14621 * Mail Source Functions::
14622 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
14623 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
14624 @end menu
14625
14626
14627 @node Mail Source Specifiers
14628 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
14629 @cindex POP
14630 @cindex mail server
14631 @cindex procmail
14632 @cindex mail spool
14633 @cindex mail source
14634
14635 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
14636 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
14637
14638 Here's an example:
14639
14640 @lisp
14641 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
14642 @end lisp
14643
14644 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
14645 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
14646 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
14647 default values.
14648
14649 The @code{mail-sources} is global for all mail groups. You can specify
14650 an additional mail source for a particular group by including the
14651 @code{group} mail specifier in @code{mail-sources}, and setting a
14652 @code{mail-source} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) specifying
14653 a single mail source. When this is used, @code{mail-sources} is
14654 typically just @code{(group)}; the @code{mail-source} parameter for a
14655 group might look like this:
14656
14657 @lisp
14658 (mail-source . (file :path "home/user/spools/foo.spool"))
14659 @end lisp
14660
14661 This means that the group's (and only this group's) messages will be
14662 fetched from the spool file @samp{/user/spools/foo.spool}.
14663
14664 The following mail source types are available:
14665
14666 @table @code
14667 @item file
14668 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
14669
14670 Keywords:
14671
14672 @table @code
14673 @item :path
14674 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
14675 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
14676 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
14677
14678 @item :prescript
14679 @itemx :postscript
14680 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14681 @end table
14682
14683 An example file mail source:
14684
14685 @lisp
14686 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
14687 @end lisp
14688
14689 Or using the default file name:
14690
14691 @lisp
14692 (file)
14693 @end lisp
14694
14695 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
14696 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
14697 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
14698 mail spool while moving the mail.
14699
14700 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
14701
14702 @lisp
14703 (setq mail-sources
14704 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
14705 @end lisp
14706
14707 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
14708
14709 @example
14710 #!/bin/sh
14711 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
14712 # flu@@iki.fi
14713
14714 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
14715 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
14716 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
14717 @end example
14718
14719 Alter this script to fit the @samp{movemail} and temporary
14720 file you want to use.
14721
14722
14723 @item directory
14724 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
14725 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
14726 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
14727 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
14728 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
14729 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
14730 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
14731 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
14732 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
14733 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
14734
14735 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14736 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
14737 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
14738 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
14739
14740 Keywords:
14741
14742 @table @code
14743 @item :path
14744 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
14745 value.
14746
14747 @item :suffix
14748 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
14749 @samp{.spool}.
14750
14751 @item :predicate
14752 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
14753 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
14754 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
14755 predicate are considered.
14756
14757 @item :prescript
14758 @itemx :postscript
14759 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14760
14761 @end table
14762
14763 An example directory mail source:
14764
14765 @lisp
14766 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
14767 :suffix ".prcml")
14768 @end lisp
14769
14770 @item pop
14771 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14772
14773 Keywords:
14774
14775 @table @code
14776 @item :server
14777 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
14778 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14779
14780 @item :port
14781 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (e.g.,
14782 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (e.g., @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
14783 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
14784 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
14785 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
14786
14787 @item :user
14788 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
14789 name.
14790
14791 @item :password
14792 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
14793 the user is prompted.
14794
14795 @item :program
14796 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
14797 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
14798
14799 @example
14800 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
14801 @end example
14802
14803 The valid format specifier characters are:
14804
14805 @table @samp
14806 @item t
14807 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
14808 included in this string.
14809
14810 @item s
14811 The name of the server.
14812
14813 @item P
14814 The port number of the server.
14815
14816 @item u
14817 The user name to use.
14818
14819 @item p
14820 The password to use.
14821 @end table
14822
14823 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14824 corresponding keywords.
14825
14826 @item :prescript
14827 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14828 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14829
14830 One popular way to use this is to set up an SSH tunnel to access the
14831 @acronym{POP} server. Here's an example:
14832
14833 @lisp
14834 (pop :server "127.0.0.1"
14835 :port 1234
14836 :user "foo"
14837 :password "secret"
14838 :prescript
14839 "nohup ssh -f -L 1234:pop.server:110 remote.host sleep 3600 &")
14840 @end lisp
14841
14842 @item :postscript
14843 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14844 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14845
14846 @item :function
14847 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
14848 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
14849 mail should be moved to.
14850
14851 @item :authentication
14852 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
14853 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
14854 @code{password}.
14855
14856 @item :leave
14857 Non-@code{nil} if the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
14858 after fetching. Only the built-in @code{pop3-movemail} program (the
14859 default) supports this keyword.
14860
14861 If this is a number, leave mails on the server for this many days since
14862 you first checked new mails. In that case, mails once fetched will
14863 never be fetched again by the @acronym{UIDL} control. If this is
14864 @code{nil} (the default), mails will be deleted on the server right
14865 after fetching. If this is neither @code{nil} nor a number, all mails
14866 will be left on the server, and you will end up getting the same mails
14867 again and again.
14868
14869 @vindex pop3-uidl-file
14870 The @code{pop3-uidl-file} variable specifies the file to which the
14871 @acronym{UIDL} data are locally stored. The default value is
14872 @file{~/.pop3-uidl}.
14873
14874 Note that @acronym{POP} servers maintain no state information between
14875 sessions, so what the client believes is there and what is actually
14876 there may not match up. If they do not, then you may get duplicate
14877 mails or the whole thing can fall apart and leave you with a corrupt
14878 mailbox.
14879
14880 @end table
14881
14882 @findex pop3-movemail
14883 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
14884 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
14885 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used.
14886
14887 Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14888
14889 Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
14890 name, and default fetcher:
14891
14892 @lisp
14893 (pop)
14894 @end lisp
14895
14896 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
14897
14898 @lisp
14899 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
14900 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
14901 @end lisp
14902
14903 Leave mails on the server for 14 days:
14904
14905 @lisp
14906 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
14907 :user "user-name" :password "secret"
14908 :leave 14)
14909 @end lisp
14910
14911 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
14912
14913 @lisp
14914 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
14915 @end lisp
14916
14917 @item maildir
14918 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
14919 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
14920 contains exactly one mail.
14921
14922 Keywords:
14923
14924 @table @code
14925 @item :path
14926 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
14927 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
14928 @file{~/Maildir/}.
14929 @item :subdirs
14930 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
14931 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
14932
14933 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
14934 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
14935 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
14936 @c below.
14937
14938 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
14939 from locking problems).
14940
14941 @end table
14942
14943 Two example maildir mail sources:
14944
14945 @lisp
14946 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
14947 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
14948 @end lisp
14949
14950 @lisp
14951 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
14952 :subdirs ("new"))
14953 @end lisp
14954
14955 @item imap
14956 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
14957 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (i.e.,
14958 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
14959 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
14960 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{Using IMAP}, for more information.
14961
14962 Keywords:
14963
14964 @table @code
14965 @item :server
14966 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
14967 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14968
14969 @item :port
14970 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
14971 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14972
14973 @item :user
14974 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
14975 name.
14976
14977 @item :password
14978 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
14979 prompted.
14980
14981 @item :stream
14982 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
14983 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
14984 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
14985 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
14986
14987 @item :authentication
14988 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
14989 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
14990 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
14991 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
14992
14993 @item :program
14994 When using the @samp{shell} :stream, the contents of this variable is
14995 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
14996 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
14997
14998 @example
14999 ssh %s imapd
15000 @end example
15001
15002 Make sure nothing is interfering with the output of the program, e.g.,
15003 don't forget to redirect the error output to the void. The valid format
15004 specifier characters are:
15005
15006 @table @samp
15007 @item s
15008 The name of the server.
15009
15010 @item l
15011 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
15012
15013 @item p
15014 The port number of the server.
15015 @end table
15016
15017 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
15018 corresponding keywords.
15019
15020 @item :mailbox
15021 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
15022 which normally is the mailbox which receives incoming mail. Instead of
15023 a single mailbox, this can be a list of mailboxes to fetch mail from.
15024
15025 @item :predicate
15026 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
15027 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
15028 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
15029 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
15030 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
15031 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
15032
15033 @item :fetchflag
15034 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
15035 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
15036 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
15037 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
15038
15039 @item :dontexpunge
15040 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
15041 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
15042
15043 @end table
15044
15045 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
15046
15047 @lisp
15048 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
15049 :stream kerberos4
15050 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
15051 @end lisp
15052
15053 @item group
15054 Get the actual mail source from the @code{mail-source} group parameter,
15055 @xref{Group Parameters}.
15056
15057 @end table
15058
15059 @table @dfn
15060 @item Common Keywords
15061 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
15062
15063 Keywords:
15064
15065 @table @code
15066 @item :plugged
15067 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
15068 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
15069 example:
15070
15071 @lisp
15072 (setq mail-sources
15073 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
15074 :suffix ""
15075 :plugged t)))
15076 @end lisp
15077
15078 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
15079 useful when you use local mail and news.
15080
15081 @end table
15082 @end table
15083
15084 @node Mail Source Functions
15085 @subsubsection Function Interface
15086
15087 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
15088 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
15089 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
15090 consider the following mail-source setting:
15091
15092 @lisp
15093 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
15094 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
15095 @end lisp
15096
15097 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
15098 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
15099 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
15100 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
15101 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
15102
15103 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
15104
15105
15106 @node Mail Source Customization
15107 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
15108
15109 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
15110 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
15111 variables.
15112
15113 @table @code
15114 @item mail-source-crash-box
15115 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
15116 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
15117 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
15118
15119 @cindex Incoming*
15120 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
15121 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
15122 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
15123 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
15124 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
15125 (the deletion will only happen when receiving new mail). You may also
15126 set @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
15127 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
15128 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{10} in alpha Gnusae
15129 and @code{2} in released Gnusae. @xref{Gnus Development}.
15130
15131 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15132 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15133 If non-@code{nil}, ask for confirmation before deleting old incoming
15134 files. This variable only applies when
15135 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
15136
15137 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
15138 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
15139 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
15140
15141 @item mail-source-directory
15142 @vindex mail-source-directory
15143 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
15144 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
15145 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
15146 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
15147
15148 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15149 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15150 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
15151 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
15152 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
15153 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
15154 number.
15155
15156 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
15157 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
15158 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is @code{#o600}.
15159
15160 @item mail-source-movemail-program
15161 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
15162 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
15163 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
15164
15165 @end table
15166
15167
15168 @node Fetching Mail
15169 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
15170
15171 @vindex mail-sources
15172 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
15173 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
15174 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
15175
15176 If this variable is @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to
15177 fetch mail by themselves.
15178
15179 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
15180 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
15181
15182 @lisp
15183 (setq mail-sources
15184 '((file)
15185 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15186 :password "secret")))
15187 @end lisp
15188
15189 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
15190
15191 @lisp
15192 (setq mail-sources
15193 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
15194 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15195 :user "user-name"
15196 :port "pop3"
15197 :password "secret")))
15198 @end lisp
15199
15200
15201 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
15202 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
15203 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
15204 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
15205 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
15206 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
15207
15208
15209
15210 @node Mail Back End Variables
15211 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
15212
15213 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
15214 mail back ends.
15215
15216 @table @code
15217 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15218 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15219 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
15220 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
15221
15222 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
15223 @item nnmail-split-hook
15224 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
15225 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
15226 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
15227 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
15228 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
15229 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
15230 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
15231 in the buffer will show up in any files.
15232 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
15233 to this hook.
15234
15235 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15236 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15237 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15238 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15239 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
15240 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
15241 starting to handle the new mail) and
15242 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
15243 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
15244 default file modes the new mail files get:
15245
15246 @lisp
15247 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15248 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o700)))
15249
15250 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15251 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o775)))
15252 @end lisp
15253
15254 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
15255 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
15256 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
15257 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
15258 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
15259 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
15260 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
15261
15262 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
15263 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
15264 @findex delete-file
15265 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
15266
15267 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15268 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15269 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
15270 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
15271 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
15272
15273 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15274 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15275 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
15276 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
15277 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
15278
15279 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
15280 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
15281 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
15282
15283 @end table
15284
15285
15286 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
15287 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
15288 @cindex mail splitting
15289 @cindex fancy mail splitting
15290
15291 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
15292 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
15293 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
15294 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
15295 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
15296 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
15297
15298 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
15299
15300 @lisp
15301 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
15302 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
15303 ;; @r{from real errors.}
15304 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
15305 "mail.misc"))
15306 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
15307 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
15308 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
15309 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
15310 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
15311 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
15312 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
15313 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
15314 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
15315 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
15316 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
15317 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
15318 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
15319 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
15320 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
15321 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
15322 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
15323 "misc.misc")
15324 @end lisp
15325
15326 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
15327 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
15328 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
15329
15330 @table @code
15331
15332 @item group
15333 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
15334 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
15335
15336 @c Don't fold this line.
15337 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
15338 The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
15339 first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
15340 @var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
15341 @var{split}.
15342
15343 If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
15344 @var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
15345 @var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
15346 @var{split} is processed.
15347
15348 The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
15349 non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
15350 variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
15351 be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15352
15353 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
15354 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
15355 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
15356 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
15357 stored in one or more groups.
15358
15359 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
15360 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
15361 process all @var{split}s in the list.
15362
15363 @item junk
15364 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
15365 this message. Use with extreme caution.
15366
15367 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
15368 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
15369 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
15370 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
15371
15372 @cindex body split
15373 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
15374 body of the messages:
15375
15376 @lisp
15377 (defun split-on-body ()
15378 (save-excursion
15379 (save-restriction
15380 (widen)
15381 (goto-char (point-min))
15382 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
15383 "string.group"))))
15384 @end lisp
15385
15386 The buffer is narrowed to the header of the message in question when
15387 @var{function} is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called
15388 after @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
15389 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
15390 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
15391 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
15392 (@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
15393
15394 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
15395 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
15396 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
15397 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
15398 should return a split.
15399
15400 @item nil
15401 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
15402
15403 @end table
15404
15405 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
15406
15407 Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
15408 according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
15409 @var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
15410 which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
15411 for example,
15412
15413 @example
15414 (any "joe" "joemail")
15415 @end example
15416
15417 @noindent
15418 messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
15419 in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
15420 of the following three ways:
15421
15422 @enumerate
15423 @item
15424 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
15425 You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
15426 to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
15427 match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
15428 words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
15429 @code{nil}.
15430
15431 Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
15432
15433 @item
15434 @var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
15435 a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
15436 in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
15437 @code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
15438 @code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
15439
15440 @item
15441 You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
15442 @samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
15443 section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
15444 are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15445 @code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
15446 ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15447 non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15448 @end enumerate
15449
15450 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
15451 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
15452 they are expanded as specified by the variable
15453 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
15454 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
15455 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
15456 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
15457
15458 @table @code
15459 @item from
15460 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
15461 @item to
15462 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
15463 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
15464 @item any
15465 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
15466 @end table
15467
15468 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
15469 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
15470 when all this splitting is performed.
15471
15472 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
15473 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
15474 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
15475
15476 @example
15477 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
15478 @end example
15479
15480 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
15481 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
15482
15483 If the string contains the element @samp{\\&}, then the previously
15484 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
15485 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
15486 groupings 1 through 9.
15487
15488 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
15489 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
15490 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
15491 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
15492 groups when users send to an address using different case
15493 (i.e., mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
15494 is @code{t}.
15495
15496 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
15497 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
15498 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
15499 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
15500 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
15501 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
15502 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
15503 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
15504 it once per thread.
15505
15506 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
15507 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
15508 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
15509 using the colon feature, like so:
15510 @lisp
15511 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
15512 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
15513 nnmail-split-fancy
15514 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
15515 ;; @r{other splits go here}
15516 ))
15517 @end lisp
15518
15519 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
15520 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
15521 in the file specified by the variable
15522 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
15523 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
15524 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
15525 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
15526 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
15527 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
15528 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
15529 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
15530 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
15531 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
15532 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
15533 300 kBytes in size.)
15534 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15535 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
15536 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
15537 messages goes into the new group.
15538
15539 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
15540 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
15541 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
15542 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
15543 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
15544 ``outgoing'' group.
15545
15546
15547 @node Group Mail Splitting
15548 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
15549 @cindex mail splitting
15550 @cindex group mail splitting
15551
15552 @findex gnus-group-split
15553 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
15554 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
15555 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
15556 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
15557 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
15558 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
15559 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
15560 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
15561
15562 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
15563 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
15564 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
15565 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
15566
15567 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
15568 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
15569 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
15570 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
15571 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
15572 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
15573 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
15574
15575 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
15576 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
15577 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
15578 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
15579 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
15580 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
15581 @code{gnus-group-split}.
15582
15583 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
15584 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
15585 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
15586 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
15587 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
15588 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
15589 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
15590 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
15591 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
15592 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
15593 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
15594 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
15595 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
15596
15597 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
15598 been defined:
15599
15600 @example
15601 nnml:mail.bar:
15602 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
15603 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
15604 nnml:mail.foo:
15605 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
15606 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
15607 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
15608 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
15609 nnml:mail.others:
15610 ((split-spec . catch-all))
15611 @end example
15612
15613 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
15614 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
15615 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
15616
15617 @lisp
15618 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
15619 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
15620 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
15621 "mail.others")
15622 @end lisp
15623
15624 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
15625 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
15626 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
15627 splits like this:
15628
15629 @lisp
15630 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
15631 @end lisp
15632
15633 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
15634 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
15635 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
15636 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
15637 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
15638 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
15639 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
15640 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
15641 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
15642
15643 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
15644 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
15645 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
15646 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
15647 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
15648 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
15649 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
15650 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
15651 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
15652
15653 @findex gnus-group-split-update
15654 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
15655 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
15656 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
15657 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
15658 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
15659
15660 @lisp
15661 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
15662 @end lisp
15663
15664 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
15665 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
15666 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
15667 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
15668 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
15669 value.
15670
15671 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
15672 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
15673 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
15674 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
15675
15676 @node Incorporating Old Mail
15677 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
15678 @cindex incorporating old mail
15679 @cindex import old mail
15680
15681 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
15682 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
15683 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
15684 your mail groups.
15685
15686 Doing so can be quite easy.
15687
15688 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
15689 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
15690 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
15691 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
15692 your @code{nnml} groups.
15693
15694 Here's how:
15695
15696 @enumerate
15697 @item
15698 Go to the group buffer.
15699
15700 @item
15701 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
15702 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15703
15704 @item
15705 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
15706
15707 @item
15708 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
15709 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
15710
15711 @item
15712 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
15713 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
15714 @end enumerate
15715
15716 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
15717 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
15718 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
15719 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
15720 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
15721
15722 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
15723 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
15724 using the new mail back end.
15725
15726
15727 @node Expiring Mail
15728 @subsection Expiring Mail
15729 @cindex article expiry
15730 @cindex expiring mail
15731
15732 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
15733 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
15734 different approach to mail reading.
15735
15736 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
15737 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
15738 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
15739 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
15740 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
15741 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
15742 course.
15743
15744 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
15745 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
15746 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
15747 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
15748 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
15749 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
15750 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
15751 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
15752 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
15753
15754 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-marks
15755 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
15756 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
15757 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
15758 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
15759 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
15760 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
15761 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} (and so on) are considered
15762 expirable. @code{gnus-auto-expirable-marks} has the full list of
15763 these marks.
15764
15765 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
15766 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
15767 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
15768 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
15769 into its own group.)
15770
15771 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
15772 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
15773 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
15774 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
15775 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
15776 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
15777 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
15778 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
15779 scoring.
15780
15781 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15782 Groups that match the regular expression
15783 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
15784 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
15785 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
15786
15787 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
15788 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
15789 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
15790 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
15791 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15792
15793 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
15794 @lisp
15795 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
15796 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
15797 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
15798 @end lisp
15799
15800 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
15801 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
15802 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
15803 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
15804 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
15805
15806 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
15807 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
15808
15809 @lisp
15810 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15811 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
15812 @end lisp
15813
15814 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
15815 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
15816
15817 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
15818 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
15819 don't really mix very well.
15820
15821 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
15822 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
15823 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
15824 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
15825 days.
15826
15827 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
15828 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
15829 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
15830 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
15831 everywhere else:
15832
15833 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15834 @lisp
15835 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15836 (lambda (group)
15837 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
15838 31)
15839 ((string= group "mail.junk")
15840 1)
15841 ((string= group "important")
15842 'never)
15843 (t
15844 6))))
15845 @end lisp
15846
15847 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
15848 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
15849
15850 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
15851 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
15852 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
15853 @code{never}.
15854
15855 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
15856 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
15857
15858 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
15859 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
15860 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
15861 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
15862 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
15863 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
15864 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
15865 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
15866 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
15867 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
15868 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
15869 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
15870 name or @code{delete}.
15871
15872 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
15873 @lisp
15874 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
15875 @end lisp
15876
15877 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15878 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15879 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
15880 expire mail to groups according to the variable
15881 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
15882
15883 @lisp
15884 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15885 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15886 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
15887 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
15888 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
15889 @end lisp
15890
15891 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
15892 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
15893 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
15894 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
15895 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
15896 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
15897
15898 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
15899 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
15900 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
15901 easier for procmail users.
15902
15903 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
15904 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
15905 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
15906 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
15907 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
15908 caution. Even more dangerous is the
15909 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
15910 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
15911 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
15912 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
15913 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
15914 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
15915 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
15916 with! So there!
15917
15918 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
15919
15920 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
15921 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
15922 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
15923 auto-expire turned on.
15924
15925 @vindex gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable
15926 The expirable marks of articles will be removed when copying or moving
15927 them to a group in which auto-expire is not turned on. This is for
15928 preventing articles from being expired unintentionally. On the other
15929 hand, to a group that has turned auto-expire on, the expirable marks of
15930 articles that are copied or moved will not be changed by default. I.e.,
15931 when copying or moving to such a group, articles that were expirable
15932 will be left expirable and ones that were not expirable will not be
15933 marked as expirable. So, even though in auto-expire groups, some
15934 articles will never get expired (unless you read them again). If you
15935 don't side with that behavior that unexpirable articles may be mixed
15936 into auto-expire groups, you can set
15937 @code{gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable} to a
15938 non-@code{nil} value. In that case, articles that have been read will
15939 be marked as expirable automatically when being copied or moved to a
15940 group that has auto-expire turned on. The default value is @code{nil}.
15941
15942
15943 @node Washing Mail
15944 @subsection Washing Mail
15945 @cindex mail washing
15946 @cindex list server brain damage
15947 @cindex incoming mail treatment
15948
15949 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
15950 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
15951 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
15952 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
15953 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
15954 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
15955
15956 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
15957 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
15958 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
15959 laugh.
15960
15961 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
15962 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
15963 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
15964 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
15965
15966 @table @code
15967 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15968 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15969 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
15970 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
15971 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
15972
15973 @table @code
15974 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15975 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15976 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
15977 Emacs running on MS machines.
15978
15979 @end table
15980
15981 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15982 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15983 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
15984 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
15985
15986 @table @code
15987 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15988 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15989 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
15990 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
15991
15992 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
15993 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
15994 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
15995 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
15996 into a feature by documenting it.)
15997
15998 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15999 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
16000 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
16001 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
16002 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
16003 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
16004 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
16005 @code{\\(..\\)}.
16006
16007 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
16008 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
16009
16010 @lisp
16011 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
16012 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
16013 @end lisp
16014
16015 This can also be done non-destructively with
16016 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
16017
16018 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
16019 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
16020 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
16021
16022 @item nnmail-ignore-broken-references
16023 @findex nnmail-ignore-broken-references
16024 @c @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
16025 @cindex Eudora
16026 @cindex Pegasus
16027 Some mail user agents (e.g., Eudora and Pegasus) produce broken
16028 @code{References} headers, but correct @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This
16029 function will get rid of the @code{References} header if the headers
16030 contain a line matching the regular expression
16031 @code{nnmail-broken-references-mailers}.
16032
16033 @end table
16034
16035 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
16036 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
16037 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
16038 include:
16039
16040 @table @code
16041 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
16042 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
16043 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
16044
16045 @end table
16046 @end table
16047
16048
16049 @node Duplicates
16050 @subsection Duplicates
16051
16052 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
16053 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
16054 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
16055 @cindex duplicate mails
16056 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
16057 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
16058 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
16059 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s:
16060 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
16061 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
16062 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
16063 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
16064 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
16065 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
16066 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
16067 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
16068 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
16069
16070 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
16071 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
16072 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
16073 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
16074
16075 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
16076 @code{nil}.
16077
16078 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
16079 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
16080 methods:
16081
16082 @lisp
16083 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
16084 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
16085 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
16086 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
16087 (any mail "mail.misc")
16088 ;; @r{Other rules.}
16089 [...] ))
16090 @end lisp
16091 @noindent
16092 Or something like:
16093 @lisp
16094 (setq nnmail-split-methods
16095 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
16096 ;; @r{Other rules.}
16097 [...]))
16098 @end lisp
16099
16100 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
16101 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
16102 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
16103 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
16104 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
16105
16106
16107 @node Not Reading Mail
16108 @subsection Not Reading Mail
16109
16110 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
16111 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
16112 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
16113
16114 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
16115 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
16116 mail, which should help.
16117
16118 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16119 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16120 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16121 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16122 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16123 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
16124 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old (pre-Emacs
16125 23) Rmail file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
16126 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
16127 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
16128 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
16129
16130 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
16131 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
16132 incoming mail.
16133
16134
16135 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
16136 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
16137
16138 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
16139 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
16140 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
16141
16142 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
16143 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
16144 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
16145 Spool}).
16146
16147 @menu
16148 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
16149 * Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
16150 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
16151 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
16152 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
16153 * nnmaildir Group Parameters::
16154 * Article Identification::
16155 * NOV Data::
16156 * Article Marks::
16157 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
16158 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
16159 @end menu
16160
16161
16162
16163 @node Unix Mail Box
16164 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
16165 @cindex nnmbox
16166 @cindex unix mail box
16167
16168 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16169 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16170 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
16171 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
16172 which group it belongs in.
16173
16174 Virtual server settings:
16175
16176 @table @code
16177 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
16178 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16179 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
16180 @file{~/mbox}.
16181
16182 @item nnmbox-active-file
16183 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16184 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
16185 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
16186
16187 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
16188 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16189 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
16190 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
16191 @end table
16192
16193
16194 @node Babyl
16195 @subsubsection Babyl
16196 @cindex nnbabyl
16197
16198 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16199 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16200 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box to store mail.
16201 @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each mail article to say which
16202 group it belongs in.
16203
16204 Virtual server settings:
16205
16206 @table @code
16207 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
16208 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16209 The name of the Babyl file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
16210
16211 @item nnbabyl-active-file
16212 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16213 The name of the active file for the Babyl file. The default is
16214 @file{~/.rmail-active}
16215
16216 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16217 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16218 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
16219 @code{t}
16220 @end table
16221
16222
16223 @node Mail Spool
16224 @subsubsection Mail Spool
16225 @cindex nnml
16226 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
16227
16228 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
16229 format. It should be used with some caution.
16230
16231 @vindex nnml-directory
16232 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
16233 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
16234 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
16235 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
16236
16237 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
16238 care of all that.
16239
16240 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
16241 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
16242 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
16243 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
16244 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
16245 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
16246 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
16247 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
16248
16249 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
16250 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
16251 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
16252 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
16253
16254 Virtual server settings:
16255
16256 @table @code
16257 @item nnml-directory
16258 @vindex nnml-directory
16259 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
16260 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
16261 is @file{~/Mail}).
16262
16263 @item nnml-active-file
16264 @vindex nnml-active-file
16265 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
16266 @file{~/Mail/active}.
16267
16268 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
16269 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
16270 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16271 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
16272
16273 @item nnml-get-new-mail
16274 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16275 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
16276 @code{t}.
16277
16278 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
16279 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
16280 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16281 default is @code{nil}.
16282
16283 @item nnml-nov-file-name
16284 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
16285 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
16286
16287 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16288 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16289 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
16290
16291 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
16292 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
16293 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
16294 files. This requires @code{auto-compression-mode} to be enabled
16295 (@pxref{Compressed Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
16296 If the value of @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is a string, it is used
16297 as the file extension specifying the compression program. You can set it
16298 to @samp{.bz2} if your Emacs supports it. A value of @code{t} is
16299 equivalent to @samp{.gz}.
16300
16301 @item nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16302 @vindex nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16303 Default size threshold for compressed message files. Message files with
16304 bodies larger than that many characters will be automatically compressed
16305 if @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil}.
16306
16307 @end table
16308
16309 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
16310 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
16311 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
16312 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
16313 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
16314 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
16315 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
16316 Commands}).
16317
16318
16319 @node MH Spool
16320 @subsubsection MH Spool
16321 @cindex nnmh
16322 @cindex mh-e mail spool
16323
16324 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
16325 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
16326 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
16327 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
16328 for.
16329
16330 Virtual server settings:
16331
16332 @table @code
16333 @item nnmh-directory
16334 @vindex nnmh-directory
16335 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
16336 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
16337 @file{~/Mail})
16338
16339 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
16340 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16341 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
16342 @code{t}.
16343
16344 @item nnmh-be-safe
16345 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
16346 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
16347 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
16348 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
16349 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
16350 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
16351 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
16352 @end table
16353
16354
16355 @node Maildir
16356 @subsubsection Maildir
16357 @cindex nnmaildir
16358 @cindex maildir
16359
16360 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
16361 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
16362 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
16363 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
16364 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
16365 within a maildir.
16366
16367 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
16368 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
16369 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
16370 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
16371 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
16372 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
16373 that appear as group in Gnus.
16374
16375 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
16376 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
16377 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
16378
16379 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
16380 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
16381 another, and you will keep your marks.
16382
16383 Virtual server settings:
16384
16385 @table @code
16386 @item directory
16387 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
16388 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
16389 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
16390 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
16391 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
16392 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
16393 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
16394 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
16395 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
16396 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
16397
16398 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
16399 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
16400 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
16401 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
16402 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
16403 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
16404 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
16405 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
16406 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
16407 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
16408 value.
16409
16410 @item target-prefix
16411 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
16412 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
16413 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
16414 closed.
16415
16416 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
16417 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
16418 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
16419 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
16420 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
16421 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
16422 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
16423 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
16424 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
16425
16426 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
16427 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
16428 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
16429 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
16430 symlinks pointing to them will be).
16431
16432 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
16433 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
16434 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
16435 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
16436 @code{force} argument.
16437
16438 @item directory-files
16439 This should be a function with the same interface as
16440 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
16441 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
16442 parameter is optional; the default is
16443 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
16444 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
16445 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
16446 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
16447 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
16448 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
16449
16450 @item get-new-mail
16451 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
16452 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
16453 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
16454 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
16455 value is @code{nil}.
16456
16457 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
16458 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
16459 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
16460 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
16461 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
16462 @end table
16463
16464 @node nnmaildir Group Parameters
16465 @subsubsection Group parameters
16466
16467 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
16468 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
16469 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
16470 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
16471 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
16472 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
16473 another back end.
16474
16475 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
16476 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
16477 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
16478 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
16479 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
16480 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
16481 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
16482 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
16483 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
16484
16485 @table @code
16486 @item expire-age
16487 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
16488 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
16489 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
16490 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
16491 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
16492 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
16493 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
16494 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
16495 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
16496 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
16497 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
16498 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
16499 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
16500
16501 @item expire-group
16502 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
16503 @example
16504 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
16505 @end example
16506 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
16507 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
16508 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
16509 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
16510 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
16511 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
16512 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
16513 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
16514 article. So that form can refer to
16515 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
16516 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
16517 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
16518 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
16519
16520 @item read-only
16521 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
16522 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
16523 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
16524 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
16525 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
16526 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
16527 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
16528 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
16529 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
16530 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
16531 contain extra copies of the articles.
16532
16533 @item directory-files
16534 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
16535 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
16536 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
16537 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
16538
16539 @item distrust-Lines:
16540 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
16541 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
16542 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
16543
16544 @item always-marks
16545 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
16546 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16547 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
16548 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
16549 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
16550 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16551
16552 @item never-marks
16553 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
16554 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16555 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
16556 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
16557 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
16558 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
16559 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16560
16561 @item nov-cache-size
16562 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
16563 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
16564 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
16565 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
16566 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
16567 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
16568 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
16569 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
16570 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
16571 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
16572 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
16573 @end table
16574
16575 @node Article Identification
16576 @subsubsection Article identification
16577 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
16578 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
16579 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
16580 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
16581 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
16582 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
16583 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
16584 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
16585 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
16586 request the article in the summary buffer.
16587
16588 @node NOV Data
16589 @subsubsection NOV data
16590 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
16591 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
16592 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
16593 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
16594 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
16595 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
16596 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
16597 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
16598 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
16599 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
16600 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
16601
16602 @node Article Marks
16603 @subsubsection Article marks
16604 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
16605 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
16606 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16607 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
16608 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16609 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
16610 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
16611 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
16612
16613 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
16614 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
16615 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
16616 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
16617 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
16618 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
16619 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
16620 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
16621 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
16622
16623
16624 @node Mail Folders
16625 @subsubsection Mail Folders
16626 @cindex nnfolder
16627 @cindex mbox folders
16628 @cindex mail folders
16629
16630 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
16631 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
16632 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
16633 numbers and arrival dates.
16634
16635 Virtual server settings:
16636
16637 @table @code
16638 @item nnfolder-directory
16639 @vindex nnfolder-directory
16640 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
16641 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
16642 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
16643
16644 @item nnfolder-active-file
16645 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
16646 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
16647
16648 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16649 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16650 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16651 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
16652
16653 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
16654 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16655 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
16656 default is @code{t}
16657
16658 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16659 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16660 @cindex backup files
16661 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
16662 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
16663 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
16664 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
16665
16666 @lisp
16667 (defun turn-off-backup ()
16668 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
16669
16670 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
16671 @end lisp
16672
16673 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16674 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16675 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
16676 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
16677 extract some information from it before removing it.
16678
16679 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16680 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16681 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16682 default is @code{nil}.
16683
16684 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16685 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16686 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
16687
16688 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
16689 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
16690 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
16691 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
16692
16693 @end table
16694
16695
16696 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
16697 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
16698 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
16699 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
16700 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
16701 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
16702 though.
16703
16704 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
16705 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
16706
16707 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
16708 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
16709 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
16710 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
16711 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
16712
16713 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
16714 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
16715 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
16716 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
16717 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
16718 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
16719 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
16720 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
16721 via NFS).
16722
16723 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
16724 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
16725 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
16726 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
16727
16728 @table @code
16729 @item nnmbox
16730
16731 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-defined
16732 format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
16733 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
16734 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
16735 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
16736 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
16737 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
16738 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
16739 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
16740 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
16741 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
16742 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
16743 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
16744 what's where.
16745
16746 @item nnbabyl
16747
16748 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
16749 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
16750 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
16751 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
16752 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
16753 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
16754 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
16755 Rmail was Emacs's first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
16756 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
16757 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
16758 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
16759 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
16760 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
16761 course, and is still maintained within Emacs. Since Emacs 23, it
16762 uses standard mbox format rather than Babyl.
16763
16764 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
16765 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
16766 look at your mail.
16767
16768 @item nnml
16769
16770 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
16771 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
16772 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
16773 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
16774 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
16775 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
16776 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
16777 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
16778 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
16779 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
16780 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
16781 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
16782 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
16783 provided by the active file and overviews.
16784
16785 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
16786 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
16787 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
16788 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
16789 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
16790 wins big.
16791
16792 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
16793 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
16794 tiny files.
16795
16796 @item nnmh
16797
16798 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
16799 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
16800 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
16801 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
16802 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
16803 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
16804 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
16805
16806 @item nnfolder
16807
16808 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
16809 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
16810 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
16811 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
16812 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
16813 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
16814 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
16815 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
16816 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
16817
16818 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
16819 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
16820 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
16821 friendly mail back end all over.
16822
16823 @item nnmaildir
16824
16825 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
16826 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
16827 mail back ends.
16828
16829 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
16830 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
16831 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
16832 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
16833 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}.
16834 (Use @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this
16835 slows you down or takes up very much space, a non-block-structured
16836 file system.
16837
16838 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
16839 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
16840 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
16841 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
16842 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
16843 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
16844 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
16845 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
16846 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
16847 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
16848 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
16849
16850 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
16851 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
16852 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
16853 else, and still have your marks.
16854
16855 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
16856 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
16857 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
16858 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
16859 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
16860 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
16861 removed in the future.
16862
16863 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
16864 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
16865 on your file system.
16866
16867 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
16868 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
16869
16870 @end table
16871
16872
16873 @node Browsing the Web
16874 @section Browsing the Web
16875 @cindex web
16876 @cindex browsing the web
16877 @cindex www
16878 @cindex http
16879
16880 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
16881 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
16882 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
16883 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
16884 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
16885 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
16886 even know what a news group is.
16887
16888 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
16889 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
16890 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
16891 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
16892 you mad in the end.
16893
16894 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
16895 to do it instead?
16896
16897 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
16898 interfaces to these sources.
16899
16900 @menu
16901 * Archiving Mail::
16902 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
16903 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
16904 @end menu
16905
16906 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
16907 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
16908 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
16909 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
16910 though, you should be ok.
16911
16912 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
16913 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
16914 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
16915 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
16916 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
16917
16918 @node Archiving Mail
16919 @subsection Archiving Mail
16920 @cindex archiving mail
16921 @cindex backup of mail
16922
16923 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
16924 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
16925 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
16926 marks is fairly simple.
16927
16928 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
16929 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
16930 though.)
16931
16932 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
16933 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
16934 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
16935 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
16936 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
16937 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
16938 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
16939 before you restore the data.
16940
16941 @node Web Searches
16942 @subsection Web Searches
16943 @cindex nnweb
16944 @cindex Google
16945 @cindex dejanews
16946 @cindex gmane
16947 @cindex Usenet searches
16948 @cindex searching the Usenet
16949
16950 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
16951 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
16952 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
16953 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
16954 searches without having to use a browser.
16955
16956 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
16957 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
16958 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
16959 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
16960 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
16961
16962 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
16963 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
16964 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
16965 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
16966 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
16967 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
16968 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
16969 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
16970 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
16971 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
16972 group as read.
16973
16974 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
16975 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
16976 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'être} is to
16977 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
16978 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
16979 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
16980
16981 Virtual server variables:
16982
16983 @table @code
16984 @item nnweb-type
16985 @vindex nnweb-type
16986 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
16987 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
16988 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
16989
16990 @item nnweb-search
16991 @vindex nnweb-search
16992 The search string to feed to the search engine.
16993
16994 @item nnweb-max-hits
16995 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
16996 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
16997 999.
16998
16999 @item nnweb-type-definition
17000 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
17001 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
17002 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
17003 present:
17004
17005 @table @code
17006 @item article
17007 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
17008 understands.
17009
17010 @item map
17011 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
17012
17013 @item search
17014 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
17015
17016 @item address
17017 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
17018 to.
17019
17020 @item id
17021 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
17022 @end table
17023
17024 @end table
17025
17026
17027 @node RSS
17028 @subsection RSS
17029 @cindex nnrss
17030 @cindex RSS
17031
17032 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
17033 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
17034 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
17035 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
17036 changes to a wiki (e.g., @url{http://cliki.net/site/recent-changes}).
17037
17038 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
17039 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
17040
17041 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
17042 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
17043 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
17044 group names.
17045
17046 @kindex G R (Group)
17047 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
17048 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
17049 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
17050 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
17051
17052 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
17053 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
17054 subscribe to groups.
17055
17056 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
17057 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
17058 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
17059 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
17060 variable or other. Also @xref{Non-ASCII Group Names}, for more
17061 information.
17062
17063 The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
17064 @acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
17065 and a @samp{text/html} part.
17066
17067 @cindex OPML
17068 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
17069 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
17070 Markup Language).
17071
17072 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
17073 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
17074 file.
17075 @end defun
17076
17077 @defun nnrss-opml-export
17078 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
17079 @acronym{OPML} format.
17080 @end defun
17081
17082 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
17083
17084 @table @code
17085 @item nnrss-directory
17086 @vindex nnrss-directory
17087 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
17088 @file{~/News/rss/}.
17089
17090 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
17091 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
17092 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
17093 data files. The default is the value of
17094 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
17095 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
17096
17097 @item nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17098 @vindex nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17099 Some feeds update constantly article fields during their publications,
17100 e.g., to indicate the number of comments. However, if there is
17101 a difference between the local article and the distant one, the latter
17102 is considered to be new. To avoid this and discard some fields, set this
17103 variable to the list of fields to be ignored. The default is
17104 @code{'(slash:comments)}.
17105
17106 @item nnrss-use-local
17107 @vindex nnrss-use-local
17108 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
17109 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
17110 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
17111 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
17112 download script using @command{wget}.
17113 @end table
17114
17115 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
17116 the summary buffer.
17117
17118 @lisp
17119 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
17120 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
17121
17122 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
17123 (let ((descr
17124 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
17125 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
17126 @end lisp
17127
17128 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
17129 summary buffer.
17130
17131 @lisp
17132 (require 'browse-url)
17133
17134 (defun browse-nnrss-url (arg)
17135 (interactive "p")
17136 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
17137 (mail-header-extra
17138 (gnus-data-header
17139 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
17140 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
17141 (if url
17142 (progn
17143 (browse-url (cdr url))
17144 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
17145 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
17146
17147 (eval-after-load "gnus"
17148 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
17149 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
17150 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
17151 @end lisp
17152
17153 Even if you have added @samp{text/html} to the
17154 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
17155 Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
17156 Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
17157 more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
17158 @samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
17159 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
17160 Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
17161 @code{nnrss} groups:
17162
17163 @lisp
17164 ;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
17165 (eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
17166 '(add-to-list
17167 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
17168 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
17169 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
17170
17171 ;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
17172 (add-to-list
17173 'gnus-parameters
17174 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
17175 @end lisp
17176
17177
17178 @node Other Sources
17179 @section Other Sources
17180
17181 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
17182 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
17183 newsgroups.
17184
17185 @menu
17186 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
17187 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
17188 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
17189 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
17190 * The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
17191 @end menu
17192
17193
17194 @node Directory Groups
17195 @subsection Directory Groups
17196 @cindex nndir
17197 @cindex directory groups
17198
17199 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
17200 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
17201 names, of course.
17202
17203 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
17204 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
17205 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
17206 back end to read directories. Big deal.
17207
17208 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
17209 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
17210 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
17211 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
17212 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
17213
17214 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
17215
17216 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
17217 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
17218 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
17219 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
17220
17221
17222 @node Anything Groups
17223 @subsection Anything Groups
17224 @cindex nneething
17225
17226 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
17227 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
17228 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
17229 true.
17230
17231 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
17232 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
17233 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
17234 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
17235 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
17236 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
17237 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
17238 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g., a C source file),
17239 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
17240 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
17241 elements.
17242
17243 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
17244 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
17245 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
17246 in the article buffer, just as usual.
17247
17248 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
17249 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
17250 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
17251 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
17252
17253 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
17254 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
17255 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
17256 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
17257 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
17258 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
17259 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
17260 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
17261
17262 Some variables:
17263
17264 @table @code
17265 @item nneething-map-file-directory
17266 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
17267 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
17268 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
17269
17270 @item nneething-exclude-files
17271 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
17272 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
17273 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
17274
17275 @item nneething-include-files
17276 @vindex nneething-include-files
17277 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
17278 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
17279
17280 @item nneething-map-file
17281 @vindex nneething-map-file
17282 Name of the map files.
17283 @end table
17284
17285
17286 @node Document Groups
17287 @subsection Document Groups
17288 @cindex nndoc
17289 @cindex documentation group
17290 @cindex help group
17291
17292 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
17293 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
17294
17295 @table @code
17296 @cindex Babyl
17297 @item babyl
17298 The Babyl format.
17299
17300 @cindex mbox
17301 @cindex Unix mbox
17302 @item mbox
17303 The standard Unix mbox file.
17304
17305 @cindex MMDF mail box
17306 @item mmdf
17307 The MMDF mail box format.
17308
17309 @item news
17310 Several news articles appended into a file.
17311
17312 @cindex rnews batch files
17313 @item rnews
17314 The rnews batch transport format.
17315
17316 @item nsmail
17317 Netscape mail boxes.
17318
17319 @item mime-parts
17320 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
17321
17322 @item standard-digest
17323 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
17324
17325 @item mime-digest
17326 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
17327
17328 @item lanl-gov-announce
17329 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
17330
17331 @cindex git commit messages
17332 @item git
17333 @code{git} commit messages.
17334
17335 @cindex forwarded messages
17336 @item rfc822-forward
17337 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
17338
17339 @item outlook
17340 The Outlook mail box.
17341
17342 @item oe-dbx
17343 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
17344
17345 @item exim-bounce
17346 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
17347
17348 @item forward
17349 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
17350
17351 @item rfc934
17352 An RFC934-forwarded message.
17353
17354 @item mailman
17355 A mailman digest.
17356
17357 @item clari-briefs
17358 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
17359
17360 @item slack-digest
17361 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
17362
17363 @item mail-in-mail
17364 The last resort.
17365 @end table
17366
17367 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
17368 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
17369 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
17370 file is.
17371
17372 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
17373 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
17374 group. And that's it.
17375
17376 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
17377 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
17378 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
17379 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
17380 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
17381 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
17382 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
17383 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
17384 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
17385 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
17386
17387 Virtual server variables:
17388
17389 @table @code
17390 @item nndoc-article-type
17391 @vindex nndoc-article-type
17392 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
17393 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
17394 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
17395 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
17396 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
17397
17398 @item nndoc-post-type
17399 @vindex nndoc-post-type
17400 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
17401 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
17402 and @code{news}.
17403 @end table
17404
17405 @menu
17406 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
17407 @end menu
17408
17409
17410 @node Document Server Internals
17411 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
17412
17413 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
17414 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
17415 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
17416 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
17417
17418 First, here's an example document type definition:
17419
17420 @example
17421 (mmdf
17422 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
17423 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
17424 @end example
17425
17426 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
17427 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
17428 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
17429 types can be defined with very few settings:
17430
17431 @table @code
17432 @item first-article
17433 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
17434 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
17435 totally ignored.
17436
17437 @item article-begin
17438 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
17439 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
17440 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
17441 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
17442
17443 @item article-begin-function
17444 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
17445 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
17446
17447 @item head-begin
17448 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
17449 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17450 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
17451
17452 @item head-begin-function
17453 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17454 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
17455
17456 @item head-end
17457 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17458 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
17459
17460 @item body-begin
17461 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17462 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17463 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
17464
17465 @item body-begin-function
17466 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17467 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
17468
17469 @item body-end
17470 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17471 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17472 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
17473
17474 @item body-end-function
17475 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17476 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17477
17478 @item file-begin
17479 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17480 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17481
17482 @item file-end
17483 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17484 regexp will be totally ignored.
17485
17486 @end table
17487
17488 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17489 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17490 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17491 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17492 something that's palatable for Gnus:
17493
17494 @table @code
17495 @item prepare-body-function
17496 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17497 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17498 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
17499
17500 @item article-transform-function
17501 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17502 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17503 body of the article.
17504
17505 @item generate-head-function
17506 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17507 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17508 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17509 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
17510
17511 @item generate-article-function
17512 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17513 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17514 parameter when requesting all articles.
17515
17516 @item dissection-function
17517 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17518 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17519 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17520 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17521 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17522 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17523
17524 @end table
17525
17526 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17527 digests:
17528
17529 @example
17530 (standard-digest
17531 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17532 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17533 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17534 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17535 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17536 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17537 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17538 (subtype digest guess))
17539 @end example
17540
17541 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17542 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17543 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17544 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17545 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17546
17547 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17548 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17549 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17550 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17551 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17552 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17553 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17554 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17555 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17556 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17557 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17558 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17559
17560
17561 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17562 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17563 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17564 @cindex gateways
17565
17566 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17567 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17568 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17569
17570 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17571 used to post with.
17572
17573 Server variables:
17574
17575 @table @code
17576 @item nngateway-address
17577 @vindex nngateway-address
17578 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17579
17580 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17581 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17582 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17583 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17584 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17585 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17586 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17587 gateway address.
17588
17589 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17590 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17591 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17592
17593 @example
17594 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17595 @end example
17596
17597 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17598
17599 @example
17600 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17601 @end example
17602
17603 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17604
17605 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17606 @table @code
17607
17608 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17609 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17610 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17611
17612 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17613
17614 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17615 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17616 @code{nngateway-address}.
17617 @end table
17618
17619 @end table
17620
17621 Here's an example:
17622
17623 @lisp
17624 (setq gnus-post-method
17625 '(nngateway
17626 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17627 (nngateway-header-transformation
17628 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17629 @end lisp
17630
17631 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17632
17633 @lisp
17634 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17635 @end lisp
17636
17637
17638 @node The Empty Backend
17639 @subsection The Empty Backend
17640 @cindex nnnil
17641
17642 @code{nnnil} is a backend that can be used as a placeholder if you
17643 have to specify a backend somewhere, but don't really want to. The
17644 classical example is if you don't want to have a primary select
17645 methods, but want to only use secondary ones:
17646
17647 @lisp
17648 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnnil ""))
17649 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
17650 '((nnimap "foo")
17651 (nnml "")))
17652 @end lisp
17653
17654
17655 @node Combined Groups
17656 @section Combined Groups
17657
17658 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17659 groups.
17660
17661 @menu
17662 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17663 @end menu
17664
17665
17666 @node Virtual Groups
17667 @subsection Virtual Groups
17668 @cindex nnvirtual
17669 @cindex virtual groups
17670 @cindex merging groups
17671
17672 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17673 other groups.
17674
17675 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17676 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17677 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17678
17679 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17680 regexp to match component groups.
17681
17682 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17683 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17684 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17685 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17686 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17687 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17688 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17689 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17690
17691 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17692 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17693
17694 @lisp
17695 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17696 @end lisp
17697
17698 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17699 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17700
17701 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17702 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17703 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17704 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17705
17706 @example
17707 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17708 @end example
17709
17710 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17711 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17712 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17713
17714 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17715 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17716 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17717 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17718 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17719
17720 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17721 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17722 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17723
17724 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17725 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
17726 is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
17727 articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
17728 and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
17729 been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
17730 when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
17731 have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
17732 that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
17733 just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
17734 it---it'll have much the same effect.
17735
17736 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17737 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17738 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17739 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17740 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17741 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17742 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17743
17744 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17745 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17746
17747 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17748 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17749 inherited.
17750
17751
17752 @node Email Based Diary
17753 @section Email Based Diary
17754 @cindex diary
17755 @cindex email based diary
17756 @cindex calendar
17757
17758 This section describes a special mail back end called @code{nndiary},
17759 and its companion library @code{gnus-diary}. It is ``special'' in the
17760 sense that it is not meant to be one of the standard alternatives for
17761 reading mail with Gnus. See @ref{Choosing a Mail Back End} for that.
17762 Instead, it is used to treat @emph{some} of your mails in a special way,
17763 namely, as event reminders.
17764
17765 Here is a typical scenario:
17766
17767 @itemize @bullet
17768 @item
17769 You've got a date with Andy Mc Dowell or Bruce Willis (select according
17770 to your sexual preference) in one month. You don't want to forget it.
17771 @item
17772 So you send a ``reminder'' message (actually, a diary one) to yourself.
17773 @item
17774 You forget all about it and keep on getting and reading new mail, as usual.
17775 @item
17776 From time to time, as you type @kbd{g} in the group buffer and as the date
17777 is getting closer, the message will pop up again to remind you of your
17778 appointment, just as if it were new and unread.
17779 @item
17780 Read your ``new'' messages, this one included, and start dreaming again
17781 of the night you're gonna have.
17782 @item
17783 Once the date is over (you actually fell asleep just after dinner), the
17784 message will be automatically deleted if it is marked as expirable.
17785 @end itemize
17786
17787 The Gnus Diary back end has the ability to handle regular appointments
17788 (that wouldn't ever be deleted) as well as punctual ones, operates as a
17789 real mail back end and is configurable in many ways. All of this is
17790 explained in the sections below.
17791
17792 @menu
17793 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
17794 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
17795 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
17796 @end menu
17797
17798
17799 @node The NNDiary Back End
17800 @subsection The NNDiary Back End
17801 @cindex nndiary
17802 @cindex the nndiary back end
17803
17804 @code{nndiary} is a back end very similar to @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
17805 Spool}). Actually, it could appear as a mix of @code{nnml} and
17806 @code{nndraft}. If you know @code{nnml}, you're already familiar with
17807 the message storing scheme of @code{nndiary}: one file per message, one
17808 directory per group.
17809
17810 Before anything, there is one requirement to be able to run
17811 @code{nndiary} properly: you @emph{must} use the group timestamp feature
17812 of Gnus. This adds a timestamp to each group's parameters. @ref{Group
17813 Timestamp} to see how it's done.
17814
17815 @menu
17816 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
17817 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
17818 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
17819 @end menu
17820
17821 @node Diary Messages
17822 @subsubsection Diary Messages
17823 @cindex nndiary messages
17824 @cindex nndiary mails
17825
17826 @code{nndiary} messages are just normal ones, except for the mandatory
17827 presence of 7 special headers. These headers are of the form
17828 @code{X-Diary-<something>}, @code{<something>} being one of
17829 @code{Minute}, @code{Hour}, @code{Dom}, @code{Month}, @code{Year},
17830 @code{Time-Zone} and @code{Dow}. @code{Dom} means ``Day of Month'', and
17831 @code{dow} means ``Day of Week''. These headers actually behave like
17832 crontab specifications and define the event date(s):
17833
17834 @itemize @bullet
17835 @item
17836 For all headers except the @code{Time-Zone} one, a header value is
17837 either a star (meaning all possible values), or a list of fields
17838 (separated by a comma).
17839 @item
17840 A field is either an integer, or a range.
17841 @item
17842 A range is two integers separated by a dash.
17843 @item
17844 Possible integer values are 0--59 for @code{Minute}, 0--23 for
17845 @code{Hour}, 1--31 for @code{Dom}, 1--12 for @code{Month}, above 1971
17846 for @code{Year} and 0--6 for @code{Dow} (0 meaning Sunday).
17847 @item
17848 As a special case, a star in either @code{Dom} or @code{Dow} doesn't
17849 mean ``all possible values'', but ``use only the other field''. Note
17850 that if both are star'ed, the use of either one gives the same result.
17851 @item
17852 The @code{Time-Zone} header is special in that it can only have one
17853 value (@code{GMT}, for instance). A star doesn't mean ``all possible
17854 values'' (because it makes no sense), but ``the current local time
17855 zone''. Most of the time, you'll be using a star here. However, for a
17856 list of available time zone values, see the variable
17857 @code{nndiary-headers}.
17858 @end itemize
17859
17860 As a concrete example, here are the diary headers to add to your message
17861 for specifying ``Each Monday and each 1st of month, at 12:00, 20:00,
17862 21:00, 22:00, 23:00 and 24:00, from 1999 to 2010'' (I'll let you find
17863 what to do then):
17864
17865 @example
17866 X-Diary-Minute: 0
17867 X-Diary-Hour: 12, 20-24
17868 X-Diary-Dom: 1
17869 X-Diary-Month: *
17870 X-Diary-Year: 1999-2010
17871 X-Diary-Dow: 1
17872 X-Diary-Time-Zone: *
17873 @end example
17874
17875 @node Running NNDiary
17876 @subsubsection Running NNDiary
17877 @cindex running nndiary
17878 @cindex nndiary operation modes
17879
17880 @code{nndiary} has two modes of operation: ``traditional'' (the default)
17881 and ``autonomous''. In traditional mode, @code{nndiary} does not get new
17882 mail by itself. You have to move (@kbd{B m}) or copy (@kbd{B c}) mails
17883 from your primary mail back end to nndiary groups in order to handle them
17884 as diary messages. In autonomous mode, @code{nndiary} retrieves its own
17885 mail and handles it independently from your primary mail back end.
17886
17887 One should note that Gnus is not inherently designed to allow several
17888 ``master'' mail back ends at the same time. However, this does make
17889 sense with @code{nndiary}: you really want to send and receive diary
17890 messages to your diary groups directly. So, @code{nndiary} supports
17891 being sort of a ``second primary mail back end'' (to my knowledge, it is
17892 the only back end offering this feature). However, there is a limitation
17893 (which I hope to fix some day): respooling doesn't work in autonomous
17894 mode.
17895
17896 In order to use @code{nndiary} in autonomous mode, you have several
17897 things to do:
17898
17899 @itemize @bullet
17900 @item
17901 Allow @code{nndiary} to retrieve new mail by itself. Put the following
17902 line in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17903
17904 @lisp
17905 (setq nndiary-get-new-mail t)
17906 @end lisp
17907 @item
17908 You must arrange for diary messages (those containing @code{X-Diary-*}
17909 headers) to be split in a private folder @emph{before} Gnus treat them.
17910 Again, this is needed because Gnus cannot (yet ?) properly handle
17911 multiple primary mail back ends. Getting those messages from a separate
17912 source will compensate this misfeature to some extent.
17913
17914 As an example, here's my procmailrc entry to store diary files in
17915 @file{~/.nndiary} (the default @code{nndiary} mail source file):
17916
17917 @example
17918 :0 HD :
17919 * ^X-Diary
17920 .nndiary
17921 @end example
17922 @end itemize
17923
17924 Once this is done, you might want to customize the following two options
17925 that affect the diary mail retrieval and splitting processes:
17926
17927 @defvar nndiary-mail-sources
17928 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17929 @code{mail-sources} variable. It obeys the same syntax, and defaults to
17930 @code{(file :path "~/.nndiary")}.
17931 @end defvar
17932
17933 @defvar nndiary-split-methods
17934 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17935 @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable. It obeys the same syntax.
17936 @end defvar
17937
17938 Finally, you may add a permanent @code{nndiary} virtual server
17939 (something like @code{(nndiary "diary")} should do) to your
17940 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}.
17941
17942 Hopefully, almost everything (see the TODO section in
17943 @file{nndiary.el}) will work as expected when you restart Gnus: in
17944 autonomous mode, typing @kbd{g} and @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer, will
17945 also get your new diary mails and split them according to your
17946 diary-specific rules, @kbd{F} will find your new diary groups etc.
17947
17948 @node Customizing NNDiary
17949 @subsubsection Customizing NNDiary
17950 @cindex customizing nndiary
17951 @cindex nndiary customization
17952
17953 Now that @code{nndiary} is up and running, it's time to customize it.
17954 The custom group is called @code{nndiary} (no, really ?!). You should
17955 browse it to figure out which options you'd like to tweak. The following
17956 two variables are probably the only ones you will want to change:
17957
17958 @defvar nndiary-reminders
17959 This is the list of times when you want to be reminded of your
17960 appointments (e.g., 3 weeks before, then 2 days before, then 1 hour
17961 before and that's it). Remember that ``being reminded'' means that the
17962 diary message will pop up as brand new and unread again when you get new
17963 mail.
17964 @end defvar
17965
17966 @defvar nndiary-week-starts-on-monday
17967 Rather self-explanatory. Otherwise, Sunday is assumed (this is the
17968 default).
17969 @end defvar
17970
17971
17972 @node The Gnus Diary Library
17973 @subsection The Gnus Diary Library
17974 @cindex gnus-diary
17975 @cindex the gnus diary library
17976
17977 Using @code{nndiary} manually (I mean, writing the headers by hand and
17978 so on) would be rather boring. Fortunately, there is a library called
17979 @code{gnus-diary} written on top of @code{nndiary}, that does many
17980 useful things for you.
17981
17982 In order to use it, add the following line to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17983
17984 @lisp
17985 (require 'gnus-diary)
17986 @end lisp
17987
17988 Also, you shouldn't use any @code{gnus-user-format-function-[d|D]}
17989 (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} provides both of these
17990 (sorry if you used them before).
17991
17992
17993 @menu
17994 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
17995 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
17996 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
17997 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
17998 @end menu
17999
18000 @node Diary Summary Line Format
18001 @subsubsection Diary Summary Line Format
18002 @cindex diary summary buffer line
18003 @cindex diary summary line format
18004
18005 Displaying diary messages in standard summary line format (usually
18006 something like @samp{From Joe: Subject}) is pretty useless. Most of
18007 the time, you're the one who wrote the message, and you mostly want to
18008 see the event's date.
18009
18010 @code{gnus-diary} provides two supplemental user formats to be used in
18011 summary line formats. @code{D} corresponds to a formatted time string
18012 for the next occurrence of the event (e.g., ``Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00''),
18013 while @code{d} corresponds to an approximate remaining time until the
18014 next occurrence of the event (e.g., ``in 6 months, 1 week'').
18015
18016 For example, here's how Joe's birthday is displayed in my
18017 @code{nndiary+diary:birthdays} summary buffer (note that the message is
18018 expirable, but will never be deleted, as it specifies a periodic event):
18019
18020 @example
18021 E Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00: Joe's birthday (in 6 months, 1 week)
18022 @end example
18023
18024 In order to get something like the above, you would normally add the
18025 following line to your diary groups'parameters:
18026
18027 @lisp
18028 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z %uD: %(%s%) (%ud)\n")
18029 @end lisp
18030
18031 However, @code{gnus-diary} does it automatically (@pxref{Diary Group
18032 Parameters}). You can however customize the provided summary line format
18033 with the following user options:
18034
18035 @defvar gnus-diary-summary-line-format
18036 Defines the summary line format used for diary groups (@pxref{Summary
18037 Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} uses it to automatically update the
18038 diary groups'parameters.
18039 @end defvar
18040
18041 @defvar gnus-diary-time-format
18042 Defines the format to display dates in diary summary buffers. This is
18043 used by the @code{D} user format. See the docstring for details.
18044 @end defvar
18045
18046 @defvar gnus-diary-delay-format-function
18047 Defines the format function to use for displaying delays (remaining
18048 times) in diary summary buffers. This is used by the @code{d} user
18049 format. There are currently built-in functions for English and French;
18050 you can also define your own. See the docstring for details.
18051 @end defvar
18052
18053 @node Diary Articles Sorting
18054 @subsubsection Diary Articles Sorting
18055 @cindex diary articles sorting
18056 @cindex diary summary lines sorting
18057 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule
18058 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule
18059 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-schedule
18060
18061 @code{gnus-diary} provides new sorting functions (@pxref{Sorting the
18062 Summary Buffer} ) called @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule},
18063 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule} and
18064 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-schedule}. These functions let you organize
18065 your diary summary buffers from the closest event to the farthest one.
18066
18067 @code{gnus-diary} automatically installs
18068 @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule} as a menu item in the summary
18069 buffer's ``sort'' menu, and the two others as the primary (hence
18070 default) sorting functions in the group parameters (@pxref{Diary Group
18071 Parameters}).
18072
18073 @node Diary Headers Generation
18074 @subsubsection Diary Headers Generation
18075 @cindex diary headers generation
18076 @findex gnus-diary-check-message
18077
18078 @code{gnus-diary} provides a function called
18079 @code{gnus-diary-check-message} to help you handle the @code{X-Diary-*}
18080 headers. This function ensures that the current message contains all the
18081 required diary headers, and prompts you for values or corrections if
18082 needed.
18083
18084 This function is hooked into the @code{nndiary} back end, so that
18085 moving or copying an article to a diary group will trigger it
18086 automatically. It is also bound to @kbd{C-c C-f d} in
18087 @code{message-mode} and @code{article-edit-mode} in order to ease the
18088 process of converting a usual mail to a diary one.
18089
18090 This function takes a prefix argument which will force prompting of
18091 all diary headers, regardless of their presence or validity. That way,
18092 you can very easily reschedule an already valid diary message, for
18093 instance.
18094
18095 @node Diary Group Parameters
18096 @subsubsection Diary Group Parameters
18097 @cindex diary group parameters
18098
18099 When you create a new diary group, or visit one, @code{gnus-diary}
18100 automatically checks your group parameters and if needed, sets the
18101 summary line format to the diary-specific value, installs the
18102 diary-specific sorting functions, and also adds the different
18103 @code{X-Diary-*} headers to the group's posting-style. It is then easier
18104 to send a diary message, because if you use @kbd{C-u a} or @kbd{C-u m}
18105 on a diary group to prepare a message, these headers will be inserted
18106 automatically (although not filled with proper values yet).
18107
18108 @node Sending or Not Sending
18109 @subsection Sending or Not Sending
18110
18111 Well, assuming you've read all of the above, here are two final notes on
18112 mail sending with @code{nndiary}:
18113
18114 @itemize @bullet
18115 @item
18116 @code{nndiary} is a @emph{real} mail back end. You really send real diary
18117 messages for real. This means for instance that you can give
18118 appointments to anybody (provided they use Gnus and @code{nndiary}) by
18119 sending the diary message to them as well.
18120 @item
18121 However, since @code{nndiary} also has a @code{request-post} method, you
18122 can also use @kbd{C-u a} instead of @kbd{C-u m} on a diary group and the
18123 message won't actually be sent; just stored locally in the group. This
18124 comes in very handy for private appointments.
18125 @end itemize
18126
18127 @node Gnus Unplugged
18128 @section Gnus Unplugged
18129 @cindex offline
18130 @cindex unplugged
18131 @cindex agent
18132 @cindex Gnus agent
18133 @cindex Gnus unplugged
18134
18135 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
18136 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
18137 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
18138 read news. Believe it or not.
18139
18140 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
18141 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
18142 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
18143 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
18144 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
18145
18146 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
18147 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
18148 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
18149 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
18150 reading news on a machine.
18151
18152 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
18153 fact, you don't have to configure anything as the agent is now enabled
18154 by default (@pxref{Agent Variables, gnus-agent}).
18155
18156 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
18157
18158 @menu
18159 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
18160 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
18161 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
18162 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
18163 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
18164 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
18165 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
18166 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
18167 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
18168 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
18169 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
18170 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
18171 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
18172 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
18173 @end menu
18174
18175
18176 @node Agent Basics
18177 @subsection Agent Basics
18178
18179 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
18180
18181 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
18182 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
18183 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
18184 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
18185
18186 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
18187 connected to the net continuously.
18188
18189 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
18190 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
18191
18192 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
18193 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
18194 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
18195 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
18196 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
18197
18198 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
18199 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
18200 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
18201 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
18202 they're kinda like plugged always).
18203
18204 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
18205 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
18206 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
18207 the culprit.
18208
18209 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
18210 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
18211 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
18212 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
18213 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
18214
18215 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
18216
18217 @itemize @bullet
18218
18219 @item
18220 @findex gnus-unplugged
18221 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
18222 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
18223 already fetched while in this mode.
18224
18225 @item
18226 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
18227 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
18228 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
18229 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
18230 Source Specifiers}).
18231
18232 @item
18233 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
18234 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
18235 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
18236 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
18237 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
18238
18239 @item
18240 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
18241 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
18242 then you read the news offline.
18243
18244 @item
18245 And then you go to step 2.
18246 @end itemize
18247
18248 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
18249 the Agent.
18250
18251 @itemize @bullet
18252
18253 @item
18254 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
18255 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
18256 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
18257 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
18258 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
18259 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
18260 no servers are agentized.
18261
18262 @item
18263 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
18264 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
18265 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
18266 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
18267
18268 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
18269 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
18270 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
18271 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
18272 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
18273 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
18274 configure them.
18275
18276 @item
18277 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
18278 @end itemize
18279
18280
18281 @node Agent Categories
18282 @subsection Agent Categories
18283
18284 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
18285 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
18286 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
18287 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
18288 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
18289 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
18290 you're interested in the articles anyway.
18291
18292 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
18293 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
18294 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
18295 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
18296 buffer for creating and managing categories.
18297
18298 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
18299 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
18300 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
18301 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
18302 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
18303 sink.
18304
18305 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
18306 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
18307 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
18308 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
18309 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
18310 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
18311 your settings.
18312
18313 @menu
18314 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
18315 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
18316 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
18317 @end menu
18318
18319
18320 @node Category Syntax
18321 @subsubsection Category Syntax
18322
18323 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
18324 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
18325 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
18326 listed below.
18327
18328 @cindex Agent Parameters
18329 @table @code
18330 @item agent-groups
18331 The list of groups that are in this category.
18332
18333 @item agent-predicate
18334 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
18335 are eligible for downloading; and
18336
18337 @item agent-score
18338 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
18339 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
18340 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
18341
18342 @item agent-enable-expiration
18343 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
18344 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
18345 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
18346 only groups that should not be expired.
18347
18348 @item agent-days-until-old
18349 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
18350 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
18351
18352 @item agent-low-score
18353 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
18354
18355 @item agent-high-score
18356 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
18357
18358 @item agent-short-article
18359 an integer that overrides the value of
18360 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
18361
18362 @item agent-long-article
18363 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
18364
18365 @item agent-enable-undownloaded-faces
18366 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
18367 undownloaded articles using the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face}
18368 faces. Any symbol other than @code{nil} will enable the use of
18369 undownloaded faces.
18370 @end table
18371
18372 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
18373 created.
18374
18375 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
18376 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
18377 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
18378 category.
18379
18380 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
18381 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
18382 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
18383 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
18384
18385 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
18386 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
18387 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
18388
18389 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
18390 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
18391 operators sprinkled in between.
18392
18393 Perhaps some examples are in order.
18394
18395 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
18396 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
18397
18398 @lisp
18399 short
18400 @end lisp
18401
18402 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
18403 short (for some value of ``short'').
18404
18405 Here's a more complex predicate:
18406
18407 @lisp
18408 (or high
18409 (and
18410 (not low)
18411 (not long)))
18412 @end lisp
18413
18414 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
18415 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
18416 drift.
18417
18418 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
18419 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
18420 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
18421
18422 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
18423 you want to do, you can write your own.
18424
18425 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
18426 bound to the value determined by calling
18427 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
18428 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
18429 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
18430 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
18431 predicate to individual groups.
18432
18433 @table @code
18434 @item short
18435 True if the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
18436 lines; default 100.
18437
18438 @item long
18439 True if the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
18440 lines; default 200.
18441
18442 @item low
18443 True if the article has a download score less than
18444 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
18445
18446 @item high
18447 True if the article has a download score greater than
18448 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
18449
18450 @item spam
18451 True if the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
18452 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
18453 checksum and sees whether articles match.
18454
18455 @item true
18456 Always true.
18457
18458 @item false
18459 Always false.
18460 @end table
18461
18462 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
18463 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
18464 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
18465 useful values.
18466
18467 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
18468 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g., posted
18469 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
18470 something along the lines of the following:
18471
18472 @lisp
18473 (defun my-article-old-p ()
18474 "Say whether an article is old."
18475 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
18476 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
18477 @end lisp
18478
18479 with the predicate then defined as:
18480
18481 @lisp
18482 (not my-article-old-p)
18483 @end lisp
18484
18485 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
18486 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
18487 wherever.
18488
18489 @lisp
18490 (require 'gnus-agent)
18491 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
18492 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
18493 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
18494 @end lisp
18495
18496 and simply specify your predicate as:
18497
18498 @lisp
18499 (not old)
18500 @end lisp
18501
18502 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
18503 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
18504 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
18505 just don't give a damn.
18506
18507 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
18508 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
18509 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
18510 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
18511 parameters like so:
18512
18513 @lisp
18514 (agent-predicate . short)
18515 @end lisp
18516
18517 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
18518 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
18519 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
18520
18521 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
18522
18523 @lisp
18524 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
18525 @end lisp
18526
18527 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
18528 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18529 predicate is assumed to be a list.
18530
18531
18532 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18533 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18534 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18535 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18536 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18537 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
18538
18539 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18540 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18541 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18542 if it's to be specific to that group.
18543
18544 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18545 three forms:
18546
18547 @enumerate
18548 @item
18549 Score rule
18550
18551 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18552 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
18553
18554 example:
18555
18556 @itemize @bullet
18557 @item
18558 Category specification
18559
18560 @lisp
18561 (("from"
18562 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18563 ("lines"
18564 (500 -100 nil <)))
18565 @end lisp
18566
18567 @item
18568 Group/Topic Parameter specification
18569
18570 @lisp
18571 (agent-score ("from"
18572 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18573 ("lines"
18574 (500 -100 nil <)))
18575 @end lisp
18576
18577 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18578 @end itemize
18579
18580 @item
18581 Agent score file
18582
18583 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18584 keywords stated above.
18585
18586 example:
18587
18588 @itemize @bullet
18589 @item
18590 Category specification
18591
18592 @lisp
18593 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18594 @end lisp
18595
18596 or perhaps
18597
18598 @lisp
18599 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18600 @end lisp
18601
18602 @item
18603 Group Parameter specification
18604
18605 @lisp
18606 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18607 @end lisp
18608
18609 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18610 about parenthesis?
18611 @end itemize
18612
18613 @item
18614 Use @code{normal} score files
18615
18616 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18617 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18618 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18619 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18620
18621 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18622 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18623 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18624 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18625
18626 @itemize @bullet
18627 @item
18628 Category Specification
18629
18630 @lisp
18631 file
18632 @end lisp
18633
18634 @item
18635 Group Parameter specification
18636
18637 @lisp
18638 (agent-score . file)
18639 @end lisp
18640 @end itemize
18641 @end enumerate
18642
18643 @node Category Buffer
18644 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18645
18646 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18647 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18648 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18649
18650 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18651
18652 @table @kbd
18653 @item q
18654 @kindex q (Category)
18655 @findex gnus-category-exit
18656 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18657
18658 @item e
18659 @kindex e (Category)
18660 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18661 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18662 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18663
18664 @item k
18665 @kindex k (Category)
18666 @findex gnus-category-kill
18667 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18668
18669 @item c
18670 @kindex c (Category)
18671 @findex gnus-category-copy
18672 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18673
18674 @item a
18675 @kindex a (Category)
18676 @findex gnus-category-add
18677 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18678
18679 @item p
18680 @kindex p (Category)
18681 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18682 Edit the predicate of the current category
18683 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18684
18685 @item g
18686 @kindex g (Category)
18687 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18688 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18689 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18690
18691 @item s
18692 @kindex s (Category)
18693 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18694 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18695 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18696
18697 @item l
18698 @kindex l (Category)
18699 @findex gnus-category-list
18700 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18701 @end table
18702
18703
18704 @node Category Variables
18705 @subsubsection Category Variables
18706
18707 @table @code
18708 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18709 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18710 Hook run in category buffers.
18711
18712 @item gnus-category-line-format
18713 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18714 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18715 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18716
18717 @table @samp
18718 @item c
18719 The name of the category.
18720
18721 @item g
18722 The number of groups in the category.
18723 @end table
18724
18725 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18726 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18727 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18728
18729 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18730 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18731 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18732
18733 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18734 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18735 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18736
18737 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18738 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18739 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18740 0.
18741
18742 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18743 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18744 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18745 0.
18746
18747 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18748 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18749 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18750 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18751 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18752 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18753 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18754 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18755 read.
18756 Default 7.
18757
18758 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18759 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18760 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18761 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18762 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18763 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18764 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18765
18766 @end table
18767
18768
18769 @node Agent Commands
18770 @subsection Agent Commands
18771 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18772 @kindex J j (Agent)
18773
18774 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18775 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18776 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18777
18778
18779 @menu
18780 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18781 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18782 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18783 @end menu
18784
18785
18786
18787
18788 @node Group Agent Commands
18789 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18790
18791 @table @kbd
18792 @item J u
18793 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18794 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18795 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18796 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18797
18798 @item J c
18799 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18800 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18801 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18802
18803 @item J s
18804 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18805 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18806 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18807 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18808
18809 @item J S
18810 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18811 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18812 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18813 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18814
18815 @item J a
18816 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18817 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18818 Add the current group to an Agent category
18819 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18820 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18821
18822 @item J r
18823 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18824 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18825 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18826 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18827 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18828
18829 @item J Y
18830 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18831 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18832 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18833
18834
18835 @end table
18836
18837
18838 @node Summary Agent Commands
18839 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18840
18841 @table @kbd
18842 @item J #
18843 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18844 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18845 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18846
18847 @item J M-#
18848 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18849 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18850 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18851 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18852
18853 @cindex %
18854 @item @@
18855 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18856 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18857 Toggle whether to download the article
18858 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18859 default.
18860
18861 @item J c
18862 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18863 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18864 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18865
18866 @item J S
18867 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18868 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18869 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18870 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18871
18872 @item J s
18873 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18874 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series
18875 Download all processable articles in this group.
18876 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series}).
18877
18878 @item J u
18879 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18880 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18881 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18882 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18883
18884 @end table
18885
18886
18887 @node Server Agent Commands
18888 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18889
18890 @table @kbd
18891 @item J a
18892 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18893 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18894 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18895 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18896
18897 @item J r
18898 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18899 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18900 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18901 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18902
18903 @end table
18904
18905
18906 @node Agent Visuals
18907 @subsection Agent Visuals
18908
18909 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18910 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18911 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18912 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18913 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18914 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18915 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18916 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18917 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18918 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18919
18920 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18921 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18922 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18923 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18924 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18925 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18926 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18927 articles will be available when unplugged.
18928
18929 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18930 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18931 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18932 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18933 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18934 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18935 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18936 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18937
18938 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18939 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18940 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18941 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18942 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18943 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18944 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18945 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18946 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18947
18948 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18949 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18950 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18951 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18952 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear. For those
18953 users using the agent to improve online performance by caching the NOV
18954 database (most users since 5.10.2), the undownloaded faces may appear
18955 to be an absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since none
18956 of their articles have been fetched into the Agent, all of the
18957 normal faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces.
18958
18959 If you would like to use the undownloaded faces, you must enable the
18960 undownloaded faces by setting the @code{agent-enable-undownloaded-faces}
18961 group parameter to @code{t}. This parameter, like all other agent
18962 parameters, may be set on an Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}),
18963 a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic Parameters}), or an individual group
18964 (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18965
18966 The one problem common to all users using the agent is how quickly it
18967 can consume disk space. If you using the agent on many groups, it is
18968 even more difficult to effectively recover disk space. One solution
18969 is the @samp{%F} format available in @code{gnus-group-line-format}.
18970 This format will display the actual disk space used by articles
18971 fetched into both the agent and cache. By knowing which groups use
18972 the most space, users know where to focus their efforts when ``agent
18973 expiring'' articles.
18974
18975 @node Agent as Cache
18976 @subsection Agent as Cache
18977
18978 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18979 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18980 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18981 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18982 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18983 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18984 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18985 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18986 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18987
18988 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18989 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18990 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18991 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18992 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18993
18994 @node Agent Expiry
18995 @subsection Agent Expiry
18996
18997 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18998 @findex gnus-agent-expire
18999 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
19000 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
19001 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
19002 @cindex agent expiry
19003 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
19004 @cindex expiry, in Gnus agent
19005
19006 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
19007 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
19008 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
19009 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
19010 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
19011 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
19012 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
19013 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
19014
19015 Note that other functions might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you
19016 to keep the agent synchronized with the group.
19017
19018 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
19019 prevent expiration in selected groups.
19020
19021 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
19022 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
19023 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
19024 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
19025 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
19026 be kept indefinitely.
19027
19028 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
19029 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
19030 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
19031 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
19032
19033 @node Agent Regeneration
19034 @subsection Agent Regeneration
19035
19036 @cindex agent regeneration
19037 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
19038 @cindex regeneration
19039
19040 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
19041 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
19042 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
19043 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
19044 internal inconsistencies.
19045
19046 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
19047 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
19048 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
19049 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
19050 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
19051 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
19052
19053 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
19054 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
19055 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
19056 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
19057 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
19058 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
19059
19060 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19061 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19062 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
19063 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
19064 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
19065 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
19066 agent as unread.
19067
19068 @node Agent and flags
19069 @subsection Agent and flags
19070
19071 The Agent works with any Gnus back end including those, such as
19072 nnimap, that store flags (read, ticked, etc.)@: on the server. Sadly,
19073 the Agent does not actually know which backends keep their flags in
19074 the backend server rather than in @file{.newsrc}. This means that the
19075 Agent, while unplugged or disconnected, will always record all changes
19076 to the flags in its own files.
19077
19078 When you plug back in, Gnus will then check to see if you have any
19079 changed any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the
19080 server. This behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
19081
19082 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19083 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19084 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19085 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19086 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19087 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19088
19089 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
19090 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
19091 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
19092 in the group buffer.
19093
19094 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
19095 all local flags to the server, but rather by incrementally updated the
19096 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
19097 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group then
19098 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
19099 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
19100 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
19101 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
19102
19103 @node Agent and IMAP
19104 @subsection Agent and IMAP
19105
19106 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
19107 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
19108 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
19109 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
19110
19111 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
19112 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
19113
19114 @itemize @bullet
19115
19116 @item
19117 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
19118
19119 @item
19120 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
19121
19122 @end itemize
19123
19124 @node Outgoing Messages
19125 @subsection Outgoing Messages
19126
19127 By default, when Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail
19128 and news) are stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}).
19129 You can view them there after posting, and edit them at will.
19130
19131 You can control the circumstances under which outgoing mail is queued
19132 (see @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail}, @pxref{Agent Variables}). Outgoing
19133 news is always queued when Gnus is unplugged, and never otherwise.
19134
19135 You can send the messages either from the draft group with the special
19136 commands available there, or you can use the @kbd{J S} command in the
19137 group buffer to send all the sendable messages in the draft group.
19138 Posting news will only work when Gnus is plugged, but you can send
19139 mail at any time.
19140
19141 If sending mail while unplugged does not work for you and you worry
19142 about hitting @kbd{J S} by accident when unplugged, you can have Gnus
19143 ask you to confirm your action (see
19144 @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue}, @pxref{Agent Variables}).
19145
19146 @node Agent Variables
19147 @subsection Agent Variables
19148
19149 @table @code
19150 @item gnus-agent
19151 @vindex gnus-agent
19152 Is the agent enabled? The default is @code{t}. When first enabled,
19153 the agent will use @code{gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods} to
19154 automatically mark some back ends as agentized. You may change which
19155 back ends are agentized using the agent commands in the server buffer.
19156
19157 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
19158 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
19159
19160
19161 @item gnus-agent-directory
19162 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
19163 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
19164 @file{~/News/agent/}.
19165
19166 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
19167 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
19168 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
19169 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
19170 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
19171 by default.
19172
19173 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19174 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19175 Hook run when connecting to the network.
19176
19177 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19178 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19179 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
19180
19181 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19182 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19183 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
19184
19185 @item gnus-agent-cache
19186 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
19187 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
19188 articles when plugged, e.g., essentially using the Agent as a cache.
19189 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
19190
19191 @item gnus-agent-go-online
19192 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
19193 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
19194 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
19195 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
19196 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
19197 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
19198 online status.
19199
19200 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19201 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19202 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
19203 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
19204 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
19205 read. The default is @code{t}.
19206
19207 @item gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19208 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19209 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19210 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19211 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19212 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19213 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19214
19215 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19216 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19217 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
19218 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
19219 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
19220 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
19221 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
19222 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
19223 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
19224 over and over again.
19225
19226 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19227 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19228 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
19229 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
19230 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
19231 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
19232 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
19233 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
19234 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
19235 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
19236 However, all articles parsed prior to losing the connection will be
19237 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
19238 see any cycling.
19239
19240 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
19241 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
19242 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
19243 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
19244 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
19245 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
19246 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
19247 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
19248 is only valid if the Agent is used.
19249
19250 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19251 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19252 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
19253 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
19254 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
19255 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
19256
19257 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
19258 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
19259 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
19260 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
19261 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
19262
19263 @item gnus-agent-queue-mail
19264 @vindex gnus-agent-queue-mail
19265 When @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail} is @code{always}, Gnus will always
19266 queue mail rather than sending it straight away. When @code{t}, Gnus
19267 will queue mail when unplugged only. When @code{nil}, never queue
19268 mail. The default is @code{t}.
19269
19270 @item gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19271 @vindex gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19272 When @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue} is non-@code{nil} Gnus will
19273 prompt you to confirm that you really wish to proceed if you hit
19274 @kbd{J S} while unplugged. The default is @code{nil}.
19275
19276 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19277 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19278 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
19279 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
19280 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
19281 which back ends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
19282 to agentize remote back ends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
19283 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
19284 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
19285 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
19286 start Gnus. The default is @samp{nil}.
19287
19288 @end table
19289
19290
19291 @node Example Setup
19292 @subsection Example Setup
19293
19294 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
19295 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
19296 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
19297
19298 @lisp
19299 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
19300 ;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
19301 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
19302
19303 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
19304 ;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
19305 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
19306
19307 ;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
19308 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
19309
19310 ;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
19311 ;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
19312 ;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
19313 @end lisp
19314
19315 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
19316 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
19317 gnus}.
19318
19319 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
19320 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
19321 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
19322 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
19323 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
19324 once.
19325
19326 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
19327 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
19328 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
19329 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
19330 back all the killed groups.)
19331
19332 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
19333 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
19334 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
19335
19336
19337 @node Batching Agents
19338 @subsection Batching Agents
19339 @findex gnus-agent-batch
19340
19341 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
19342 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
19343 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
19344
19345 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
19346 following incantation:
19347
19348 @example
19349 #!/bin/sh
19350 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
19351 @end example
19352
19353
19354 @node Agent Caveats
19355 @subsection Agent Caveats
19356
19357 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
19358 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
19359 may ask:
19360
19361 @table @dfn
19362 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
19363
19364 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
19365 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
19366 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
19367
19368 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
19369 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
19370
19371 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
19372
19373 @end table
19374
19375 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
19376 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
19377 locally stored articles.
19378
19379
19380 @node Scoring
19381 @chapter Scoring
19382 @cindex scoring
19383
19384 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
19385 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
19386 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
19387 attention!
19388
19389 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
19390 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
19391 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
19392 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
19393 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
19394
19395 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
19396 before generating the summary buffer.
19397
19398 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
19399 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
19400 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
19401
19402 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
19403 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
19404 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
19405 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
19406
19407 @menu
19408 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
19409 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
19410 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
19411 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
19412 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
19413 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
19414 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
19415 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
19416 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
19417 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
19418 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
19419 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
19420 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
19421 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
19422 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
19423 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
19424 @end menu
19425
19426
19427 @node Summary Score Commands
19428 @section Summary Score Commands
19429 @cindex score commands
19430
19431 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
19432 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
19433 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
19434 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
19435 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
19436
19437 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
19438 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
19439 some other score file (e.g., @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
19440 score file the current one.
19441
19442 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
19443
19444 @table @kbd
19445
19446 @item V s
19447 @kindex V s (Summary)
19448 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
19449 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
19450
19451 @item V S
19452 @kindex V S (Summary)
19453 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
19454 Display the score of the current article
19455 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
19456
19457 @item V t
19458 @kindex V t (Summary)
19459 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
19460 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
19461 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @file{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
19462 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
19463 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
19464 score file and edit it.
19465
19466 @item V w
19467 @kindex V w (Summary)
19468 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
19469 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
19470
19471 @item V R
19472 @kindex V R (Summary)
19473 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
19474 Run the current summary through the scoring process
19475 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
19476 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
19477 effect you're having.
19478
19479 @item V c
19480 @kindex V c (Summary)
19481 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
19482 Make a different score file the current
19483 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
19484
19485 @item V e
19486 @kindex V e (Summary)
19487 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
19488 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
19489 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
19490 File Editing}).
19491
19492 @item V f
19493 @kindex V f (Summary)
19494 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
19495 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
19496 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
19497
19498 @item V F
19499 @kindex V F (Summary)
19500 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19501 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
19502 after editing score files.
19503
19504 @item V C
19505 @kindex V C (Summary)
19506 @findex gnus-score-customize
19507 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
19508 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
19509
19510 @end table
19511
19512 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
19513
19514 @table @kbd
19515
19516 @item V m
19517 @kindex V m (Summary)
19518 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
19519 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
19520 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
19521
19522 @item V x
19523 @kindex V x (Summary)
19524 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
19525 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
19526 expunge all articles below this score
19527 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
19528 @end table
19529
19530 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
19531 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
19532 them.)
19533
19534 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
19535 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
19536
19537 @enumerate
19538 @item
19539 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
19540 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
19541 @item
19542 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
19543 keys are available:
19544 @table @kbd
19545
19546 @item a
19547 Score on the author name.
19548
19549 @item s
19550 Score on the subject line.
19551
19552 @item x
19553 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
19554
19555 @item r
19556 Score on the @code{References} line.
19557
19558 @item d
19559 Score on the date.
19560
19561 @item l
19562 Score on the number of lines.
19563
19564 @item i
19565 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
19566
19567 @item e
19568 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
19569 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
19570
19571 @item f
19572 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
19573 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
19574 @file{ADAPT} files.)
19575
19576 @item b
19577 Score on the body.
19578
19579 @item h
19580 Score on the head.
19581
19582 @item t
19583 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19584 files.)
19585
19586 @end table
19587
19588 @item
19589 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19590 what headers you are scoring on.
19591
19592 @table @code
19593
19594 @item strings
19595
19596 @table @kbd
19597
19598 @item e
19599 Exact matching.
19600
19601 @item s
19602 Substring matching.
19603
19604 @item f
19605 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
19606
19607 @item r
19608 Regexp matching
19609 @end table
19610
19611 @item date
19612 @table @kbd
19613
19614 @item b
19615 Before date.
19616
19617 @item a
19618 After date.
19619
19620 @item n
19621 This date.
19622 @end table
19623
19624 @item number
19625 @table @kbd
19626
19627 @item <
19628 Less than number.
19629
19630 @item =
19631 Equal to number.
19632
19633 @item >
19634 Greater than number.
19635 @end table
19636 @end table
19637
19638 @item
19639 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19640 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19641 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19642 file.
19643 @table @kbd
19644
19645 @item t
19646 Temporary score entry.
19647
19648 @item p
19649 Permanent score entry.
19650
19651 @item i
19652 Immediately scoring.
19653 @end table
19654
19655 @item
19656 If you are scoring on @samp{e} (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19657 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19658 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19659
19660 @end enumerate
19661
19662 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19663 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19664 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19665 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19666
19667 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19668 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19669 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19670 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19671 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19672
19673 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19674 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19675 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19676 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19677 current score file.
19678
19679 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19680 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19681 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19682
19683
19684 @node Group Score Commands
19685 @section Group Score Commands
19686 @cindex group score commands
19687
19688 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19689
19690 @table @kbd
19691
19692 @item W e
19693 @kindex W e (Group)
19694 @findex gnus-score-edit-all-score
19695 Edit the apply-to-all-groups all.SCORE file. You will be popped into
19696 a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score File Editing}).
19697
19698 @item W f
19699 @kindex W f (Group)
19700 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19701 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19702 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19703 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19704
19705 @end table
19706
19707 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19708
19709 @findex gnus-batch-score
19710 @cindex batch scoring
19711 @example
19712 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19713 @end example
19714
19715
19716 @node Score Variables
19717 @section Score Variables
19718 @cindex score variables
19719
19720 @table @code
19721
19722 @item gnus-use-scoring
19723 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19724 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19725 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19726
19727 @item gnus-kill-killed
19728 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19729 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19730 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19731 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19732 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19733 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19734 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19735
19736 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19737 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19738 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19739 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19740 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19741
19742 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19743 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19744 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19745 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19746
19747 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19748 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19749 @cindex score cache
19750 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19751 score files. However, this might make your Emacs grow big and
19752 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19753 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19754 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19755 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19756 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19757 be cached.
19758
19759 @item gnus-save-score
19760 @vindex gnus-save-score
19761 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19762 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19763 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19764
19765 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19766 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19767 across group visits.
19768
19769 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19770 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19771 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19772 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19773 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19774 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19775 manually entered data.
19776
19777 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19778 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19779 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19780
19781 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19782 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19783 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19784 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19785 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19786 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19787
19788 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19789 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19790 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19791 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19792
19793 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19794 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19795 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19796 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19797
19798 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19799 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19800 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19801 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19802
19803 Predefined functions available are:
19804 @table @code
19805
19806 @item gnus-score-find-single
19807 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19808 Only apply the group's own score file.
19809
19810 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19811 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19812 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19813 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19814 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19815 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19816 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19817 then a regexp match is done.
19818
19819 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19820 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19821
19822 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19823 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19824 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19825 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19826
19827 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19828 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19829 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19830 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19831 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19832 server.
19833
19834 @end table
19835 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19836 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19837 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19838 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19839 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19840 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19841 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19842 Phu.
19843
19844 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19845 overall score file, you could use the value
19846 @example
19847 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19848 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19849 @end example
19850
19851 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19852 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19853 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19854 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19855 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19856
19857 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19858 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19859 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19860 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19861 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19862 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19863 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19864 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19865
19866 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19867 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19868 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19869
19870 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19871 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19872 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19873 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19874 threading---according to the current value of
19875 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19876 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19877 simplified in this manner.
19878
19879 @end table
19880
19881
19882 @node Score File Format
19883 @section Score File Format
19884 @cindex score file format
19885
19886 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19887 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19888 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19889
19890 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19891
19892 @lisp
19893 (("from"
19894 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19895 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19896 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19897 ("subject"
19898 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19899 ("xref"
19900 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19901 ("lines"
19902 (2 -100 nil <))
19903 (mark 0)
19904 (expunge -1000)
19905 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19906 (read-only nil)
19907 (orphan -10)
19908 (adapt t)
19909 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19910 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19911 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19912 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19913 (eval (ding)))
19914 @end lisp
19915
19916 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19917 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19918
19919 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19920 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19921 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19922
19923 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19924
19925 @table @code
19926
19927 @item STRING
19928 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19929 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19930 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19931 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19932 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19933 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19934 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19935 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19936 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19937 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19938 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19939 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19940 to articles that matches these score entries.
19941
19942 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19943 score entry has one to four elements.
19944 @enumerate
19945
19946 @item
19947 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19948 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19949 integer.
19950
19951 @item
19952 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19953 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19954 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19955 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19956 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19957 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19958
19959 @item
19960 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19961 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19962 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19963 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19964 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19965
19966 @item
19967 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19968 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19969 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19970 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19971 @table @dfn
19972
19973 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19974 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19975 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19976 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19977 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19978 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19979 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19980 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19981 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19982 instead, if you feel like.
19983
19984 @item Extra
19985 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19986 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19987 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19988 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19989 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19990 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19991 overviews:
19992
19993 @lisp
19994 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19995 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19996 @end lisp
19997
19998 @item Lines, Chars
19999 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
20000 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
20001
20002 These predicates are true if
20003
20004 @example
20005 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
20006 @end example
20007
20008 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
20009 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
20010 following form:
20011
20012 @lisp
20013 (< header-value 4)
20014 @end lisp
20015
20016 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
20017 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
20018 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
20019 it's not. I think.)
20020
20021 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
20022 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
20023 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
20024 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
20025
20026 @item Date
20027 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
20028 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
20029 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
20030 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
20031 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
20032 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
20033 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
20034
20035 @cindex ISO8601
20036 @cindex date
20037 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
20038 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
20039 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
20040 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
20041 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
20042 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
20043 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
20044 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
20045 whole family, eh?)
20046
20047 @item Head, Body, All
20048 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc.)@:
20049 header uses.
20050
20051 @item Followup
20052 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
20053 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
20054 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
20055 you to increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
20056 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
20057 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
20058 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
20059 files.)
20060
20061 @item Thread
20062 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
20063 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
20064 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
20065 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
20066 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
20067 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
20068 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
20069 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
20070 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
20071 nondeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
20072 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
20073 @end table
20074 @end enumerate
20075
20076 @cindex score file atoms
20077 @item mark
20078 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20079 lower than this number will be marked as read.
20080
20081 @item expunge
20082 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20083 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
20084
20085 @item mark-and-expunge
20086 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20087 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
20088 summary buffer.
20089
20090 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
20091 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
20092 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
20093 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
20094 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
20095
20096 @item files
20097 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
20098 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
20099 this one was.
20100
20101 @item exclude-files
20102 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
20103 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
20104 other.
20105
20106 @item eval
20107 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}ed. This element will be
20108 ignored when handling global score files.
20109
20110 @item read-only
20111 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
20112 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
20113 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
20114 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
20115
20116 @item orphan
20117 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
20118 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
20119 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
20120 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
20121
20122 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
20123
20124 @example
20125 (orphan -500)
20126 (mark-and-expunge -100)
20127 @end example
20128
20129 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
20130 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
20131 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{c y}) the
20132 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
20133 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
20134
20135 I.e., the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
20136 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
20137 scoring rules exist.
20138
20139 @item adapt
20140 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
20141 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
20142 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
20143 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
20144 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
20145 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
20146 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20147 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
20148 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
20149 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
20150 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
20151 it.
20152
20153 @item adapt-file
20154 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
20155 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
20156 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
20157 file for a number of groups.
20158
20159 @item local
20160 @cindex local variables
20161 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
20162 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
20163 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
20164 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
20165 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
20166 be evaluated.
20167 @end table
20168
20169
20170 @node Score File Editing
20171 @section Score File Editing
20172
20173 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
20174 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
20175 with a mode for that.
20176
20177 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
20178 additional commands:
20179
20180 @table @kbd
20181
20182 @item C-c C-c
20183 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
20184 @findex gnus-score-edit-exit
20185 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
20186 (@code{gnus-score-edit-exit}).
20187
20188 @item C-c C-d
20189 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
20190 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
20191 Insert the current date in numerical format
20192 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
20193 you were wondering.
20194
20195 @item C-c C-p
20196 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
20197 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
20198 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
20199 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
20200 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
20201 you.
20202
20203 @end table
20204
20205 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
20206
20207 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
20208 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
20209
20210 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
20211 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
20212
20213
20214 @node Adaptive Scoring
20215 @section Adaptive Scoring
20216 @cindex adaptive scoring
20217
20218 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
20219 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
20220 stupidity, to be precise.
20221
20222 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
20223 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
20224 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
20225 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
20226 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20227 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
20228 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
20229 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
20230 variable to @code{(word line)}.
20231
20232 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20233 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
20234 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
20235 might look something like this:
20236
20237 @lisp
20238 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20239 '((gnus-unread-mark)
20240 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
20241 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
20242 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
20243 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
20244 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
20245 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
20246 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
20247 (gnus-ancient-mark)
20248 (gnus-low-score-mark)
20249 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
20250 @end lisp
20251
20252 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
20253 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
20254 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
20255 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
20256 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
20257 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
20258 entries.
20259
20260 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
20261 will be applied to each article.
20262
20263 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
20264 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
20265 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
20266 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
20267
20268 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
20269 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
20270 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
20271 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
20272
20273 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
20274 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
20275 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
20276 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
20277
20278 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
20279 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
20280 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
20281 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
20282 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
20283 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
20284
20285 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
20286 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
20287 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
20288
20289 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
20290 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
20291 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
20292
20293 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
20294 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
20295 let you use different rules in different groups.
20296
20297 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
20298 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
20299 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
20300 is @file{ADAPT}.
20301
20302 @vindex gnus-adaptive-pretty-print
20303 Adaptive score files can get huge and are not meant to be edited by
20304 human hands. If @code{gnus-adaptive-pretty-print} is @code{nil} (the
20305 default) those files will not be written in a human readable way.
20306
20307 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
20308 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
20309 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
20310 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
20311 the length of the match is less than
20312 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
20313 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
20314 this problem.
20315
20316 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20317 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
20318 headers. If you adapt on words, the
20319 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
20320 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
20321
20322 @lisp
20323 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20324 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
20325 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
20326 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
20327 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
20328 @end lisp
20329
20330 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
20331 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
20332 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
20333 score with 30 points.
20334
20335 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
20336 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
20337 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
20338 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
20339 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
20340
20341 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
20342 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
20343 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
20344 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
20345 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
20346
20347 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
20348 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
20349 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
20350 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
20351
20352 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
20353 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
20354 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
20355 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
20356
20357 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
20358 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
20359 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
20360 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
20361 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
20362
20363 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
20364 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
20365 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
20366
20367 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
20368 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
20369 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
20370 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
20371
20372
20373 @node Home Score File
20374 @section Home Score File
20375
20376 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
20377 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
20378 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
20379 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
20380
20381 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
20382 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
20383 could perhaps use the same home score file.
20384
20385 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
20386 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
20387 be:
20388
20389 @enumerate
20390 @item
20391 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
20392 groups.
20393
20394 @item
20395 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
20396 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
20397 parameter.
20398
20399 @item
20400 A list. The elements in this list can be:
20401
20402 @enumerate
20403 @item
20404 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
20405 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
20406
20407 @item
20408 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
20409 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
20410 name of the group as the parameter.
20411
20412 @item
20413 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
20414 @end enumerate
20415
20416 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
20417 for matches.
20418
20419 @end enumerate
20420
20421 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
20422
20423 @lisp
20424 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20425 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
20426 @end lisp
20427
20428 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
20429 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
20430
20431 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
20432 @lisp
20433 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20434 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
20435 @end lisp
20436
20437 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
20438 Other functions include
20439
20440 @table @code
20441 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
20442 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
20443 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
20444 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
20445
20446 @end table
20447
20448 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
20449 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
20450 their own home score files:
20451
20452 @lisp
20453 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20454 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
20455 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
20456 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
20457 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
20458 @end lisp
20459
20460 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
20461 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
20462 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
20463 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
20464 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
20465
20466 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
20467 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
20468 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
20469 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
20470 precedence over this variable.
20471
20472
20473 @node Followups To Yourself
20474 @section Followups To Yourself
20475
20476 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
20477 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
20478 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
20479 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
20480 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
20481 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
20482
20483 @table @code
20484
20485 @item gnus-score-followup-article
20486 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
20487 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
20488 article.
20489
20490 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
20491 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
20492 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
20493 your own article.
20494 @end table
20495
20496 @vindex message-sent-hook
20497 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
20498 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
20499 @lisp
20500 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
20501 @end lisp
20502
20503
20504 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
20505 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
20506 mine:
20507
20508 @example
20509 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20510 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20511 @end example
20512
20513 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
20514 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
20515 myself:
20516
20517 @lisp
20518 ("references"
20519 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
20520 1000 nil r))
20521 @end lisp
20522
20523 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
20524 is system-dependent.
20525
20526
20527 @node Scoring On Other Headers
20528 @section Scoring On Other Headers
20529 @cindex scoring on other headers
20530
20531 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
20532 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
20533 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
20534 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
20535 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
20536
20537 @vindex gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring
20538 You can inhibit this slow scoring on headers or body by setting the
20539 variable @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring}. If
20540 @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring} is regexp, slow scoring is inhibited if
20541 the group matches the regexp. If it is @code{t}, slow scoring on it is
20542 inhibited for all groups.
20543
20544 Now, there's not much you can do about the slowness for news groups, but for
20545 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
20546 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
20547 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
20548 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
20549
20550 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
20551
20552 @lisp
20553 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
20554 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
20555 @end lisp
20556
20557 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
20558 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
20559 time if you have much mail.
20560
20561 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
20562 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
20563
20564 See? Simple.
20565
20566
20567 @node Scoring Tips
20568 @section Scoring Tips
20569 @cindex scoring tips
20570
20571 @table @dfn
20572
20573 @item Crossposts
20574 @cindex crossposts
20575 @cindex scoring crossposts
20576 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
20577 the @code{Xref} header.
20578 @lisp
20579 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
20580 @end lisp
20581
20582 @item Multiple crossposts
20583 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
20584 more than, say, 3 groups:
20585 @lisp
20586 ("xref"
20587 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
20588 -1000 nil r))
20589 @end lisp
20590
20591 @item Matching on the body
20592 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
20593 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
20594 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20595 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20596 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20597 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20598 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20599 the matches.
20600
20601 @item Marking as read
20602 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20603 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20604 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20605 @lisp
20606 ((mark -100))
20607 @end lisp
20608 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
20609
20610 @item Negated character classes
20611 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20612 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20613 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
20614 @end table
20615
20616
20617 @node Reverse Scoring
20618 @section Reverse Scoring
20619 @cindex reverse scoring
20620
20621 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20622 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20623 like this in your score file:
20624
20625 @lisp
20626 (("subject"
20627 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20628 (mark 1)
20629 (expunge 1))
20630 @end lisp
20631
20632 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20633 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
20634
20635
20636 @node Global Score Files
20637 @section Global Score Files
20638 @cindex global score files
20639
20640 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20641 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20642 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
20643
20644 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20645 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20646 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
20647
20648 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
20649 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20650 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20651 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20652 files are applicable to which group.
20653
20654 To use the score file
20655 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20656 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20657 say this:
20658
20659 @lisp
20660 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20661 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20662 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20663 @end lisp
20664
20665 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20666 @noindent
20667 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20668 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20669 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20670 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20671
20672 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20673 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20674
20675 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20676 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20677 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20678 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20679 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20680 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20681
20682 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20683 head:
20684
20685 @itemize @bullet
20686
20687 @item
20688 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20689 @item
20690 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20691 @item
20692 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20693 @item
20694 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20695 lowered out of existence.
20696 @item
20697 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20698 articles completely.
20699
20700 @item
20701 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20702 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20703 old articles for a long time.
20704 @end itemize
20705
20706 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20707 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20708 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20709 holding our breath yet?
20710
20711
20712 @node Kill Files
20713 @section Kill Files
20714 @cindex kill files
20715
20716 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20717 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20718 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20719
20720 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20721 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20722 files into score files.
20723
20724 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20725 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20726 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20727 that isn't a very good idea.
20728
20729 Normal kill files look like this:
20730
20731 @lisp
20732 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20733 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20734 (gnus-expunge "X")
20735 @end lisp
20736
20737 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20738 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20739
20740 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20741 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20742 interpreting it.
20743
20744 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20745
20746 @table @kbd
20747
20748 @item M-k
20749 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20750 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20751 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20752
20753 @item M-K
20754 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20755 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20756 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20757 @end table
20758
20759 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20760
20761 @table @kbd
20762
20763 @item M-k
20764 @kindex M-k (Group)
20765 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20766 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20767
20768 @item M-K
20769 @kindex M-K (Group)
20770 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20771 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20772 @end table
20773
20774 Kill file variables:
20775
20776 @table @code
20777 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20778 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20779 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20780 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20781 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20782 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20783 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20784
20785 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20786 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20787 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20788 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20789 kills.
20790
20791 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20792 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20793 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20794 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20795 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20796 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20797 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20798 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20799 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20800
20801 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20802 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20803 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20804
20805 @end table
20806
20807
20808 @node Converting Kill Files
20809 @section Converting Kill Files
20810 @cindex kill files
20811 @cindex converting kill files
20812
20813 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20814 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20815 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20816 by hand.
20817
20818 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Emacs by default.
20819 You can fetch it from the contrib directory of the Gnus distribution or
20820 from
20821 @uref{http://heim.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20822
20823 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20824 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20825 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20826 before.
20827
20828
20829 @node Advanced Scoring
20830 @section Advanced Scoring
20831
20832 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20833 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20834 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20835 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20836 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20837
20838 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20839 scoring patterns.
20840
20841 @menu
20842 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20843 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20844 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20845 @end menu
20846
20847
20848 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20849 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20850
20851 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20852 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20853 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20854 non-@code{nil} value.
20855
20856 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20857 operator, and various match operators.
20858
20859 Logical operators:
20860
20861 @table @code
20862 @item &
20863 @itemx and
20864 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20865 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20866 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20867 @code{true}.
20868
20869 @item |
20870 @itemx or
20871 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20872 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20873 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20874
20875 @item !
20876 @itemx not
20877 @itemx ¬
20878 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20879 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20880
20881 @end table
20882
20883 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20884 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20885 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20886 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20887 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20888 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20889 the ancestry you want to go.
20890
20891 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20892 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20893 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20894 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20895 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20896
20897
20898 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20899 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20900
20901 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20902 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20903 of parentheses.
20904
20905 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20906 when he's talking about Gnus:
20907
20908 @example
20909 @group
20910 ((&
20911 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20912 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20913 1000)
20914 @end group
20915 @end example
20916
20917 Quite simple, huh?
20918
20919 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20920
20921 @example
20922 ((&
20923 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20924 (|
20925 ("subject" "Gnus")
20926 ("lines" 100 >)))
20927 1000)
20928 @end example
20929
20930 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20931 really don't want to read what he's written:
20932
20933 @example
20934 ((&
20935 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20936 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigil Logge")))
20937 -100000)
20938 @end example
20939
20940 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20941 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20942 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20943 very interesting:
20944
20945 @example
20946 ((&
20947 (1-
20948 (&
20949 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20950 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20951 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20952 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20953 1000)
20954 @end example
20955
20956 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
20957 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
20958 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
20959 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
20960
20961 @example
20962 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20963 -200)
20964 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20965 200)
20966 @end example
20967
20968 The possibilities are endless.
20969
20970 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20971 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20972
20973 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20974 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20975 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20976 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20977 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20978 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20979 @samp{subject}) first.
20980
20981 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20982 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20983 something like:
20984
20985 @example
20986 ...
20987 (1-
20988 (1-
20989 ("from" "lars")))
20990 ...
20991 @end example
20992
20993 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20994 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20995
20996 @example
20997 (1-
20998 (&
20999 ("from" "Lars")
21000 ("subject" "Gnus")))
21001 @end example
21002
21003 than it is to say:
21004
21005 @example
21006 (&
21007 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
21008 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
21009 @end example
21010
21011
21012 @node Score Decays
21013 @section Score Decays
21014 @cindex score decays
21015 @cindex decays
21016
21017 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
21018 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
21019 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
21020 use them in any sensible way.
21021
21022 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
21023 @findex gnus-decay-score
21024 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
21025 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
21026 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
21027 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
21028 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
21029 If @code{gnus-decay-scores} is a regexp, only score files matching this
21030 regexp are treated. E.g., you may set it to @samp{\\.ADAPT\\'} if only
21031 @emph{adaptive} score files should be decayed. The decay itself if
21032 performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function} function, which is
21033 @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the definition of that
21034 function:
21035
21036 @lisp
21037 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
21038 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
21039 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
21040 (let ((n (- score
21041 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
21042 (min (abs score)
21043 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
21044 (* (abs score)
21045 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
21046 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
21047 ;; XEmacs's floor can handle only the floating point
21048 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
21049 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
21050 (string-to-number
21051 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
21052 (floor n))))
21053 @end lisp
21054
21055 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
21056 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
21057 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
21058 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
21059
21060 @enumerate
21061 @item
21062 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
21063
21064 @item
21065 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
21066
21067 @item
21068 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
21069 score.
21070 @end enumerate
21071
21072 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
21073 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
21074 the new score, which should be an integer.
21075
21076 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
21077 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
21078
21079 @node Searching
21080 @chapter Searching
21081 @cindex searching
21082
21083 FIXME: Add a brief overview of Gnus search capabilities. A brief
21084 comparison of nnir, nnmairix, contrib/gnus-namazu would be nice
21085 as well.
21086
21087 This chapter describes tools for searching groups and servers for
21088 articles matching a query and then retrieving those articles. Gnus
21089 provides a simpler mechanism for searching through articles in a summary buffer
21090 to find those matching a pattern. @xref{Searching for Articles}.
21091
21092 @menu
21093 * nnir:: Searching with various engines.
21094 * nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
21095 @end menu
21096
21097 @node nnir
21098 @section nnir
21099 @cindex nnir
21100
21101 This section describes how to use @code{nnir} to search for articles
21102 within gnus.
21103
21104 @menu
21105 * What is nnir?:: What does @code{nnir} do?
21106 * Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
21107 * Setting up nnir:: How to set up @code{nnir}.
21108 @end menu
21109
21110 @node What is nnir?
21111 @subsection What is nnir?
21112
21113 @code{nnir} is a Gnus interface to a number of tools for searching
21114 through mail and news repositories. Different backends (like
21115 @code{nnimap} and @code{nntp}) work with different tools (called
21116 @dfn{engines} in @code{nnir} lingo), but all use the same basic search
21117 interface.
21118
21119 The @code{nnimap} and @code{gmane} search engines should work with no
21120 configuration. Other engines require a local index that needs to be
21121 created and maintained outside of Gnus.
21122
21123
21124 @node Basic Usage
21125 @subsection Basic Usage
21126
21127 In the group buffer typing @kbd{G G} will search the group on the
21128 current line by calling @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. This prompts
21129 for a query string, creates an ephemeral @code{nnir} group containing
21130 the articles that match this query, and takes you to a summary buffer
21131 showing these articles. Articles may then be read, moved and deleted
21132 using the usual commands.
21133
21134 The @code{nnir} group made in this way is an @code{ephemeral} group,
21135 and some changes are not permanent: aside from reading, moving, and
21136 deleting, you can't act on the original article. But there is an
21137 alternative: you can @emph{warp} (i.e., jump) to the original group
21138 for the article on the current line with @kbd{A W}, aka
21139 @code{gnus-warp-to-article}. Even better, the function
21140 @code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}, bound by default in summary buffers
21141 to @kbd{A T}, will first warp to the original group before it works
21142 its magic and includes all the articles in the thread. From here you
21143 can read, move and delete articles, but also copy them, alter article
21144 marks, whatever. Go nuts.
21145
21146 You say you want to search more than just the group on the current line?
21147 No problem: just process-mark the groups you want to search. You want
21148 even more? Calling for an nnir search with the cursor on a topic heading
21149 will search all the groups under that heading.
21150
21151 Still not enough? OK, in the server buffer
21152 @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group} (now bound to @kbd{G}) will search all
21153 groups from the server on the current line. Too much? Want to ignore
21154 certain groups when searching, like spam groups? Just customize
21155 @code{nnir-ignored-newsgroups}.
21156
21157 One more thing: individual search engines may have special search
21158 features. You can access these special features by giving a prefix-arg
21159 to @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. If you are searching multiple
21160 groups with different search engines you will be prompted for the
21161 special search features for each engine separately.
21162
21163
21164 @node Setting up nnir
21165 @subsection Setting up nnir
21166
21167 To set up nnir you may need to do some prep work. Firstly, you may need
21168 to configure the search engines you plan to use. Some of them, like
21169 @code{imap} and @code{gmane}, need no special configuration. Others,
21170 like @code{namazu} and @code{swish}, require configuration as described
21171 below. Secondly, you need to associate a search engine with a server or
21172 a backend.
21173
21174 If you just want to use the @code{imap} engine to search @code{nnimap}
21175 servers, and the @code{gmane} engine to search @code{gmane} then you
21176 don't have to do anything. But you might want to read the details of the
21177 query language anyway.
21178
21179 @menu
21180 * Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
21181 * The imap Engine:: Imap configuration and usage.
21182 * The gmane Engine:: Gmane configuration and usage.
21183 * The swish++ Engine:: Swish++ configuration and usage.
21184 * The swish-e Engine:: Swish-e configuration and usage.
21185 * The namazu Engine:: Namazu configuration and usage.
21186 * The notmuch Engine:: Notmuch configuration and usage.
21187 * The hyrex Engine:: Hyrex configuration and usage.
21188 * Customizations:: User customizable settings.
21189 @end menu
21190
21191 @node Associating Engines
21192 @subsubsection Associating Engines
21193
21194
21195 When searching a group, @code{nnir} needs to know which search engine to
21196 use. You can configure a given server to use a particular engine by
21197 setting the server variable @code{nnir-search-engine} to the engine
21198 name. For example to use the @code{namazu} engine to search the server
21199 named @code{home} you can use
21200
21201 @lisp
21202 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
21203 '((nnml "home"
21204 (nnimap-address "localhost")
21205 (nnir-search-engine namazu))))
21206 @end lisp
21207
21208 Alternatively you might want to use a particular engine for all servers
21209 with a given backend. For example, you might want to use the @code{imap}
21210 engine for all servers using the @code{nnimap} backend. In this case you
21211 can customize the variable @code{nnir-method-default-engines}. This is
21212 an alist of pairs of the form @code{(backend . engine)}. By default this
21213 variable is set to use the @code{imap} engine for all servers using the
21214 @code{nnimap} backend, and the @code{gmane} backend for @code{nntp}
21215 servers. (Don't worry, the @code{gmane} search engine won't actually try
21216 to search non-gmane @code{nntp} servers.) But if you wanted to use
21217 @code{namazu} for all your servers with an @code{nnimap} backend you
21218 could change this to
21219
21220 @lisp
21221 '((nnimap . namazu)
21222 (nntp . gmane))
21223 @end lisp
21224
21225 @node The imap Engine
21226 @subsubsection The imap Engine
21227
21228 The @code{imap} engine requires no configuration.
21229
21230 Queries using the @code{imap} engine follow a simple query language.
21231 The search is always case-insensitive and supports the following
21232 features (inspired by the Google search input language):
21233
21234 @table @samp
21235
21236 @item Boolean query operators
21237 AND, OR, and NOT are supported, and parentheses can be used to control
21238 operator precedence, e.g., (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux. Note that
21239 operators must be written with all capital letters to be
21240 recognized. Also preceding a term with a @minus{} sign is equivalent
21241 to NOT term.
21242
21243 @item Automatic AND queries
21244 If you specify multiple words then they will be treated as an AND
21245 expression intended to match all components.
21246
21247 @item Phrase searches
21248 If you wrap your query in double-quotes then it will be treated as a
21249 literal string.
21250
21251 @end table
21252
21253 By default the whole message will be searched. The query can be limited
21254 to a specific part of a message by using a prefix-arg. After inputting
21255 the query this will prompt (with completion) for a message part.
21256 Choices include ``Whole message'', ``Subject'', ``From'', and
21257 ``To''. Any unrecognized input is interpreted as a header name. For
21258 example, typing @kbd{Message-ID} in response to this prompt will limit
21259 the query to the Message-ID header.
21260
21261 Finally selecting ``Imap'' will interpret the query as a raw
21262 @acronym{IMAP} search query. The format of such queries can be found in
21263 RFC3501.
21264
21265 If you don't like the default of searching whole messages you can
21266 customize @code{nnir-imap-default-search-key}. For example to use
21267 @acronym{IMAP} queries by default
21268
21269 @lisp
21270 (setq nnir-imap-default-search-key "Imap")
21271 @end lisp
21272
21273 @node The gmane Engine
21274 @subsubsection The gmane Engine
21275
21276 The @code{gmane} engine requires no configuration.
21277
21278 Gmane queries follow a simple query language:
21279
21280 @table @samp
21281 @item Boolean query operators
21282 AND, OR, NOT (or AND NOT), and XOR are supported, and brackets can be
21283 used to control operator precedence, e.g., (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux.
21284 Note that operators must be written with all capital letters to be
21285 recognized.
21286
21287 @item Required and excluded terms
21288 + and @minus{} can be used to require or exclude terms, e.g., football
21289 @minus{}american
21290
21291 @item Unicode handling
21292 The search engine converts all text to utf-8, so searching should work
21293 in any language.
21294
21295 @item Stopwords
21296 Common English words (like 'the' and 'a') are ignored by default. You
21297 can override this by prefixing such words with a + (e.g., +the) or
21298 enclosing the word in quotes (e.g., "the").
21299
21300 @end table
21301
21302 The query can be limited to articles by a specific author using a
21303 prefix-arg. After inputting the query this will prompt for an author
21304 name (or part of a name) to match.
21305
21306 @node The swish++ Engine
21307 @subsubsection The swish++ Engine
21308
21309 FIXME: Say something more here.
21310
21311 Documentation for swish++ may be found at the swish++ sourceforge page:
21312 @uref{http://swishplusplus.sourceforge.net}
21313
21314 @table @code
21315
21316 @item nnir-swish++-program
21317 The name of the swish++ executable. Defaults to @code{search}
21318
21319 @item nnir-swish++-additional-switches
21320 A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21321 swish++. @code{nil} by default.
21322
21323 @item nnir-swish++-remove-prefix
21324 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish++ in order
21325 to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21326
21327 @end table
21328
21329 @node The swish-e Engine
21330 @subsubsection The swish-e Engine
21331
21332 FIXME: Say something more here.
21333
21334 Documentation for swish-e may be found at the swish-e homepage
21335 @uref{http://swish-e.org}
21336
21337 @table @code
21338
21339 @item nnir-swish-e-program
21340 The name of the swish-e search program. Defaults to @code{swish-e}.
21341
21342 @item nnir-swish-e-additional-switches
21343 A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21344 swish-e. @code{nil} by default.
21345
21346 @item nnir-swish-e-remove-prefix
21347 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish-e in order
21348 to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21349
21350 @end table
21351
21352 @node The namazu Engine
21353 @subsubsection The namazu Engine
21354
21355 Using the namazu engine requires creating and maintaining index files.
21356 One directory should contain all the index files, and nnir must be told
21357 where to find them by setting the @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory}
21358 variable.
21359
21360 To work correctly the @code{nnir-namazu-remove-prefix} variable must
21361 also be correct. This is the prefix to remove from each file name
21362 returned by Namazu in order to get a proper group name (albeit with @samp{/}
21363 instead of @samp{.}).
21364
21365 For example, suppose that Namazu returns file names such as
21366 @samp{/home/john/Mail/mail/misc/42}. For this example, use the
21367 following setting: @code{(setq nnir-namazu-remove-prefix
21368 "/home/john/Mail/")} Note the trailing slash. Removing this prefix from
21369 the directory gives @samp{mail/misc/42}. @code{nnir} knows to remove
21370 the @samp{/42} and to replace @samp{/} with @samp{.} to arrive at the
21371 correct group name @samp{mail.misc}.
21372
21373 Extra switches may be passed to the namazu search command by setting the
21374 variable @code{nnir-namazu-additional-switches}. It is particularly
21375 important not to pass any any switches to namazu that will change the
21376 output format. Good switches to use include @option{--sort},
21377 @option{--ascending}, @option{--early} and @option{--late}.
21378 Refer to the Namazu documentation for further
21379 information on valid switches.
21380
21381 Mail must first be indexed with the @command{mknmz} program. Read the
21382 documentation for namazu to create a configuration file. Here is an
21383 example:
21384
21385 @cartouche
21386 @example
21387 package conf; # Don't remove this line!
21388
21389 # Paths which will not be indexed. Don't use '^' or '$' anchors.
21390 $EXCLUDE_PATH = "spam|sent";
21391
21392 # Header fields which should be searchable. case-insensitive
21393 $REMAIN_HEADER = "from|date|message-id|subject";
21394
21395 # Searchable fields. case-insensitive
21396 $SEARCH_FIELD = "from|date|message-id|subject";
21397
21398 # The max length of a word.
21399 $WORD_LENG_MAX = 128;
21400
21401 # The max length of a field.
21402 $MAX_FIELD_LENGTH = 256;
21403 @end example
21404 @end cartouche
21405
21406 For this example, mail is stored in the directories @samp{~/Mail/mail/},
21407 @samp{~/Mail/lists/} and @samp{~/Mail/archive/}, so to index them go to
21408 the index directory set in @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory} and issue
21409 the following command:
21410
21411 @example
21412 mknmz --mailnews ~/Mail/archive/ ~/Mail/mail/ ~/Mail/lists/
21413 @end example
21414
21415 For maximum searching efficiency you might want to have a cron job run
21416 this command periodically, say every four hours.
21417
21418
21419 @node The notmuch Engine
21420 @subsubsection The notmuch Engine
21421
21422 @table @code
21423 @item nnir-notmuch-program
21424 The name of the notmuch search executable. Defaults to
21425 @samp{notmuch}.
21426
21427 @item nnir-notmuch-additional-switches
21428 A list of strings, to be given as additional arguments to notmuch.
21429
21430 @item nnir-notmuch-remove-prefix
21431 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by notmuch in order
21432 to get a group name (albeit with @samp{/} instead of @samp{.}). This
21433 is a regular expression.
21434
21435 @end table
21436
21437
21438 @node The hyrex Engine
21439 @subsubsection The hyrex Engine
21440 This engine is obsolete.
21441
21442 @node Customizations
21443 @subsubsection Customizations
21444
21445 @table @code
21446
21447 @item nnir-method-default-engines
21448 Alist of pairs of server backends and search engines. The default
21449 associations are
21450 @example
21451 (nnimap . imap)
21452 (nntp . gmane)
21453 @end example
21454
21455 @item nnir-ignored-newsgroups
21456 A regexp to match newsgroups in the active file that should be skipped
21457 when searching all groups on a server.
21458
21459 @item nnir-summary-line-format
21460 The format specification to be used for lines in an nnir summary buffer.
21461 All the items from @code{gnus-summary-line-format} are available, along with
21462 three items unique to nnir summary buffers:
21463
21464 @example
21465 %Z Search retrieval score value (integer)
21466 %G Article original full group name (string)
21467 %g Article original short group name (string)
21468 @end example
21469
21470 If @code{nil} (the default) this will use @code{gnus-summary-line-format}.
21471
21472 @item nnir-retrieve-headers-override-function
21473 If non-@code{nil}, a function that retrieves article headers rather than using
21474 the gnus built-in function. This function takes an article list and
21475 group as arguments and populates the @code{nntp-server-buffer} with the
21476 retrieved headers. It should then return either 'nov or 'headers
21477 indicating the retrieved header format. Failure to retrieve headers
21478 should return @code{nil}.
21479
21480 If this variable is @code{nil}, or if the provided function returns
21481 @code{nil} for a search result, @code{gnus-retrieve-headers} will be
21482 called instead."
21483
21484
21485 @end table
21486
21487
21488 @node nnmairix
21489 @section nnmairix
21490
21491 @cindex mairix
21492 @cindex nnmairix
21493 This paragraph describes how to set up mairix and the back end
21494 @code{nnmairix} for indexing and searching your mail from within
21495 Gnus. Additionally, you can create permanent ``smart'' groups which are
21496 bound to mairix searches and are automatically updated.
21497
21498 @menu
21499 * About mairix:: About the mairix mail search engine
21500 * nnmairix requirements:: What you will need for using nnmairix
21501 * What nnmairix does:: What does nnmairix actually do?
21502 * Setting up mairix:: Set up your mairix installation
21503 * Configuring nnmairix:: Set up the nnmairix back end
21504 * nnmairix keyboard shortcuts:: List of available keyboard shortcuts
21505 * Propagating marks:: How to propagate marks from nnmairix groups
21506 * nnmairix tips and tricks:: Some tips, tricks and examples
21507 * nnmairix caveats:: Some more stuff you might want to know
21508 @end menu
21509
21510 @c FIXME: The markup in this section might need improvement.
21511 @c E.g., adding @samp, @var, @file, @command, etc.
21512 @c Cf. (info "(texinfo)Indicating")
21513
21514 @node About mairix
21515 @subsection About mairix
21516
21517 Mairix is a tool for indexing and searching words in locally stored
21518 mail. It was written by Richard Curnow and is licensed under the
21519 GPL@. Mairix comes with most popular GNU/Linux distributions, but it also
21520 runs under Windows (with cygwin), Mac OS X and Solaris. The homepage can
21521 be found at
21522 @uref{http://www.rpcurnow.force9.co.uk/mairix/index.html}
21523
21524 Though mairix might not be as flexible as other search tools like
21525 swish++ or namazu, which you can use via the @code{nnir} back end, it
21526 has the prime advantage of being incredibly fast. On current systems, it
21527 can easily search through headers and message bodies of thousands and
21528 thousands of mails in well under a second. Building the database
21529 necessary for searching might take a minute or two, but only has to be
21530 done once fully. Afterwards, the updates are done incrementally and
21531 therefore are really fast, too. Additionally, mairix is very easy to set
21532 up.
21533
21534 For maximum speed though, mairix should be used with mails stored in
21535 @code{Maildir} or @code{MH} format (this includes the @code{nnml} back
21536 end), although it also works with mbox. Mairix presents the search
21537 results by populating a @emph{virtual} maildir/MH folder with symlinks
21538 which point to the ``real'' message files (if mbox is used, copies are
21539 made). Since mairix already presents search results in such a virtual
21540 mail folder, it is very well suited for using it as an external program
21541 for creating @emph{smart} mail folders, which represent certain mail
21542 searches.
21543
21544 @node nnmairix requirements
21545 @subsection nnmairix requirements
21546
21547 Mairix searches local mail---that means, mairix absolutely must have
21548 direct access to your mail folders. If your mail resides on another
21549 server (e.g., an @acronym{IMAP} server) and you happen to have shell
21550 access, @code{nnmairix} supports running mairix remotely, e.g., via ssh.
21551
21552 Additionally, @code{nnmairix} only supports the following Gnus back
21553 ends: @code{nnml}, @code{nnmaildir}, and @code{nnimap}. You must use
21554 one of these back ends for using @code{nnmairix}. Other back ends, like
21555 @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnfolder} or @code{nnmh}, won't work.
21556
21557 If you absolutely must use mbox and still want to use @code{nnmairix},
21558 you can set up a local @acronym{IMAP} server, which you then access via
21559 @code{nnimap}. This is a rather massive setup for accessing some mbox
21560 files, so just change to MH or Maildir already... However, if you're
21561 really, really passionate about using mbox, you might want to look into
21562 the package @file{mairix.el}, which comes with Emacs 23.
21563
21564 @node What nnmairix does
21565 @subsection What nnmairix does
21566
21567 The back end @code{nnmairix} enables you to call mairix from within Gnus,
21568 either to query mairix with a search term or to update the
21569 database. While visiting a message in the summary buffer, you can use
21570 several pre-defined shortcuts for calling mairix, e.g., to quickly
21571 search for all mails from the sender of the current message or to
21572 display the whole thread associated with the message, even if the
21573 mails are in different folders.
21574
21575 Additionally, you can create permanent @code{nnmairix} groups which are bound
21576 to certain mairix searches. This way, you can easily create a group
21577 containing mails from a certain sender, with a certain subject line or
21578 even for one specific thread based on the Message-ID@. If you check for
21579 new mail in these folders (e.g., by pressing @kbd{g} or @kbd{M-g}), they
21580 automatically update themselves by calling mairix.
21581
21582 You might ask why you need @code{nnmairix} at all, since mairix already
21583 creates the group, populates it with links to the mails so that you can
21584 then access it with Gnus, right? Well, this @emph{might} work, but often
21585 does not---at least not without problems. Most probably you will get
21586 strange article counts, and sometimes you might see mails which Gnus
21587 claims have already been canceled and are inaccessible. This is due to
21588 the fact that Gnus isn't really amused when things are happening behind
21589 its back. Another problem can be the mail back end itself, e.g., if you
21590 use mairix with an @acronym{IMAP} server (I had Dovecot complaining
21591 about corrupt index files when mairix changed the contents of the search
21592 group). Using @code{nnmairix} should circumvent these problems.
21593
21594 @code{nnmairix} is not really a mail back end---it's actually more like
21595 a wrapper, sitting between a ``real'' mail back end where mairix stores
21596 the searches and the Gnus front end. You can choose between three
21597 different mail back ends for the mairix folders: @code{nnml},
21598 @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnimap}. @code{nnmairix} will call the mairix
21599 binary so that the search results are stored in folders named
21600 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>} on this mail back end, but it will
21601 present these folders in the Gnus front end only with @code{<NAME>}.
21602 You can use an existing mail back end where you already store your mail,
21603 but if you're uncomfortable with @code{nnmairix} creating new mail
21604 groups alongside your other mail, you can also create, e.g., a new
21605 @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml} server exclusively for mairix, but then
21606 make sure those servers do not accidentally receive your new mail
21607 (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). A special case exists if you want to use
21608 mairix remotely on an IMAP server with @code{nnimap}---here the mairix
21609 folders and your other mail must be on the same @code{nnimap} back end.
21610
21611 @node Setting up mairix
21612 @subsection Setting up mairix
21613
21614 First: create a backup of your mail folders (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}).
21615
21616 Setting up mairix is easy: simply create a @file{.mairixrc} file with
21617 (at least) the following entries:
21618
21619 @example
21620 # Your Maildir/MH base folder
21621 base=~/Maildir
21622 @end example
21623
21624 This is the base folder for your mails. All the following directories
21625 are relative to this base folder. If you want to use @code{nnmairix}
21626 with @code{nnimap}, this base directory has to point to the mail
21627 directory where the @acronym{IMAP} server stores the mail folders!
21628
21629 @example
21630 maildir= ... your maildir folders which should be indexed ...
21631 mh= ... your nnml/mh folders which should be indexed ...
21632 mbox = ... your mbox files which should be indexed ...
21633 @end example
21634
21635 This specifies all your mail folders and mbox files (relative to the
21636 base directory!) you want to index with mairix. Note that the
21637 @code{nnml} back end saves mails in MH format, so you have to put those
21638 directories in the @code{mh} line. See the example at the end of this
21639 section and mairixrc's man-page for further details.
21640
21641 @example
21642 omit=zz_mairix-*
21643 @end example
21644
21645 @vindex nnmairix-group-prefix
21646 This should make sure that you don't accidentally index the mairix
21647 search results. You can change the prefix of these folders with the
21648 variable @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
21649
21650 @example
21651 mformat= ... 'maildir' or 'mh' ...
21652 database= ... location of database file ...
21653 @end example
21654
21655 The @code{format} setting specifies the output format for the mairix
21656 search folder. Set this to @code{mh} if you want to access search results
21657 with @code{nnml}. Otherwise choose @code{maildir}.
21658
21659 To summarize, here is my shortened @file{.mairixrc} file as an example:
21660
21661 @example
21662 base=~/Maildir
21663 maildir=.personal:.work:.logcheck:.sent
21664 mh=../Mail/nnml/*...
21665 mbox=../mboxmail/mailarchive_year*
21666 mformat=maildir
21667 omit=zz_mairix-*
21668 database=~/.mairixdatabase
21669 @end example
21670
21671 In this case, the base directory is @file{~/Maildir}, where all my Maildir
21672 folders are stored. As you can see, the folders are separated by
21673 colons. If you wonder why every folder begins with a dot: this is
21674 because I use Dovecot as @acronym{IMAP} server, which again uses
21675 @code{Maildir++} folders. For testing nnmairix, I also have some
21676 @code{nnml} mail, which is saved in @file{~/Mail/nnml}. Since this has
21677 to be specified relative to the @code{base} directory, the @code{../Mail}
21678 notation is needed. Note that the line ends in @code{*...}, which means
21679 to recursively scan all files under this directory. Without the three
21680 dots, the wildcard @code{*} will not work recursively. I also have some
21681 old mbox files with archived mail lying around in @file{~/mboxmail}.
21682 The other lines should be obvious.
21683
21684 See the man page for @code{mairixrc} for details and further options,
21685 especially regarding wildcard usage, which may be a little different
21686 than you are used to.
21687
21688 Now simply call @code{mairix} to create the index for the first time.
21689 Note that this may take a few minutes, but every following index will do
21690 the updates incrementally and hence is very fast.
21691
21692 @node Configuring nnmairix
21693 @subsection Configuring nnmairix
21694
21695 In group mode, type @kbd{G b c}
21696 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). This will ask you for all
21697 necessary information and create a @code{nnmairix} server as a foreign
21698 server. You will have to specify the following:
21699
21700 @itemize @bullet
21701
21702 @item
21703 The @strong{name} of the @code{nnmairix} server---choose whatever you
21704 want.
21705
21706 @item
21707 The name of the @strong{back end server} where mairix should store its
21708 searches. This must be a full server name, like @code{nnml:mymail}.
21709 Just hit @kbd{TAB} to see the available servers. Currently, servers
21710 which are accessed through @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnimap} and
21711 @code{nnml} are supported. As explained above, for locally stored
21712 mails, this can be an existing server where you store your mails.
21713 However, you can also create, e.g., a new @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml}
21714 server exclusively for @code{nnmairix} in your secondary select methods
21715 (@pxref{Finding the News}). If you use a secondary @code{nnml} server
21716 just for mairix, make sure that you explicitly set the server variable
21717 @code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}, or you might lose mail
21718 (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). If you want to use mairix remotely on an
21719 @acronym{IMAP} server, you have to choose the corresponding
21720 @code{nnimap} server here.
21721
21722 @item
21723 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-search-options
21724 The @strong{command} to call the mairix binary. This will usually just
21725 be @code{mairix}, but you can also choose something like @code{ssh
21726 SERVER mairix} if you want to call mairix remotely, e.g., on your
21727 @acronym{IMAP} server. If you want to add some default options to
21728 mairix, you could do this here, but better use the variable
21729 @code{nnmairix-mairix-search-options} instead.
21730
21731 @item
21732 The name of the @strong{default search group}. This will be the group
21733 where all temporary mairix searches are stored, i.e., all searches which
21734 are not bound to permanent @code{nnmairix} groups. Choose whatever you
21735 like.
21736
21737 @item
21738 If the mail back end is @code{nnimap} or @code{nnmaildir}, you will be
21739 asked if you work with @strong{Maildir++}, i.e., with hidden maildir
21740 folders (=beginning with a dot). For example, you have to answer
21741 @samp{yes} here if you work with the Dovecot @acronym{IMAP}
21742 server. Otherwise, you should answer @samp{no} here.
21743
21744 @end itemize
21745
21746 @node nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21747 @subsection nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21748
21749 In group mode:
21750
21751 @table @kbd
21752
21753 @item G b c
21754 @kindex G b c (Group)
21755 @findex nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group
21756 Creates @code{nnmairix} server and default search group for this server
21757 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). You should have done
21758 this by now (@pxref{Configuring nnmairix}).
21759
21760 @item G b s
21761 @kindex G b s (Group)
21762 @findex nnmairix-search
21763 Prompts for query which is then sent to the mairix binary. Search
21764 results are put into the default search group which is automatically
21765 displayed (@code{nnmairix-search}).
21766
21767 @item G b m
21768 @kindex G b m (Group)
21769 @findex nnmairix-widget-search
21770 Allows you to create a mairix search or a permanent group more
21771 comfortably using graphical widgets, similar to a customization
21772 group. Just try it to see how it works (@code{nnmairix-widget-search}).
21773
21774 @item G b i
21775 @kindex G b i (Group)
21776 @findex nnmairix-search-interactive
21777 Another command for creating a mairix query more comfortably, but uses
21778 only the minibuffer (@code{nnmairix-search-interactive}).
21779
21780 @item G b g
21781 @kindex G b g (Group)
21782 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group
21783 Creates a permanent group which is associated with a search query
21784 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group}). The @code{nnmairix} back end
21785 automatically calls mairix when you update this group with @kbd{g} or
21786 @kbd{M-g}.
21787
21788 @item G b q
21789 @kindex G b q (Group)
21790 @findex nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group
21791 Changes the search query for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor
21792 (@code{nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group}).
21793
21794 @item G b t
21795 @kindex G b t (Group)
21796 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group
21797 Toggles the 'threads' parameter for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor,
21798 i.e., if you want see the whole threads of the found messages
21799 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group}).
21800
21801 @item G b u
21802 @kindex G b u (Group)
21803 @findex nnmairix-update-database
21804 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-update-options
21805 Calls mairix binary for updating the database
21806 (@code{nnmairix-update-database}). The default parameters are @code{-F}
21807 and @code{-Q} for making this as fast as possible (see variable
21808 @code{nnmairix-mairix-update-options} for defining these default
21809 options).
21810
21811 @item G b r
21812 @kindex G b r (Group)
21813 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group
21814 Keep articles in this @code{nnmairix} group always read or unread, or leave the
21815 marks unchanged (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group}).
21816
21817 @item G b d
21818 @kindex G b d (Group)
21819 @findex nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group
21820 Recreate @code{nnmairix} group on the ``real'' mail back end
21821 (@code{nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group}). You can do this if
21822 you always get wrong article counts with a @code{nnmairix} group.
21823
21824 @item G b a
21825 @kindex G b a (Group)
21826 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group
21827 Toggles the @code{allow-fast} parameters for group under cursor
21828 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group}). The default
21829 behavior of @code{nnmairix} is to do a mairix search every time you
21830 update or enter the group. With the @code{allow-fast} parameter set,
21831 mairix will only be called when you explicitly update the group, but not
21832 upon entering. This makes entering the group faster, but it may also
21833 lead to dangling symlinks if something changed between updating and
21834 entering the group which is not yet in the mairix database.
21835
21836 @item G b p
21837 @kindex G b p (Group)
21838 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group
21839 Toggle marks propagation for this group
21840 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group}). (@pxref{Propagating
21841 marks}).
21842
21843 @item G b o
21844 @kindex G b o (Group)
21845 @findex nnmairix-propagate-marks
21846 Manually propagate marks (@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks}); needed only when
21847 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} is set to @code{nil}.
21848
21849 @end table
21850
21851 In summary mode:
21852
21853 @table @kbd
21854
21855 @item $ m
21856 @kindex $ m (Summary)
21857 @findex nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article
21858 Allows you to create a mairix query or group based on the current
21859 message using graphical widgets (same as @code{nnmairix-widget-search})
21860 (@code{nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article}).
21861
21862 @item $ g
21863 @kindex $ g (Summary)
21864 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message
21865 Interactively creates a new search group with query based on the current
21866 message, but uses the minibuffer instead of graphical widgets
21867 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message}).
21868
21869 @item $ t
21870 @kindex $ t (Summary)
21871 @findex nnmairix-search-thread-this-article
21872 Searches thread for the current article
21873 (@code{nnmairix-search-thread-this-article}). This is effectively a
21874 shortcut for calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{m:msgid} of the
21875 current article and enabled threads.
21876
21877 @item $ f
21878 @kindex $ f (Summary)
21879 @findex nnmairix-search-from-this-article
21880 Searches all messages from sender of the current article
21881 (@code{nnmairix-search-from-this-article}). This is a shortcut for
21882 calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{f:From}.
21883
21884 @item $ o
21885 @kindex $ o (Summary)
21886 @findex nnmairix-goto-original-article
21887 (Only in @code{nnmairix} groups!) Tries determine the group this article
21888 originally came from and displays the article in this group, so that,
21889 e.g., replying to this article the correct posting styles/group
21890 parameters are applied (@code{nnmairix-goto-original-article}). This
21891 function will use the registry if available, but can also parse the
21892 article file name as a fallback method.
21893
21894 @item $ u
21895 @kindex $ u (Summary)
21896 @findex nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article
21897 Remove possibly existing tick mark from original article
21898 (@code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article}). (@pxref{nnmairix
21899 tips and tricks}).
21900
21901 @end table
21902
21903 @node Propagating marks
21904 @subsection Propagating marks
21905
21906 First of: you really need a patched mairix binary for using the marks
21907 propagation feature efficiently. Otherwise, you would have to update
21908 the mairix database all the time. You can get the patch at
21909
21910 @uref{http://www.randomsample.de/mairix-maildir-patch.tar}
21911
21912 You need the mairix v0.21 source code for this patch; everything else
21913 is explained in the accompanied readme file. If you don't want to use
21914 marks propagation, you don't have to apply these patches, but they also
21915 fix some annoyances regarding changing maildir flags, so it might still
21916 be useful to you.
21917
21918 With the patched mairix binary, you can use @code{nnmairix} as an
21919 alternative to mail splitting (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}). For
21920 example, instead of splitting all mails from @samp{david@@foobar.com}
21921 into a group, you can simply create a search group with the query
21922 @samp{f:david@@foobar.com}. This is actually what ``smart folders'' are
21923 all about: simply put everything in one mail folder and dynamically
21924 create searches instead of splitting. This is more flexible, since you
21925 can dynamically change your folders any time you want to. This also
21926 implies that you will usually read your mails in the @code{nnmairix}
21927 groups instead of your ``real'' mail groups.
21928
21929 There is one problem, though: say you got a new mail from
21930 @samp{david@@foobar.com}; it will now show up in two groups, the
21931 ``real'' group (your INBOX, for example) and in the @code{nnmairix}
21932 search group (provided you have updated the mairix database). Now you
21933 enter the @code{nnmairix} group and read the mail. The mail will be
21934 marked as read, but only in the @code{nnmairix} group---in the ``real''
21935 mail group it will be still shown as unread.
21936
21937 You could now catch up the mail group (@pxref{Group Data}), but this is
21938 tedious and error prone, since you may overlook mails you don't have
21939 created @code{nnmairix} groups for. Of course, you could first use
21940 @code{nnmairix-goto-original-article} (@pxref{nnmairix keyboard
21941 shortcuts}) and then read the mail in the original group, but that's
21942 even more cumbersome.
21943
21944 Clearly, the easiest way would be if marks could somehow be
21945 automatically set for the original article. This is exactly what
21946 @emph{marks propagation} is about.
21947
21948 Marks propagation is inactive by default. You can activate it for a
21949 certain @code{nnmairix} group with
21950 @code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group} (bound to @kbd{G b
21951 p}). This function will warn you if you try to use it with your default
21952 search group; the reason is that the default search group is used for
21953 temporary searches, and it's easy to accidentally propagate marks from
21954 this group. However, you can ignore this warning if you really want to.
21955
21956 With marks propagation enabled, all the marks you set in a @code{nnmairix}
21957 group should now be propagated to the original article. For example,
21958 you can now tick an article (by default with @kbd{!}) and this mark should
21959 magically be set for the original article, too.
21960
21961 A few more remarks which you may or may not want to know:
21962
21963 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close
21964 Marks will not be set immediately, but only upon closing a group. This
21965 not only makes marks propagation faster, it also avoids problems with
21966 dangling symlinks when dealing with maildir files (since changing flags
21967 will change the file name). You can also control when to propagate marks
21968 via @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} (see the doc-string for
21969 details).
21970
21971 Obviously, @code{nnmairix} will have to look up the original group for every
21972 article you want to set marks for. If available, @code{nnmairix} will first
21973 use the registry for determining the original group. The registry is very
21974 fast, hence you should really, really enable the registry when using
21975 marks propagation. If you don't have to worry about RAM and disc space,
21976 set @code{gnus-registry-max-entries} to a large enough value; to be on
21977 the safe side, choose roughly the amount of mails you index with mairix.
21978
21979 @vindex nnmairix-only-use-registry
21980 If you don't want to use the registry or the registry hasn't seen the
21981 original article yet, @code{nnmairix} will use an additional mairix
21982 search for determining the file name of the article. This, of course, is
21983 way slower than the registry---if you set hundreds or even thousands of
21984 marks this way, it might take some time. You can avoid this situation by
21985 setting @code{nnmairix-only-use-registry} to @code{t}.
21986
21987 Maybe you also want to propagate marks the other way round, i.e., if you
21988 tick an article in a "real" mail group, you'd like to have the same
21989 article in a @code{nnmairix} group ticked, too. For several good
21990 reasons, this can only be done efficiently if you use maildir. To
21991 immediately contradict myself, let me mention that it WON'T work with
21992 @code{nnmaildir}, since @code{nnmaildir} stores the marks externally and
21993 not in the file name. Therefore, propagating marks to @code{nnmairix}
21994 groups will usually only work if you use an IMAP server which uses
21995 maildir as its file format.
21996
21997 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups
21998 If you work with this setup, just set
21999 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t} and see what
22000 happens. If you don't like what you see, just set it to @code{nil} again.
22001 One problem might be that you get a wrong number of unread articles; this
22002 usually happens when you delete or expire articles in the original
22003 groups. When this happens, you can recreate the @code{nnmairix} group on
22004 the back end using @kbd{G b d}.
22005
22006 @node nnmairix tips and tricks
22007 @subsection nnmairix tips and tricks
22008
22009 @itemize
22010 @item
22011 Checking Mail
22012
22013 @findex nnmairix-update-groups
22014 I put all my important mail groups at group level 1. The mairix groups
22015 have group level 5, so they do not get checked at start up (@pxref{Group
22016 Levels}).
22017
22018 I use the following to check for mails:
22019
22020 @lisp
22021 (defun my-check-mail-mairix-update (level)
22022 (interactive "P")
22023 ;; if no prefix given, set level=1
22024 (gnus-group-get-new-news (or level 1))
22025 (nnmairix-update-groups "mairixsearch" t t)
22026 (gnus-group-list-groups))
22027
22028 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map "g" 'my-check-mail-mairix-update)
22029 @end lisp
22030
22031 Instead of @samp{"mairixsearch"} use the name of your @code{nnmairix}
22032 server. See the doc string for @code{nnmairix-update-groups} for
22033 details.
22034
22035 @item
22036 Example: search group for ticked articles
22037
22038 For example, you can create a group for all ticked articles, where the
22039 articles always stay unread:
22040
22041 Hit @kbd{G b g}, enter group name (e.g., @samp{important}), use
22042 @samp{F:f} as query and do not include threads.
22043
22044 Now activate marks propagation for this group by using @kbd{G b p}. Then
22045 activate the always-unread feature by using @kbd{G b r} twice.
22046
22047 So far so good---but how do you remove the tick marks in the @code{nnmairix}
22048 group? There are two options: You may simply use
22049 @code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article} (bound to @kbd{$ u}) to remove
22050 tick marks from the original article. The other possibility is to set
22051 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t}, but see the above
22052 comments about this option. If it works for you, the tick marks should
22053 also exist in the @code{nnmairix} group and you can remove them as usual,
22054 e.g., by marking an article as read.
22055
22056 When you have removed a tick mark from the original article, this
22057 article should vanish from the @code{nnmairix} group after you have updated the
22058 mairix database and updated the group. Fortunately, there is a function
22059 for doing exactly that: @code{nnmairix-update-groups}. See the previous code
22060 snippet and the doc string for details.
22061
22062 @item
22063 Dealing with auto-subscription of mail groups
22064
22065 As described before, all @code{nnmairix} groups are in fact stored on
22066 the mail back end in the form @samp{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can
22067 see them when you enter the back end server in the server buffer. You
22068 should not subscribe these groups! Unfortunately, these groups will
22069 usually get @emph{auto-subscribed} when you use @code{nnmaildir} or
22070 @code{nnml}, i.e., you will suddenly see groups of the form
22071 @samp{zz_mairix*} pop up in your group buffer. If this happens to you,
22072 simply kill these groups with C-k. For avoiding this, turn off
22073 auto-subscription completely by setting the variable
22074 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups} to @code{nil} (@pxref{Filtering New
22075 Groups}), or if you like to keep this feature use the following kludge
22076 for turning it off for all groups beginning with @samp{zz_}:
22077
22078 @lisp
22079 (setq gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
22080 "^\\(nnml\\|nnfolder\\|nnmbox\\|nnmh\\|nnbabyl\\|nnmaildir\\).*:\\([^z]\\|z$\\|\\z[^z]\\|zz$\\|zz[^_]\\|zz_$\\).*")
22081 @end lisp
22082
22083 @end itemize
22084
22085 @node nnmairix caveats
22086 @subsection nnmairix caveats
22087
22088 @itemize
22089 @item
22090 You can create a secondary @code{nnml} server just for nnmairix, but then
22091 you have to explicitly set the corresponding server variable
22092 @code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}. Otherwise, new mail might get
22093 put into this secondary server (and would never show up again). Here's
22094 an example server definition:
22095
22096 @lisp
22097 (nnml "mairix" (nnml-directory "mairix") (nnml-get-new-mail nil))
22098 @end lisp
22099
22100 (The @code{nnmaildir} back end also has a server variable
22101 @code{get-new-mail}, but its default value is @code{nil}, so you don't
22102 have to explicitly set it if you use a @code{nnmaildir} server just for
22103 mairix.)
22104
22105 @item
22106 If you use the Gnus registry: don't use the registry with
22107 @code{nnmairix} groups (put them in
22108 @code{gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups}; this is the default). Be
22109 @emph{extra careful} if you use
22110 @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}; mails which are split
22111 into @code{nnmairix} groups are usually gone for good as soon as you
22112 check the group for new mail (yes, it has happened to me...).
22113
22114 @item
22115 Therefore: @emph{Never ever} put ``real'' mails into @code{nnmairix}
22116 groups (you shouldn't be able to, anyway).
22117
22118 @item
22119 If you use the Gnus agent (@pxref{Gnus Unplugged}): don't agentize
22120 @code{nnmairix} groups (though I have no idea what happens if you do).
22121
22122 @item
22123 mairix does only support us-ascii characters.
22124
22125 @item
22126 @code{nnmairix} uses a rather brute force method to force Gnus to
22127 completely reread the group on the mail back end after mairix was
22128 called---it simply deletes and re-creates the group on the mail
22129 back end. So far, this has worked for me without any problems, and I
22130 don't see how @code{nnmairix} could delete other mail groups than its
22131 own, but anyway: you really should have a backup of your mail
22132 folders.
22133
22134 @item
22135 All necessary information is stored in the group parameters
22136 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). This has the advantage that no active file
22137 is needed, but also implies that when you kill a @code{nnmairix} group,
22138 it is gone for good.
22139
22140 @item
22141 @findex nnmairix-purge-old-groups
22142 If you create and kill a lot of @code{nnmairix} groups, the
22143 ``zz_mairix-*'' groups will accumulate on the mail back end server. To
22144 delete old groups which are no longer needed, call
22145 @code{nnmairix-purge-old-groups}. Note that this assumes that you don't
22146 save any ``real'' mail in folders of the form
22147 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can change the prefix of
22148 @code{nnmairix} groups by changing the variable
22149 @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
22150
22151 @item
22152 The following only applies if you @emph{don't} use the mentioned patch
22153 for mairix (@pxref{Propagating marks}):
22154
22155 A problem can occur when using @code{nnmairix} with maildir folders and
22156 comes with the fact that maildir stores mail flags like @samp{Seen} or
22157 @samp{Replied} by appending chars @samp{S} and @samp{R} to the message
22158 file name, respectively. This implies that currently you would have to
22159 update the mairix database not only when new mail arrives, but also when
22160 mail flags are changing. The same applies to new mails which are indexed
22161 while they are still in the @samp{new} folder but then get moved to
22162 @samp{cur} when Gnus has seen the mail. If you don't update the database
22163 after this has happened, a mairix query can lead to symlinks pointing to
22164 non-existing files. In Gnus, these messages will usually appear with
22165 ``(none)'' entries in the header and can't be accessed. If this happens
22166 to you, using @kbd{G b u} and updating the group will usually fix this.
22167
22168 @end itemize
22169
22170 @iftex
22171 @iflatex
22172 @chapter Message
22173 @include message.texi
22174 @chapter Emacs MIME
22175 @include emacs-mime.texi
22176 @chapter Sieve
22177 @include sieve.texi
22178 @chapter EasyPG
22179 @include epa.texi
22180 @chapter SASL
22181 @include sasl.texi
22182 @end iflatex
22183 @end iftex
22184
22185 @node Various
22186 @chapter Various
22187
22188 @menu
22189 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
22190 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
22191 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
22192 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
22193 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
22194 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
22195 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
22196 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
22197 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
22198 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
22199 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
22200 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
22201 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
22202 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
22203 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
22204 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
22205 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
22206 * The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
22207 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
22208 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
22209 @end menu
22210
22211
22212 @node Process/Prefix
22213 @section Process/Prefix
22214 @cindex process/prefix convention
22215
22216 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
22217 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
22218
22219 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
22220 command to be performed on.
22221
22222 It goes like this:
22223
22224 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
22225 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
22226 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
22227 with the current one.
22228
22229 @vindex transient-mark-mode
22230 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
22231 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
22232
22233 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
22234 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
22235 the process mark.
22236
22237 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
22238 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
22239
22240 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
22241 are avoided.
22242
22243 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
22244 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
22245 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
22246 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
22247
22248 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
22249 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
22250 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
22251 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
22252 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
22253 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
22254 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
22255 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
22256
22257 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
22258 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
22259 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
22260 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
22261 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
22262
22263
22264 @node Interactive
22265 @section Interactive
22266 @cindex interaction
22267
22268 @table @code
22269
22270 @item gnus-novice-user
22271 @vindex gnus-novice-user
22272 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
22273 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
22274 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
22275 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
22276 default.
22277
22278 @item gnus-expert-user
22279 @vindex gnus-expert-user
22280 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
22281 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing,
22282 no matter how strange. For example, quitting Gnus, exiting a group
22283 without an update, catching up with a group, deleting expired
22284 articles, and replying by mail to a news message will not require
22285 confirmation.
22286
22287 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
22288 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
22289 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
22290 is @code{t} by default.
22291
22292 @item gnus-interactive-exit
22293 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
22294 If non-@code{nil}, require a confirmation when exiting Gnus. If
22295 @code{quiet}, update any active summary buffers automatically without
22296 querying. The default value is @code{t}.
22297 @end table
22298
22299
22300 @node Symbolic Prefixes
22301 @section Symbolic Prefixes
22302 @cindex symbolic prefixes
22303
22304 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
22305 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
22306 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
22307 rule of 900 to the current article.
22308
22309 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
22310 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
22311 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
22312 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
22313 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
22314 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
22315 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
22316
22317 @kindex M-i (Summary)
22318 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
22319 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
22320 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
22321 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
22322 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
22323 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
22324 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
22325 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
22326
22327 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
22328 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
22329 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
22330
22331 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
22332 Interactive}.
22333
22334
22335 @node Formatting Variables
22336 @section Formatting Variables
22337 @cindex formatting variables
22338
22339 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
22340 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
22341 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
22342 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
22343 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
22344 be annoyed by.
22345
22346 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
22347 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
22348 lots of percentages everywhere.
22349
22350 @menu
22351 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
22352 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
22353 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
22354 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
22355 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
22356 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
22357 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
22358 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
22359 @end menu
22360
22361 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
22362 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
22363 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
22364 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
22365 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
22366 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
22367 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
22368 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
22369
22370 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
22371 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
22372
22373 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
22374 @findex gnus-update-format
22375 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
22376 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
22377 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
22378 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
22379
22380
22381
22382 @node Formatting Basics
22383 @subsection Formatting Basics
22384
22385 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
22386 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
22387 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
22388
22389 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
22390 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
22391 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
22392 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
22393 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
22394 the right instead.
22395
22396 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
22397 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
22398 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
22399 less than 4 characters wide.
22400
22401 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
22402 @samp{%&user-date;}.
22403
22404
22405 @node Mode Line Formatting
22406 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
22407
22408 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
22409 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
22410 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
22411 with the following two differences:
22412
22413 @enumerate
22414
22415 @item
22416 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
22417
22418 @item
22419 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
22420 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
22421 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
22422 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
22423 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
22424 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
22425 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
22426
22427 @end enumerate
22428
22429
22430 @node Advanced Formatting
22431 @subsection Advanced Formatting
22432
22433 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
22434 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
22435 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
22436 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
22437
22438 These are the valid modifiers:
22439
22440 @table @code
22441 @item pad
22442 @itemx pad-left
22443 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
22444 length.
22445
22446 @item pad-right
22447 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
22448 length.
22449
22450 @item max
22451 @itemx max-left
22452 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
22453
22454 @item max-right
22455 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
22456 length.
22457
22458 @item cut
22459 @itemx cut-left
22460 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
22461
22462 @item cut-right
22463 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
22464
22465 @item ignore
22466 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
22467
22468 @item form
22469 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
22470 used.
22471
22472 Here's an example:
22473
22474 @lisp
22475 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
22476 @end lisp
22477
22478 @end table
22479
22480 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
22481 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
22482 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
22483 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
22484 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
22485 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
22486 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
22487
22488 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
22489 last operation, padding.
22490
22491
22492 @node User-Defined Specs
22493 @subsection User-Defined Specs
22494
22495 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
22496 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
22497 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
22498 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
22499 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
22500 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
22501 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
22502 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
22503 should protect against that.
22504
22505 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
22506 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
22507
22508 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
22509 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
22510 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
22511 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
22512 inserted.
22513
22514
22515 @node Formatting Fonts
22516 @subsection Formatting Fonts
22517
22518 @cindex %(, %)
22519 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
22520 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
22521 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
22522 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
22523 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
22524 over it.
22525
22526 @cindex %@{, %@}
22527 @vindex gnus-face-0
22528 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
22529 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
22530 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
22531 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
22532 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
22533 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
22534
22535 @cindex %<<, %>>, guillemets
22536 @c @cindex %<<, %>>, %«, %», guillemets
22537 @vindex gnus-balloon-face-0
22538 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
22539 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
22540 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
22541 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
22542 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
22543 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
22544 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
22545 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
22546 (in Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
22547 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
22548 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
22549 paragraph.)
22550
22551 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
22552
22553 @lisp
22554 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
22555 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
22556 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
22557
22558 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
22559 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
22560 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
22561 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
22562 ;; @r{Set the color.}
22563 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
22564 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
22565
22566 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
22567 (setq gnus-group-line-format
22568 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
22569 @end lisp
22570
22571 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
22572 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
22573
22574 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
22575 mode-line variables.
22576
22577 @node Positioning Point
22578 @subsection Positioning Point
22579
22580 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
22581 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
22582 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
22583
22584 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
22585
22586 @findex gnus-goto-colon
22587 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
22588 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
22589
22590 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
22591 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
22592 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
22593 place point there.
22594
22595
22596 @node Tabulation
22597 @subsection Tabulation
22598
22599 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
22600 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
22601 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
22602 about lining up the following text afterwards.
22603
22604 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
22605 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
22606
22607 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
22608 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
22609 This is the soft tabulator.
22610
22611 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
22612 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
22613 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
22614
22615
22616 @node Wide Characters
22617 @subsection Wide Characters
22618
22619 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
22620 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
22621 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
22622
22623 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
22624 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
22625 these countries, that's not true.
22626
22627 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
22628 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
22629 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
22630 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
22631 for Emacs.
22632
22633
22634 @node Window Layout
22635 @section Window Layout
22636 @cindex window layout
22637
22638 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
22639
22640 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
22641 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
22642 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
22643 @code{t} by default.
22644
22645 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
22646 glitches. Use at your own peril.
22647
22648 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
22649 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
22650 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
22651
22652 @lisp
22653 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)))
22654 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22655 (article 1.0))))
22656 @end lisp
22657
22658 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
22659 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
22660 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
22661 possible names is listed below.
22662
22663 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
22664 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example:
22665
22666 @lisp
22667 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22668 (article 1.0)))
22669 @end lisp
22670
22671 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
22672 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
22673 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
22674 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
22675 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
22676 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
22677 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
22678 size spec per split.
22679
22680 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
22681 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
22682 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e., is the third or
22683 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
22684 present) gets focus.
22685
22686 Here's a more complicated example:
22687
22688 @lisp
22689 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
22690 (summary 0.25 point)
22691 (article 1.0)))
22692 @end lisp
22693
22694 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
22695 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
22696 occupy, not a percentage.
22697
22698 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
22699 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
22700 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
22701 be used as a split.
22702
22703 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
22704
22705 @lisp
22706 (article (horizontal 1.0
22707 (vertical 0.5
22708 (group 1.0))
22709 (vertical 1.0
22710 (summary 0.25 point)
22711 (article 1.0))))
22712 @end lisp
22713
22714 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
22715 @code{horizontal} thingie?
22716
22717 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
22718 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
22719 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
22720 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
22721 the screen is to be given to this strip.
22722
22723 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
22724 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
22725 lines from the splits.
22726
22727 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
22728 may look like:
22729
22730 @example
22731 @group
22732 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
22733 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
22734 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
22735 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
22736 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
22737 size = number | frame-params
22738 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
22739 @end group
22740 @end example
22741
22742 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
22743 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
22744 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
22745 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
22746
22747 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
22748 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
22749 @cindex window height
22750 @cindex window width
22751 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
22752 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
22753 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
22754 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
22755 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
22756 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
22757
22758 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
22759 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
22760 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
22761 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
22762
22763 @findex gnus-configure-frame
22764 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
22765 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
22766 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
22767 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
22768 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
22769 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
22770 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
22771 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
22772 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
22773 configuration list.
22774
22775 @lisp
22776 (gnus-configure-frame
22777 '(horizontal 1.0
22778 (vertical 10
22779 (group 1.0)
22780 (article 0.3 point))
22781 (vertical 1.0
22782 (article 1.0)
22783 (horizontal 4
22784 (group 1.0)
22785 (article 10)))))
22786 @end lisp
22787
22788 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
22789 @code{frame} split:
22790
22791 @lisp
22792 (gnus-configure-frame
22793 '(frame 1.0
22794 (vertical 1.0
22795 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
22796 (article 1.0))
22797 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
22798 (user-position . t)
22799 (left . -1) (top . 1))
22800 (picon 1.0))))
22801
22802 @end lisp
22803
22804 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
22805 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
22806 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
22807 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
22808 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
22809 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
22810 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
22811 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
22812 is such a plist.
22813 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
22814 be found in its default value.
22815
22816 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
22817 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
22818 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
22819 might be used:
22820
22821 @lisp
22822 (message (horizontal 1.0
22823 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
22824 (vertical 0.24
22825 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
22826 '(summary 0.5))
22827 (group 1.0))))
22828 @end lisp
22829
22830 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
22831 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
22832 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
22833
22834 @lisp
22835 (message
22836 (frame 1.0
22837 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
22838 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
22839 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
22840 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
22841 (name . "Message"))
22842 (message 1.0 point))))
22843 @end lisp
22844
22845 @findex gnus-add-configuration
22846 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
22847 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
22848 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
22849 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
22850
22851 @lisp
22852 (gnus-add-configuration
22853 '(article (vertical 1.0
22854 (group 4)
22855 (summary .25 point)
22856 (article 1.0))))
22857 @end lisp
22858
22859 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
22860 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
22861 Gnus has been loaded.
22862
22863 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
22864 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
22865 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
22866 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
22867 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
22868
22869 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
22870 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
22871 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
22872 windows resized.
22873
22874 @subsection Window Configuration Names
22875
22876 Here's a list of most of the currently known window configurations,
22877 and when they're used:
22878
22879 @table @code
22880 @item group
22881 The group buffer.
22882
22883 @item summary
22884 Entering a group and showing only the summary.
22885
22886 @item article
22887 Selecting an article.
22888
22889 @item server
22890 The server buffer.
22891
22892 @item browse
22893 Browsing groups from the server buffer.
22894
22895 @item message
22896 Composing a (new) message.
22897
22898 @item only-article
22899 Showing only the article buffer.
22900
22901 @item edit-article
22902 Editing an article.
22903
22904 @item edit-form
22905 Editing group parameters and the like.
22906
22907 @item edit-score
22908 Editing a server definition.
22909
22910 @item post
22911 Composing a news message.
22912
22913 @item reply
22914 Replying or following up an article without yanking the text.
22915
22916 @item forward
22917 Forwarding a message.
22918
22919 @item reply-yank
22920 Replying or following up an article with yanking the text.
22921
22922 @item mail-bound
22923 Bouncing a message.
22924
22925 @item pipe
22926 Sending an article to an external process.
22927
22928 @item bug
22929 Sending a bug report.
22930
22931 @item score-trace
22932 Displaying the score trace.
22933
22934 @item score-words
22935 Displaying the score words.
22936
22937 @item split-trace
22938 Displaying the split trace.
22939
22940 @item compose-bounce
22941 Composing a bounce message.
22942
22943 @item mml-preview
22944 Previewing a @acronym{MIME} part.
22945
22946 @end table
22947
22948
22949 @subsection Example Window Configurations
22950
22951 @itemize @bullet
22952 @item
22953 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
22954 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
22955
22956 @ifinfo
22957 @example
22958 +---+---------+
22959 | G | Summary |
22960 | r +---------+
22961 | o | |
22962 | u | Article |
22963 | p | |
22964 +---+---------+
22965 @end example
22966 @end ifinfo
22967
22968 @lisp
22969 (gnus-add-configuration
22970 '(article
22971 (horizontal 1.0
22972 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22973 (vertical 1.0
22974 (summary 0.16 point)
22975 (article 1.0)))))
22976
22977 (gnus-add-configuration
22978 '(summary
22979 (horizontal 1.0
22980 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22981 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
22982 @end lisp
22983
22984 @end itemize
22985
22986
22987 @node Faces and Fonts
22988 @section Faces and Fonts
22989 @cindex faces
22990 @cindex fonts
22991 @cindex colors
22992
22993 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
22994 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
22995 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
22996 interface.
22997
22998
22999 @node Mode Lines
23000 @section Mode Lines
23001 @cindex mode lines
23002
23003 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
23004 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
23005 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
23006 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
23007 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
23008 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
23009 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
23010 quicker.
23011
23012 @cindex display-time
23013
23014 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
23015 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
23016 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
23017 to display (e.g., the subject of the article) is often longer than the
23018 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
23019 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
23020 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
23021 additional elements on the mode line (e.g., a clock), you should modify
23022 this variable:
23023
23024 @c Hook written by Francesco Potortì <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
23025 @lisp
23026 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
23027 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
23028 (+ 21
23029 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
23030 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
23031 (length display-time-string)))))
23032 @end lisp
23033
23034 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
23035 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
23036 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
23037 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
23038 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
23039
23040
23041 @node Highlighting and Menus
23042 @section Highlighting and Menus
23043 @cindex visual
23044 @cindex highlighting
23045 @cindex menus
23046
23047 @vindex gnus-visual
23048 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
23049 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
23050 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
23051 file.
23052
23053 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
23054 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
23055
23056 @table @code
23057 @item group-highlight
23058 Do highlights in the group buffer.
23059 @item summary-highlight
23060 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
23061 @item article-highlight
23062 Do highlights in the article buffer.
23063 @item highlight
23064 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
23065 @item group-menu
23066 Create menus in the group buffer.
23067 @item summary-menu
23068 Create menus in the summary buffers.
23069 @item article-menu
23070 Create menus in the article buffer.
23071 @item browse-menu
23072 Create menus in the browse buffer.
23073 @item server-menu
23074 Create menus in the server buffer.
23075 @item score-menu
23076 Create menus in the score buffers.
23077 @item menu
23078 Create menus in all buffers.
23079 @end table
23080
23081 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
23082 buffers, you could say something like:
23083
23084 @lisp
23085 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
23086 @end lisp
23087
23088 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
23089
23090 @lisp
23091 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
23092 @end lisp
23093
23094 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
23095 in all Gnus buffers.
23096
23097 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
23098
23099 @table @code
23100 @item gnus-mouse-face
23101 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
23102 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
23103 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
23104
23105 @end table
23106
23107 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
23108
23109 @table @code
23110
23111 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
23112 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
23113 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
23114
23115 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
23116 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
23117 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
23118
23119 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
23120 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
23121 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
23122
23123 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
23124 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
23125 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
23126
23127 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
23128 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
23129 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
23130
23131 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
23132 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
23133 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
23134
23135 @end table
23136
23137
23138 @node Daemons
23139 @section Daemons
23140 @cindex demons
23141 @cindex daemons
23142
23143 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
23144 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
23145 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
23146 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
23147 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
23148
23149 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
23150 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
23151 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
23152
23153 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
23154 been idle for thirty minutes:
23155
23156 @lisp
23157 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
23158 @end lisp
23159
23160 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
23161 Emacs is idle:
23162
23163 @lisp
23164 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
23165 @end lisp
23166
23167 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
23168 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
23169 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23170
23171 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
23172 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
23173 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
23174 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23175
23176 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
23177 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
23178 @var{idle} minutes.
23179
23180 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
23181 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
23182 minutes.
23183
23184 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
23185 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
23186 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
23187
23188 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
23189 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
23190 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
23191 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
23192
23193 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
23194 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23195
23196 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
23197 @lisp
23198 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
23199 @end lisp
23200
23201 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
23202 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
23203 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
23204 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
23205 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
23206 @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
23207 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
23208 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
23209 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
23210 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
23211
23212 @findex gnus-demon-init
23213 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
23214 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
23215 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
23216 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
23217 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
23218
23219 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
23220 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
23221 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
23222 behave.
23223
23224
23225 @node Undo
23226 @section Undo
23227 @cindex undo
23228
23229 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
23230 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
23231 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
23232
23233 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
23234 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
23235 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
23236 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
23237 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
23238 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
23239 @code{undo} function.
23240
23241 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
23242 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
23243 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
23244 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
23245 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
23246 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
23247 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
23248 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
23249 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
23250 never be totally undoable.
23251
23252 @findex gnus-undo-mode
23253 @vindex gnus-use-undo
23254 @findex gnus-undo
23255 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
23256 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
23257 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
23258 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
23259 command.
23260
23261
23262 @node Predicate Specifiers
23263 @section Predicate Specifiers
23264 @cindex predicate specifiers
23265
23266 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
23267 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
23268 to type all that much.
23269
23270 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
23271
23272 Here's an example:
23273
23274 @lisp
23275 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
23276 gnus-article-unread-p)
23277 @end lisp
23278
23279 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
23280 functions all take one parameter.
23281
23282 @findex gnus-make-predicate
23283 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
23284 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
23285 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
23286 specifier.
23287
23288
23289 @node Moderation
23290 @section Moderation
23291 @cindex moderation
23292
23293 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
23294 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
23295 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
23296 get a copy.
23297
23298 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
23299 buffers. Put
23300
23301 @lisp
23302 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
23303 @end lisp
23304
23305 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
23306
23307 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
23308 supposed to work:
23309
23310 @enumerate
23311 @item
23312 You split your incoming mail by matching on
23313 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
23314 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
23315
23316 @item
23317 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
23318 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
23319
23320 @item
23321 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
23322 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
23323 @kbd{c} command.
23324 @end enumerate
23325
23326 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
23327
23328 @lisp
23329 (setq gnus-moderated-list
23330 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
23331 @end lisp
23332
23333
23334 @node Fetching a Group
23335 @section Fetching a Group
23336 @cindex fetching a group
23337
23338 @findex gnus-fetch-group
23339 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
23340 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
23341 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
23342 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
23343 It takes the group name as a parameter.
23344
23345
23346 @node Image Enhancements
23347 @section Image Enhancements
23348
23349 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
23350 support images, Emacs 22 does.} and up, are able to display pictures and
23351 stuff, so Gnus has taken advantage of that.
23352
23353 @menu
23354 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
23355 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
23356 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
23357 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
23358 * Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
23359 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
23360 @end menu
23361
23362
23363 @node X-Face
23364 @subsection X-Face
23365 @cindex x-face
23366
23367 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
23368 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
23369 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
23370 readers.
23371
23372 @cindex x-face
23373 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
23374 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
23375 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
23376 @iftex
23377 @iflatex
23378 \include{xface}
23379 @end iflatex
23380 @end iftex
23381 @c @anchor{X-Face}
23382
23383 Viewing an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
23384 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions have), or that you
23385 have suitable conversion or display programs installed. If your Emacs
23386 has image support the default action is to display the face before the
23387 @code{From} header. If there's no native @code{X-Face} support, Gnus
23388 will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using external programs
23389 from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends, see below. For XEmacs it's
23390 faster if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support. The
23391 default action under Emacs without image support is to fork off the
23392 @code{display} program.
23393
23394 On a GNU/Linux system, the @code{display} program is included in the
23395 ImageMagick package. For external conversion programs look for packages
23396 with names like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.
23397 On Windows, you may use the packages @code{netpbm} and @code{compface}
23398 from @url{http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net}. You need to add the
23399 @code{bin} directory to your @code{PATH} environment variable.
23400 @c In fact only the following DLLs and binaries seem to be required:
23401 @c compface1.dll uncompface.exe libnetpbm10.dll icontopbm.exe
23402
23403 The variable @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} controls which programs
23404 are used to display the @code{X-Face} header. If this variable is a
23405 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
23406 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
23407 If @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches the
23408 @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
23409
23410 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
23411 @code{xface}).
23412
23413 @noindent
23414 Face and variable:
23415
23416 @table @code
23417 @item gnus-x-face
23418 @vindex gnus-x-face
23419 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
23420 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
23421 default colors are black and white.
23422
23423 @item gnus-face-properties-alist
23424 @vindex gnus-face-properties-alist
23425 Alist of image types and properties applied to Face (@pxref{Face}) and
23426 X-Face images. The default value is @code{((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face))
23427 (png . nil))} for Emacs or @code{((xface . (:face gnus-x-face)))} for
23428 XEmacs. Here are examples:
23429
23430 @lisp
23431 ;; Specify the altitude of Face and X-Face images in the From header.
23432 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23433 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :ascent 80))
23434 (png . (:ascent 80))))
23435
23436 ;; Show Face and X-Face images as pressed buttons.
23437 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23438 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :relief -2))
23439 (png . (:relief -2))))
23440 @end lisp
23441
23442 @pxref{Image Descriptors, ,Image Descriptors, elisp, The Emacs Lisp
23443 Reference Manual} for the valid properties for various image types.
23444 Currently, @code{pbm} is used for X-Face images and @code{png} is used
23445 for Face images in Emacs. Only the @code{:face} property is effective
23446 on the @code{xface} image type in XEmacs if it is built with the
23447 @samp{libcompface} library.
23448 @end table
23449
23450 If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
23451 @code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
23452 provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
23453 insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages. You also need the
23454 above mentioned ImageMagick, netpbm or other image conversion packages
23455 (depending the values of the variables below) for these functions.
23456
23457 @findex gnus-random-x-face
23458 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
23459 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
23460 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
23461 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
23462 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
23463 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
23464 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
23465 header data as a string.
23466
23467 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
23468 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
23469 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
23470 randomly generated data.
23471
23472 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
23473 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
23474 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
23475 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
23476 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
23477
23478 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
23479 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23480
23481 @lisp
23482 (setq message-required-news-headers
23483 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23484 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
23485 @end lisp
23486
23487 Using the last function would be something like this:
23488
23489 @lisp
23490 (setq message-required-news-headers
23491 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23492 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
23493 (gnus-x-face-from-file
23494 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
23495 @end lisp
23496
23497
23498 @node Face
23499 @subsection Face
23500 @cindex face
23501
23502 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces' implementations should really be harmonized.
23503
23504 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
23505 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
23506 represent the author of the message.
23507
23508 @cindex face
23509 @findex gnus-article-display-face
23510 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
23511 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
23512 specifications.
23513
23514 The @code{gnus-face-properties-alist} variable affects the appearance of
23515 displayed Face images. @xref{X-Face}.
23516
23517 Viewing a @code{Face} header requires an Emacs that is able to display
23518 PNG images.
23519 @c Maybe add this:
23520 @c (if (featurep 'xemacs)
23521 @c (featurep 'png)
23522 @c (image-type-available-p 'png))
23523
23524 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
23525 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
23526
23527 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
23528 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
23529 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
23530
23531 @findex gnus-face-from-file
23532 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
23533 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
23534 converts the file to Face format by using the
23535 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
23536
23537 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
23538 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23539
23540 @lisp
23541 (setq message-required-news-headers
23542 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23543 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
23544 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
23545 @end lisp
23546
23547
23548 @node Smileys
23549 @subsection Smileys
23550 @cindex smileys
23551
23552 @iftex
23553 @iflatex
23554 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
23555 \input{smiley}
23556 @end iflatex
23557 @end iftex
23558
23559 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
23560 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
23561
23562 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
23563 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23564
23565 @lisp
23566 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
23567 @end lisp
23568
23569 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
23570 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
23571 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
23572 text and maps that to file names.
23573
23574 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
23575 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
23576 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
23577 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
23578 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
23579 displayed.
23580
23581 The following variables customize the appearance of the smileys:
23582
23583 @table @code
23584
23585 @item smiley-style
23586 @vindex smiley-style
23587 Specifies the smiley style. Predefined smiley styles include
23588 @code{low-color} (small 13x14 pixel, three-color images), @code{medium}
23589 (more colorful images, 16x16 pixel), and @code{grayscale} (grayscale
23590 images, 14x14 pixel). The default depends on the height of the default
23591 face.
23592
23593 @item smiley-data-directory
23594 @vindex smiley-data-directory
23595 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files. You shouldn't set this
23596 variable anymore. Customize @code{smiley-style} instead.
23597
23598 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
23599 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
23600 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
23601
23602 @end table
23603
23604
23605 @node Picons
23606 @subsection Picons
23607
23608 @iftex
23609 @iflatex
23610 \include{picons}
23611 @end iflatex
23612 @end iftex
23613
23614 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
23615 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
23616 over your shoulder as you read news.
23617
23618 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
23619
23620 @iftex
23621 @iflatex
23622 \margindex{}
23623 @end iflatex
23624 @end iftex
23625
23626 @quotation
23627 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
23628 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
23629 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
23630 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
23631 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
23632 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
23633 @code{GIF} formats.
23634 @end quotation
23635
23636 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23637 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
23638 point your Web browser at
23639 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
23640
23641 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
23642 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
23643
23644 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
23645 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
23646 Picons databases.
23647
23648 @vindex gnus-picon-style
23649 The variable @code{gnus-picon-style} controls how picons are displayed.
23650 If @code{inline}, the textual representation is replaced. If
23651 @code{right}, picons are added right to the textual representation.
23652
23653 @vindex gnus-picon-properties
23654 The value of the variable @code{gnus-picon-properties} is a list of
23655 properties applied to picons.
23656
23657 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
23658
23659 @table @code
23660
23661 @item gnus-picon-databases
23662 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23663 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
23664 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
23665 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
23666 "/usr/local/faces")}.
23667
23668 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
23669 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
23670 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23671 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
23672
23673 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
23674 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
23675 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
23676 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
23677
23678 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
23679 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
23680 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23681 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
23682 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
23683
23684 @item gnus-picon-file-types
23685 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
23686 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
23687 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
23688
23689 @item gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23690 @vindex gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23691 If non-@code{nil} (which is the default), don't display picons for
23692 things like @samp{.net} and @samp{.de}, which aren't usually very
23693 interesting.
23694
23695 @end table
23696
23697 @node Gravatars
23698 @subsection Gravatars
23699
23700 @iftex
23701 @iflatex
23702 \include{gravatars}
23703 @end iflatex
23704 @end iftex
23705
23706 A gravatar is an image registered to an e-mail address.
23707
23708 You can submit yours on-line at @uref{http://www.gravatar.com}.
23709
23710 The following variables offer control over how things are displayed.
23711
23712 @table @code
23713
23714 @item gnus-gravatar-size
23715 @vindex gnus-gravatar-size
23716 The size in pixels of gravatars. Gravatars are always square, so one
23717 number for the size is enough.
23718
23719 @item gnus-gravatar-properties
23720 @vindex gnus-gravatar-properties
23721 List of image properties applied to Gravatar images.
23722
23723 @item gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23724 @vindex gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23725 Regexp that matches mail addresses or names of people of which avatars
23726 should not be displayed, or @code{nil}. It default to the value of
23727 @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (@pxref{X-Face}).
23728
23729 @end table
23730
23731 If you want to see them in the From field, set:
23732 @lisp
23733 (setq gnus-treat-from-gravatar 'head)
23734 @end lisp
23735
23736 If you want to see them in the Cc and To fields, set:
23737
23738 @lisp
23739 (setq gnus-treat-mail-gravatar 'head)
23740 @end lisp
23741
23742
23743 @node XVarious
23744 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
23745
23746 @table @code
23747 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23748 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23749 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
23750 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
23751 unusual directory structure.
23752
23753 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23754 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23755 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
23756 default.
23757
23758 @end table
23759
23760 @subsubsection Toolbar
23761
23762 @table @code
23763
23764 @item gnus-use-toolbar
23765 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
23766 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
23767 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
23768 be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
23769 @code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
23770 toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
23771 names show. The default is @code{default}.
23772
23773 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
23774 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
23775 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
23776 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
23777 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
23778 The default is that of the default toolbar.
23779
23780 @item gnus-group-toolbar
23781 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
23782 The toolbar in the group buffer.
23783
23784 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
23785 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
23786 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
23787
23788 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23789 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23790 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
23791
23792 @end table
23793
23794 @iftex
23795 @iflatex
23796 \margindex{}
23797 @end iflatex
23798 @end iftex
23799
23800
23801 @node Fuzzy Matching
23802 @section Fuzzy Matching
23803 @cindex fuzzy matching
23804
23805 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
23806 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
23807
23808 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
23809 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
23810 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
23811
23812 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
23813 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
23814 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
23815 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
23816 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
23817
23818
23819 @node Thwarting Email Spam
23820 @section Thwarting Email Spam
23821 @cindex email spam
23822 @cindex spam
23823 @cindex UCE
23824 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23825
23826 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
23827 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
23828 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
23829 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
23830 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
23831 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
23832 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
23833 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
23834 in the end.
23835
23836 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
23837 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
23838 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
23839 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
23840 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
23841 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
23842
23843 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
23844
23845 @menu
23846 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
23847 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
23848 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
23849 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
23850 @end menu
23851
23852 @node The problem of spam
23853 @subsection The problem of spam
23854 @cindex email spam
23855 @cindex spam filtering approaches
23856 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
23857 @cindex UCE
23858 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23859
23860 First, some background on spam.
23861
23862 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
23863 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
23864 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
23865 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
23866 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
23867 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
23868 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
23869 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
23870 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
23871
23872 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
23873 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
23874 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
23875 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
23876 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
23877 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
23878 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
23879 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
23880 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
23881 and processing.
23882
23883 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
23884 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
23885 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
23886 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
23887 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
23888 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
23889 from Bulgarian IPs.
23890
23891 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
23892 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
23893 etc.)@: or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.)@: from contacting
23894 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
23895
23896 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
23897 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
23898 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
23899 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
23900
23901 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
23902 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
23903 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
23904 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
23905 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
23906 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
23907 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
23908 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
23909 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
23910
23911 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
23912 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
23913 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
23914 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
23915 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
23916 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
23917 down for some time because of the incident.
23918
23919 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
23920 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
23921 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
23922 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
23923 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
23924 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
23925 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
23926 to store the database of spam analysis. Statistical analysis on the
23927 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
23928 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
23929 the server that it has misclassified mail.
23930
23931 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
23932 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
23933 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
23934 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
23935 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
23936 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
23937 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
23938 spam plague.
23939
23940 @node Anti-Spam Basics
23941 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
23942 @cindex email spam
23943 @cindex spam
23944 @cindex UCE
23945 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23946
23947 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
23948 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
23949
23950 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
23951 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
23952 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
23953 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
23954 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
23955 part of the mail address.)
23956
23957 @lisp
23958 (setq message-default-news-headers
23959 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
23960 @end lisp
23961
23962 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
23963 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23964
23965 @lisp
23966 (...
23967 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
23968 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
23969 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
23970 "spam"))
23971 ...)
23972 @end lisp
23973
23974 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
23975 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
23976 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
23977 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
23978
23979 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
23980 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
23981 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
23982 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
23983 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
23984 your fancy split rule in this way:
23985
23986 @lisp
23987 (
23988 ...
23989 (to "larsi" "misc")
23990 "spam")
23991 @end lisp
23992
23993 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
23994 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
23995 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
23996 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
23997 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
23998
23999 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
24000 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
24001 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
24002 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
24003
24004 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
24005
24006
24007 @node SpamAssassin
24008 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
24009 @cindex SpamAssassin
24010 @cindex Vipul's Razor
24011 @cindex DCC
24012
24013 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
24014 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
24015 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
24016 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
24017 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
24018 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
24019 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
24020
24021 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
24022 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
24023 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
24024 recipes.
24025
24026 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
24027 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
24028 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
24029 Specifiers}) follow.
24030
24031 @lisp
24032 (setq mail-sources
24033 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
24034 (pop :user "jrl"
24035 :server "pophost"
24036 :postscript
24037 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
24038 @end lisp
24039
24040 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
24041 the mail contain, e.g., a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
24042 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
24043
24044 @lisp
24045 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
24046 ...))
24047 @end lisp
24048
24049 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
24050
24051 @lisp
24052 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
24053 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
24054 ...))
24055 @end lisp
24056
24057 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
24058 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
24059 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
24060 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
24061
24062 @lisp
24063 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
24064 ...))
24065 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
24066 (save-excursion
24067 (save-restriction
24068 (widen)
24069 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
24070 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
24071 "spam"))))
24072 @end lisp
24073
24074 Note that with the nnimap back end, message bodies will not be
24075 downloaded by default. You need to set
24076 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
24077 (@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
24078
24079 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
24080 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
24081 spam. And here is the nifty function:
24082
24083 @lisp
24084 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
24085 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
24086 (interactive)
24087 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d" t)
24088 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
24089 @end lisp
24090
24091 @node Hashcash
24092 @subsection Hashcash
24093 @cindex hashcash
24094
24095 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
24096 costly and demonstrably unique for each message they send. This has
24097 the obvious drawback that you cannot rely on everyone in the world
24098 using this technique, since it is not part of the Internet standards,
24099 but it may be useful in smaller communities.
24100
24101 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
24102 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
24103 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
24104 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
24105 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
24106 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
24107 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
24108 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
24109 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
24110 one of them separately.
24111
24112 @cindex X-Hashcash
24113 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
24114 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
24115 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:} header.
24116 For more details, and for the external application @code{hashcash} you
24117 need to install to use this feature, see
24118 @uref{http://www.hashcash.org/}. Even more information can be found
24119 at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
24120
24121 If you wish to generate hashcash for each message you send, you can
24122 customize @code{message-generate-hashcash} (@pxref{Mail Headers, ,Mail
24123 Headers,message, The Message Manual}), as in:
24124
24125 @lisp
24126 (setq message-generate-hashcash t)
24127 @end lisp
24128
24129 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
24130
24131 @table @code
24132
24133 @item hashcash-default-payment
24134 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
24135 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
24136 should consist of. By default this is 20. Suggested useful values
24137 include 17 to 29.
24138
24139 @item hashcash-payment-alist
24140 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
24141 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
24142 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
24143 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
24144 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
24145 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
24146 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
24147 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
24148
24149 @item hashcash-path
24150 @vindex hashcash-path
24151 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed. This variable should
24152 be automatically set by @code{executable-find}, but if it's @code{nil}
24153 (usually because the @code{hashcash} binary is not in your path)
24154 you'll get a warning when you check hashcash payments and an error
24155 when you generate hashcash payments.
24156
24157 @end table
24158
24159 Gnus can verify hashcash cookies, although this can also be done by
24160 hand customized mail filtering scripts. To verify a hashcash cookie
24161 in a message, use the @code{mail-check-payment} function in the
24162 @code{hashcash.el} library. You can also use the @code{spam.el}
24163 package with the @code{spam-use-hashcash} back end to validate hashcash
24164 cookies in incoming mail and filter mail accordingly (@pxref{Anti-spam
24165 Hashcash Payments}).
24166
24167 @node Spam Package
24168 @section Spam Package
24169 @cindex spam filtering
24170 @cindex spam
24171
24172 The Spam package provides Gnus with a centralized mechanism for
24173 detecting and filtering spam. It filters new mail, and processes
24174 messages according to whether they are spam or ham. (@dfn{Ham} is the
24175 name used throughout this manual to indicate non-spam messages.)
24176
24177 @menu
24178 * Spam Package Introduction::
24179 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
24180 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
24181 * Spam and Ham Processors::
24182 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
24183 * Spam Back Ends::
24184 * Extending the Spam package::
24185 * Spam Statistics Package::
24186 @end menu
24187
24188 @node Spam Package Introduction
24189 @subsection Spam Package Introduction
24190 @cindex spam filtering
24191 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
24192 @cindex spam
24193
24194 You must read this section to understand how the Spam package works.
24195 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
24196
24197 Make sure you read the section on the @code{spam.el} sequence of
24198 events. See @xref{Extending the Spam package}.
24199
24200 @cindex spam-initialize
24201 @vindex spam-use-stat
24202 To use the Spam package, you @strong{must} first run the function
24203 @code{spam-initialize}:
24204
24205 @example
24206 (spam-initialize)
24207 @end example
24208
24209 This autoloads @code{spam.el} and installs the various hooks necessary
24210 to let the Spam package do its job. In order to make use of the Spam
24211 package, you have to set up certain group parameters and variables,
24212 which we will describe below. All of the variables controlling the
24213 Spam package can be found in the @samp{spam} customization group.
24214
24215 There are two ``contact points'' between the Spam package and the rest
24216 of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and leaving a group.
24217
24218 Checking new mail for spam is done in one of two ways: while splitting
24219 incoming mail, or when you enter a group.
24220
24221 The first way, checking for spam while splitting incoming mail, is
24222 suited to mail back ends such as @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap}, where
24223 new mail appears in a single spool file. The Spam package processes
24224 incoming mail, and sends mail considered to be spam to a designated
24225 ``spam'' group. @xref{Filtering Incoming Mail}.
24226
24227 The second way is suited to back ends such as @code{nntp}, which have
24228 no incoming mail spool, or back ends where the server is in charge of
24229 splitting incoming mail. In this case, when you enter a Gnus group,
24230 the unseen or unread messages in that group are checked for spam.
24231 Detected spam messages are marked as spam. @xref{Detecting Spam in
24232 Groups}.
24233
24234 @cindex spam back ends
24235 In either case, you have to tell the Spam package what method to use
24236 to detect spam messages. There are several methods, or @dfn{spam back
24237 ends} (not to be confused with Gnus back ends!) to choose from: spam
24238 ``blacklists'' and ``whitelists'', dictionary-based filters, and so
24239 forth. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24240
24241 In the Gnus summary buffer, messages that have been identified as spam
24242 always appear with a @samp{$} symbol.
24243
24244 The Spam package divides Gnus groups into three categories: ham
24245 groups, spam groups, and unclassified groups. You should mark each of
24246 the groups you subscribe to as either a ham group or a spam group,
24247 using the @code{spam-contents} group parameter (@pxref{Group
24248 Parameters}). Spam groups have a special property: when you enter a
24249 spam group, all unseen articles are marked as spam. Thus, mail split
24250 into a spam group is automatically marked as spam.
24251
24252 Identifying spam messages is only half of the Spam package's job. The
24253 second half comes into play whenever you exit a group buffer. At this
24254 point, the Spam package does several things:
24255
24256 First, it calls @dfn{spam and ham processors} to process the articles
24257 according to whether they are spam or ham. There is a pair of spam
24258 and ham processors associated with each spam back end, and what the
24259 processors do depends on the back end. At present, the main role of
24260 spam and ham processors is for dictionary-based spam filters: they add
24261 the contents of the messages in the group to the filter's dictionary,
24262 to improve its ability to detect future spam. The @code{spam-process}
24263 group parameter specifies what spam processors to use. @xref{Spam and
24264 Ham Processors}.
24265
24266 If the spam filter failed to mark a spam message, you can mark it
24267 yourself, so that the message is processed as spam when you exit the
24268 group:
24269
24270 @table @kbd
24271 @item $
24272 @itemx M-d
24273 @itemx M s x
24274 @itemx S x
24275 @kindex $ (Summary)
24276 @kindex M-d (Summary)
24277 @kindex S x (Summary)
24278 @kindex M s x (Summary)
24279 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24280 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24281 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark
24282 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}).
24283 @end table
24284
24285 @noindent
24286 Similarly, you can unmark an article if it has been erroneously marked
24287 as spam. @xref{Setting Marks}.
24288
24289 Normally, a ham message found in a non-ham group is not processed as
24290 ham---the rationale is that it should be moved into a ham group for
24291 further processing (see below). However, you can force these articles
24292 to be processed as ham by setting
24293 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
24294 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups}.
24295
24296 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24297 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24298 The second thing that the Spam package does when you exit a group is
24299 to move ham articles out of spam groups, and spam articles out of ham
24300 groups. Ham in a spam group is moved to the group specified by the
24301 variable @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}, or the group parameter
24302 @code{ham-process-destination}. Spam in a ham group is moved to the
24303 group specified by the variable @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations},
24304 or the group parameter @code{spam-process-destination}. If these
24305 variables are not set, the articles are left in their current group.
24306 If an article cannot be moved (e.g., with a read-only backend such
24307 as @acronym{NNTP}), it is copied.
24308
24309 If an article is moved to another group, it is processed again when
24310 you visit the new group. Normally, this is not a problem, but if you
24311 want each article to be processed only once, load the
24312 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and set the variable
24313 @code{spam-log-to-registry} to @code{t}. @xref{Spam Package
24314 Configuration Examples}.
24315
24316 Normally, spam groups ignore @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations}.
24317 However, if you set @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only} to
24318 @code{nil}, spam will also be moved out of spam groups, depending on
24319 the @code{spam-process-destination} parameter.
24320
24321 The final thing the Spam package does is to mark spam articles as
24322 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
24323
24324 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
24325 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
24326 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
24327
24328 @node Filtering Incoming Mail
24329 @subsection Filtering Incoming Mail
24330 @cindex spam filtering
24331 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
24332 @cindex spam
24333
24334 To use the Spam package to filter incoming mail, you must first set up
24335 fancy mail splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}. The Spam package
24336 defines a special splitting function that you can add to your fancy
24337 split variable (either @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
24338 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on your mail back end):
24339
24340 @example
24341 (: spam-split)
24342 @end example
24343
24344 @vindex spam-split-group
24345 @noindent
24346 The @code{spam-split} function scans incoming mail according to your
24347 chosen spam back end(s), and sends messages identified as spam to a
24348 spam group. By default, the spam group is a group named @samp{spam},
24349 but you can change this by customizing @code{spam-split-group}. Make
24350 sure the contents of @code{spam-split-group} are an unqualified group
24351 name. For instance, in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server},
24352 the value @samp{spam} means @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The value
24353 @samp{nnimap+server:spam} is therefore wrong---it gives the group
24354 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam}.
24355
24356 @code{spam-split} does not modify the contents of messages in any way.
24357
24358 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
24359 Note for IMAP users: if you use the @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
24360 @code{spam-check-ifile}, and @code{spam-check-stat} spam back ends,
24361 you should also set the variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to
24362 @code{t}. These spam back ends are most useful when they can ``scan''
24363 the full message body. By default, the nnimap back end only retrieves
24364 the message headers; @code{nnimap-split-download-body} tells it to
24365 retrieve the message bodies as well. We don't set this by default
24366 because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and that is not an
24367 appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user. @xref{Client-Side
24368 IMAP Splitting}.
24369
24370 You have to specify one or more spam back ends for @code{spam-split}
24371 to use, by setting the @code{spam-use-*} variables. @xref{Spam Back
24372 Ends}. Normally, @code{spam-split} simply uses all the spam back ends
24373 you enabled in this way. However, you can tell @code{spam-split} to
24374 use only some of them. Why this is useful? Suppose you are using the
24375 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and @code{spam-use-blackholes} spam back
24376 ends, and the following split rule:
24377
24378 @example
24379 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24380 (any "ding" "ding")
24381 (: spam-split)
24382 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24383 "mail")
24384 @end example
24385
24386 @noindent
24387 The problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the ding
24388 folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam detected by
24389 SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through, when it's
24390 sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to the ding
24391 list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the invocation
24392 of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
24393
24394 The solution is to let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, and
24395 perform the other @code{spam-split} rules (including a second
24396 invocation of the regex-headers check) after the ding rule. This is
24397 done by passing a parameter to @code{spam-split}:
24398
24399 @example
24400 nnimap-split-fancy
24401 '(|
24402 ;; @r{spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
24403 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24404 (any "ding" "ding")
24405 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
24406 (: spam-split)
24407 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24408 "mail")
24409 @end example
24410
24411 @noindent
24412 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
24413 your particular needs, and target the results of those checks to a
24414 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
24415 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
24416 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
24417 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
24418 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
24419
24420 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24421 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24422 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24423 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24424
24425 @c @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
24426 @c statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
24427 @c don't.}
24428
24429 @node Detecting Spam in Groups
24430 @subsection Detecting Spam in Groups
24431
24432 To detect spam when visiting a group, set the group's
24433 @code{spam-autodetect} and @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group
24434 parameters. These are accessible with @kbd{G c} or @kbd{G p}, as
24435 usual (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
24436
24437 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24438 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24439 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24440 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set.
24441
24442 By default, only unseen articles are processed for spam. You can
24443 force Gnus to recheck all messages in the group by setting the
24444 variable @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages} to @code{t}.
24445
24446 If you use the @code{spam-autodetect} method of checking for spam, you
24447 can specify different spam detection methods for different groups.
24448 For instance, the @samp{ding} group may have @code{spam-use-BBDB} as
24449 the autodetection method, while the @samp{suspect} group may have the
24450 @code{spam-use-blacklist} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods
24451 enabled. Unlike with @code{spam-split}, you don't have any control
24452 over the @emph{sequence} of checks, but this is probably unimportant.
24453
24454 @node Spam and Ham Processors
24455 @subsection Spam and Ham Processors
24456 @cindex spam filtering
24457 @cindex spam filtering variables
24458 @cindex spam variables
24459 @cindex spam
24460
24461 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
24462 Spam and ham processors specify special actions to take when you exit
24463 a group buffer. Spam processors act on spam messages, and ham
24464 processors on ham messages. At present, the main role of these
24465 processors is to update the dictionaries of dictionary-based spam back
24466 ends such as Bogofilter (@pxref{Bogofilter}) and the Spam Statistics
24467 package (@pxref{Spam Statistics Filtering}).
24468
24469 The spam and ham processors that apply to each group are determined by
24470 the group's@code{spam-process} group parameter. If this group
24471 parameter is not defined, they are determined by the variable
24472 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups}.
24473
24474 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24475 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
24476 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
24477 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
24478 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
24479 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
24480 by customizing the corresponding variable
24481 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
24482 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
24483 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
24484 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
24485 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
24486 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
24487 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
24488 default.
24489
24490 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
24491 @cindex $
24492 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
24493 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
24494 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
24495 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
24496 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
24497 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
24498 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
24499 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
24500 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
24501 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
24502 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
24503 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
24504 processor which will study them as spam samples.
24505
24506 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
24507 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
24508 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
24509 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
24510 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
24511 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
24512 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
24513 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
24514
24515 @defvar ham-marks
24516 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24517 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
24518 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
24519 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
24520 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
24521 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
24522 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
24523 happy for you.
24524 @end defvar
24525
24526 @defvar spam-marks
24527 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24528 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
24529 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
24530 you really want to.
24531 @end defvar
24532
24533 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
24534 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
24535 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
24536 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
24537 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
24538 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
24539 and nothing else.
24540
24541 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24542 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
24543 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
24544 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
24545 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
24546 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
24547 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
24548 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
24549 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
24550 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
24551 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
24552 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
24553 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
24554 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
24555 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
24556
24557 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
24558 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24559
24560 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24561 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
24562 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
24563
24564 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
24565 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
24566
24567 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
24568 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
24569 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
24570 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
24571 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
24572
24573 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
24574 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
24575 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
24576 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
24577 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
24578 it there.
24579
24580 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24581 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
24582 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
24583 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
24584 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
24585 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
24586 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
24587 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
24588 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
24589 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
24590 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
24591 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
24592 group buffer then you need it here as well.
24593
24594 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
24595 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24596
24597 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24598 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
24599 training} groups.
24600
24601 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
24602 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
24603 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
24604 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
24605 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
24606 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
24607 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
24608
24609 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
24610 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
24611 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
24612 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
24613
24614 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
24615 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
24616 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
24617 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
24618 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
24619 from the mail server.
24620
24621 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
24622 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
24623 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
24624 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
24625
24626 @node Spam Package Configuration Examples
24627 @subsection Spam Package Configuration Examples
24628 @cindex spam filtering
24629 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
24630 @cindex spam configuration examples
24631 @cindex spam
24632
24633 @subsubheading Ted's setup
24634
24635 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
24636 @example
24637 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
24638 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
24639 (gnus-registry-initialize)
24640 (spam-initialize)
24641
24642 (setq
24643 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
24644 spam-use-BBDB t
24645 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
24646 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
24647 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24648 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24649 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
24650 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
24651 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
24652 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
24653 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
24654 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
24655 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24656 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
24657 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
24658 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
24659 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24660 (any "ding" "ding")
24661 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
24662 (: spam-split)
24663 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24664 "mail"))
24665
24666 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
24667
24668 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
24669 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
24670 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
24671 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
24672
24673 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24674
24675 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
24676 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
24677 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
24678 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
24679 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24680
24681 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
24682 ((spam-autodetect . t))
24683
24684 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
24685
24686 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
24687 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
24688
24689 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
24690 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
24691 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
24692
24693 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
24694
24695 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
24696 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
24697
24698 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
24699 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
24700 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
24701 (ham-marks
24702 (gnus-ticked-mark))
24703 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
24704 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
24705 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
24706
24707 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
24708 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
24709 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
24710
24711 @end example
24712
24713 @subsubheading Using @code{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
24714 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24715
24716 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
24717 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
24718 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
24719 i.e., to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
24720 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
24721 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
24722 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
24723 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
24724 @samp{training.spam} folders.
24725
24726 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
24727 does most of the job for me:
24728
24729 @lisp
24730 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
24731 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
24732 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
24733 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24734 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
24735 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
24736 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
24737 @end lisp
24738
24739 @itemize
24740
24741 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
24742
24743 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
24744 (i.e., legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
24745 bogofilter or DCC).
24746
24747 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
24748 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
24749 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark
24750 (@code{ham-marks}, @ref{Spam and Ham Processors}). On group exit,
24751 those messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want
24752 to have the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter)
24753 and deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
24754
24755 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
24756 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
24757 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e., chars) makes finding
24758 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
24759 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
24760 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
24761
24762 @item @b{Ham folders:}
24763
24764 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
24765 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
24766 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
24767 @samp{training.spam}.
24768 @end itemize
24769
24770 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
24771
24772 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24773
24774 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
24775 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
24776 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
24777
24778 @lisp
24779 ("^gmane\\."
24780 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
24781 @end lisp
24782
24783 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
24784 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
24785 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e., the article numbers are
24786 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
24787 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
24788
24789 @node Spam Back Ends
24790 @subsection Spam Back Ends
24791 @cindex spam back ends
24792
24793 The spam package offers a variety of back ends for detecting spam.
24794 Each back end defines a set of methods for detecting spam
24795 (@pxref{Filtering Incoming Mail}, @pxref{Detecting Spam in Groups}),
24796 and a pair of spam and ham processors (@pxref{Spam and Ham
24797 Processors}).
24798
24799 @menu
24800 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
24801 * BBDB Whitelists::
24802 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
24803 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
24804 * Blackholes::
24805 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
24806 * Bogofilter::
24807 * SpamAssassin back end::
24808 * ifile spam filtering::
24809 * Spam Statistics Filtering::
24810 * SpamOracle::
24811 @end menu
24812
24813 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
24814 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
24815 @cindex spam filtering
24816 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
24817 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
24818 @cindex spam
24819
24820 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
24821
24822 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
24823 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
24824 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
24825 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
24826 be spammers.
24827
24828 @end defvar
24829
24830 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
24831
24832 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
24833 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
24834 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24835 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
24836 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24837
24838 @end defvar
24839
24840 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
24841
24842 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
24843 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24844 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
24845
24846 @end defvar
24847
24848 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
24849
24850 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24851 customizing the group parameters or the
24852 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24853 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24854 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
24855
24856 @emph{WARNING}
24857
24858 Instead of the obsolete
24859 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
24860 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
24861 the same way, we promise.
24862
24863 @end defvar
24864
24865 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
24866
24867 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24868 customizing the group parameters or the
24869 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24870 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24871 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24872 whitelist.
24873
24874 @emph{WARNING}
24875
24876 Instead of the obsolete
24877 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
24878 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
24879 the same way, we promise.
24880
24881 @end defvar
24882
24883 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
24884 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
24885 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
24886 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
24887 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
24888
24889 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
24890 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
24891 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
24892 Emacs regular expression syntax.
24893
24894 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
24895 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
24896 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
24897 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
24898 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
24899 @file{blacklist} respectively.
24900
24901 @node BBDB Whitelists
24902 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
24903 @cindex spam filtering
24904 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
24905 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
24906 @cindex spam
24907
24908 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
24909
24910 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24911 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
24912 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
24913 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
24914 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24915 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
24916 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24917
24918 @end defvar
24919
24920 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
24921
24922 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
24923 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24924 unless the sender is in the BBDB@. Use with care. Only sender
24925 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
24926 classified as spammers.
24927
24928 While @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} @emph{can} be used as an alias
24929 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} as far as @code{spam.el} is concerned, it is
24930 @emph{not} a separate back end. If you set
24931 @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} to @code{t}, @emph{all} your BBDB splitting
24932 will be exclusive.
24933
24934 @end defvar
24935
24936 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
24937
24938 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24939 customizing the group parameters or the
24940 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24941 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24942 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24943 BBDB.
24944
24945 @emph{WARNING}
24946
24947 Instead of the obsolete
24948 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
24949 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
24950 the same way, we promise.
24951
24952 @end defvar
24953
24954 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
24955 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
24956 @cindex spam reporting
24957 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24958 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24959 @cindex spam
24960
24961 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
24962
24963 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24964 customizing the group parameters or the
24965 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24966 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
24967 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
24968 HTTP request.
24969
24970 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
24971
24972 @emph{WARNING}
24973
24974 Instead of the obsolete
24975 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
24976 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
24977 same way, we promise.
24978
24979 @end defvar
24980
24981 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
24982
24983 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
24984 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
24985 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
24986 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
24987 @code{spam-report.el} will fetch the number from the article headers.
24988
24989 @end defvar
24990
24991 @defvar spam-report-user-mail-address
24992
24993 Mail address exposed in the User-Agent spam reports to Gmane. It allows
24994 the Gmane administrators to contact you in case of misreports. The
24995 default is @code{user-mail-address}.
24996
24997 @end defvar
24998
24999 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
25000 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
25001 @cindex spam filtering
25002 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
25003 @cindex spam
25004
25005 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
25006
25007 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
25008 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
25009 instead of the sender address. Messages without a hashcash payment
25010 token will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an explicit
25011 filter, meaning that unless a hashcash token is found, the messages
25012 are not assumed to be spam or ham.
25013
25014 @end defvar
25015
25016 @node Blackholes
25017 @subsubsection Blackholes
25018 @cindex spam filtering
25019 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
25020 @cindex spam
25021
25022 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
25023
25024 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
25025 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
25026 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
25027 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
25028 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
25029 contains outdated servers.
25030
25031 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
25032 @code{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
25033 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
25034 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
25035 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
25036 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
25037
25038 @end defvar
25039
25040 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
25041
25042 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
25043
25044 @end defvar
25045
25046 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
25047
25048 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
25049 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
25050
25051 @end defvar
25052
25053 @defvar spam-use-dig
25054
25055 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
25056 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
25057
25058 @end defvar
25059
25060 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
25061 ham processor for blackholes.
25062
25063 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
25064 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
25065 @cindex spam filtering
25066 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
25067 @cindex spam
25068
25069 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
25070
25071 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
25072 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
25073 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
25074 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
25075 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
25076 message is spam or ham, respectively.
25077
25078 @end defvar
25079
25080 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
25081
25082 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
25083 the message, positively identify it as spam.
25084
25085 @end defvar
25086
25087 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
25088
25089 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
25090 the message, positively identify it as ham.
25091
25092 @end defvar
25093
25094 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
25095 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
25096
25097 @node Bogofilter
25098 @subsubsection Bogofilter
25099 @cindex spam filtering
25100 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
25101 @cindex spam
25102
25103 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
25104
25105 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25106 speedy Bogofilter.
25107
25108 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
25109 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
25110 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
25111 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
25112 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
25113 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
25114
25115 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
25116 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
25117 documentation.
25118
25119 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
25120 processing will be turned off.
25121
25122 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
25123
25124 @end defvar
25125
25126 @table @kbd
25127 @item M s t
25128 @itemx S t
25129 @kindex M s t
25130 @kindex S t
25131 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
25132 Get the Bogofilter spamicity score (@code{spam-bogofilter-score}).
25133 @end table
25134
25135 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
25136
25137 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25138 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
25139 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
25140 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
25141 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
25142 installation documents for details.
25143
25144 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
25145
25146 @end defvar
25147
25148 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
25149 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25150 customizing the group parameters or the
25151 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25152 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
25153 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
25154
25155 @emph{WARNING}
25156
25157 Instead of the obsolete
25158 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25159 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25160 the same way, we promise.
25161 @end defvar
25162
25163 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
25164 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25165 customizing the group parameters or the
25166 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25167 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25168 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
25169 of non-spam messages.
25170
25171 @emph{WARNING}
25172
25173 Instead of the obsolete
25174 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25175 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25176 the same way, we promise.
25177 @end defvar
25178
25179 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
25180
25181 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
25182 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
25183 database directory.
25184
25185 @end defvar
25186
25187 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
25188 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25189 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
25190 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
25191 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
25192 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
25193
25194 @node SpamAssassin back end
25195 @subsubsection SpamAssassin back end
25196 @cindex spam filtering
25197 @cindex spamassassin, spam filtering
25198 @cindex spam
25199
25200 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin
25201
25202 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use SpamAssassin.
25203
25204 SpamAssassin assigns a score to each article based on a set of rules
25205 and tests, including a Bayesian filter. The Bayesian filter can be
25206 trained by associating the @samp{$} mark for spam articles. The
25207 spam score can be viewed by using the command @kbd{S t} in summary
25208 mode.
25209
25210 If you set this variable, each article will be processed by
25211 SpamAssassin when @code{spam-split} is called. If your mail is
25212 preprocessed by SpamAssassin, and you want to just use the
25213 SpamAssassin headers, set @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}
25214 instead.
25215
25216 You should not enable this if you use
25217 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}.
25218
25219 @end defvar
25220
25221 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin-headers
25222
25223 Set this variable if your mail is preprocessed by SpamAssassin and
25224 want @code{spam-split} to split based on the SpamAssassin headers.
25225
25226 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-spamassassin}.
25227
25228 @end defvar
25229
25230 @defvar spam-spamassassin-program
25231
25232 This variable points to the SpamAssassin executable. If you have
25233 @code{spamd} running, you can set this variable to the @code{spamc}
25234 executable for faster processing. See the SpamAssassin documentation
25235 for more information on @code{spamd}/@code{spamc}.
25236
25237 @end defvar
25238
25239 SpamAssassin is a powerful and flexible spam filter that uses a wide
25240 variety of tests to identify spam. A ham and a spam processors are
25241 provided, plus the @code{spam-use-spamassassin} and
25242 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers} variables to indicate to
25243 spam-split that SpamAssassin should be either used, or has already
25244 been used on the article. The 2.63 version of SpamAssassin was used
25245 to test this functionality.
25246
25247 @node ifile spam filtering
25248 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
25249 @cindex spam filtering
25250 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
25251 @cindex spam
25252
25253 @defvar spam-use-ifile
25254
25255 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
25256 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
25257
25258 @end defvar
25259
25260 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
25261
25262 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
25263 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
25264 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
25265
25266 @end defvar
25267
25268 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
25269
25270 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
25271 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
25272 the default value of @samp{spam}.
25273 @end defvar
25274
25275 @defvar spam-ifile-database
25276
25277 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
25278 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
25279
25280 @end defvar
25281
25282 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
25283 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25284 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
25285 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
25286 functionality.
25287
25288 @node Spam Statistics Filtering
25289 @subsubsection Spam Statistics Filtering
25290 @cindex spam filtering
25291 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
25292 @cindex spam-stat
25293 @cindex spam
25294
25295 This back end uses the Spam Statistics Emacs Lisp package to perform
25296 statistics-based filtering (@pxref{Spam Statistics Package}). Before
25297 using this, you may want to perform some additional steps to
25298 initialize your Spam Statistics dictionary. @xref{Creating a
25299 spam-stat dictionary}.
25300
25301 @defvar spam-use-stat
25302
25303 @end defvar
25304
25305 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
25306 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25307 customizing the group parameters or the
25308 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25309 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
25310 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
25311
25312 @emph{WARNING}
25313
25314 Instead of the obsolete
25315 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25316 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25317 the same way, we promise.
25318 @end defvar
25319
25320 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
25321 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25322 customizing the group parameters or the
25323 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25324 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25325 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
25326 of non-spam messages.
25327
25328 @emph{WARNING}
25329
25330 Instead of the obsolete
25331 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25332 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25333 the same way, we promise.
25334 @end defvar
25335
25336 This enables @code{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
25337 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
25338 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
25339 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
25340 @code{spam-split} are provided.
25341
25342 @node SpamOracle
25343 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
25344 @cindex spam filtering
25345 @cindex SpamOracle
25346 @cindex spam
25347
25348 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
25349 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
25350 installed separately.
25351
25352 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
25353 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
25354 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
25355 mail as a spam mail or not.
25356
25357 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
25358 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
25359 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
25360
25361 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Spam Package})
25362 call SpamOracle.
25363
25364 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
25365 To enable SpamOracle usage by @code{spam.el}, set the variable
25366 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
25367 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}. @xref{Spam
25368 Package}. In this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is
25369 filtered using SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be
25370 moved to @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham
25371 messages stay in @samp{INBOX}:
25372
25373 @example
25374 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
25375 spam-split-group "Junk"
25376 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
25377 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
25378 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
25379 @end example
25380
25381 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
25382 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
25383 SpamOracle.
25384 @end defvar
25385
25386 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
25387 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
25388 user's PATH@. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
25389 can be customized.
25390 @end defvar
25391
25392 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
25393 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
25394 store its analysis. This is controlled by the variable
25395 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
25396 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
25397 database to live somewhere special, set
25398 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
25399 @end defvar
25400
25401 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
25402 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
25403 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns
25404 the characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
25405 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
25406 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary
25407 buffer and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using
25408 @file{spam.el}'s spam- and ham-processors, which is much more
25409 convenient. For a detailed description of spam- and ham-processors,
25410 @xref{Spam Package}.
25411
25412 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
25413 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25414 customizing the group parameter or the
25415 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25416 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
25417 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
25418
25419 @emph{WARNING}
25420
25421 Instead of the obsolete
25422 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25423 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25424 the same way, we promise.
25425 @end defvar
25426
25427 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
25428 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25429 customizing the group parameter or the
25430 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25431 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
25432 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
25433 messages.
25434
25435 @emph{WARNING}
25436
25437 Instead of the obsolete
25438 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25439 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25440 the same way, we promise.
25441 @end defvar
25442
25443 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
25444 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
25445 messages.
25446 @example
25447 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
25448 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
25449 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
25450 @end example
25451 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
25452 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
25453 (e.g., because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
25454 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
25455 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
25456 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
25457
25458 @node Extending the Spam package
25459 @subsection Extending the Spam package
25460 @cindex spam filtering
25461 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
25462 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
25463
25464 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
25465 incoming mail, provide the following:
25466
25467 @enumerate
25468
25469 @item
25470 Code
25471
25472 @lisp
25473 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
25474 "True if blackbox should be used.")
25475 @end lisp
25476
25477 Write @code{spam-check-blackbox} if Blackbox can check incoming mail.
25478
25479 Write @code{spam-blackbox-register-routine} and
25480 @code{spam-blackbox-unregister-routine} using the bogofilter
25481 register/unregister routines as a start, or other register/unregister
25482 routines more appropriate to Blackbox, if Blackbox can
25483 register/unregister spam and ham.
25484
25485 @item
25486 Functionality
25487
25488 The @code{spam-check-blackbox} function should return @samp{nil} or
25489 @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other conventions. See the
25490 existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for examples of what you can
25491 do, and stick to the template unless you fully understand the reasons
25492 why you aren't.
25493
25494 @end enumerate
25495
25496 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
25497
25498 @enumerate
25499
25500 @item
25501 Code
25502
25503 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
25504 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
25505
25506 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
25507 variables. Instead the form @code{(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
25508 @code{(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
25509 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
25510
25511 @lisp
25512 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
25513 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
25514 Only applicable to spam groups.")
25515
25516 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
25517 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
25518 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
25519
25520 @end lisp
25521
25522 @item
25523 Gnus parameters
25524
25525 Add
25526 @lisp
25527 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
25528 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
25529 @end lisp
25530 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
25531 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
25532 variable customization.
25533
25534 Add
25535 @lisp
25536 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
25537 @end lisp
25538 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
25539 @code{gnus.el} if Blackbox can check incoming mail for spam contents.
25540
25541 Finally, use the appropriate @code{spam-install-*-backend} function in
25542 @code{spam.el}. Here are the available functions.
25543
25544
25545 @enumerate
25546
25547 @item
25548 @code{spam-install-backend-alias}
25549
25550 This function will simply install an alias for a back end that does
25551 everything like the original back end. It is currently only used to
25552 make @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} act like @code{spam-use-BBDB}.
25553
25554 @item
25555 @code{spam-install-nocheck-backend}
25556
25557 This function installs a back end that has no check function, but can
25558 register/unregister ham or spam. The @code{spam-use-gmane} back end is
25559 such a back end.
25560
25561 @item
25562 @code{spam-install-checkonly-backend}
25563
25564 This function will install a back end that can only check incoming mail
25565 for spam contents. It can't register or unregister messages.
25566 @code{spam-use-blackholes} and @code{spam-use-hashcash} are such
25567 back ends.
25568
25569 @item
25570 @code{spam-install-statistical-checkonly-backend}
25571
25572 This function installs a statistical back end (one which requires the
25573 full body of a message to check it) that can only check incoming mail
25574 for contents. @code{spam-use-regex-body} is such a filter.
25575
25576 @item
25577 @code{spam-install-statistical-backend}
25578
25579 This function install a statistical back end with incoming checks and
25580 registration/unregistration routines. @code{spam-use-bogofilter} is
25581 set up this way.
25582
25583 @item
25584 @code{spam-install-backend}
25585
25586 This is the most normal back end installation, where a back end that can
25587 check and register/unregister messages is set up without statistical
25588 abilities. The @code{spam-use-BBDB} is such a back end.
25589
25590 @item
25591 @code{spam-install-mover-backend}
25592
25593 Mover back ends are internal to @code{spam.el} and specifically move
25594 articles around when the summary is exited. You will very probably
25595 never install such a back end.
25596 @end enumerate
25597
25598 @end enumerate
25599
25600 @node Spam Statistics Package
25601 @subsection Spam Statistics Package
25602 @cindex Paul Graham
25603 @cindex Graham, Paul
25604 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
25605 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
25606 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
25607
25608 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
25609 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
25610 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
25611 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
25612 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
25613 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
25614 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
25615 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
25616 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
25617 or not.
25618
25619 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
25620 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
25621 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
25622 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
25623 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
25624 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
25625 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
25626 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
25627
25628 The Spam Statistics package adds support to Gnus for this kind of
25629 filtering. It can be used as one of the back ends of the Spam package
25630 (@pxref{Spam Package}), or by itself.
25631
25632 Before using the Spam Statistics package, you need to set it up.
25633 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
25634 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
25635 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
25636 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
25637
25638 @menu
25639 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
25640 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
25641 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
25642 @end menu
25643
25644 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25645 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25646
25647 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
25648 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
25649 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
25650 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
25651 need several hundred emails in both collections.
25652
25653 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
25654 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
25655 per mail. Use the following:
25656
25657 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
25658 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
25659 is treated as one spam mail.
25660 @end defun
25661
25662 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
25663 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
25664 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
25665 @end defun
25666
25667 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
25668 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds to
25669 the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
25670 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
25671 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds to the group
25672 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
25673
25674 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
25675 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
25676 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
25677 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
25678 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
25679
25680 @defvar spam-stat
25681 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
25682 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
25683 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
25684 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
25685 @end defvar
25686
25687 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
25688 reset the dictionary.
25689
25690 @defun spam-stat-reset
25691 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
25692 @end defun
25693
25694 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
25695 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
25696 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
25697 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
25698 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
25699 only non-spam mails.
25700
25701 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
25702 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
25703 to update the dictionary incrementally.
25704 @end defun
25705
25706 @defun spam-stat-save
25707 Save the dictionary.
25708 @end defun
25709
25710 @defvar spam-stat-file
25711 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
25712 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
25713 @end defvar
25714
25715 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
25716 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
25717
25718 This section describes how to use the Spam statistics
25719 @emph{independently} of the @xref{Spam Package}.
25720
25721 First, add the following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25722
25723 @lisp
25724 (require 'spam-stat)
25725 (spam-stat-load)
25726 @end lisp
25727
25728 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
25729 created.
25730
25731 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
25732 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
25733 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
25734 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
25735
25736 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
25737 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
25738 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
25739 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
25740
25741 @lisp
25742 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25743 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25744 "mail.misc"))
25745 @end lisp
25746
25747 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
25748 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
25749 @end defvar
25750
25751 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
25752 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
25753 expression are considered potential spam.
25754
25755 @lisp
25756 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25757 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25758 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25759 "mail.misc"))
25760 @end lisp
25761
25762 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
25763 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
25764 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
25765 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
25766 mails, when creating the dictionary!
25767
25768 @lisp
25769 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25770 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25771 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25772 "mail.misc"))
25773 @end lisp
25774
25775 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
25776 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
25777 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
25778 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
25779 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
25780 dictionary!
25781
25782 @lisp
25783 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25784 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
25785 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25786 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25787 "mail.misc"))
25788 @end lisp
25789
25790
25791 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25792 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25793
25794 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
25795
25796 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
25797 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
25798 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25799 @end defun
25800
25801 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
25802 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
25803 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25804 @end defun
25805
25806 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
25807 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
25808 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
25809 already been processed as non-spam.
25810 @end defun
25811
25812 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
25813 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
25814 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
25815 been processed as spam.
25816 @end defun
25817
25818 @defun spam-stat-save
25819 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
25820 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25821 @end defun
25822
25823 @defun spam-stat-load
25824 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
25825 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25826 @end defun
25827
25828 @defun spam-stat-score-word
25829 Return the spam score for a word.
25830 @end defun
25831
25832 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
25833 Return the spam score for a buffer.
25834 @end defun
25835
25836 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
25837 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
25838 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
25839 @end defun
25840
25841 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
25842 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25843
25844 @lisp
25845 (require 'spam-stat)
25846 (spam-stat-load)
25847 @end lisp
25848
25849 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
25850
25851 @smallexample
25852 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25853 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25854 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25855 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25856 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25857 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25858 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25859 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25860 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25861 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25862 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25863 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25864 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25865 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25866 @end smallexample
25867
25868 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
25869
25870 @smallexample
25871 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25872 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25873 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25874 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
25875 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25876 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25877 @end smallexample
25878
25879 @node The Gnus Registry
25880 @section The Gnus Registry
25881 @cindex registry
25882 @cindex split
25883 @cindex track
25884
25885 The Gnus registry is a package that tracks messages by their
25886 Message-ID across all backends. This allows Gnus users to do several
25887 cool things, be the envy of the locals, get free haircuts, and be
25888 experts on world issues. Well, maybe not all of those, but the
25889 features are pretty cool.
25890
25891 Although they will be explained in detail shortly, here's a quick list
25892 of said features in case your attention span is... never mind.
25893
25894 @enumerate
25895 @item
25896 Split messages to their parent
25897
25898 This keeps discussions in the same group. You can use the subject and
25899 the sender in addition to the Message-ID@. Several strategies are
25900 available.
25901
25902 @item
25903 Refer to messages by ID
25904
25905 Commands like @code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article} can take
25906 advantage of the registry to jump to the referred article, regardless
25907 of the group the message is in.
25908
25909 @item
25910 Store custom flags and keywords
25911
25912 The registry can store custom flags and keywords for a message. For
25913 instance, you can mark a message ``To-Do'' this way and the flag will
25914 persist whether the message is in the nnimap, nnml, nnmaildir,
25915 etc.@: backends.
25916
25917 @item
25918 Store arbitrary data
25919
25920 Through a simple ELisp API, the registry can remember any data for a
25921 message. A built-in inverse map, when activated, allows quick lookups
25922 of all messages matching a particular set of criteria.
25923 @end enumerate
25924
25925 @menu
25926 * Gnus Registry Setup::
25927 * Registry Article Refer Method::
25928 * Fancy splitting to parent::
25929 * Store custom flags and keywords::
25930 * Store arbitrary data::
25931 @end menu
25932
25933 @node Gnus Registry Setup
25934 @subsection Gnus Registry Setup
25935
25936 Fortunately, setting up the Gnus registry is pretty easy:
25937
25938 @lisp
25939 (setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
25940
25941 (gnus-registry-initialize)
25942 @end lisp
25943
25944 This adds registry saves to Gnus newsrc saves (which happen on exit
25945 and when you press @kbd{s} from the @file{*Group*} buffer. It also
25946 adds registry calls to article actions in Gnus (copy, move, etc.)@: so
25947 it's not easy to undo the initialization. See
25948 @code{gnus-registry-initialize} for the gory details.
25949
25950 Here are other settings used by the author of the registry (understand
25951 what they do before you copy them blindly).
25952
25953 @lisp
25954 (setq
25955 gnus-registry-split-strategy 'majority
25956 gnus-registry-ignored-groups '(("nntp" t)
25957 ("nnrss" t)
25958 ("spam" t)
25959 ("train" t))
25960 gnus-registry-max-entries 500000
25961 ;; this is the default
25962 gnus-registry-track-extra '(sender subject))
25963 @end lisp
25964
25965 They say: keep a lot of messages around, track messages by sender and
25966 subject (not just parent Message-ID), and when the registry splits
25967 incoming mail, use a majority rule to decide where messages should go
25968 if there's more than one possibility. In addition, the registry
25969 should ignore messages in groups that match ``nntp'', ``nnrss'',
25970 ``spam'', or ``train.''
25971
25972 You are doubtless impressed by all this, but you ask: ``I am a Gnus
25973 user, I customize to live. Give me more.'' Here you go, these are
25974 the general settings.
25975
25976 @defvar gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups
25977 The groups that will not be followed by
25978 @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}. They will still be
25979 remembered by the registry. This is a list of regular expressions.
25980 By default any group name that ends with ``delayed'', ``drafts'',
25981 ``queue'', or ``INBOX'', belongs to the nnmairix backend, or contains
25982 the word ``archive'' is not followed.
25983 @end defvar
25984
25985 @defvar gnus-registry-max-entries
25986 The number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries the
25987 registry will keep. If the registry has reached or exceeded this
25988 size, it will reject insertion of new entries.
25989 @end defvar
25990
25991 @defvar gnus-registry-prune-factor
25992 This option (a float between 0 and 1) controls how much the registry
25993 is cut back during pruning. In order to prevent constant pruning, the
25994 registry will be pruned back to less than
25995 @code{gnus-registry-max-entries}. This option controls exactly how
25996 much less: the target is calculated as the maximum number of entries
25997 minus the maximum number times this factor. The default is 0.1:
25998 i.e., if your registry is limited to 50000 entries, pruning will try to
25999 cut back to 45000 entries. Entries with keys marked as precious will
26000 not be pruned.
26001 @end defvar
26002
26003 @defvar gnus-registry-default-sort-function
26004 This option specifies how registry entries are sorted during pruning.
26005 If a function is given, it should sort least valuable entries first,
26006 as pruning starts from the beginning of the list. The default value
26007 is @code{gnus-registry-sort-by-creation-time}, which proposes the
26008 oldest entries for pruning. Set to nil to perform no sorting, which
26009 will speed up the pruning process.
26010 @end defvar
26011
26012 @defvar gnus-registry-cache-file
26013 The file where the registry will be stored between Gnus sessions. By
26014 default the file name is @code{.gnus.registry.eieio} in the same
26015 directory as your @code{.newsrc.eld}.
26016 @end defvar
26017
26018 @node Registry Article Refer Method
26019 @subsection Fetching by @code{Message-ID} Using the Registry
26020
26021 The registry knows how to map each @code{Message-ID} to the group it's
26022 in. This can be leveraged to enhance the ``article refer method'',
26023 the thing that tells Gnus how to look up an article given its
26024 Message-ID (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
26025
26026 @vindex nnregistry
26027 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
26028
26029 The @code{nnregistry} refer method does exactly that. It has the
26030 advantage that an article may be found regardless of the group it's
26031 in---provided its @code{Message-ID} is known to the registry. It can
26032 be enabled by augmenting the start-up file with something along these
26033 lines:
26034
26035 @example
26036 ;; Keep enough entries to have a good hit rate when referring to an
26037 ;; article using the registry. Use long group names so that Gnus
26038 ;; knows where the article is.
26039 (setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
26040
26041 (gnus-registry-initialize)
26042
26043 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
26044 '(current
26045 (nnregistry)
26046 (nnweb "gmane" (nnweb-type gmane))))
26047 @end example
26048
26049 The example above instructs Gnus to first look up the article in the
26050 current group, or, alternatively, using the registry, and finally, if
26051 all else fails, using Gmane.
26052
26053 @node Fancy splitting to parent
26054 @subsection Fancy splitting to parent
26055
26056 Simply put, this lets you put followup e-mail where it belongs.
26057
26058 Every message has a Message-ID, which is unique, and the registry
26059 remembers it. When the message is moved or copied, the registry will
26060 notice this and offer the new group as a choice to the splitting
26061 strategy.
26062
26063 When a followup is made, usually it mentions the original message's
26064 Message-ID in the headers. The registry knows this and uses that
26065 mention to find the group where the original message lives. You only
26066 have to put a rule like this:
26067
26068 @lisp
26069 (setq nnimap-my-split-fancy '(|
26070
26071 ;; split to parent: you need this
26072 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
26073
26074 ;; other rules, as an example
26075 (: spam-split)
26076 ;; default mailbox
26077 "mail")
26078 @end lisp
26079
26080 in your fancy split setup. In addition, you may want to customize the
26081 following variables.
26082
26083 @defvar gnus-registry-track-extra
26084 This is a list of symbols, so it's best to change it from the
26085 Customize interface. By default it's @code{(subject sender recipient)},
26086 which may work for you. It can be annoying if your mail flow is large
26087 and people don't stick to the same groups.
26088
26089 When you decide to stop tracking any of those extra data, you can use
26090 the command @code{gnus-registry-remove-extra-data} to purge it from
26091 the existing registry entries.
26092 @end defvar
26093
26094 @defvar gnus-registry-split-strategy
26095 This is a symbol, so it's best to change it from the Customize
26096 interface. By default it's @code{nil}, but you may want to set it to
26097 @code{majority} or @code{first} to split by sender or subject based on
26098 the majority of matches or on the first found. I find @code{majority}
26099 works best.
26100 @end defvar
26101
26102 @node Store custom flags and keywords
26103 @subsection Store custom flags and keywords
26104
26105 The registry lets you set custom flags and keywords per message. You
26106 can use the Gnus->Registry Marks menu or the @kbd{M M x} keyboard
26107 shortcuts, where @code{x} is the first letter of the mark's name.
26108
26109 @defvar gnus-registry-marks
26110 The custom marks that the registry can use. You can modify the
26111 default list, if you like. If you do, you'll have to exit Emacs
26112 before they take effect (you can also unload the registry and reload
26113 it or evaluate the specific macros you'll need, but you probably don't
26114 want to bother). Use the Customize interface to modify the list.
26115
26116 By default this list has the @code{Important}, @code{Work},
26117 @code{Personal}, @code{To-Do}, and @code{Later} marks. They all have
26118 keyboard shortcuts like @kbd{M M i} for Important, using the first
26119 letter.
26120 @end defvar
26121
26122 @defun gnus-registry-mark-article
26123 Call this function to mark an article with a custom registry mark. It
26124 will offer the available marks for completion.
26125 @end defun
26126
26127 You can use @code{defalias} to install a summary line formatting
26128 function that will show the registry marks. There are two flavors of
26129 this function, either showing the marks as single characters, using
26130 their @code{:char} property, or showing the marks as full strings.
26131
26132 @lisp
26133 ;; show the marks as single characters (see the :char property in
26134 ;; 'gnus-registry-marks'):
26135 ;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-chars)
26136
26137 ;; show the marks by name (see 'gnus-registry-marks'):
26138 ;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-names)
26139 @end lisp
26140
26141
26142 @node Store arbitrary data
26143 @subsection Store arbitrary data
26144
26145 The registry has a simple API that uses a Message-ID as the key to
26146 store arbitrary data (as long as it can be converted to a list for
26147 storage).
26148
26149 @defun gnus-registry-set-id-key (id key value)
26150 Store @code{value} under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
26151 @end defun
26152
26153 @defun gnus-registry-get-id-key (id key)
26154 Get the data under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
26155 @end defun
26156
26157 @defvar gnus-registry-extra-entries-precious
26158 If any extra entries are precious, their presence will make the
26159 registry keep the whole entry forever, even if there are no groups for
26160 the Message-ID and if the size limit of the registry is reached. By
26161 default this is just @code{(marks)} so the custom registry marks are
26162 precious.
26163 @end defvar
26164
26165 @node Other modes
26166 @section Interaction with other modes
26167
26168 @subsection Dired
26169 @cindex dired
26170
26171 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provides some useful functions for dired
26172 buffers. It is enabled with
26173 @lisp
26174 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
26175 @end lisp
26176
26177 @table @kbd
26178 @item C-c C-m C-a
26179 @findex gnus-dired-attach
26180 @cindex attachments, selection via dired
26181 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
26182 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
26183
26184 @item C-c C-m C-l
26185 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
26186 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
26187 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
26188 buffer.
26189
26190 @item C-c C-m C-p
26191 @findex gnus-dired-print
26192 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
26193 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
26194 @end table
26195
26196 @node Various Various
26197 @section Various Various
26198 @cindex mode lines
26199 @cindex highlights
26200
26201 @table @code
26202
26203 @item gnus-home-directory
26204 @vindex gnus-home-directory
26205 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
26206 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
26207
26208 @item gnus-directory
26209 @vindex gnus-directory
26210 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
26211 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
26212 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
26213
26214 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
26215 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
26216 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
26217 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
26218
26219 @item gnus-default-directory
26220 @vindex gnus-default-directory
26221 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
26222 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
26223 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
26224 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
26225 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
26226 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
26227
26228 @item gnus-verbose
26229 @vindex gnus-verbose
26230 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
26231 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
26232 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
26233 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
26234 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
26235
26236 @item gnus-verbose-backends
26237 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
26238 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
26239 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
26240
26241 @item gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26242 @vindex gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26243 This variable controls whether to add timestamps to messages that are
26244 controlled by @code{gnus-verbose} and @code{gnus-verbose-backends} and
26245 are issued. The default value is @code{nil} which means never to add
26246 timestamp. If it is @code{log}, add timestamps to only the messages
26247 that go into the @file{*Messages*} buffer (in XEmacs, it is the
26248 @w{@file{ *Message-Log*}} buffer). If it is neither @code{nil} nor
26249 @code{log}, add timestamps not only to log messages but also to the ones
26250 displayed in the echo area.
26251
26252 @item nnheader-max-head-length
26253 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
26254 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
26255 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
26256 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
26257 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
26258 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
26259 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
26260 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
26261 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
26262
26263 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
26264 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
26265 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
26266 read when doing the operation described above.
26267
26268 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26269 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26270 @cindex file names
26271 @cindex invalid characters in file names
26272 @cindex characters in file names
26273 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
26274 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
26275 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
26276
26277 @lisp
26278 @group
26279 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26280 '((?: . ?_)))
26281 @end group
26282 @end lisp
26283
26284 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
26285 Windows (phooey) systems.
26286
26287 @item gnus-hidden-properties
26288 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
26289 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
26290 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
26291 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
26292
26293 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
26294 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
26295 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
26296 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
26297 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
26298
26299 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
26300 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
26301 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
26302
26303 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26304 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26305
26306 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
26307 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
26308 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
26309 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
26310 group).
26311
26312 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
26313
26314 @item gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26315 @vindex gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26316 Groups in which links in html articles are considered all safe. The
26317 value may be a regexp matching those groups, a list of group names, or
26318 @code{nil}. This overrides @code{mm-w3m-safe-url-regexp}. The default
26319 value is @code{"\\`nnrss[+:]"}. This is effective only when emacs-w3m
26320 renders html articles, i.e., in the case @code{mm-text-html-renderer} is
26321 set to @code{w3m}. @xref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization,
26322 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}.
26323
26324 @end table
26325
26326 @node The End
26327 @chapter The End
26328
26329 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
26330 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
26331
26332 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
26333
26334 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
26335
26336 @quotation
26337 @strong{Te Deum}
26338
26339 @sp 1
26340 Not because of victories @*
26341 I sing,@*
26342 having none,@*
26343 but for the common sunshine,@*
26344 the breeze,@*
26345 the largess of the spring.
26346
26347 @sp 1
26348 Not for victory@*
26349 but for the day's work done@*
26350 as well as I was able;@*
26351 not for a seat upon the dais@*
26352 but at the common table.@*
26353 @end quotation
26354
26355
26356 @node Appendices
26357 @chapter Appendices
26358
26359 @menu
26360 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
26361 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
26362 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
26363 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
26364 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
26365 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
26366 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
26367 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
26368 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
26369 @end menu
26370
26371
26372 @node XEmacs
26373 @section XEmacs
26374 @cindex XEmacs
26375 @cindex installing under XEmacs
26376
26377 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
26378 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
26379 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
26380 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
26381 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print},
26382 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
26383
26384
26385 @node History
26386 @section History
26387
26388 @cindex history
26389 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
26390 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
26391
26392 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
26393 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
26394 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
26395 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
26396 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
26397
26398 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
26399 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
26400 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
26401 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
26402 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
26403 appropriate name, don't you think?)
26404
26405 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
26406 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
26407 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
26408 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
26409
26410 @menu
26411 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
26412 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
26413 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
26414 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
26415 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
26416 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
26417 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
26418 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
26419 @end menu
26420
26421
26422 @node Gnus Versions
26423 @subsection Gnus Versions
26424 @cindex ding Gnus
26425 @cindex September Gnus
26426 @cindex Red Gnus
26427 @cindex Quassia Gnus
26428 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
26429 @cindex Oort Gnus
26430 @cindex No Gnus
26431 @cindex Ma Gnus
26432 @cindex Gnus versions
26433
26434 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
26435 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
26436 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
26437
26438 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
26439 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
26440
26441 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
26442 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
26443
26444 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
26445 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
26446
26447 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
26448 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
26449 1999.
26450
26451 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
26452 Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
26453
26454 On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
26455
26456 On April 19, 2010 Gnus development was moved to Git. See
26457 http://git.gnus.org for details (http://www.gnus.org will be updated
26458 with the information when possible).
26459
26460 On the January 31th 2012, Ma Gnus was begun.
26461
26462 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name---``(ding)
26463 Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
26464 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'', ``Ma Gnus''---don't
26465 panic. Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly.
26466 Whatever you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of
26467 its reach. Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to
26468 that instead.
26469
26470
26471 @node Why?
26472 @subsection Why?
26473
26474 What's the point of Gnus?
26475
26476 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
26477 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
26478 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
26479 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
26480 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
26481 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
26482 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
26483 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
26484 keep track of millions of people who post?
26485
26486 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
26487 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
26488 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
26489 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
26490 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
26491 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
26492 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
26493 every one of you to explore and invent.
26494
26495 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
26496 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
26497
26498
26499 @node Compatibility
26500 @subsection Compatibility
26501
26502 @cindex compatibility
26503 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
26504 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
26505 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
26506
26507 Our motto is:
26508 @quotation
26509 @cartouche
26510 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
26511 @end cartouche
26512 @end quotation
26513
26514 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
26515 their names.
26516
26517 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
26518 Articles}.
26519
26520 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
26521 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
26522 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
26523 important variables have their values copied into their global
26524 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
26525 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
26526
26527 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
26528 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
26529 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
26530 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
26531 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
26532 peculiar results.
26533
26534 @cindex hilit19
26535 @cindex highlighting
26536 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
26537 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
26538 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
26539 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
26540 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
26541 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
26542 Away!
26543
26544 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
26545 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
26546 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
26547 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
26548
26549 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
26550 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
26551 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
26552 to stop doing it the old way.
26553
26554 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
26555
26556 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
26557 @findex gnus-bug
26558 @cindex reporting bugs
26559 @cindex bugs
26560 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
26561 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
26562 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
26563
26564 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
26565 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
26566 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
26567 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
26568 up at you.
26569
26570
26571 @node Conformity
26572 @subsection Conformity
26573
26574 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
26575 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
26576 with, of course.
26577
26578 @table @strong
26579
26580 @item RFC (2)822
26581 @cindex RFC 822
26582 @cindex RFC 2822
26583 There are no known breaches of this standard.
26584
26585 @item RFC 1036
26586 @cindex RFC 1036
26587 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
26588
26589 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
26590 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
26591 We do have some breaches to this one.
26592
26593 @table @emph
26594
26595 @item X-Newsreader
26596 @itemx User-Agent
26597 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
26598 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
26599 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
26600 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
26601 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
26602 @end table
26603
26604 @item USEFOR
26605 @cindex USEFOR
26606 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
26607 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
26608 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
26609 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
26610
26611 @item MIME---RFC 2045--2049 etc
26612 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
26613 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
26614
26615 @item Disposition Notifications---RFC 2298
26616 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
26617
26618 @item PGP---RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
26619 @cindex RFC 1991
26620 @cindex RFC 2440
26621 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
26622 published as an informational RFC@. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
26623 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
26624 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
26625 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
26626 decryption).
26627
26628 @item PGP/MIME---RFC 2015/3156
26629 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
26630 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RFC 1991/2440 format.
26631 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
26632
26633 @item S/MIME---RFC 2633
26634 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
26635
26636 @item IMAP---RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
26637 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
26638 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
26639 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
26640 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
26641 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
26642 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
26643 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
26644
26645 @end table
26646
26647 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
26648 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
26649 know.
26650
26651
26652 @node Emacsen
26653 @subsection Emacsen
26654 @cindex Emacsen
26655 @cindex XEmacs
26656 @cindex Mule
26657 @cindex Emacs
26658
26659 This version of Gnus should work on:
26660
26661 @itemize @bullet
26662
26663 @item
26664 Emacs 23.1 and up.
26665
26666 @item
26667 XEmacs 21.4 and up.
26668
26669 @end itemize
26670
26671 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
26672 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
26673 Emacs versions. Particularly, Gnus 5.10.8 should also work on Emacs
26674 20.7 and XEmacs 21.1.
26675
26676 @c No-merge comment: The paragraph added in v5-10 here must not be
26677 @c synced here!
26678
26679 @node Gnus Development
26680 @subsection Gnus Development
26681
26682 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
26683 discussion on the development mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}, where people
26684 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
26685 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
26686 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
26687 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
26688 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
26689 have names like ``Oort Gnus'' and ``No Gnus''. @xref{Gnus Versions}.
26690
26691 After futzing around for 10--100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
26692 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
26693 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.10.1'' instead. Normal people are
26694 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
26695 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup. This newgroup is mirrored to the
26696 mailing list @samp{info-gnus-english@@gnu.org} which is carried on Gmane
26697 as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.user}. These releases are finally integrated
26698 in Emacs.
26699
26700 @cindex Incoming*
26701 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26702 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26703 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26704 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26705 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26706
26707 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
26708 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
26709 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
26710 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
26711 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
26712 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
26713 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
26714 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
26715 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
26716 can't be assumed to do so.
26717
26718 So if you have problems with or questions about the alpha versions,
26719 direct those to the ding mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}. This list
26720 is also available on Gmane as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.general}.
26721
26722 @cindex Incoming*
26723 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26724 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26725 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26726 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26727 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26728
26729 @node Contributors
26730 @subsection Contributors
26731 @cindex contributors
26732
26733 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
26734 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
26735 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
26736 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
26737 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
26738 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
26739 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
26740 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
26741 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
26742 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
26743
26744 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
26745 wrong show.
26746
26747 @itemize @bullet
26748
26749 @item
26750 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
26751
26752 @item
26753 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el,
26754 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
26755 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
26756 functionality and stuff.
26757
26758 @item
26759 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
26760 well as numerous other things).
26761
26762 @item
26763 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
26764
26765 @item
26766 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
26767
26768 @item
26769 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
26770
26771 @item
26772 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
26773
26774 @item
26775 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
26776 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
26777
26778 @item
26779 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
26780
26781 @item
26782 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section.
26783
26784 @item
26785 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
26786
26787 @item
26788 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
26789
26790 @item
26791 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bug detection and fixes.
26792
26793 @item
26794 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
26795
26796 @item
26797 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
26798 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
26799
26800 @item
26801 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
26802
26803 @item
26804 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
26805
26806 @item
26807 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
26808
26809 @item
26810 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
26811 .newsrc files.
26812
26813 @item
26814 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
26815
26816 @item
26817 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
26818
26819 @item
26820 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
26821
26822 @item
26823 François Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
26824 well as autoconf support.
26825
26826 @end itemize
26827
26828 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
26829 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
26830
26831 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
26832
26833 Christopher Davis,
26834 Andrew Eskilsson,
26835 Kai Grossjohann,
26836 Kevin Greiner,
26837 Jesper Harder,
26838 Paul Jarc,
26839 Simon Josefsson,
26840 David K@aa{}gedal,
26841 Richard Pieri,
26842 Fabrice Popineau,
26843 Daniel Quinlan,
26844 Michael Shields,
26845 Reiner Steib,
26846 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
26847 Jack Vinson,
26848 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
26849 and
26850 Teodor Zlatanov.
26851
26852 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
26853
26854 Jari Aalto,
26855 Adrian Aichner,
26856 Vladimir Alexiev,
26857 Russ Allbery,
26858 Peter Arius,
26859 Matt Armstrong,
26860 Marc Auslander,
26861 Miles Bader,
26862 Alexei V. Barantsev,
26863 Frank Bennett,
26864 Robert Bihlmeyer,
26865 Chris Bone,
26866 Mark Borges,
26867 Mark Boyns,
26868 Lance A. Brown,
26869 Rob Browning,
26870 Kees de Bruin,
26871 Martin Buchholz,
26872 Joe Buehler,
26873 Kevin Buhr,
26874 Alastair Burt,
26875 Joao Cachopo,
26876 Zlatko Calusic,
26877 Massimo Campostrini,
26878 Castor,
26879 David Charlap,
26880 Dan Christensen,
26881 Kevin Christian,
26882 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
26883 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
26884 Laura Conrad,
26885 Michael R. Cook,
26886 Glenn Coombs,
26887 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
26888 Neil Crellin,
26889 Frank D. Cringle,
26890 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
26891 Andre Deparade,
26892 Ulrik Dickow,
26893 Dave Disser,
26894 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
26895 Joev Dubach,
26896 Michael Welsh Duggan,
26897 Dave Edmondson,
26898 Paul Eggert,
26899 Mark W. Eichin,
26900 Karl Eichwalder,
26901 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
26902 Michael Ernst,
26903 Luc Van Eycken,
26904 Sam Falkner,
26905 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
26906 Sigbjorn Finne,
26907 Sven Fischer,
26908 Paul Fisher,
26909 Decklin Foster,
26910 Gary D. Foster,
26911 Paul Franklin,
26912 Guy Geens,
26913 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
26914 David S. Goldberg,
26915 Michelangelo Grigni,
26916 Dale Hagglund,
26917 D. Hall,
26918 Magnus Hammerin,
26919 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
26920 Raja R. Harinath,
26921 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
26922 P. E. Jareth Hein,
26923 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
26924 Scott Hofmann,
26925 Tassilo Horn,
26926 Marc Horowitz,
26927 Gunnar Horrigmo,
26928 Richard Hoskins,
26929 Brad Howes,
26930 Miguel de Icaza,
26931 François Felix Ingrand,
26932 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
26933 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
26934 Lee Iverson,
26935 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
26936 Rajappa Iyer,
26937 Andreas Jaeger,
26938 Adam P. Jenkins,
26939 Randell Jesup,
26940 Fred Johansen,
26941 Gareth Jones,
26942 Greg Klanderman,
26943 Karl Kleinpaste,
26944 Michael Klingbeil,
26945 Peter Skov Knudsen,
26946 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
26947 Petr Konecny,
26948 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
26949 Thor Kristoffersen,
26950 Jens Lautenbacher,
26951 Martin Larose,
26952 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
26953 Joerg Lenneis,
26954 Carsten Leonhardt,
26955 James LewisMoss,
26956 Christian Limpach,
26957 Markus Linnala,
26958 Dave Love,
26959 Mike McEwan,
26960 Tonny Madsen,
26961 Shlomo Mahlab,
26962 Nat Makarevitch,
26963 Istvan Marko,
26964 David Martin,
26965 Jason R. Mastaler,
26966 Gordon Matzigkeit,
26967 Timo Metzemakers,
26968 Richard Mlynarik,
26969 Lantz Moore,
26970 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
26971 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
26972 Hrvoje Niksic,
26973 Andy Norman,
26974 Fred Oberhauser,
26975 C. R. Oldham,
26976 Alexandre Oliva,
26977 Ken Olstad,
26978 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
26979 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
26980 Ettore Perazzoli,
26981 William Perry,
26982 Stephen Peters,
26983 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
26984 Ulrich Pfeifer,
26985 Matt Pharr,
26986 Andy Piper,
26987 John McClary Prevost,
26988 Bill Pringlemeir,
26989 Mike Pullen,
26990 Jim Radford,
26991 Colin Rafferty,
26992 Lasse Rasinen,
26993 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
26994 Joe Reiss,
26995 Renaud Rioboo,
26996 Roland B. Roberts,
26997 Bart Robinson,
26998 Christian von Roques,
26999 Markus Rost,
27000 Jason Rumney,
27001 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
27002 Jay Sachs,
27003 Dewey M. Sasser,
27004 Conrad Sauerwald,
27005 Loren Schall,
27006 Dan Schmidt,
27007 Ralph Schleicher,
27008 Philippe Schnoebelen,
27009 Andreas Schwab,
27010 Randal L. Schwartz,
27011 Danny Siu,
27012 Matt Simmons,
27013 Paul D. Smith,
27014 Jeff Sparkes,
27015 Toby Speight,
27016 Michael Sperber,
27017 Darren Stalder,
27018 Richard Stallman,
27019 Greg Stark,
27020 Sam Steingold,
27021 Paul Stevenson,
27022 Jonas Steverud,
27023 Paul Stodghill,
27024 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
27025 Kurt Swanson,
27026 Samuel Tardieu,
27027 Teddy,
27028 Chuck Thompson,
27029 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
27030 Philippe Troin,
27031 James Troup,
27032 Trung Tran-Duc,
27033 Jack Twilley,
27034 Aaron M. Ucko,
27035 Aki Vehtari,
27036 Didier Verna,
27037 Vladimir Volovich,
27038 Jan Vroonhof,
27039 Stefan Waldherr,
27040 Pete Ware,
27041 Barry A. Warsaw,
27042 Christoph Wedler,
27043 Joe Wells,
27044 Lee Willis,
27045 and
27046 Lloyd Zusman.
27047
27048
27049 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
27050 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
27051 (550kB and counting).
27052
27053 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
27054 sure.
27055
27056 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
27057 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
27058
27059
27060 @node New Features
27061 @subsection New Features
27062 @cindex new features
27063
27064 @menu
27065 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
27066 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
27067 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
27068 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
27069 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
27070 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
27071 * No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13.
27072 * Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
27073 @end menu
27074
27075 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
27076 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
27077 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
27078
27079 @node ding Gnus
27080 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
27081
27082 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
27083
27084 @itemize @bullet
27085
27086 @item
27087 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
27088 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
27089
27090 @item
27091 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
27092 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
27093
27094 @item
27095 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
27096
27097 @item
27098 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
27099 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
27100 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
27101
27102 @item
27103 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
27104 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
27105 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
27106 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27107
27108 @item
27109 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
27110 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27111
27112 @item
27113 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
27114 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
27115 (@pxref{The Active File}).
27116
27117 @item
27118 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
27119 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
27120
27121 @item
27122 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
27123 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
27124 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27125
27126 @item
27127 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
27128 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
27129 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
27130
27131 @item
27132 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
27133 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
27134
27135 @item
27136 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
27137 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
27138
27139 @item
27140 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
27141 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27142
27143 @item
27144 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
27145 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
27146
27147 @item
27148 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
27149 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27150
27151 @item
27152 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
27153
27154 @item
27155 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
27156 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
27157
27158 @item
27159 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
27160 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
27161
27162 @item
27163 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
27164 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
27165
27166 @item
27167 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
27168
27169 @item
27170 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
27171 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27172
27173 @item
27174 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
27175 Articles}).
27176
27177 @item
27178 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
27179 Buttons}).
27180
27181 @item
27182 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
27183 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
27184
27185 @end itemize
27186
27187
27188 @node September Gnus
27189 @subsubsection September Gnus
27190
27191 @iftex
27192 @iflatex
27193 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
27194 @end iflatex
27195 @end iftex
27196
27197 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
27198
27199 @itemize @bullet
27200
27201 @item
27202 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
27203 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
27204 now obsolete.
27205
27206 @item
27207 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
27208 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
27209 Threading}).
27210
27211 @lisp
27212 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
27213 @end lisp
27214
27215 @item
27216 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
27217 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
27218
27219 @item
27220 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
27221 referred.
27222
27223 @item
27224 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions.
27225
27226 @item
27227 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
27228
27229 @item
27230 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
27231
27232 @lisp
27233 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
27234 @end lisp
27235
27236 @item
27237 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
27238 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
27239
27240 @lisp
27241 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
27242 @end lisp
27243
27244 @item
27245 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
27246 Groups}).
27247
27248 @item
27249 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
27250 Topics}).
27251
27252 @lisp
27253 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
27254 @end lisp
27255
27256 @item
27257 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
27258
27259 @item
27260 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
27261 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
27262
27263 @lisp
27264 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
27265 @end lisp
27266
27267 @item
27268 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
27269 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
27270
27271 @item
27272 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
27273
27274 @item
27275 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
27276 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
27277 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27278
27279 @item
27280 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets.
27281
27282 @item
27283 The Gnus cache is much faster.
27284
27285 @item
27286 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
27287 Groups}).
27288
27289 @item
27290 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
27291 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
27292
27293 @item
27294 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
27295 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
27296
27297 @item
27298 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
27299 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
27300
27301 @item
27302 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
27303 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
27304 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
27305
27306 @item
27307 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
27308 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
27309
27310 @item
27311 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
27312
27313 @item
27314 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27315
27316 @item
27317 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
27318
27319 @item
27320 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
27321
27322 @item
27323 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
27324 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
27325
27326 @item
27327 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
27328 Layout}).
27329
27330 @item
27331 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
27332 @iftex
27333 @iflatex
27334 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
27335 @end iflatex
27336 @end iftex
27337
27338 @item
27339 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27340
27341 @lisp
27342 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
27343 @end lisp
27344
27345 @item
27346 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
27347
27348 @item
27349 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
27350
27351 @item
27352 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
27353 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27354
27355 @lisp
27356 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
27357 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
27358 @end lisp
27359
27360 @item
27361 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
27362 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
27363
27364 @lisp
27365 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
27366 @end lisp
27367
27368 @item
27369 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
27370 buffer to allow easier treatment.
27371
27372 @item
27373 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
27374
27375 @item
27376 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
27377 Articles}).
27378
27379 @lisp
27380 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
27381 @end lisp
27382
27383 @item
27384 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
27385 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
27386
27387 @lisp
27388 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
27389 @end lisp
27390
27391 @item
27392 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
27393 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27394
27395 @item
27396 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
27397 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27398
27399 @lisp
27400 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
27401 @end lisp
27402
27403 @item
27404 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27405
27406 @item
27407 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
27408
27409 @item
27410 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
27411
27412 @end itemize
27413
27414
27415 @node Red Gnus
27416 @subsubsection Red Gnus
27417
27418 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
27419
27420 @iftex
27421 @iflatex
27422 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
27423 @end iflatex
27424 @end iftex
27425
27426 @itemize @bullet
27427
27428 @item
27429 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
27430
27431 @item
27432 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
27433 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27434
27435 @item
27436 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
27437 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
27438 Scoring}).
27439
27440 @item
27441 Article washing status can be displayed in the
27442 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
27443
27444 @item
27445 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
27446
27447 @item
27448 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
27449 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
27450
27451 @lisp
27452 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
27453 @end lisp
27454
27455 @item
27456 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
27457 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
27458 been added.
27459
27460 @item
27461 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extensible (@pxref{Document
27462 Server Internals}).
27463
27464 @item
27465 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
27466 Parameters}).
27467
27468 @item
27469 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
27470
27471 @item
27472 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
27473 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
27474
27475 @item
27476 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
27477 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
27478 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
27479
27480 @item
27481 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
27482 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27483
27484 @item
27485 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
27486 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
27487
27488 @item
27489 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
27490 (@pxref{Undo}).
27491
27492 @item
27493 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
27494 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27495
27496 @item
27497 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
27498 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27499
27500 @lisp
27501 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
27502 @end lisp
27503
27504 @item
27505 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
27506
27507 @lisp
27508 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
27509 @end lisp
27510
27511 @item
27512 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
27513 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27514
27515 @item
27516 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
27517 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27518
27519 @item
27520 A new command for reading collections of documents
27521 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
27522 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
27523
27524 @item
27525 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
27526 Marks}).
27527
27528 @item
27529 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
27530 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
27531
27532 @item
27533 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
27534 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
27535 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
27536
27537 @item
27538 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
27539 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
27540 Sorting}).
27541
27542 @item
27543 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
27544 Groups}).
27545
27546 @item
27547 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
27548 Commands}).
27549 @iftex
27550 @iflatex
27551 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
27552 @end iflatex
27553 @end iftex
27554
27555 @item
27556 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
27557 Variables}).
27558
27559 @item
27560 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
27561 Mail}).
27562
27563 @item
27564 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
27565 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
27566
27567 @item
27568 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
27569
27570 @end itemize
27571
27572
27573 @node Quassia Gnus
27574 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
27575
27576 New features in Gnus 5.6:
27577
27578 @itemize @bullet
27579
27580 @item
27581 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
27582 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
27583 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
27584
27585 @item
27586 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
27587 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
27588 group, which is created automatically.
27589
27590 @item
27591 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
27592 values.
27593
27594 @item
27595 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-IDs.
27596
27597 @item
27598 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
27599 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
27600
27601 @item
27602 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
27603 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
27604
27605 @item
27606 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
27607
27608 @item
27609 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
27610 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
27611
27612 @item
27613 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
27614
27615 @item
27616 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
27617 details.
27618
27619 @item
27620 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
27621 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
27622
27623 @item
27624 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
27625 control over simplification.
27626
27627 @item
27628 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
27629
27630 @item
27631 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
27632 limit.
27633
27634 @item
27635 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
27636
27637 @item
27638 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
27639
27640 @item
27641 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
27642 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
27643 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
27644
27645 @item
27646 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
27647 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
27648
27649 @item
27650 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
27651 text---@kbd{W d}.
27652
27653 @item
27654 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
27655 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
27656
27657 @item
27658 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
27659 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
27660
27661 @item
27662 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
27663 has been added.
27664
27665 @item
27666 A history of where mails have been split is available.
27667
27668 @item
27669 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
27670
27671 @item
27672 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
27673 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
27674
27675 @item
27676 A new function for citing in Message has been
27677 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
27678
27679 @item
27680 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
27681
27682 @item
27683 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
27684 been added.
27685
27686 @item
27687 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
27688 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
27689
27690 @item
27691 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
27692 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
27693
27694 @item
27695 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
27696
27697 @item
27698 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
27699
27700 @end itemize
27701
27702 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
27703 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
27704
27705 New features in Gnus 5.8:
27706
27707 @itemize @bullet
27708
27709 @item
27710 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
27711 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
27712
27713 If you used procmail like in
27714
27715 @lisp
27716 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
27717 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
27718 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
27719 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
27720 @end lisp
27721
27722 this now has changed to
27723
27724 @lisp
27725 (setq mail-sources
27726 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
27727 :suffix ".in")))
27728 @end lisp
27729
27730 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
27731
27732 @item
27733 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
27734 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
27735
27736 @item
27737 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
27738 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
27739
27740 @item
27741 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
27742 called to position point.
27743
27744 @item
27745 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
27746 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
27747
27748 @item
27749 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
27750 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
27751
27752 @item
27753 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
27754 subtly different manner.
27755
27756 @item
27757 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
27758 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
27759 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
27760
27761 @item
27762 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
27763
27764 @end itemize
27765
27766 @node Oort Gnus
27767 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
27768 @cindex Oort Gnus
27769
27770 New features in Gnus 5.10:
27771
27772 @itemize @bullet
27773
27774 @item Installation changes
27775 @c ***********************
27776
27777 @itemize @bullet
27778 @item
27779 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
27780
27781 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
27782 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
27783 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
27784 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
27785 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
27786 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
27787 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
27788 isn't save in general.
27789
27790 @item
27791 Lisp files are now installed in @file{.../site-lisp/gnus/} by default.
27792 It defaulted to @file{.../site-lisp/} formerly. In addition to this,
27793 the new installer issues a warning if other Gnus installations which
27794 will shadow the latest one are detected. You can then remove those
27795 shadows manually or remove them using @code{make
27796 remove-installed-shadows}.
27797
27798 @item
27799 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
27800
27801 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
27802 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
27803 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, if you want
27804 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
27805 the second parameter.
27806
27807 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
27808 automatic recognition of XEmacs and Emacs, generates
27809 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
27810 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
27811 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
27812 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
27813 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
27814 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
27815 cycle used under Unix systems.
27816
27817 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} and @file{xemacs.mak}
27818 superfluous, so they have been removed.
27819
27820 @item
27821 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
27822
27823 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
27824 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
27825 hierarchy.
27826
27827 @c FIXME: 'gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
27828 @c the repository. We should find a better place for this item.
27829 @item
27830 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
27831
27832 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
27833 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
27834 lisp directory into load-path.
27835
27836 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
27837 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
27838
27839 @end itemize
27840
27841 @item New packages and libraries within Gnus
27842 @c *****************************************
27843
27844 @itemize @bullet
27845
27846 @item
27847 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
27848 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
27849
27850 @item
27851 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
27852
27853 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
27854 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GnuTLS.
27855
27856 @item
27857 Improved anti-spam features.
27858
27859 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
27860 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
27861 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
27862 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
27863 are also new. @ref{Thwarting Email Spam} and @ref{Spam Package}.
27864 @c FIXME: @xref{Spam Package}?. Should this be under Misc?
27865
27866 @item
27867 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
27868
27869 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
27870 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
27871 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
27872 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
27873 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
27874
27875 @end itemize
27876
27877 @item Changes in group mode
27878 @c ************************
27879
27880 @itemize @bullet
27881
27882 @item
27883 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
27884 using @kbd{G M}.
27885
27886 @item
27887 Retrieval of charters and control messages
27888
27889 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
27890 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
27891
27892 @item
27893 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
27894
27895 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
27896 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
27897 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
27898 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
27899 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
27900 parameters, a'la:
27901 @lisp
27902 (setq gnus-parameters
27903 '(("mail\\..*"
27904 (gnus-show-threads nil)
27905 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
27906 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
27907 (to-group . "\\1"))))
27908 @end lisp
27909
27910 @item
27911 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
27912
27913 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
27914 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
27915 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
27916 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
27917 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} (called after getting new
27918 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
27919 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
27920 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
27921 when getting new mail, remove the function.
27922
27923 @item
27924 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
27925
27926 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
27927 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
27928 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
27929
27930 @item
27931 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
27932 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
27933
27934 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
27935 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
27936 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
27937 @lisp
27938 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
27939 @end lisp
27940
27941 @item
27942 Old intermediate incoming mail files (@file{Incoming*}) are deleted
27943 after a couple of days, not immediately. @xref{Mail Source
27944 Customization}. (New in Gnus 5.10.10 / Emacs 22.2)
27945
27946 @end itemize
27947
27948 @item Changes in summary and article mode
27949 @c **************************************
27950
27951 @itemize @bullet
27952
27953 @item
27954 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
27955 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
27956 region if the region is active.
27957
27958 @item
27959 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
27960 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
27961
27962 @item
27963 Article Buttons
27964
27965 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
27966 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
27967 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
27968 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
27969
27970 @item
27971 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
27972
27973 @item
27974 Picons
27975
27976 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
27977 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
27978
27979 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
27980 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
27981 @xref{Picons}.
27982
27983 @item
27984 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
27985 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
27986
27987 @item
27988 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
27989
27990 @item
27991 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
27992 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
27993
27994 @item
27995 Warn about email replies to news
27996
27997 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
27998 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
27999 you.
28000
28001 @item
28002 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
28003 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
28004 built.
28005
28006 @item
28007 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
28008 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
28009
28010 @item
28011 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
28012 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
28013
28014 @item
28015 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
28016 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
28017
28018 @item
28019 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
28020
28021 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
28022 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
28023 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
28024 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
28025 citations.
28026
28027 The new command @kbd{W Y f}
28028 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}) allows deuglifying broken
28029 Outlook (Express) articles.
28030
28031 @item
28032 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
28033
28034 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
28035 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
28036 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
28037 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
28038
28039 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
28040 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
28041 message cited below.
28042
28043 @item
28044 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc.)@: are now displayed graphically in
28045 Emacs too.
28046
28047 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
28048 disable it.
28049
28050 @item
28051 Face headers handling. @xref{Face}.
28052
28053 @item
28054 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
28055 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
28056
28057 @item
28058 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
28059
28060 @item
28061 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
28062
28063 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
28064 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
28065 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
28066 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
28067 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
28068 groups.
28069
28070 @item
28071 Deleting of attachments.
28072
28073 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
28074 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
28075 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
28076 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
28077 that support editing.
28078
28079 @item
28080 @code{gnus-default-charset}
28081
28082 The default value is determined from the
28083 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
28084 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
28085 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
28086
28087 @item
28088 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
28089
28090 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
28091 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
28092 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
28093
28094 @item
28095 Extended format specs.
28096
28097 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
28098 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
28099 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
28100 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
28101 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
28102 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
28103
28104 @item
28105 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
28106 @c FIXME: Was this a user-visible change?
28107
28108 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
28109 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
28110 out other articles.
28111
28112 @item
28113 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
28114
28115 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
28116 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
28117 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
28118 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
28119
28120 @item
28121 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
28122
28123 @end itemize
28124
28125 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28126 @c ****************************************************
28127
28128 @itemize @bullet
28129
28130 @item
28131 Delayed articles
28132
28133 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
28134 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
28135 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
28136
28137 @item
28138 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
28139 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
28140
28141 @item
28142 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
28143 Gcc articles as read.
28144
28145 @item
28146 Externalizing of attachments
28147
28148 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
28149 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
28150 local files as external parts.
28151
28152 @item
28153 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
28154 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
28155
28156 @item
28157 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
28158
28159 Earlier it was generated when the user configurable email address was
28160 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
28161 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
28162 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
28163 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
28164 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
28165 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
28166 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
28167 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
28168
28169 @item
28170 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
28171
28172 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
28173 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
28174 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
28175 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
28176 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
28177 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
28178
28179 @item
28180 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
28181 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
28182 @code{nil}.
28183
28184 @item
28185 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers. @xref{X-Face}.
28186
28187 @item
28188 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
28189
28190 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
28191 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
28192 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
28193 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
28194 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
28195 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
28196 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
28197 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
28198 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
28199 was inserted directly.
28200
28201 @item
28202 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
28203
28204 @c FIXME should that not be 'message-user-agent?
28205 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
28206 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
28207 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
28208 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
28209
28210 @item
28211 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
28212
28213 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
28214 @lisp
28215 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
28216 'bbdb-complete-name)
28217 @end lisp
28218
28219 @item
28220 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
28221
28222 Add a new format of match like
28223 @lisp
28224 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
28225 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28226 @end lisp
28227 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
28228 @lisp
28229 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
28230 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28231 @end lisp
28232
28233 @item
28234 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
28235
28236 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
28237 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
28238 need add those two headers too.
28239
28240 @item
28241 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
28242 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
28243 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
28244 versions.
28245
28246 @item
28247 The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
28248 ``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
28249 inline PGP signed messages. @xref{Flowed text, , Flowed text,
28250 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
28251 @c This entry is also present in the node "No Gnus".
28252
28253 @item
28254 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
28255
28256 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
28257
28258 @item
28259 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
28260
28261 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
28262 the valid values.
28263
28264 @item
28265 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
28266
28267 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
28268 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
28269 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
28270 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
28271 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
28272 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
28273 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
28274 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
28275
28276 @item
28277 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
28278 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630--2633).
28279
28280 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
28281 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
28282 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
28283 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
28284
28285 @item
28286 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
28287 C-m}.
28288
28289 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
28290 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
28291
28292 @item
28293 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to the symbol
28294 @code{best}.
28295
28296 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
28297 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
28298 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
28299 invalidate the digital signature.
28300
28301 @item
28302 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
28303 decompressed when activated.
28304 @c FIXME: Does this affect article or message mode?
28305
28306 @item
28307 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
28308
28309 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
28310 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
28311 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
28312 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
28313 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
28314 controls this.
28315
28316 @item You can now drag and drop attachments to the Message buffer.
28317 See @code{mml-dnd-protocol-alist} and @code{mml-dnd-attach-options}.
28318 @xref{MIME, ,MIME, message, Message Manual}.
28319 @c New in 5.10.9 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.1)
28320
28321 @item @code{auto-fill-mode} is enabled by default in Message mode.
28322 See @code{message-fill-column}. @xref{Various Message Variables, ,
28323 Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
28324 @c New in Gnus 5.10.12 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.3)
28325
28326 @end itemize
28327
28328 @item Changes in back ends
28329 @c ***********************
28330
28331 @itemize @bullet
28332 @item
28333 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
28334
28335 @item
28336 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
28337
28338 @item
28339 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
28340
28341 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
28342
28343 @item
28344 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
28345
28346 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
28347 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
28348 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
28349 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within, e.g., a department. It
28350 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
28351 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
28352 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
28353 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
28354 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
28355 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
28356 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
28357
28358 @end itemize
28359
28360 @item Appearance
28361 @c *************
28362
28363 @itemize @bullet
28364
28365 @item
28366 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
28367 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
28368
28369 @item
28370 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
28371 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
28372 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
28373 message, Message Manual}).
28374
28375 @item
28376 The tool bars have been updated to use GNOME icons in Group, Summary and
28377 Message mode. You can also customize the tool bars: @kbd{M-x
28378 customize-apropos RET -tool-bar$} should get you started. This is a new
28379 feature in Gnus 5.10.10. (Only for Emacs, not in XEmacs.)
28380
28381 @item The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly
28382 in the group buffer, see the variable @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}.
28383 Its default value depends on your Emacs version. This is a new feature
28384 in Gnus 5.10.9.
28385 @end itemize
28386
28387
28388 @item Miscellaneous changes
28389 @c ************************
28390
28391 @itemize @bullet
28392
28393 @item
28394 @code{gnus-agent}
28395
28396 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
28397 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
28398 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
28399 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
28400 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
28401 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
28402 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
28403 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
28404 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
28405 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
28406 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
28407 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
28408 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
28409 is not needed any more.
28410
28411 @item
28412 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
28413
28414 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
28415 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
28416 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
28417
28418 @item
28419 Dired integration
28420
28421 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
28422 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
28423 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
28424 entry.
28425
28426 @item
28427 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
28428
28429 @item
28430 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
28431
28432 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
28433
28434 @end itemize
28435
28436 @end itemize
28437
28438 @node No Gnus
28439 @subsubsection No Gnus
28440 @cindex No Gnus
28441
28442 New features in No Gnus:
28443 @c FIXME: Gnus 5.12?
28444
28445 @include gnus-news.texi
28446
28447 @node Ma Gnus
28448 @subsubsection Ma Gnus
28449 @cindex Ma Gnus
28450
28451 I'm sure there will be lots of text here. It's really spelled 真
28452 Gnus.
28453
28454 New features in Ma Gnus:
28455
28456 @itemize @bullet
28457
28458 @item Changes in summary and article mode
28459 @c **************************************
28460
28461 @itemize @bullet
28462
28463 @item
28464 By default, @acronym{MIME} part buttons for attachments (if any) will
28465 appear in the end of the article header in addition to the bottom of the
28466 article body, so you can easily find them without scrolling the article
28467 again and again. @xref{MIME Commands}.
28468
28469 @end itemize
28470
28471 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28472 @c ****************************************************
28473
28474 @itemize @bullet
28475
28476 @item
28477 The new hooks @code{gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook} and
28478 @code{gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook} are run before/after encoding
28479 the message body of the Gcc copy of a sent message. See
28480 @xref{Archived Messages}.
28481
28482 @end itemize
28483
28484 @end itemize
28485
28486 @iftex
28487
28488 @page
28489 @node The Manual
28490 @section The Manual
28491 @cindex colophon
28492 @cindex manual
28493
28494 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
28495 either @code{texi2dvi}
28496 @iflatex
28497 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
28498 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
28499 @end iflatex
28500 to get what you hold in your hands now.
28501
28502 The following conventions have been used:
28503
28504 @enumerate
28505
28506 @item
28507 This is a @samp{string}
28508
28509 @item
28510 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
28511
28512 @item
28513 This is a @file{file}
28514
28515 @item
28516 This is a @code{symbol}
28517
28518 @end enumerate
28519
28520 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
28521 mean:
28522
28523 @lisp
28524 (setq flargnoze "yes")
28525 @end lisp
28526
28527 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
28528
28529 @lisp
28530 (setq flumphel 'yes)
28531 @end lisp
28532
28533 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
28534 ever get them confused.
28535
28536 @iflatex
28537 @c @head
28538 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
28539 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
28540 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
28541 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
28542 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
28543 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
28544 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
28545 @end iflatex
28546
28547 @end iftex
28548
28549
28550 @node On Writing Manuals
28551 @section On Writing Manuals
28552
28553 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
28554 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
28555 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
28556 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
28557 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
28558 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code go hand
28559 in hand.
28560
28561 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
28562 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
28563 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
28564 started with Gnus.
28565
28566 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
28567 reference manual as source material. It would look quite different.
28568
28569
28570 @page
28571 @node Terminology
28572 @section Terminology
28573
28574 @cindex terminology
28575 @table @dfn
28576
28577 @item news
28578 @cindex news
28579 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
28580 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
28581 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
28582 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
28583 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
28584
28585 @item mail
28586 @cindex mail
28587 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
28588 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
28589 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
28590 not posting, and replying is not following up.
28591
28592 @item reply
28593 @cindex reply
28594 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
28595
28596 @item follow up
28597 @cindex follow up
28598 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
28599 are reading.
28600
28601 @item back end
28602 @cindex back end
28603 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
28604 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
28605 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
28606 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
28607 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
28608 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
28609 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
28610 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
28611 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
28612 number 4711''.
28613
28614 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
28615 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
28616 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
28617 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
28618 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
28619 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
28620
28621 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
28622 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
28623 access the articles.
28624
28625 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
28626 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
28627 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
28628 confusing.
28629
28630 @item native
28631 @cindex native
28632 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
28633 default, way of getting news. Groups from the native select method
28634 have names like @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}.
28635
28636 @item foreign
28637 @cindex foreign
28638 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same
28639 time. These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends
28640 for getting news. Foreign groups have names like
28641 @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
28642
28643 @item secondary
28644 @cindex secondary
28645 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and
28646 being foreign, but they mostly act like they are native, but they, too
28647 have names like @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
28648
28649 @item article
28650 @cindex article
28651 A message that has been posted as news.
28652
28653 @item mail message
28654 @cindex mail message
28655 A message that has been mailed.
28656
28657 @item message
28658 @cindex message
28659 A mail message or news article
28660
28661 @item head
28662 @cindex head
28663 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.)@: is
28664 put.
28665
28666 @item body
28667 @cindex body
28668 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
28669 body.
28670
28671 @item header
28672 @cindex header
28673 A line from the head of an article.
28674
28675 @item headers
28676 @cindex headers
28677 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
28678 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
28679
28680 @item @acronym{NOV}
28681 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
28682 @acronym{NOV} stands for News OverView, which is a type of news server
28683 header which provide datas containing the condensed header information
28684 of articles. They are produced by the server itself; in the @code{nntp}
28685 back end Gnus uses the ones that the @acronym{NNTP} server makes, but
28686 Gnus makes them by itself for some backends (in particular, @code{nnml}).
28687
28688 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
28689 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
28690 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
28691 normal @sc{head} format.
28692
28693 The @acronym{NOV} data consist of one or more text lines (@pxref{Text
28694 Lines, ,Motion by Text Lines, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual})
28695 where each line has the header information of one article. The header
28696 information is a tab-separated series of the header's contents including
28697 an article number, a subject, an author, a date, a message-id,
28698 references, etc.
28699
28700 Those data enable Gnus to generate summary lines quickly. However, if
28701 the server does not support @acronym{NOV} or you disable it purposely or
28702 for some reason, Gnus will try to generate the header information by
28703 parsing each article's headers one by one. It will take time.
28704 Therefore, it is not usually a good idea to set nn*-nov-is-evil
28705 (@pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}) to a non-@code{nil} value unless you
28706 know that the server makes wrong @acronym{NOV} data.
28707
28708 @item level
28709 @cindex levels
28710 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1--9). The ones
28711 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
28712 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1--5 are considered
28713 @dfn{subscribed}; 6--7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
28714 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
28715 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
28716
28717 @item killed groups
28718 @cindex killed groups
28719 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
28720 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
28721
28722 @item zombie groups
28723 @cindex zombie groups
28724 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
28725
28726 @item active file
28727 @cindex active file
28728 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
28729 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
28730 is rather large, as you might surmise.
28731
28732 @item bogus groups
28733 @cindex bogus groups
28734 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
28735 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
28736 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
28737
28738 @item activating
28739 @cindex activating groups
28740 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
28741 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
28742 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
28743
28744 @item spool
28745 @cindex spool
28746 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
28747 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
28748 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
28749
28750 @item server
28751 @cindex server
28752 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
28753
28754 @item select method
28755 @cindex select method
28756 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
28757 server settings.
28758
28759 @item virtual server
28760 @cindex virtual server
28761 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
28762 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
28763 whole is a virtual server.
28764
28765 @item washing
28766 @cindex washing
28767 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
28768 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
28769 original.
28770
28771 @item ephemeral groups
28772 @cindex ephemeral groups
28773 @cindex temporary groups
28774 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
28775 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
28776 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
28777
28778 @item solid groups
28779 @cindex solid groups
28780 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
28781 group buffer are solid groups.
28782
28783 @item sparse articles
28784 @cindex sparse articles
28785 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
28786 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
28787
28788 @item threading
28789 @cindex threading
28790 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
28791 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
28792
28793 @item root
28794 @cindex root
28795 @cindex thread root
28796 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
28797 articles in the thread.
28798
28799 @item parent
28800 @cindex parent
28801 An article that has responses.
28802
28803 @item child
28804 @cindex child
28805 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
28806
28807 @item digest
28808 @cindex digest
28809 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
28810 specified by RFC 1153.
28811
28812 @item splitting
28813 @cindex splitting, terminology
28814 @cindex mail sorting
28815 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
28816 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
28817 incorrectly called mail filtering.
28818
28819 @end table
28820
28821
28822 @page
28823 @node Customization
28824 @section Customization
28825 @cindex general customization
28826
28827 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
28828 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
28829 for some quite common situations.
28830
28831 @menu
28832 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
28833 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
28834 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
28835 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
28836 @end menu
28837
28838
28839 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
28840 @subsection Slow/Expensive Connection
28841
28842 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
28843 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
28844 Gnus has to get from the server.
28845
28846 @table @code
28847
28848 @item gnus-read-active-file
28849 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
28850 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
28851 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28852 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
28853 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
28854
28855 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
28856 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
28857 Usually this one must @emph{always} be @code{nil} (which is the
28858 default). If, for example, you wish to not use @acronym{NOV}
28859 (@pxref{Terminology}) with the @code{nntp} back end (@pxref{Crosspost
28860 Handling}), set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to a non-@code{nil} value
28861 instead of setting this. But you normally do not need to set
28862 @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} since Gnus by itself will detect whether the
28863 @acronym{NNTP} server supports @acronym{NOV}. Anyway, grabbing article
28864 headers from the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast if you tell
28865 Gnus not to use @acronym{NOV}.
28866
28867 As the variables for the other back ends, there are
28868 @code{nndiary-nov-is-evil}, @code{nndir-nov-is-evil},
28869 @code{nnfolder-nov-is-evil}, @code{nnimap-nov-is-evil},
28870 @code{nnml-nov-is-evil}, and @code{nnspool-nov-is-evil}. Note that a
28871 non-@code{nil} value for @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} overrides all those
28872 variables.
28873 @end table
28874
28875
28876 @node Slow Terminal Connection
28877 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
28878
28879 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
28880 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
28881 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
28882
28883 @table @code
28884
28885 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
28886 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
28887 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
28888 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
28889 horizontal and vertical recentering.
28890
28891 @item gnus-visible-headers
28892 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
28893 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
28894 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
28895 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
28896
28897 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
28898 @lisp
28899 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
28900 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
28901 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
28902 @end lisp
28903
28904 @item gnus-use-full-window
28905 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
28906 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
28907 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
28908 want to read them anyway.
28909
28910 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
28911 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
28912 hidden initially.
28913
28914
28915 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
28916 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
28917 lines, which might save some time.
28918 @end table
28919
28920
28921 @node Little Disk Space
28922 @subsection Little Disk Space
28923 @cindex disk space
28924
28925 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
28926 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
28927
28928 @table @code
28929
28930 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
28931 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
28932 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28933 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28934 default.
28935
28936 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
28937 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
28938 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28939 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28940 default.
28941
28942 @item gnus-save-killed-list
28943 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
28944 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
28945 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
28946 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
28947
28948 @end table
28949
28950
28951 @node Slow Machine
28952 @subsection Slow Machine
28953 @cindex slow machine
28954
28955 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
28956 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
28957
28958 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28959 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
28960
28961 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
28962 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
28963 summary buffer faster. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
28964
28965
28966 @page
28967 @node Troubleshooting
28968 @section Troubleshooting
28969 @cindex troubleshooting
28970
28971 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
28972 problems, really.
28973
28974 Ahem.
28975
28976 @enumerate
28977
28978 @item
28979 Make sure your computer is switched on.
28980
28981 @item
28982 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
28983 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
28984 Gnus will work.
28985
28986 @item
28987 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
28988 like @c
28989 @samp{Gnus v5.13} @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change this line!
28990 @c
28991 you have the right files loaded. Otherwise you have some old @file{.el}
28992 files lying around. Delete these.
28993
28994 @item
28995 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
28996 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
28997
28998 @item
28999 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
29000 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
29001 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
29002 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
29003 something like that.
29004 @end enumerate
29005
29006 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
29007
29008 @cindex bugs
29009 @cindex reporting bugs
29010
29011 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
29012 @findex gnus-bug
29013 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
29014 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
29015 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
29016 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
29017
29018 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
29019 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
29020 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
29021 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
29022 time.
29023
29024 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
29025 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
29026 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
29027 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
29028 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
29029 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
29030
29031 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
29032 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
29033 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
29034 the bug report.
29035
29036 @cindex patches
29037 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
29038 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
29039
29040 @cindex edebug
29041 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
29042 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
29043 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
29044 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
29045 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
29046 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
29047 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
29048 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
29049 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
29050 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
29051 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
29052 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
29053 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
29054 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
29055
29056 @cindex elp
29057 @cindex profile
29058 @cindex slow
29059 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
29060 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
29061 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
29062 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
29063 helps isolating the real problem areas).
29064
29065 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP@. The profiler is
29066 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
29067 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
29068 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g., @kbd{M-x
29069 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
29070 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
29071 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
29072 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
29073 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
29074 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
29075 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
29076 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
29077 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
29078 work perfectly.
29079
29080 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
29081 @cindex ding mailing list
29082 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
29083 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
29084 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
29085 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
29086
29087
29088 @page
29089 @node Gnus Reference Guide
29090 @section Gnus Reference Guide
29091
29092 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
29093 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
29094 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
29095 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
29096 it.
29097
29098 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
29099 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
29100 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
29101 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
29102 and general methods of operation.
29103
29104 @menu
29105 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
29106 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
29107 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
29108 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
29109 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
29110 * Group Info:: The group info format.
29111 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
29112 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
29113 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
29114 @end menu
29115
29116
29117 @node Gnus Utility Functions
29118 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
29119 @cindex Gnus utility functions
29120 @cindex utility functions
29121 @cindex functions
29122 @cindex internal variables
29123
29124 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
29125 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
29126 Below is a list of the most common ones.
29127
29128 @table @code
29129
29130 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
29131 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
29132 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
29133
29134 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
29135 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
29136 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
29137
29138 @item gnus-group-real-name
29139 @findex gnus-group-real-name
29140 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
29141 name.
29142
29143 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
29144 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
29145 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
29146 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
29147
29148 @item gnus-get-info
29149 @findex gnus-get-info
29150 Returns the group info list for @var{group} (@pxref{Group Info}).
29151
29152 @item gnus-group-unread
29153 @findex gnus-group-unread
29154 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
29155 unknown.
29156
29157 @item gnus-active
29158 @findex gnus-active
29159 The active entry (i.e., a cons cell containing the lowest and highest
29160 article numbers) for @var{group}.
29161
29162 @item gnus-set-active
29163 @findex gnus-set-active
29164 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
29165
29166 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29167 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29168 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
29169 exit.
29170
29171 @item gnus-continuum-version
29172 @findex gnus-continuum-version
29173 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
29174 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
29175 versions.
29176
29177 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
29178 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
29179 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
29180
29181 @item gnus-news-group-p
29182 @findex gnus-news-group-p
29183 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
29184
29185 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29186 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29187 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
29188
29189 @item gnus-server-to-method
29190 @findex gnus-server-to-method
29191 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
29192
29193 @item gnus-server-equal
29194 @findex gnus-server-equal
29195 Says whether two virtual servers are essentially equal. For instance,
29196 two virtual servers may have server parameters in different order, but
29197 this function will consider them equal.
29198
29199 @item gnus-group-native-p
29200 @findex gnus-group-native-p
29201 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
29202
29203 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
29204 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
29205 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
29206
29207 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
29208 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
29209 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
29210
29211 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
29212 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
29213 Returns the parameter list of @var{group} (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
29214 If given a second parameter, returns the value of that parameter for
29215 @var{group}.
29216
29217 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
29218 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
29219 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
29220
29221 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
29222 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
29223 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
29224
29225 @item gnus-check-backend-function
29226 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
29227 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
29228 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
29229
29230 @lisp
29231 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
29232 @result{} t
29233 @end lisp
29234
29235 @item gnus-read-method
29236 @findex gnus-read-method
29237 Prompts the user for a select method.
29238
29239 @end table
29240
29241
29242 @node Back End Interface
29243 @subsection Back End Interface
29244
29245 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
29246 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
29247 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
29248 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
29249 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
29250 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
29251
29252 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
29253 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
29254 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
29255 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
29256 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
29257 been opened, the function should fail.
29258
29259 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
29260 name. Take this example:
29261
29262 @lisp
29263 (nntp "odd-one"
29264 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
29265 (nntp-port-number 4324))
29266 @end lisp
29267
29268 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
29269 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
29270
29271 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
29272 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
29273 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
29274
29275 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
29276 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
29277 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
29278
29279 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
29280 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
29281 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
29282 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
29283 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
29284 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
29285 return value.
29286
29287 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
29288 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
29289 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server'';
29290 they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
29291 more.
29292
29293 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
29294 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
29295 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
29296 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
29297 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
29298 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
29299 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
29300 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
29301 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
29302 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
29303
29304 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
29305 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
29306 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
29307 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
29308 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
29309 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
29310 of numbers as long as possible.
29311
29312 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
29313 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
29314 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
29315
29316 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
29317 @code{nnchoke}.
29318
29319 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
29320
29321 @menu
29322 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
29323 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
29324 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
29325 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
29326 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
29327 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
29328 @end menu
29329
29330
29331 @node Required Back End Functions
29332 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
29333
29334 @table @code
29335
29336 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
29337
29338 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
29339 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
29340 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
29341 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
29342
29343 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
29344 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
29345 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
29346 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
29347
29348 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
29349 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
29350 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
29351 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
29352 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
29353 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
29354 number, do maximum fetches.
29355
29356 Here's an example HEAD:
29357
29358 @example
29359 221 1056 Article retrieved.
29360 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
29361 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
29362 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
29363 Subject: Re: Something very droll
29364 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
29365 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
29366 Lines: 26
29367 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
29368 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
29369 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
29370 .
29371 @end example
29372
29373 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
29374 these in the data buffer.
29375
29376 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
29377
29378 @example
29379 headers = *head
29380 head = error / valid-head
29381 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
29382 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
29383 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
29384 header = <text> eol
29385 @end example
29386
29387 @cindex BNF
29388 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
29389
29390 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
29391 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
29392 separated by tabs.
29393
29394 @example
29395 nov-buffer = *nov-line
29396 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
29397 field = <text except TAB>
29398 @end example
29399
29400 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
29401 @pxref{Headers}.
29402
29403
29404 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
29405
29406 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
29407 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
29408
29409 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
29410 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
29411 server. In fact, it should do so.
29412
29413 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
29414 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
29415
29416
29417 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
29418
29419 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
29420 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
29421 reason.
29422
29423 There should be no data returned.
29424
29425
29426 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
29427
29428 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
29429 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
29430 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
29431 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
29432
29433 There should be no data returned.
29434
29435
29436 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
29437
29438 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
29439 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
29440 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
29441 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
29442
29443 There should be no data returned.
29444
29445
29446 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
29447
29448 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
29449
29450 There should be no data returned.
29451
29452
29453 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
29454
29455 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
29456 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
29457 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
29458 it would be nice if that were possible.
29459
29460 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
29461 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
29462 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
29463 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
29464 into its article buffer.
29465
29466 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
29467 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
29468 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
29469 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
29470 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
29471 on successful article retrieval.
29472
29473
29474 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST INFO)
29475
29476 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
29477 making @var{group} the current group.
29478
29479 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
29480 the current group.
29481
29482 If @var{info}, it allows the backend to update the group info
29483 structure.
29484
29485 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
29486
29487 @example
29488 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
29489 @end example
29490
29491 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
29492 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
29493 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
29494 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
29495 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
29496 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
29497 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
29498 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
29499 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
29500 highest as 0.
29501
29502 @example
29503 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
29504 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
29505 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
29506 @end example
29507
29508
29509 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29510
29511 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
29512 a no-op on most back ends.
29513
29514 There should be no data returned.
29515
29516
29517 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
29518
29519 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
29520 @emph{all}.
29521
29522 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
29523
29524 @example
29525 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
29526 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
29527 @end example
29528
29529 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
29530 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
29531 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
29532 and the highest as 0.
29533
29534 @example
29535 active-file = *active-line
29536 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
29537 name = <string>
29538 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
29539 @end example
29540
29541 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
29542 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
29543 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
29544
29545
29546 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
29547
29548 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
29549 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
29550 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
29551 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
29552 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
29553 clear if the posting could not be completed.
29554
29555 There should be no result data from this function.
29556
29557 @end table
29558
29559
29560 @node Optional Back End Functions
29561 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
29562
29563 @table @code
29564
29565 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
29566
29567 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
29568 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
29569 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
29570
29571 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
29572 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
29573 former is in the same format as the data from
29574 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
29575 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
29576
29577 @example
29578 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
29579 @end example
29580
29581
29582 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
29583
29584 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
29585 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
29586 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
29587 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
29588 should return a non-@code{nil} value (exceptionally,
29589 @code{nntp-request-update-info} always returns @code{nil} not to waste
29590 the network resources).
29591
29592 There should be no result data from this function.
29593
29594
29595 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
29596
29597 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
29598 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
29599 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
29600 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
29601 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
29602 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
29603 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
29604 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
29605
29606 There should be no result data from this function.
29607
29608
29609 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
29610
29611 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
29612 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc.)@: internally, and store them in
29613 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
29614 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
29615 propagate the mark information to the server.
29616
29617 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
29618
29619 @example
29620 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
29621 @end example
29622
29623 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
29624 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
29625 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
29626 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
29627 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
29628 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend}, and
29629 @code{forward}, but your back end should, if possible, not limit
29630 itself to these.
29631
29632 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
29633 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
29634 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
29635 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
29636
29637 An example action list:
29638
29639 @example
29640 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
29641 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
29642 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
29643 @end example
29644
29645 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
29646 mark on (currently not used for anything).
29647
29648 There should be no result data from this function.
29649
29650 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
29651
29652 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
29653 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
29654 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
29655 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
29656 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
29657
29658 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
29659 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
29660 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
29661 expirable.
29662
29663 There should be no result data from this function.
29664
29665
29666 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
29667
29668 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
29669 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
29670 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
29671 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
29672 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
29673 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
29674 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
29675 local if that's practical.
29676
29677 There should be no result data from this function.
29678
29679
29680 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
29681
29682 The result data from this function should be a description of
29683 @var{group}.
29684
29685 @example
29686 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
29687 name = <string>
29688 description = <text>
29689 @end example
29690
29691 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
29692
29693 The result data from this function should be the description of all
29694 groups available on the server.
29695
29696 @example
29697 description-buffer = *description-line
29698 @end example
29699
29700
29701 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
29702
29703 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
29704 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
29705 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
29706 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
29707 in the active buffer format.
29708
29709 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
29710 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
29711 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
29712 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
29713 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
29714 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
29715 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
29716
29717
29718 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29719
29720 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
29721
29722 There should be no return data.
29723
29724
29725 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
29726
29727 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
29728 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
29729 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
29730 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
29731 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
29732 they are.
29733
29734 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
29735 able to delete.
29736
29737 There should be no result data returned.
29738
29739
29740 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
29741
29742 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
29743 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
29744
29745 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
29746 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
29747 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
29748 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
29749 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
29750 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
29751
29752 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
29753 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
29754 optimizations.
29755
29756 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29757 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29758
29759 There should be no data returned.
29760
29761
29762 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
29763
29764 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
29765 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
29766 this function in short order.
29767
29768 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29769 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29770
29771 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
29772 article for that group.
29773
29774 There should be no data returned.
29775
29776
29777 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
29778
29779 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
29780 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
29781
29782 There should be no data returned.
29783
29784
29785 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
29786
29787 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
29788 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
29789 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
29790
29791 There should be no data returned.
29792
29793
29794 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
29795
29796 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
29797 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
29798
29799 There should be no data returned.
29800
29801 @end table
29802
29803
29804 @node Error Messaging
29805 @subsubsection Error Messaging
29806
29807 @findex nnheader-report
29808 @findex nnheader-get-report
29809 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
29810 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
29811 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
29812 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
29813 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
29814 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
29815
29816 @lisp
29817 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
29818
29819 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
29820 @end lisp
29821
29822 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
29823 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
29824 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
29825 takes one argument---the server symbol.
29826
29827 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
29828 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
29829 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
29830
29831
29832 @node Writing New Back Ends
29833 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
29834
29835 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
29836 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
29837 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
29838 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
29839 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
29840 editing articles.
29841
29842 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
29843 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
29844 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
29845
29846 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
29847 package called @code{nnoo}.
29848
29849 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
29850 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
29851 following macros:
29852
29853 @table @code
29854
29855 @item nnoo-declare
29856 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
29857 parameters. For instance:
29858
29859 @lisp
29860 (nnoo-declare nndir
29861 nnml nnmh)
29862 @end lisp
29863
29864 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
29865 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
29866
29867 @item defvoo
29868 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
29869 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
29870 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
29871
29872 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
29873 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
29874 a function in those back ends.
29875
29876 @lisp
29877 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
29878 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29879 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29880 @end lisp
29881
29882 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
29883 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
29884 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
29885
29886 @item nnoo-define-basics
29887 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
29888 have.
29889
29890 @lisp
29891 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29892 @end lisp
29893
29894 @item deffoo
29895 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
29896 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
29897 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
29898
29899 @item nnoo-map-functions
29900 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
29901 functions from the parent back ends.
29902
29903 @lisp
29904 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
29905 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29906 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
29907 @end lisp
29908
29909 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
29910 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
29911 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
29912 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
29913
29914 @item nnoo-import
29915 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
29916 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
29917 haven't already been defined.
29918
29919 @lisp
29920 (nnoo-import nndir
29921 (nnmh
29922 nnmh-request-list
29923 nnmh-request-newgroups)
29924 (nnml))
29925 @end lisp
29926
29927 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
29928 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
29929 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
29930 defined now.
29931
29932 @end table
29933
29934 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
29935
29936 @lisp
29937 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
29938 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,1996 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
29939
29940 ;;; @r{Code:}
29941
29942 (require 'nnheader)
29943 (require 'nnmh)
29944 (require 'nnml)
29945 (require 'nnoo)
29946 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
29947
29948 (nnoo-declare nndir
29949 nnml nnmh)
29950
29951 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
29952 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29953 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29954
29955 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
29956 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
29957 nnml-nov-is-evil)
29958
29959 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
29960 nil
29961 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
29962 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
29963 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
29964
29965 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
29966 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
29967
29968 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
29969
29970 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29971
29972 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
29973 (setq nndir-directory
29974 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
29975 server))
29976 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
29977 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
29978 (push `(nndir-current-group
29979 ,(file-name-nondirectory
29980 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29981 defs)
29982 (push `(nndir-top-directory
29983 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29984 defs)
29985 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
29986
29987 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
29988 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29989 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29990 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
29991 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
29992
29993 (nnoo-import nndir
29994 (nnmh
29995 nnmh-status-message
29996 nnmh-request-list
29997 nnmh-request-newgroups))
29998
29999 (provide 'nndir)
30000 @end lisp
30001
30002
30003 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
30004 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
30005
30006 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
30007 @findex gnus-declare-backend
30008 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
30009 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
30010 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
30011
30012 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
30013 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
30014
30015 Here's an example:
30016
30017 @lisp
30018 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
30019 @end lisp
30020
30021 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
30022
30023 The abilities can be:
30024
30025 @table @code
30026 @item mail
30027 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
30028 @item post
30029 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
30030 @item post-mail
30031 This back end supports both mail and news.
30032 @item none
30033 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
30034 different.
30035 @item respool
30036 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
30037 articles and groups.
30038 @item address
30039 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
30040 true for almost all back ends.
30041 @item prompt-address
30042 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
30043 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
30044 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
30045 @end table
30046
30047
30048 @node Mail-like Back Ends
30049 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
30050
30051 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
30052 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
30053 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
30054 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
30055
30056 @lisp
30057 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
30058 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
30059 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
30060 @end lisp
30061
30062 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
30063 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
30064 mail.
30065
30066 This function takes four parameters.
30067
30068 @table @var
30069 @item method
30070 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
30071 the call.
30072
30073 @item exit-function
30074 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
30075
30076 @item temp-directory
30077 Where the temporary files should be stored.
30078
30079 @item group
30080 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
30081 performed for one group only.
30082 @end table
30083
30084 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
30085 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
30086 find the article number assigned to this article.
30087
30088 The function also uses the following variables:
30089 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
30090 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
30091 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
30092 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
30093 this:
30094
30095 @example
30096 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
30097 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
30098 @end example
30099
30100
30101 @node Score File Syntax
30102 @subsection Score File Syntax
30103
30104 Score files are meant to be easily parsable, but yet extremely
30105 malleable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
30106 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
30107
30108 Here's a typical score file:
30109
30110 @lisp
30111 (("summary"
30112 ("Windows 95" -10000 nil s)
30113 ("Gnus"))
30114 ("from"
30115 ("Lars" -1000))
30116 (mark -100))
30117 @end lisp
30118
30119 BNF definition of a score file:
30120
30121 @example
30122 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
30123 element = rule / atom
30124 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
30125 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
30126 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
30127 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
30128 quote = <ascii 34>
30129 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
30130 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
30131 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
30132 date-header = "date"
30133 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30134 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30135 score = "nil" / <integer>
30136 date = "nil" / <natural number>
30137 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
30138 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
30139 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
30140 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
30141 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30142 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30143 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
30144 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30145 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
30146 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
30147 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
30148 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
30149 exclude-files / read-only / touched
30150 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
30151 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
30152 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
30153 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
30154 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
30155 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
30156 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
30157 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
30158 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
30159 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
30160 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
30161 eval = "eval" space <form>
30162 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
30163 @end example
30164
30165 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
30166 discarded.
30167
30168 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
30169 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
30170 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
30171 one looong line, then that's ok.
30172
30173 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
30174 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
30175
30176
30177 @node Headers
30178 @subsection Headers
30179
30180 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
30181 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
30182 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
30183 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
30184
30185 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
30186 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
30187 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
30188 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
30189 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
30190 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
30191 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
30192
30193 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
30194 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
30195 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
30196 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
30197 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
30198
30199 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
30200 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
30201
30202
30203 @node Ranges
30204 @subsection Ranges
30205
30206 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
30207 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
30208
30209 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
30210 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
30211 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
30212 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
30213
30214 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
30215 sequence.
30216
30217 @example
30218 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
30219 @end example
30220
30221 is transformed into
30222
30223 @example
30224 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
30225 @end example
30226
30227 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
30228 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
30229
30230 @example
30231 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
30232 @end example
30233
30234 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
30235 is slightly tricky:
30236
30237 @example
30238 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
30239 @end example
30240
30241 and
30242
30243 @example
30244 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
30245 @end example
30246
30247 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
30248
30249 @example
30250 (1 2 3 4 5)
30251 @end example
30252
30253 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
30254 also valid:
30255
30256 @example
30257 (1 . 5)
30258 @end example
30259
30260 and is equal to the previous range.
30261
30262 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
30263 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
30264 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
30265 range handling.)
30266
30267 @example
30268 range = simple-range / normal-range
30269 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
30270 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
30271 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
30272 number *[ " " contents ]
30273 @end example
30274
30275 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
30276 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
30277 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
30278 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
30279 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
30280 sequences.)
30281
30282
30283 @node Group Info
30284 @subsection Group Info
30285
30286 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
30287 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
30288 describes the group.
30289
30290 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
30291 second is a more complex one:
30292
30293 @example
30294 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
30295
30296 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
30297 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
30298 (nnml "")
30299 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
30300 @end example
30301
30302 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
30303 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
30304 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
30305 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
30306 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
30307 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
30308 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
30309 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
30310 this section is about.
30311
30312 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
30313 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
30314 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
30315
30316 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
30317
30318 @example
30319 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
30320 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
30321 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30322 group = quote <string> quote
30323 ralevel = rank / level
30324 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30325 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
30326 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30327 read = range
30328 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
30329 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
30330 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
30331 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
30332 @end example
30333
30334 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
30335 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
30336 in pseudo-BNF.
30337
30338 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
30339 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
30340
30341 @table @code
30342 @item gnus-info-group
30343 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
30344 @findex gnus-info-group
30345 @findex gnus-info-set-group
30346 Get/set the group name.
30347
30348 @item gnus-info-rank
30349 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
30350 @findex gnus-info-rank
30351 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
30352 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
30353
30354 @item gnus-info-level
30355 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
30356 @findex gnus-info-level
30357 @findex gnus-info-set-level
30358 Get/set the group level.
30359
30360 @item gnus-info-score
30361 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
30362 @findex gnus-info-score
30363 @findex gnus-info-set-score
30364 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
30365
30366 @item gnus-info-read
30367 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
30368 @findex gnus-info-read
30369 @findex gnus-info-set-read
30370 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
30371
30372 @item gnus-info-marks
30373 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
30374 @findex gnus-info-marks
30375 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
30376 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
30377
30378 @item gnus-info-method
30379 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
30380 @findex gnus-info-method
30381 @findex gnus-info-set-method
30382 Get/set the group select method.
30383
30384 @item gnus-info-params
30385 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
30386 @findex gnus-info-params
30387 @findex gnus-info-set-params
30388 Get/set the group parameters.
30389 @end table
30390
30391 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
30392 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
30393
30394 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
30395 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
30396 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
30397 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
30398
30399
30400 @node Extended Interactive
30401 @subsection Extended Interactive
30402 @cindex interactive
30403 @findex gnus-interactive
30404
30405 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
30406 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
30407 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
30408
30409 @lisp
30410 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
30411 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
30412 ...
30413 )
30414 @end lisp
30415
30416 The best thing to do would have been to implement
30417 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
30418 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
30419 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
30420 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
30421 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
30422 @code{interactive}.
30423
30424 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
30425 adds a few more.
30426
30427 @table @samp
30428 @item y
30429 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
30430 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
30431 variable.
30432
30433 @item Y
30434 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
30435 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
30436 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
30437
30438 @item A
30439 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
30440 function.
30441
30442 @item H
30443 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
30444 function.
30445
30446 @item g
30447 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
30448 function.
30449
30450 @end table
30451
30452
30453 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
30454 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
30455 @cindex XEmacs
30456 @cindex Emacsen
30457
30458 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
30459 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
30460 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
30461
30462 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
30463 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
30464 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
30465 Gnus, that's very useful.
30466
30467 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
30468 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
30469 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
30470 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
30471 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
30472 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
30473 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
30474 following function:
30475
30476 @lisp
30477 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
30478 (start-itimer
30479 "gnus-run-at-time"
30480 `(lambda ()
30481 (,function ,@@args))
30482 time repeat))
30483 @end lisp
30484
30485 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
30486 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
30487 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
30488 all over.
30489
30490 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
30491 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
30492 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
30493
30494 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
30495 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
30496 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
30497
30498
30499 @node Various File Formats
30500 @subsection Various File Formats
30501
30502 @menu
30503 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
30504 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
30505 @end menu
30506
30507
30508 @node Active File Format
30509 @subsubsection Active File Format
30510
30511 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
30512 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
30513 in each group.
30514
30515 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
30516
30517 @example
30518 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
30519 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
30520 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
30521 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
30522 no.general 1000 900 y
30523 @end example
30524
30525 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
30526
30527 @example
30528 active = *group-line
30529 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
30530 group = <non-white-space string>
30531 spc = " "
30532 high-number = <non-negative integer>
30533 low-number = <positive integer>
30534 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
30535 @end example
30536
30537 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
30538 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
30539
30540
30541 @node Newsgroups File Format
30542 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
30543
30544 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
30545 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
30546 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
30547 the user.
30548
30549 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
30550 Here's the definition:
30551
30552 @example
30553 newsgroups = *line
30554 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
30555 group = <non-white-space string>
30556 tab = <TAB>
30557 description = <string>
30558 @end example
30559
30560
30561 @page
30562 @node Emacs for Heathens
30563 @section Emacs for Heathens
30564
30565 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
30566 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
30567 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
30568 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
30569 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
30570 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
30571 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
30572 cat instead.
30573
30574 @menu
30575 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
30576 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
30577 @end menu
30578
30579
30580 @node Keystrokes
30581 @subsection Keystrokes
30582
30583 @itemize @bullet
30584 @item
30585 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
30586
30587 @item
30588 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
30589 @end itemize
30590
30591 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
30592 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
30593 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
30594 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
30595 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
30596 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
30597
30598 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
30599 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
30600 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
30601 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
30602 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
30603 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
30604 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
30605
30606 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
30607 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
30608 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
30609 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
30610 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
30611 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
30612 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
30613
30614 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
30615 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
30616 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
30617 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
30618 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
30619 it.
30620
30621
30622
30623 @node Emacs Lisp
30624 @subsection Emacs Lisp
30625
30626 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
30627 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
30628 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
30629 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
30630
30631 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
30632 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
30633 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
30634 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
30635 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
30636 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
30637 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
30638 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
30639 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
30640 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
30641
30642 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
30643 write the following:
30644
30645 @lisp
30646 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
30647 @end lisp
30648
30649 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
30650 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
30651 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
30652 change how Gnus works.
30653
30654 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
30655 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
30656 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
30657 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
30658 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
30659
30660 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
30661 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
30662 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
30663
30664 Some pitfalls:
30665
30666 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
30667 that means:
30668
30669 @lisp
30670 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
30671 @end lisp
30672
30673 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server-file} to
30674 @samp{/etc/nntpserver}'', that means:
30675
30676 @lisp
30677 (setq gnus-nntp-server-file "/etc/nntpserver")
30678 @end lisp
30679
30680 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
30681 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
30682
30683 @page
30684 @include gnus-faq.texi
30685
30686 @node GNU Free Documentation License
30687 @chapter GNU Free Documentation License
30688 @include doclicense.texi
30689
30690 @node Index
30691 @chapter Index
30692 @printindex cp
30693
30694 @node Key Index
30695 @chapter Key Index
30696 @printindex ky
30697
30698 @bye
30699
30700 @iftex
30701 @iflatex
30702 \end{document}
30703 @end iflatex
30704 @end iftex
30705
30706 @c Local Variables:
30707 @c mode: texinfo
30708 @c coding: utf-8
30709 @c End: